Taxation II
Taxation II
TAXATION 2
STUDY MANUAL
(COVERING FINANCE ACT 2011)
CA in Bangladesh
www.facebook.com/cainbd
.
www.icab.org.bd
PARTNER IN LEARNING
Taxation II
The Institute of Chartered Accountants of Bangladesh Professional Stage
The learning materials have been prepared by the Institute of Chartered Accountants of Bangladesh
All rights reserved. No part of this publication may be reproduced in any form or by any means or stored
in any retrieval system, or transmitted in, any form or by any means, electronic, mechanical,
photocopying, recording or otherwise without prior permission of the publisher.
Contents
Page
Introduction
Study guide
Getting help
Agriculture income
Capital gains
10
11
Depreciation allowances
12
13
14
15
16
17
Assessment
18
Assessment of individuals
19
20
Assessment of companies
21
22
23
24
Imposition of Penalty
25
Recovery of Tax
26
27
Refunds
28
29
Miscellaneous
30
31
Ethics
Sample Paper
Sample Paper Answers
Introduction
1.1
What is Taxation and how does it fit within the Professional Stage?
Structure
The syllabus has been designed to develop core technical, commercial, and ethical skills and
knowledge in a structured and rigorous manner.
The diagram below shows the twelve modules at the Professional Stage, where the focus is on the
acquisition and application of technical skills and knowledge, and the Advanced Stage which
comprises of two technical integration modules and the Case Study.
Ethics
Ethics
Ethics
Ethics
Advance Audit
and Assurance
Business Analysis
Financial and
Corporate Reporting
Ethics
Business
strategy
Ethics
Business
Financial
management
Financial
accounting
Management
information
Accounting
Advanced stage
Ethics
Ethics
Ethics
Financial
reporting
Audit and
assurance
Taxation
Ethics
Ethics
Ethics
Assurance
Principles
of Taxation
Law
Application
modules
Knowledge
modules
Case Study
Professional stage
The above illustrates how the knowledge of taxation principles gives a platform from which a
progression of skills and taxation expertise is developed.
1.2
2
2.1
2.2
Specification grid
This grid shows the relative weightings of subjects within this module and should guide the relative
study time spent on each. Over time the marks available in the assessment will equate to the
weightings below, while slight variations may occur in individual assessments to enable suitably
rigorous questions to be set.
Weighting (%)
Ethical considerations
10
30
30
10
20
100
Learning objectives
Practical significance
Working context
Syllabus links
Examination context
Exam requirements
Chapter topics
Problems
Answers
The technical reference section is designed to assist you when you are working in the office. It
should help you to know where to look for further information on the topics covered. You will
not be examined on the contents of this section in your examination.
4
4.1
Study guide
Help yourself study for your ACA exams
Exams for professional bodies such as the ICAEW are very different from those you have taken at
college or university. You will be under greater time pressure before the exam as you may
be combining your study with work. Here are some hints and tips.
The right approach
1
Study cycle
The best way to approach this Study Manual is to tackle the chapters in order. We will look in
detail at how to approach each chapter below but as a general guide, taking into account your
individual learning style, you could follow this sequence for each chapter.
Key study steps
Activity
Step 1
Topic list
This topic list is shown in the contents for each chapter and helps you
navigate each part of the book; each numbered topic is a numbered
section in the chapter.
Step 2
Introduction
This sets your objectives for study by giving you the big picture in terms
of the context of the chapter. The content is referenced to the Study
guide, and Examination context guidance shows what the examiners are
looking for. The Introduction tells you why the topics covered in the
chapter need to be studied.
Section overviews give you a quick summary of the content of each of
the main chapter sections. They can also be used at the end of each
chapter to help you review each chapter quickly.
Step 3
Section overviews
Step 4
Explanations
Step 5
Note taking
Step 6
Examples
Step 7
Answers
Check yours against the suggested solutions, and make sure you
understand any discrepancies.
Step 8
Self-test
Step 9
Question practice
Moving on...
When you are ready to start revising, you should still refer back to this Study Manual.
As a source of reference (you should find the index particularly helpful for this).
As a way to review (the Section overviews, Examination context, Chapter summaries and Self
test questions help you here).
Remember to keep careful hold of this Study Manual you will find it invaluable in your work. The
technical reference section has been designed to help you in the workplace by directing you to
where you can find further information on the topics studied.
5
Getting help
Firstly, if you are receiving structured tuition, make sure you know how and when you can contact
your tutors for extra help.
Identify a work colleague who is qualified, or has at least passed the paper you are studying for,
who is willing to help if you have questions.
Form a group with a small number of other students, you can help each other and study together,
providing informal support.
e.
calculate the tax implications for an individual of different courses of action (borrowing,
investment, expenditure etc.), taking into account the relevant taxes and other
implications
Chapter 1
Introduction to Bangladesh income tax
Contents
Introduction
Examination context
Topic List
1.1
Introduction
1.2
1.3
1.4
1.5
1.6
1.7
1.8
1.9
1.10
Capital or Revenue
1.11
1.12
1.13
Liability to tax
1.14
1.15
Introduction
Learning objectives
Identify the objectives of tax in terms of economic, social justice and environmental issues
Recognise which taxes apply to different taxpayers e.g. individual, partners and companies
Identify the sources of tax law
Get the idea about the income, tax and income tax
Know the history of income tax
Recognise different rates of income tax applicable to individual, corporate and others
Understand the concept of capital and revenue expenditure
Identify the residential status of an assessee
Practical significance
Every person in Bangladesh is affected by our tax system in some ways, often on a daily basis and
without even realising it. We pay tax on the money we earn and on the things we buy and this
tax is of course used by the government to pay for our development purpose such as schools,
hospitals, roads and so on.
As government and business practices change, the tax system changes. In Bangladesh we have an
annual budget cycle which begins with the Pre Budget Report in late May/early June and ends
with the enactment of a Finance Act in June. This is supplemented by a huge body of case law and
practical interpretation. Unfortunately, the new law is usually just added to the existing law and
so the overall legislative burden increases over time. There are regular calls for a programme of
tax simplification, but although there has been much discussion, we have seen little real change.
The Income Tax Ordinance 1984, The Value Added Act 1991 are the main sources of tax law.
The National Board of Revenue (NBR), a statutory body is the highest authority for the purpose
of these Ordinance and Acts.
Income of different types is taxed at different rates. Before calculating income tax liability one
should have the concept of income, tax, income tax and income tax rate and other relevant
issues. Residential status has significance for determining tax liability.
One way of helping people to deal with complexity in the tax system is to use technology.
Presently people can use computerized system to calculate tax on his/her taxable income. Even
NBR website gives the opportunity to compute tax by using income tax calculator.
Stop and think
It is likely that you have personally been paying tax on your various sources of income/gains for some
time. Have you stopped to think about how this affects the actions that you take?
Working context
The impact of taxation on the overall economy and the society is increasing day by day. Tax is
charged on different types of assesses like individual and companies. The volume and complexity
of tax law is now such that many businesses have to spend considerable amounts of time just on
tax administration. Many business decisions will have tax consequences. Most large corporate
operate on a global basis and will choose which country they want their business to be based in.
Without advice from an accountant, a business can easily find itself paying too much tax and
missing deadlines. It is important to have a good overall feel for the tax system early in your
studies so that you know where to look for the detailed rules when you need them later on.
Syllabus links
The topics covered in this chapter are essential background knowledge which will underpin the
whole of your Taxation studies.
Examination context
Exam requirements
In the examination, candidates may be required to:
Identify the social justice principles being applied for taxation purposes
Understand which taxes apply to different taxpayers
Identify the sources of tax law in Bangladesh.
Define some terminologies relating to income tax
Determine the residential status of an assessee based on given information
Identify the five tier tax rate for individual and other tax rates for other assessees
Question practice
For question practice on these topics go to the suggested questions and answers covering the
basic idea about taxation.
1.0
Objectives
Section overview
Taxation system of Bangladesh has developed gradually and has been changed by successive
governments in accordance with their political philosophy.
Governments use taxation to encourage or discourage certain types of economic activity.
Taxation may be used to promote social justice but there is no political consensus on what is
meant by this term.
Environmental concerns have led to changes in taxation policy.
There is no exhaustive definition of income in Income Tax Ordinance 1984 (Ordinance)
Income tax is tax on income.
The Ordinance got its root in the then British India in 1860.
Different tax rates are applicable for different types of assessee and classes of income.
Income tax is levied on income and not on capital receipts.
The distinction between capital and revenue receipts is much more difficult than between
capital and revenue expenditure.
Residential status is very vital for determining tax liability.
1.1
Introduction
Among direct taxes, income tax is one of the main sources of revenue of Bangladesh
Government to generate funds for running its administration and also funding development
expenditure. It is a digressive taxation system where tax rate increases up to a certain level and
become fixed for all income exceeding that limit. Income tax is imposed on the basis of ability to
pay. The more a taxpayer earns the more he should pay''- is the basic principle of charging
income tax. It aims at ensuring equity and social justice.
Bangladesh taxation system has developed over centuries from the then British India in 1860 to
the present condition on a piecemeal basis. The system, however, developed on the basis of
generally accepted canons and there had been efforts towards rationalizing the tax administration
for optimizing revenue collection, reducing tax evasion and preventing revenue leakage through
system loss.
In the fiscal scheme of our country, at present, income tax is levied along with other direct and
indirect taxes like VAT, Excise duty, Gift tax etc.
1.2
A) Multiple tax system: The tax system of Bangladesh consists of various types of taxes which
are as follows:
I. Taxes on Income and Profit
1. Income tax - Company
2. Income tax Persons other than Company
II. Taxes on Property & Capital Transfer
1. Estate Duty
2. Gift Tax
3. Narcotics Duty
4. Land Revenue
5. Stamp Duty - non judicial
6. Registration
III. Taxes on Goods and Services
1. Customs Duties
2. Excise Duties
3. Value Added Tax (VAT)
4. Supplementary Duty (on luxury items and in addition to VAT)
5. Taxes on Vehicles
6. Electricity Duty
7. Other Taxes and Duties (travel tax, turn over tax, etc.)
B) Inadequate and stagnant revenue yield relative to GDP:
The ratio of tax revenue to GDP is very low comparing to other developing countries. We
can see the status of the ratio of tax revenue to GDP of Bangladesh in the following table for
the last six years:
Revenue as % of GDP
Total revenue
Tax Revenue
Non-tax Revenue
2005-06
10.8
8.7
2.1
2006-07
10.5
8.3
2.2
2007-08
11.1
8.8
2.3
2008-09
11.2
9.0
2.2
2009-10
11.5
9.3
2.2
2010-11
12.09
10.04
2.05
2005-06
44,868
36,175
8,693
80.63%
8,303
2006-07
49,472
39,247
10,225
79.33%
10,275
2007-08
60,539
48,012
12,527
79.31%
12,502
2008-09
69,180
55,526
13,654
80.26%
15,462
2009-10
79,484
63,956
15,528
80.46%
19,516
2010-11
95.188
79.052
16.135
83.00%
25.974
22.95%
26.18%
26.04%
27.85%
30.51%
32.90%
27,872
77.05%
28,972
73.82%
35,510
76.96%
40,064
72.15%
44,440
69.49%
53.078
67.10%
2005-06
2006-07
2007-08
2008-09
2009-10
2010-11
34.3%
22.8%
19.2%
17.7%
34.9%
21.1%
22.7%
15.5%
35.4%
19.3%
22.9%
16.6%
36.2%
17.2%
24.4%
16.4%
35.6%
16.3%
25.9%
16.4%
35.77%
13.77%
27.96%
17.15%
0.8%
0.8%
1.0%
0.8%
0.7%
0.60%
0.5%
0.5%
0.4%
0.4%
0.4%
0.35%
Over the years, many hundreds of tax cases have been brought before the courts where the
interpretation of statute law is unclear.
Decisions made by judges to resolve these cases form case law. Many judgments are precedent
for future cases which means that they must be followed unless superseded by legislation or the
decision of a higher court.
C. NBR Publication
The National Board of Revenue (NBR) is a statutory body having the highest executive authority
and empowered to make necessary rules concerning income tax matters and is authorized to
give any interpretation of any provision in any section of the Ordinance. NBR makes available
some forms, notifications, brochures, and guidelines of income tax, VAT and customs through its
websites and other forms of communication for public at large.
There are many SROs and circulars on income tax and VAT published by NBR providing
guideline for tax purpose.
The Income Tax Ordinance, 1984: The Income Tax Ordinance, 1984 came into force on 1st
July, 1984 as Income Tax Manual I. It has 23 Chapters, 187 sections, numerous subsections
and seven schedules containing provisions regarding assessment, penalty, appeal etc.
II. Income Tax Rules, 1984: Income Tax Rules, 1984 has framed various rules for the
administration of the Income Tax Ordinance, 1984 as provided therein.
III. Finance Act: To give effect to the various proposals in the annual budget covering the areas of
direct and indirect taxes, Finance Act is issued. It contains various applicable tax rates and
other amendments of the Income Tax Ordinance and Rules, 1984.
IV. SRO (Statutory Regulatory Orders): According to the Section 185 of the Income Tax
Ordinance, 1984, NBR can issue certain circulars as and when necessary. The provisions of
these SROs are also to be considered at the time of computing income tax like the
provisions of Income Tax Ordinance and Rules.
V. Income Tax Case Law: In the course of assessment proceedings, there may sometimes arise a
dispute between the NBR and the assessee over the interpretation of some of the provisions
of the act and rules. The assessee can go the court objecting the NBR's interpretation, and
the judgments given by the courts act as guidance to the assessing officers and the assessee
in similar circumstances in the future.
I.
Chapter Title
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
Sections
Preliminary
Administration
Taxes Appellate Tribunal
Charge of Income Tax
Computation of Income
Exemption and Allowances
Payment of Tax before Assessment
Return and Statement
Assessment
Liability in Special Cases
Special Provisions relating to avoidance of tax
Requirement of furnishing certain information
Registration of firms
Powers of Income Tax Authorities
Imposition of Penalty
Recovery of Tax
Double Taxation Relief
Refunds
18A
Settlement of Cases
18B
19
20
21
22
23
1-2
3-10
11-15
16-19
20-43
44-47
48-74
75-80
81-94
95-103
104-107
108-110
111 (omitted)
112-122
123-133
134-143
144-145
146-152
152A-152E
(omitted)
152F-152S
153-162
163
164-171
172-184
185-187
First Schedule:
Part-A
Title
Part B
Part - C
Third Schedule:
Fifth Schedule:
Part-A
Sixth Schedule:
Part-A
Part - B
1.7
As it has been discussed before, taxation is one of the major sources of public revenue to meet a
country's revenue and development expenditures with a view to accomplishing some
fundamental economic and social objectives, such as redistribution of income, price stabilization
and discouraging harmful consumption. The contribution of income tax is playing a pivotal role in
the economic development of Bangladesh. The government of Bangladesh has taken various
measures to modernize the tax system and imposed various provisions in the Income Tax
Ordinance, 1984. Some of the provisions are as following:
(a) Tax Holiday Scheme: According to Section 45, 46 and 47 of the ITO, 1984, an industrial
enterprise established within prescribed time limit in the prescribed area shall be exempted
from tax for period, i.e. 4 to 12 years. This is known as Tax Holiday Scheme. The main
objective of this scheme is to ensure economic development through industrialization
attracting investment in some specific sectors e.g. tourism industries.
(b) Investment allowance: Investment allowance is given on the investment in new
machineries (like machineries of new Fishing Boats & passenger boats) @ 20%, if they are
established in NBR specified areas it is 25%. This provision is also attracting investors.
(c) Accelerated Depreciation Allowance: Depreciation allowance is allowed on the new
machineries used in various industries at a specified rate (100% in first year for specified
areas, and 80% in first and 20% in the second year for industries established in other areas.)
(d) Tax incentives for Small & Cottage Industries: According to Section 47(b)(ii) tax
incentives are allowed on the income and profit of cottage industries to encourage
investment in cottage industries which can contribute to the economy significantly.
(e) Tax incentives for encouraging savings: The government also encourages savings
providing tax credit facilities on certain types of investment and expenditures. Such as,
purchase of shares and debentures, savings certificate, DPS, insurance premium, provident
fund etc.
(f) Tax exemptions in certain expenditures: Certain expenditures to enhance social
welfare like contribution to president's/prime minister's relief fund; Government Zakat fund,
Ahsania Mission Cancer Hospital etc. are exempted from tax payment. These provisions also
encourage people to spend in certain social development program.
(g) Tax incentives for foreign investors: For attracting foreign investors various
concessions like tax holiday, tax exemptions for interest, royalty, technical assistance and
fees, remittance to own country have been allowed as per the ITO, 1984.
(h) Allowance for scientific research: For developing new products, technologies in the
industrial sectors certain allowance is allowed. Tax rebate is given on the cost of relevant
scientific research.
(i) Tax incentives for remittance to Bangladesh: A significant number of Bangladeshi
people work abroad and to encourage them remittances through banking channel has been
dec1ared tax exempted.
So, it can be said that to ensure the economic development of the country certain provisions
have been introduced in the ITO, 1984. These provisions encourage not only foreign investors
but also the local entrepreneurs.
1.8 Some Definitions & Important Concepts Relating to Tax:
1. Agricultural income [U/S 2(1)]: "agricultural income" means(a) Any income derived from any land in Bangladesh and used for agricultural purposes
(i) By means of agriculture; or
(ii) By the performance of any process ordinarily employed by a cultivator to render
marketable the produce of such land; or
(iii) by the sale of the produce of the land raised by the cultivator in respect of which no
process, other than that to render the produce marketable, has been performed; or
(iv) by granting a right to any person to use the land for any period; or
(b) Any income derived from any building which(i) is occupied by the cultivator of any such land as is referred to in sub-clause (a) in which
any process is carried on to render marketable any such produce as aforesaid;
(ii) is on, or in the immediate vicinity of such land; and
(iii) is required by the cultivator as the dwelling house or store-house or other outhouse by
reason of his connection with such land.
2. Annual Value [U/S 2(3)]: "annual value" shall be deemed to be
(a) in relation to any property let out(i) the sum for which property might reasonably be expected to let from year to year and any
amount received by letting out furniture, fixture, fittings etc.; or
(ii) where the annual rent in respect thereof is in excess of the sum referred to in paragraph
(i), the amount of the annual rent.
3. Appellate Joint Commissioner [U/S 2(4)]: "Appellate Joint Commissioner" means a person appointed
to be an Appellate Joint Commissioner of Taxes U/S 3 [and includes an Appellate Additional
Commissioner of Taxes] [and also a person appointed to hold current charge of an Appellate
Joint Commissioner of Taxes].
4. Assessee [U/S 2(7)]: "Assessee", means a person by whom any tax or other sum of money is
payable under this Ordinance, and includes(a) every person in respect of whom any proceeding under this Ordinance has been taken for
the assessment of his income or the income of any other person in respect of which he is
assessable, or of the amount of refund due to him or to such other person;
(b) every person who is required to file a return U/S 75, U/S 89 or U/S 91;
(c) every person who desires to be assessed and submits his return of income under this
Ordinance; and
(d) every person who is deemed to be an assessee, or an assessee in default, under any
provision of this Ordinance;
5. Assessment [U/S 2(8)]: "assessment", with its grammatical variations and cognate expressions,
includes re-assessment and additional or further assessment;
6. Assessment Year [U/S 2(9)]: "assessment year" means the period of twelve months commencing on
the first day of July every year; and includes any such period which is deemed, under the
provisions of this Ordinance, to be assessment year in respect of any income for any period;
7. Business [U/S 2(14)]: "business" includes any trade, commerce or manufacture or any adventure
or concern in the nature of trade, commerce or manufacture;
8. Capital asset [U/S 2(15)]: "capital asset" means property of any kind held by an assessee, whether
or not connected with his business or profession, but does not include(a)
any stock-in-trade (not being stocks and shares), consumable stores or raw materials
held for the purposes of his business or profession;
(b) personal effects, that is to say, movable property (including wearing apparel, jewellery,
furniture, fixture, equipment and vehicles), which are held exclusively for personal use by,
and are not used for purposes of the business or profession of the assessee or any member
of his family dependent on him; and
(c)
(i)
in any area which is comprised within the jurisdiction of municipality (whether known
as a municipality, municipal corporation, town, or by any other name) or a cantonment
Board and which has a population of not less than ten thousand according to the last
preceding census of which the relevant figures have been published before the first day of
the income year; or
(ii) in any area within such distance not being more than five miles from the local limits of
any municipality or cantonment board referred to in paragraph (i), as the Government may
having regard to the extent of, and scope for, urbanisation of that area and other relevant
considerations, specify in this behalf by notification in the official Gazette.
9. Charitable Purpose [U/S 2(16)]: "charitable purpose" includes relief of the poor, education, medical
relief and the advancement of any object of general public utility;
10.
Child [U/S 2(18)]: "child", in relation to any individual, includes a step-child and an adopted child
of that individual;
11.
Company [U/S 2(20)]: "Company" means a company as defined in [the Companies Act, 1913
(VII of 1913) or the Companies Act, 1994 (VIII of 1994)] and includes(a) a body corporate established or constituted by or under any law for the time being in
force;
(b) any nationalized banking or other financial institution, insurance body and industrial or
business enterprise;
(bb) an association or combination of persons, called by whatever name, if any of such
persons is a company as defined in [the Companies Act, 1913 (VII of 1913) or the
Companies Act, 1994 (VllI of 1994);
(bbb) any association or body incorporated by or under the laws of a country outside
Bangladesh; and;]
(c) any foreign association or body, [not incorporated by or under any law], which the Board
may, by general or special order, declare to be a company for the purposes of this
Ordinance;
12.
13.
Deputy Commissioner of Taxes [U/S 2(23)]: "Deputy Commissioner of Taxes" means a person
appointed to be a Deputy Commissioner of Taxes U/S 3, and includes a person appointed to be
an Assistant Commissioner of Taxes, an Extra Assistant Commissioner of Taxes and a Tax
Recovery Officer;
Dividend [U/S 2(26)]: "Dividend" includes-(a) any distribution by a company of accumulated profits, whether capitalized or not, if
such distribution entails the release by the company to its shareholders of all or any part
of its assets or reserves;
(b) any distribution by a company, to the extent to which the company possesses
accumulated profits, whether capitalized or not, to its shareholders of debentures,
debenture-stock or deposit certificates in any form, whether with or without interest;
(c)
any distribution made to the shareholders of a company on its liquidation to the
extent to which the distribution is attributable to the accumulated profits of the company
immediately before its liquidation, whether capitalized or not;
(d)
any distribution by a company to its shareholders on the reduction of its capital,
to the extent to which the company possesses accumulated profits, whether such
accumulated- profits have been capitalized or not;
(dd)
any profit remitted outside Bangladesh by a company not incorporated in
Bangladesh under the Companies Act, 1994 (VIII of 1994);
(e)
any payment by a private company of any sum (whether as representing a part of
the assets of the company or otherwise) by way of advance or loan to a shareholder or
any payment by any such company on behalf, or for the individual benefit, of any such
shareholder, to the extent to which the company, in either case, possesses accumulated
profit; but does not include-(i)
a distribution made in accordance with sub-clause (c) or sub-clause (d) in respect
of any share including preference share for full cash consideration, or redemption of
debentures or debenture-stock, where the holder of the share or debenture is not
entitled in the event of liquidation to participate in the surplus assets;
(ii)
any advance or loan made to a shareholder in the ordinary course of its business,
where the lending of money is a substantial part of the business of the company; (iiia) any
bonus share issued by a company.
14.
15.
16.
17.
18.
Fees for Technical Services [U/S 2(31)]: "fees for technical services" means any consideration
(including any lump sum consideration) for the rendering of any managerial, technical or consultancy
services (including the provision of services of technical or other personnel) but does not include
consideration for any construction, assembly, mining or like project undertaken by the recipient, or
consideration which would be income of the recipient classifiable under the head "Salaries";
Income [U/S 2(34)]: "income" includes-(a)
any income, profits or gains, from whatever source derived, chargeable to tax
under any provision of this Ordinance under any head specified in U/S 20;
(b)
(c)
the profits and gains of any business of insurance carried on by a mutual insurance
association computed in accordance with paragraph 8 of the Fourth Schedule;
(d)
any sum deemed to be income, or any income accruing or arising or received, or
deemed to accrue or arise or be received in Bangladesh under any provision of this
Ordinance.
19.
Income Year [U/S 2(35)]: "income year", in respect of any separate source of income, means:
(a)
(b)
where the accounts of the assesses have been made up to a date within the said .
financial year and the assesses so opts, the twelve months ending on such date; or
(c)
in the case of a business or profession newly set up in the said financial year, the
period beginning with the date of the setting up of the business or profession and (i)
(ii)
where the accounts of the assesses have been made up to a date within the said
financial year and the assesses so opts, ending on that date; or
(d)
in the case of a business or profession newly set up in the twelve months
immediately preceding the said financial year -
(i)
if the accounts of the assessee have been made up to a date within the said
financial year and the period from the date of the setting up of the business or
profession to the first-mentioned date does not exceed twelve months, then, at
the option of the assesses, such period, or
(ii)
if any period has been determined under sub-clause (e), then the period beginning
with the date of the setting up of the business or profession and ending with the
last day of that period, as the case may be; or
(e)
in the case of any person or class of persons or any business or profession or
class of business or profession such period as may be determ;'led by the Board or by such
authority as the Board may authorize in this behalf;
(f)
in respect of the assessee's share in the income of a firm of which the assessee is a
partner and the firm has been assessed as such, the period determined as the income year
for the assessment of income of the firm;
(g)
where in respect of a particular source of income an assessee has once been
assessed or where in respect of a business or profession newly set up, an assessee has
once exercised the option under sub-clause (b) or sub-clause (c) (ii) or sub clause (d) (i)
then, he shall not, in respect of that source, or, as the case may be, business or profession,
be entitled to vary the meaning of the expression "income year" as then applicable to him,
except with the consent of the Deputy Commissioner of Taxes upon such conditions as
the Deputy Commissioner of Taxes may think fit to impose.
20.
21.
Interest [U/S 2(38)]: "Interest" means interest:payable ill any manner in respect of any money
borrowed or debt incurred (including a deposit, claim or other similar right or obligation) and
includes any service fee or other charge in respect of the money borrowed or debt incurred or in
respect of any credit facility which has not been utilized;
Market Value [U/S 2(40)]: "market value", in respect of agricultural produce, means:
(a)
where such produce is ordinarily sold in the market in its raw state or after
application to it of any process employed by a cultivator to render it fit to be taken to the
market, the value calculated according to the average price at which it has been sold
during the year previous to that in which the income derived from such produce first
becomes assessable; and
(b)
where such produce is not ordinarily sold in the market in its raw state, the
aggregate of
(i)
(ii)
the land development tax or rent paid for the lands in which it was grown; and
(iii)
such amount as the Deputy Commissioner of Taxes finds, having regard to the
circumstances of each case, to represent a reasonable rate of profit on the sale of
the produce in question as agricultural produce;
22.
23.
24.
25.
Person [U/S 2(46)]: "person" includes an individual, a firm, an association of persons, a Hindu
undivided family, a local authority, a company and every other artificial juridical person;
Profits in lieu of salary [U/S 2(50)]: "profits in lieu of salary" includes--
(a)
the amount of compensation due to, or received by, an assessee from his
employer at, or in connection with, the termination of, or the modification of any terms
and conditions relating to, his employment; and
(b)
any payment due to, or received by, an assesses from a provident or other fund to
the extent to which it does not consist of contributions by the assesses and the interest
on such contributions;
26.
27.
Recognized Provident Fund [U/S 2(52)]: "recognizled provident fund" means a provident fund which
has been, and continues to be, recognized by the Commissioner in accordance with the provisions qf
Part B of the First Schedule;
Resident [U/S 2(55)]: "resident", in respect of any income year, means
(a)
(i)
for a period of, or for periods amounting in all to, one hundred and eighty two
days or more in that year; or
(ii)
for a period of, or periods amounting in all to, ninety days or more in that year
having previously been in Bangladesh for a period of, or periods amounting in all
to, three hundred and sixty-five days or more during four years preceding that
year;
(b)
a Hindu undivided family, firm or other association of persons, the control and
management of whose affairs is situated wholly or partly in Bangladesh in that year; and
(c)
a Bangladeshi company or any other company the control and management of
whose affairs is situated wholly in Bangladesh in that year;
28.
Royalty [U/S 2(56)]: "royalty" means consideration (including any lump sum consideration but
excluding any consideration which is classifiable as income of the recipient under the head "Capital
gains") for -(a)
transfer of all or any rights, including the granting of a license in respect of a
patent, invention, model, design, secret process or formula, or trade mark or similar
property;
(b)
the imparting of any information concerning the working of, or the use of, a
patent, invention, model, design, secret process or formula, or trade mark or similar
property;
(c)
the use of any patent, invention, model, design, secret process or formula, or
trade mark or similar property;
(d)
the imparting of any information concerning technical, industrial, commercial, or
scientific knowledge, experience or skill;
(e)
the transfer of all or any rights, including granting of a license, in respect of any
copyright, literary. artistic or scientific work, including films or video tapes for use in
connection with television or tapes for use in connection with radio broadcasting, but not
including consideration for sale, distribution or exhibition of cinematograph films; or
(f)
the rendering of any services in connection with any of the aforesaid activities;
29.
Tax [U/S 2(62)]: "tax" means the income tax payable under this Ordinance and includes any
additional tax, excess profit tax, penalty, interest, fee or other charges leviable or payable under this
Ordinance;
30.
Total income [U/S 2(65)]: "total income" means the total amount of income referred to in section 17
computed in the manner laid down in this Ordinance, and includes any income which, under any
provision of this Ordinance, is to be included in the total income of an assessee;
31.
Transfer [U/S 2(66)]: "transfer", in relation to a capital asset, includes the sale, exchange or
relinquishment of the asset, or the extinguishment of any right therein, but does not include(a)
any transfer of the capital asset under a gift, bequest, will or an irrevocable trust;
(b)
and (c) any distribution of capital assets on the dissolution of a firm or other association of
persons or on the partition of a Hindu undivided family;
32.
Income is a more general term than profits or gains. The words income, profits and gains are used
in a distinctive sense, and the word income is not limited by the words profits and gains. A
receipt may be taxable as income, although it may contain no element of profits or gain. Profits or
gains mean something which is in the nature of interest or fruit, as opposed to principal or tree.
Gains is really equivalent to profits. The profit of a trade or business is the surplus by which the
receipts from the trade or business exceed the expenditure necessary for the purpose of earning
these receipts.
Section 2(34) of the Income Tax Ordinance 1984 gives a definition of Income as under:
Income Includesa) Any income, profits and gains, from whatever source derived, chargeable to tax under any
provision of the ordinance under any head specified in section 20;
(b) Any loss of such income, profits or gains;
(c) The profits and gains of any business of insurance carried on by a mutual insurance
association computed in accordance with paragraph 8 of the Fourth Schedule;
(d) Any sum deemed to be income, or any sum accruing or arising or received, in Bangladesh
under any provision of the Ordinance;
But the amount of any bonus share or the amount of bonus declared to rise paid up share capital
shall not be included as income of that shareholder.
To understand the true nature of income, the following two case decisions can be referred to:(a)
return, excluding anything in the nature of a mere windfall. Income is essentially the
product of something which is often loosely spoken as capital. It is not correct to say that
every receipt which is not a capital is assessable. On the other hand, it is only receipts that
are of the nature of income receipts that are assessable.
(b)
Therefore, for the purposes of the Income Tax Ordinance 1984, income is a periodical monetary
return coming in with some sort of regularity or expected regularity from a definite source, not
excluded by the Ordinance.
Capital or Revenue
Difference between capital and revenue is of vital importance. Income tax is levied on
income and not on capital receipts. While ascertaining the profits of a business or
profession, the revenue expenditure and not the capital expenditure is deductible from the
trading receipts. Courts have often observed that it may conclusively be judged that a particular
receipt is a capital or a revenue receipt. Decided cases merely illustrate and not all are perfect
guides.
The distinction between capital and revenue receipts is much more difficult than between capital
and revenue expenditure. There are no hard and fast rules which may help in determining
whether a particular receipt is a capital or a revenue receipt.
Whether a particular expenditure is incurred solely to earn profit or whether it is a capital
expenditure depends in each case on the nature of business, commercial practice, the nature of
the expenditure and other relative circumstances. No rigid rules can be laid down in this
connection.
1.11
1.12
(a) The limit of Total Income NOT liable to Income Tax for the Assessment year 2011-12
stands at Tk. 180,000.
Tax exempted ceiling of income for Female assessee, senior citizens at age 65 or above will
be TK. 200,000 and that for handicapped/disabled persons will be Tk. 250,000 for the
assessment year 2011-2012.
The comparative FIVE Tier tax rates for two assessment years are given below:
Tier
1
2
3
4
5
(b)
(ii)
@ 37.5% if declared dividend is less than 10% or the declared dividend is not
paid within SEC stipulated time (60 days of such declaration).
However, the rate will be reduced to 35% if such company is publicly traded.
(d)
Inter-Corporate Tax Rate (Tax Rate on Dividend) for 2011-12 assessment years
(a) Company
(i)
(ii)
If dividend declared by a company registered under Company Act 1994 or any profit
remitted outside Bangladesh by a company not incorporated in Bangladesh under
Company Act 1994, the rate on such dividend or profit is 20%.
10% to 15% in relation to a non-resident company resident of a country with whom
there is Double Taxation Agreement with Bangladesh.
(b) Individual
(i) Resident at a rate applicable to his total income
(ii) Non-resident - @ 25%
(iii) 15% if the non-resident is resident of a country with whom there is Double Taxation
Agreement with Bangladesh.
Tax Rate for Non-Resident
Tax rate for non-resident (Other than Non Resident Companies and Non-Resident Bangladeshi)
is maximum that is @ 25%.
Capital Gain Tax Rate (Paragraph 2 of the Second Schedule)
(a)
Capital gain on Capital assets other than Shares referred to in clause (b)
below:
(1) Companies: @ 15%.
(2) Other assessees:
(i) Disposal within 5 years: at regular rates applicable to assessees total income
including capital gains.
(ii) Disposal after 5 years: at regular rates applicable to total income (including
capital gains) or at 15%, whichever is lower.
(b)
1.13
Liability to tax
A.
Individuals
An individual is taxed annually on his income at the rate determined with reference to the
Finance Act enacted in every financial year.
B.
Partnerships
Companies
A company is a legal person which is legally separate from its owners (shareholders) and its
managers (directors). For the purpose of income tax the meaning of company is defined under
section 2(20) of Income Tax Ordinance 1984 (hereinafter referred to as the Ordinance).
A company is liable to the following taxes:
A company is liable to corporation tax, the rate being determined with reference to the Finance
Act enacted in every financial year.
1.14
a) the financial year (July to June) immediately preceding the assessment year.
b) If the accounts of an assessee (generally engaged in business or profession) have been made up to
a date within the said financial year, the period ending on that date.
c) If, a business or profession is newly set up in the said financial year, the period from the starting
up of business or profession to the end of the financial year or where the accounts have been
made up to a date within the said financial year, the period ending on that date.
d) The Board may determine such period as income year in the case of any person or class of
persons or any business or profession or class of business or professions (such as industrial units
under various Sector Corporations).
e) If the assessee is a partner of a firm and the firm has been assessed as such, the period
determined as the income year for the assessment of income of the firm.
f)
An assessee engaged in business or profession, once adopted a period as income year cannot
change the income year without the consent of the Deputy Commissioner of Taxes upon such
conditions as the Deputy Commissioner of Taxes thinks fit to impose.
Normally, income year of an individual, except engaging in business or profession ends on 30th
June of a year. An income year cannot exceed a period of twelve calendar months.
1.15
Assessment year:
Assessment year means the year following the financial year, i.e. income year. Thus, the
assessment year always begins on 1st July and ends on 30th June every year. This period is also known
as the financial year. Accordingly, it is the current financial year in which income of the immediately
preceding financial year (known as income year) is assessed.
As per section 2(9) of the ITO, 1984; the term "Assessment year" means the period of twelve
months commencing on the first day of July every year.
From the following example, we can see how to find out the assessment year:
Example 1
Accounting year ends on
30.06.2007
30.09.2007
31.12.2007
31.03.2008
Income year
Assessment year
2006- 07
2007- 08
2007- 08
2007- 08
2007- 08
2008- 09
2008- 09
2008- 09
31.07.2008
2008- 09
2009- 10
Example 2
Income year
01.01.08 to 31.12.08
Assessment year
2009 - 2010
01.03.08 to 31.12.08
2009 -2010
01.08.08 to 31.07.09
2010 - 2011
Solution
Upon taking approval from the Deputy Commissioner of Taxes, the assessee can close its next
annual accounts for six months period on 31st December 2010 and the income arising therefrom
would be assessed in the assessment year 2011-12.
Worked Example -1.2
An assessee regularly closes its annual accounts on 31st December and his last assessment for the
assessment year 2011-12, corresponding to the accounting year ended 31st December, 2010 was
completed. The assessee has decided to change its next annual accounts on 30th June. Determine
the date when should this assessee close its next annual accounts.
Solution
Here the assessee would not be allowed to close its next annual accounts on 30th June 2011.
Because assessment of income arising therefrom becomes assessable in the assessment year
2011-12 when assessment for this assessment year had already been completed based on the
accounts ended 31st December 2010. As such he would be required to close next annual
accounts on 30th June 2011, which would comprise a period of eighteen months.
Worked Example 1.3
Can an assessee change its annual accounts closing date? If so, under what conditions?
Solution
Different classes of
assessee:
Firm
Artificial Judicial Person
Association of Person
Local Authority
Company
Hindu Undivided Family
On the basis of
Residential Status
An assessee is allowed to
change its annual accounts
closing date upon taking
approval from the Deputy
Commissioner of Taxes and
on such conditions as the
Deputy Commissioner of
Taxes thinks fit to impose.
As for example, if due to
change of accounting year,
the assessees tax burden is
reduced the Deputy
Commissioner of Taxes is
entitled to charge tax at a
higher rate applicable for the
assessment year had no
change in closing date of
accounts occurred.
Assessee
Individual
Resident
Non-resident
Bangladeshi
Non-resident
Foreigner
Non-resident
As per ITO, 1984, assessee
is a person who is liable to
pay any sum under the Income Tax Ordinance, 1984 or in respect of whom the proceedings
have been under this Ordinance. The below diagram depicts the different classes of assessee:
Residential status of an assessee:
Section 2(55) defines the term resident as follows:- Resident, in respect of any income year,
means(a) an individual who has been in Bangladesh(i)
for a period of, or for periods amounting in all to, one hundred and eighty-two days
or more in that year; or
(ii)
for a period of, or for periods amounting in all to ninety days or more in that year
having previously been in Bangladesh for a period of, or for periods amounting in all
to three hundred and sixty-five days or more during four years preceding that year;
(b)
a Hindu un-dividend family, firm or other association of persons, the control and
management of whose affairs is situated wholly or partly in Bangladesh in that year; and
(c)
a Bangladeshi company or any other company the control and management of whose affairs is
situated wholly in Bangladesh in that year;
and, under section 2(42), non-resident means a person who is not a resident.
It is important to note here that the concept of resident as defined in the Income Tax Ordinance
has nothing to do with the nationality of a particular individual. A foreign national may be treated
as Resident for a particular year if he or she fulfils the legal requirements as above, where as a
Bangladeshi national may be treated as a Non-resident if he, or she does not fulfill the said
requirements. To test residential status of an individual, the following flow chart will be helpful:
Non resident
Foreigner (NRF)
Non resident
Bangladeshi (NRB)
Yes
No
Non-resident
No
No
90 days or more
of an income
year?
Yes
No
Yes
Resident
Taxation implication of resident or non-resident
Determination of residential status of an assessee has a significance bearing on the tax liability as
incidence of income tax varies according to the residential status of an assessee. In this regard
we can consider the following issues:
I. To determine the amount of total income: Determination of total income is different for
residents and non-residents. A resident considers global income as his total income but a
non-resident does not consider income from other countries in his total income.
II. To determine minimum limit of taxable income: A resident and non-resident Bangladeshi has to
pay tax if his total taxable income is more than Tk. 1,65,000 as per the Ordinance (in case of
women, elderly citizens being more than 65 years old, the limit is Tk. 1,80,000 and disable
persons the limit is Tk. 2,00,0000). But for a non-resident foreigner such minimum limit is not
applicable.
III. Tax rate: For a resident an non-resident Bangladeshi tax is calculated using the rates applicable
for various levels of income. Such as, for first Tk. 1,65,000 @ 0% , for next Tk. 2,75,000 @
10%. But a non-resident foreigner has to pay tax at maximum rate i.e. @ 25%.
IV. Income tax rebate: A resident and non-resident Bangladeshi assessee gets income tax rebate
on investment allowance and on tax exempted income from gross tax liability. But, for a nonresident foreigner no tax rebate is applicable.
V. Tax liability: The average tax rate applicable for a resident and non-resident Bangladeshi is less
than that of a non-resident foreigner since tax is calculated using different lower tax rates
(such as 10%, 15%, 20% & 25%). But a non-resident foreigner has to pay tax at maximum rate
i.e. @ 25%.
Thus, determination of residential status of an assessee has a significant bearing on the tax
liability as total income, taxable income and tax rate are found to vary according to the
residential status of an assessee.
Impacts of residential status in assessing income:
Determination of residential status of an assessee has a significant bearing on the tax liability as
incidence of income tax varies according to the residential status of an assessee as per Section 17
of the ITO, 1984. Therefore, the scope of total income varies according to the residential status
of an assessee. These provisions may be summarized as under:
Particulars of income
Income received or deemed to be received in Bangladesh
Income accrued or arose or deemed to accrue or arise in
Bangladesh
Income accrued or arose outside Bangladesh
To be taxed or not
Resident
Non-resident
Taxable
Taxable
Taxable
Taxable
Taxable
Non-taxable
year 2009-10?
Solution
Mr. Akash is a resident since his stay in Bangladesh during 2009 [30+31+30+31+31] = 153 days and in
2010 from 1st May to 30th June [31+30] = 61 days. In total he stayed for [153+61] =214 days in the
income year 2009-10 which is more than required 182 days.
Worked Example 1.7
Mr. Rakesh Jason, a citizen of USA, has been staying in Bangladesh since 1st January, 2006. He leaves
Bangladesh on 16 July, 2009 on a visit to USA and returns on 1st March, 2010. What will be his
residential status in the income year 2009-10?
Solution
His stay in Bangladesh during the income year 2009-10 is:
July, 2009
18
March, 2010
31
April, 2010
30
May, 2010
31
June, 2010
30
Total staying
140 days
365
2007-08
366
2006-07
365
2005-06
As his stay was more than 90 days in the income year 2009-10 and more than 365 days in the preceding
4 years, he is a resident.
Worked Example 1.8
Mr. Juris Reinhards, a British citizen has been coming to Bangladesh for 100 days every year since 200506:
(a)
(b)
Will your answer be different if he has been coming to Bangladesh for 90 days instead of
100 days every year?
Solution
(a)
He is a resident as he stayed in Bangladesh for 100 days (more than required 90 days) in
the income year 2010-11 and 400 days (100 x 4) (more than required 365 days) in the
preceding 4 income years i.e. 2006-07, 2007-08, 2008-09, 2009-10.
(b)
Yes. He will, in this case, be a non-resident as he stayed in Bangladesh for 90 days (equal to
required 90 days) in the income year 2010-11 but 360 days (90 x 4) (less than required
365 days) in the preceding 4 income years i.e. 2006-07, 2007-08, 2008-09, 2009-10. He
doesn't fulfill any of the required conditions.
Worked Example 1.9
Mr. Jashim Uddin was outside Bangladesh from 20th August, 2008 for an employment contract valid for
two years, i.e. from 1st August, 2008 to 31st July, 2010. Mr. Uddin did not come to Bangladesh at any time
during the year 2008 and 2009. He finally came to Bangladesh on 10th January, 2010 and did not go back.
Determine his residential status for the income year 2009-10.
Solution
Total number of days Mr. Uddin stayed in Bangladesh during respective years:
2009-10 (From 10th January, 2010 to 30th June, 2010): [22+28+31+30+31+30) = 172 days.
2008-09 (From 1st July, 2008 to 20th August, 2008): [31 +20) = 51 days.
2007-08 (From 1st July, 2007 to 30th June, 2008) = 365 days
2006-07 (From 1st July, 2006 to 30th J line, 2007) = 365 days
2005-06 (From 1st July, 2005 to 30th June, 2006) = 365 days
Mr. Uddin is a resident since he fulfills the second condition. His stay in Bangladesh during the income
year 2009-10 is 172 days which is more than required 90 days in that year, and [51 +365+365+365);
1,146 days during previous four years which is more than required 365 days.
Worked Example 1.10
Mr. Jayed provides the following particulars of his stay in Bangladesh over a period of last five years:
Year
2005-06
2006-07
2007-08
2008-09
2009-10
2010-11
Days
40
55
182
200
94
110
a)
b)
c)
d)
What will happen if he stays for 185 days in the year 2010-11 and total 360 days during last four
years?
Solution
a)
Mr. Jayed is a resident since he fulfills the second condition. His stay in Bangladesh during income
year 2010-11 is 110 days which is more than required 90 days in that year, and [55+182+200+94]
= 531 days during previous four years which is more than required 365 days.
b)
Mr. Jayed would be a non-resident since he doesn't fulfill the second condition. His stay in
Bangladesh during income year 2010-11 is 85 days which is less than required 90 days in that year,
although he stayed [55+182+200+94] = 531 days during previous four years which is more than
required 365 days.
c)
Mr. Jayed is a resident since he fulfills the second condition. His stay in Bangladesh during income
year 2010-11 is 110 days which is more than required 90 days in that year, but his total stay during
previous four years is 411 days [55+182+80+94] which is more than the required 365 days.
d)
Mr. Jayed would be a resident since he fulfills the first condition. His stay in Bangladesh during
income year 2010-11 is 185 days which is more than required 182 days of the first condition. In
such a case, it is not important to know regarding his stay during four preceding years.
Worked Example 1.11
Dr. Hannan Sarker works as a professor in a university in Australia. He left Bangladesh in 1996. After 7 years of
that, he first visited Bangladesh in the year 2003. After wards he visited Bangladesh every year to see his parents.
The following table is providing the information about the time period he stayed in Bangladesh in different years
from 2003 to 2010. Determine his residential status during these income years:
Year
2003-04
2004-05
2005-06
2006-07
2007-08
2008-09
2009-10
Date of entrance
16.09.03
12.10.04
11.02.06
09.12.06
01.07.07
28.12.08
15.07.09
Date of exit
28.03.04
19.03.05
14.03.06
01.03.07
28.09.07
28.06.09
12.03.10
Year
Date of entrance
Date of exit
Days of staying in
current Year
2003-04
16.09.03
28.03.04
15+31+30
+31+31+2
9+28=195
2004-05
12.10.04
19.03.05
20+30+31
+31+28+1
9=159
2005-06
11.02.06
14.03.06
18+14=32
2006-07
09.12.06
01.03.07
23+31+28
+1=83
2007-08
01.07.07
28.09.07
31+31+28
=90
2008-09
28.12.08
28.06.09
4+31+28+
31+30+31
+28=183
Days of staying in
previous 4 years
195
195+159=
354
195+159+
32=386
159+32+8
3+90=364
Residential Status
Resident
Nonresident
Nonresident
Nonresident
195+159+
32+83=46
9
Resident
2009-10
15.07.09
12.03.10
17+31+30
+31+30+3
1+31+28+
12=241
32+83+90
+183=388
Resident
Resident
Solution
2.
Profit of Tk. 40,000 from a business in London has been brought in Bangladesh. The business has
been managed and controlled from Bangladesh.
3.
Profit of Tk. 60,000 from a business in Singapore has not yet been brought in Bangladesh.
The Business has been managed and controlled wholly from Singapore.
4.
Profit of Tk. 70,000 from a business in Dubai has not yet been brought in Bangladesh. The
Business has been managed and controlled wholly from Bangladesh.
Resident;
b)
Non-resident
Solution
Mr. Abdul
Income year: 2010-11;
Assessment year: 2011 - 12
Computation of Total Income
Particulars
Resident Tk.
1. Income earned in Bangladesh: Salary Income
100,000
2. Foreign income:
Profit for business in London which has been brought in
40,000
Bangladesh
Profit for business in Singapore which has not yet been
brought in Bangladesh
Profit for business in Dubai which has been brought in
Bangladesh
Total income
Non-resident Tk.
100,000
-
60,000
70,000
270,000
100,000
2.
3.
4.
Rent from a property in Canada received there but subsequently remitted to Bangladesh Tk.
60,000
5.
Interest from deposits with a Bangladeshi bank received in Canada Tk. 20,000
6.
Resident;
b)
Non-resident
Solution
Mr. Zaman
Income year: 2010-11
Assessment year: 2011-12
Computation of Total Income
Particulars
Resident Tk.
1. Income earned /deemed to accrue/arise in Bangladesh:
Rent from property in Bangladesh
40,000
Income from business in USA controlled from Bangladesh
150,000
Income from business in Dhaka controlled from Pakistan
180,000
Interest form deposits
20,000
2. Foreign income:
Rent from property in Canada
60,000
Total income
450,000
Non-resident Tk.
40,000
150,000
180,000
20,000
390,000
Salary income received in Bangladesh for services rendered in Afganistan Tk. 40,000
2.
3.
Property income in South Africa (out of which Tk. 90,000 was remitted to Bangladesh) Tk. 180,000
4.
5.
Solution
Mr. Rahman
Income year: 2010-11
Assessment year: 2011-12
Computation of Total Income
Particulars
Resident Tk.
1. Income earned /deemed to accrue/arise in Bangladesh:
Salary income received in Bangladesh for services rendered in
40,000
Afganistan
Income from profession in Bangladesh, but received in Nepal
150,000
Profits earned from business in Chittagong Interest
60,000
Foreign income:
Property income in South Africa
180,000
Agricultural income in Bhutan
20,000
Total income
450,000
Non-resident Tk.
40,000
150,000
60,000
180,000
20,000
250,000
Chapter 2
Administration and Tribunal
Contents
Introduction
Examination context
Topic List
2.1
2.2
2.3
2.4
2.5
2.6
2.7
Self-Assessment Questions
Introduction
Learning objectives
Practical significance
There are presently 15 classes of income tax authorities. Each class of authorities has defined
functions and responsibilities.
To exercise the functions of Appellate Tribunal Government there exists a Taxes Appellate
Tribunal. The power and functions of that Tribunal are normally exercised by its Benches
constituted by the president of the Tribunal.
Understanding of the structure of income tax authorities and the Tribunals procedures are
essential for both tax advisers and the assessees for dealing the tax matters when required.
Stop and think
Do you have the clear idea of the income tax authorities? Did you know that in case of practical
cases relating to income tax in life, the knowledge on the tax authorities is very important?
Working context
The knowledge on the administrative structure of income tax authorities and the Tribunals
procedures covered by this chapter are important for both the tax payers and tax advisers in
many times in case of necessity.
On behalf of assessee the accountants sometime required to support the submission of tax
return, hearing to the court etc, so they should have a clear picture of income tax authorities
and its power and functions and the Tribunals procedures in their mind to assist their clients in
resolving relevant tax issues.
Syllabus links
The topics covered in this chapter are important to your understanding of income tax
authorities and Taxes Appellate Tribunal.
You will be using this knowledge again when you tackle the Taxation paper later on in the
Professional Stage and it will also underpin the technical aspects at case study level.
Examination context
Exam requirements
In the examination, candidates may be required to:
Question practice
For question practice on this topic go to the suggested answers covering this chapter.
2.0
2.1
Top
Administrative
Judicial
Appellate Tribunal
Middle
Taxes
Appellate Joint Commissioner of Taxes
Bottom
The Commissioner of Taxes and sometimes, the Deputy Commissioner of Taxes enjoy and
2.3
6. To determine place of assessment when jurisdiction of an assesee falls more than in one
zone. [Sec 173A]
7. To direct to make payment of tax deducted at source within the specified time. [Sec 59]
8. To recognize and authorize Chartered Accountant, cost and management accountant,
income tax practitioner and members of other accounting bodies for appearance in income
tax matters as authorized representative of the assessee. [Sec 174 (2)]
9. To take disciplinary action against any authorized representative in case of professional
misconduct. [Sec 174 (3)]
10. To allow tax holiday or tax exemption to approved undertakings. [Sec 44&45]
11. To accord and withdraw recognition to Super Annuation Fund, Pension Fund and Gratuity
Fund. [1st Schedule part A, B & C]
12. To reward employees of the tax department or any other person for furnishing information
leading to tax evasion. [Sec 184]
2.4
2.5
(ii) investigate or cause investigation to the carried out in respect of cases involving
leakage of revenue or evasion of taxes;
(iii) carry out audit of cases of offices involving income tax cases only;
(iv) furnish annual report about the working of income tax officers dealing with revenue
matters to the Board by the thirty day of December following the end of the financial
year to which it relates; and
(ii)
analyse information gathered through intelligence work vis-a-vis concerned income tax
records;
(iii) detect tax evasions, concealments of income and offences as described in chapter XXI
of Income Tax Ordinance 1984;
(iv) carry out investigations to prove tax evasion or concealment or any other irregularities
relating to taxes and to collect evidences in support of tax offences or tax frauds for
recovery of tax with penalty and to suggest prosecutions in fit cases;
(v)
(b) the Commissioners or the Commissioner (Appeals) and the Appellate Joint Commissioners
shall perform their functions in respect of such areas, or such incomes or classes of
incomes, as the Board may assign to them[Section 6(1)(b)];
(c) the Commissioner (Large Taxpayer Unit) shall perform his functions in respect of such
areas, or such persons, or such cases or classes of cases or such incomes or classes of
incomes, as the Board may assign to him[Section 6(1)(bb)];
(d) the Inspecting Joint Commissioners and the Deputy Commissioners of Taxes shall perform
their functions in respect of such areas, or such persons for classes of persons, or such
cases or classes of cases, or such incomes or classes of incomes as the Commissioners to
whom they are subordinate may assign to them[Section 6(1)(c)]; and
(e) other incomes tax authorities shall perform such functions as may be assigned to them by
the income tax authority to whom they are subordinate [Section 6(1)(d)].
(2) (a) Any area or other jurisdiction or functions assigned to an income tax authority under
section 6(1) may be modified or varied, or may be transferred to any other income tax
authority with respect to areas, persons or classes of persons or cases or classes of
case, or proceeding or classes of proceedings;
(b) any such transfers as is referred to in section 6(2)(a) may be made at any stage of the
proceedings and further proceedings may be commenced from the stage at which such
transfer takes place.
(3)
Where more income tax authorities than one have been assigned the same functions in
respect of any area, or persons or classes of persons, or cases or classes of cases, or
incomes or classes of incomes, they shall perform those functions in accordance with such
allocation or distribution of work as the authority assigning the functions may make.
(4)
The powers of the Board, Commissioners and Deputy Commissioner of Taxes, to assign
any case to any authority, or to transfer any case from one authority to another or to
perform any function or functions under this section, shall include the power in respect of
all or any proceedings relating to such case; and except as provided in section 6(5), no
such assignment, transfer or performance of functions shall be called in question by or
before any court or other authority.
(5)
Any person aggrieved by any order passed under section 6 may, within thirty days of such
order, make a representation(a) to the Inspecting Joint Commissioner if the order was passed by a Deputy
Commissioner of Taxes;
(b) to the Commissioner, the Commissioner (Appeals), if the order was passed by an
Inspecting Joint Commissioner; and
(c)
to the Board if the order was passed by a Commissioner ; and any order passed on
such representation shall be final.
2.6
(1)
For the purpose exercising the functions of the Appellate Tribunal under the Ordinance,
the Government shall establish a Taxes Appellate Tribunal consisting of a President and
such other members as the Government may, from time to time, appoint [Section 11(1)].
(2)
A person shall not be appointed as a member of the Taxes Appellate Tribunal unless(i)
(ii)
(iii) he is a chartered accountant and practiced professionally for a period not less than
8 years; or
(iv) he is a cost and management accountant and practiced professionally for a period
not less than 8 years; or
(v)
(vi) he is a professional legislative expert having experience for a period not less than 8
years in the process of drafting and making financial and tax laws; or
(vii) he is an advocate and practiced professionally for not less than 10 years in any
income tax office. [Section 11(3)]
(ix) he is, was or has been a District Judge.
(3)
The Government shall appoint a member of the Appellate Tribunal to be the President
thereof [Section 11(4)].
Unless the president in any particular case or class of cases otherwise directs, the
powers and functions of the Appellate Tribunal shall be exercised by Benches of the
Appellate Tribunal, hereinafter referred to as Bench, to be constituted by the President.
(2)
A Bench shall be so constituted that it has not less than two members.
Decision of Bench: Sec 13
(1) Subject to the provisions of sections 13(2) and (3), the decision of bench in any case or on
any point shall be given in accordance with the opinion of the majority of its members.
(2) Any point on which the members of a Bench are equally divided shall be stated in writing and
shall be referred by the president to one or more other members of the Appellate Tribunal
for hearing and the point shall be decided according to the majority of the members of the
Appellate Tribunal who have heard it including those who first heard it.
(3) Where there are only two members of the Appellate Tribunal and they differ in any case,
the Government may appoint an additional member of the Appellate Tribunal for the
purpose of hearing of the case and the decision of the case shall be given in accordance with
the opinion of the majority of the members of the Appellate Tribunal as constituted with
such additional member.
Notwithstanding anything contained in section 12, the Government may direct that the powers
and functions of the Appellate Tribunal shall be exercised by any one of its member, or members
or by two or more members jointly or severally.
Assessee
Assessee
Aggrieved by an
orderofanyIncome
TaxAuthority
Applyfor
permissiontostart
ADRprocess
With
pending
dispute before any
Income
tax
authority, tribunal
orcourt
Concern
IncomeTaxAuthority
Tribunal
Court
Where the order has been
passed or dispute is
pending
Receivedthe
permissiontostart
ADRprocess
Applyfor
ADRprocess
NationalBoardofRevenue
(NBR)
Select/appoint
thefacilitator
anddetermine
his
responsibility
Facilitator
Forwardcopy
ofapplication
No
Arrangemeetingfor
settlement
Assesseehimselfor
alongwithauthorized
representative
Facilitatorshould
communicatethe
resultwithin15
daysfromthedate
ofdisagreementto
allrelatedparties
No
Proper
reply
RespectiveDCTor
Representative
Agreementis
reachedwholly
orpartly
Assesseemayappeal
totheproperauthority
Respective
DCT
Yes
Yes
ADRshallnot
continue
Facilitatorshould
recorddetailsof
theresultand
communicateto
theassesseeand
therespective
DCT
Resultisfinaland
cannotbechallenged
An assessee may apply for resolution of the dispute through the ADR process if aggrieved by an
order of an income tax authority or if a dispute is pending before any income-tax authority,
tribunal or court. In case of any pending dispute, the assessee is required to get permission from
the authority where it is pending in writing before applying for ADR and if approval is received
and assessee applies for ADR, the matter shall remain stayed during ADR negotiation process.
To resolve dispute in an alternative way, the Board may select or appoint Facilitator and
determine his duties and responsibilities. The assessee shall be allowed to negotiate himself
personally or along with an authorized representative, with the Commissioner's Representative
for the concerned dispute under the facilitation and supervision of such Facilitator. Upon
receiving the application of ADR, the Facilitator shall forward a copy of the application to the
respective Deputy Commissioner of Taxes and also call for his opinion on the grounds of the
application. If the Deputy Commissioner of Taxes fails to give his opinion regarding fulfillment of
the conditions, the Facilitator may notify in writing the applicant and the Commissioner of Taxes
or the Commissioner's Representative to attend the meetings for settlement of disputes on a
date mentioned in the notice. Where an agreement is reached, either wholly or in part, between
the assessee and the Commissioner's Representative, the Facilitator shall record, in writing, the
details of the agreement, sign and shall communicate the same to the assessee and the concerned
Deputy Commissioner of Taxes.
However, where no agreement is reached or the dispute resolution is ended in disagreement
between the assessee and the concerned Commissioner's Representative for noncooperation of
either of the parties, the Facilitator shall communicate it within fifteen days from the date of
disagreement, to the applicant and the Board, the concerned court, Tribunal, appellate authority
and income tax authority, as the case may be, about such unsuccessful dispute resolution.
Where an agreement is reached, it shall be binding on both the parties and it cannot be
challenged in any authority, Tribunal or court either by the assessee or any other income tax
authority. Where an agreement is not reached, the assessee may prefer an appeal in following
manner:
Dispute Arises out of an order of
Appeal to
OR
Appellate Additional Commissioner of
Taxes
OR
Commissioner of Taxes (Appeals)
The assessee-applicant may also appeal to the respective appellate authority or court from
where he has got permission to apply for ADR.
Self-Assessment Questions
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
Chapter 3
Charge of Tax
Contents
Introduction
Examination context
Topic List
3.1
3.2
Charge of Surcharge
3.3
3.4
3.5
3.6
3.7
3.8
Introduction
Learning objectives
Practical significance
Income tax shall be charged levied, paid and collected at different rates in respect of the total
income in accordance with provisions of the Ordinance. It may be deducted at source, or paid or
collected in advance. The rates of tax can vary on the basis of income and types of assessee. The
assessee may be required to pay surcharge, additional tax or excess profit tax depending on the
situation.
Finance Act 2011 repealed some opportunities given by the Finance Act 2010 to the investors in
certain cases of investment in the form of special tax treatment.
The scope of total income of a resident and non-resident includes the sources and forms of
income of these persons of any income year.
Stop and think
Think about different ways of charging income tax and identify the similarity and differentiation of
the scope of income of a resident and a non resident. Do you realize that the different types of
unexplained investment will be deemed as income under different heads? Are you acknowledged
about the special tax treatment in respect of some investment?
Working context
Before determining individual and corporate tax, the rate of tax and the scope of total income
need to be identified. Based on residential status the scope of total income varies. Unexplained
investments are also taxable under respective heads. The opportunities given by the Finance Act
2010 to the investors in certain cases of investment in the form of special tax treatment were
withdrawn by Finance Act 2011.
An accountant will be expected to understand the scope of total income, deemed income,
applicable tax rate, special tax treatment and to give advice on how the total income of individual
and corporate can be determined. This can also suggest their clients to take the facility of special
tax treatment by investing in those mentioned areas.
Syllabus links
You will be familiar with the charge of income tax and to prepare for the application level and
also for the case study.
Detailed knowledge on this issue helps you to understand the progression level and stage of your
study.
You will be using this knowledge again when you tackle the Taxation paper later on in the
Professional Stage and it will also underpin the technical aspects at the Advanced Stage.
Examination context
Exam requirements
In the examination, candidates may be required to:
Question practice
For question practice on these topics go to the suggested questions and answers covering this
chapter at the end.
Examiner's comments on how students tackle questions
Candidates need to take care of the sources of total income including different classes of
unexplained investment as these are required for calculation of taxable income of an assessee.
3.0
CHARGE OF TAX
Section Overview
3.1
Introduction
Any income has to be brought under respective heads of income under S. 20 and can be charged
to tax only if it is so chargeable under the computing section corresponding to that head of
income. The liability to tax arises by virtue of this charging section which does not depend on
assessment; assessment order only quantifies the liability which is finally created by the charging
section. Following basic principles can be deduced from the analysis of the charging section:
(i) Income tax is to be charged at the rate or rates fixed for the year by the Finance Act. The
liability to tax does not arise until the annual Finance Act is passed [Kamakhya Narayan Singh
V CIT (1946) ITR 683]. Section 183 provides that if on the first day of July in any year
provision has not been made by any Act for the charging of income tax for that year, the
provision in force in the immediate preceding year or the provision proposed in the Finance
Bill then before Parliament, whichever is more favorable to the assessee, shall apply until the
new Finance Act is passed.
(ii) Income should be calculated with reference to the income year but tax rate/rates should be
the rate/rates applicable to respective assessment year. The use of the expression charged
both in the Finance Act and Income Tax Ordinance does not mean that the income is
charged to income tax under both the Act and Ordinance. They are used in different senses.
The tax will be charged in accordance with and subject to the provisions of the Income tax
Ordinance and the said charge shall be in accordance with the rates prescribed in the
Finance Act [Kesoram Industries and Cotton Mills LTD V C. W. T Calcutta (1466) ITR, 767].
(iii) The income taxed is that of the income year and not of the assessment year. Since tax is
levied on the actual income of the income year, the sources must be taken as they existed
during the income year it is immaterial whether the source of income actually exists in the
assessment year [Muthappa Chettian V CIT (1945) ITR, 311]. However, there are exceptions
for a discontinued business, for persons leaving Bangladesh when income year is the
assessment year and for certain income under S. 82(C).
(iv) The charge is on every person as stated in S. 2 (46) i. e. an individual, a firm, an association of
persons, a Hindu undivided family, a local authority, a company and any other artificial
juridical person. Estoppel is a rule of evidence, not a cause of action and it cannot be the
basis of liability under the Income Tax Ordinance. So, an assessment cannot be made on a
stranger to the income, merely he agrees or desires to be assessed on it [Asit Kumer Ghose V
CIT, ITR, 576].
(v) The tax is levied on the total income of the assessee computed in the manner laid down in
specified sections and subject to the provisions of this Ordinance. It will be for the assessee
to produce materials to hold that a receipt is of a casual or capital nature not chargeable to
tax and for the Revenue to consider the materials and arrive at a reasonable conclusion.
(vi) Tax is imposed in three stages. There is the declaration of a liability that is the part of the
statute which determines who is liable in respect of what. Next, there is the assessment
liability that does not depend on the assessment. That ex-hypothesis has already been fixed.
But assessment particularizes the exact sum which a person is liable to pay. Lastly, the
3.3
Tk. 45,000
Tk. 20,78,000
Tk. 8,23,000
Tk. 29,01,000
Nil (net wealth is less than Tk. 2 crore)
Tk. 45,000
Illustration 2
Net tax liability
Net wealth as per last assessment year
Accretion in net wealth during current year
Total net wealth up to this assessment year
Surcharge
Total tax liability
3.4
Tk. 160,000
Tk. 1,81,23,000
Tk. 24,08,000
Tk. 2,05,31,000
Tk. 16,000 (10% of Tk. 160,000)
Tk. 176,000 (Tk. 160,000 + Tk. 16,000)
24,00,00,000
126,00,00,000
150,00,00,000
The company is liable to pay additional tax as it fails to declare dividend of at least 15% of paid up
capital. The amount of additional tax will be at the rate of 5% on following:
Retained Earnings
Less: Dividend declared
10% of Tk. 100,00,00,000
Undistributed profit
Free Reserve
Total Undistributed Profit
Additional tax @ 5%
3.5
25,00,00,000
10,00,00,000
15,00,00,000
24,00,00,000
39,00,00,000
19,50,000
XYZ Bank Ltd., a scheduled bank, operates in Bangladesh under the Banking Company Act, 1991.
For the year ended June 30, 2011, the bank reports Tk. 353,00,00,000 profit in its return of
income with the following information in its Balance Sheet:
Stockholders Equity:
Paid up Capital
450,00,00,000
Statutory Reserve
20,00,00,000
Other Reserve
15,00,00,000
500,00,00,000
985,00,00,000
XYZ Bank is liable for excess profit tax for the year due to reporting excess profit i.e., in excess
of 50% of paid up capital and reserve. The amount of tax will be computed as under:
Paid up Capital
Statutory Reserve
20,00,00,000
Other Reserve
15,00,00,000
485,00,00,000
242,50,00,000
353,00,00,000
110,50,00,000
450,00,00,000
16,57,50,000
In the assessment year 2011-12, Company X reports taxable profit of Tk. 10,00,000 with annual
turnover of Tk. 1,00,00,000. Tax liability of the company will be Tk. 2,75,000 (27.5% of Tk.
10,00,000) applying regular rate which is higher than minimum tax of Tk. 50,000 (0.50% of Tk.
1,00,00,000).
Illustration 4
In the assessment year 2011-12, Company A reports total income of Tk. 3,00,000 from business,
house property and other sources. Annual assessed business turnover is Tk. 10,00,000, property
income Tk. 2,00,000 and receipt from other sources i.e. interest on bank deposit Tk. 1,200,00.
Here, the gross receipt of the company would be:
Heads of Receipts
Receipts derived from the sale of goods (Turnover)
Income from house property
Income from other sources (interest on bank deposit)
Total
(a)
(b)
(c)
Amount (TK)
10,00,000
2,00,000
1,20,000
13,20,000
Tax liability on regular income at regular rate is Tk. 82,500 (27.5% of Tk. 3,00,000). However,
minimum tax is Tk. 6,600 (0.50% of Tk. 13,20,000). As regular tax is higher than minimum tax,
tax liability of the company will be Tk. 82,500.
3.7
Charge of tax on sale of share at a premium over face value: Sec 16E
Notwithstanding anything contained in any other provisions of the ITO1984 or any other law,
where a company raises its share capital through book building or public offering or rights
offering or placement or preference or in any other way at a value in excess of face value, the
company shall be charged, in addition to tax payable under the ITO1984, tax at the rate of three
percent (3%) on the difference between the value at which the share is sold and its face value.
Illustration:
Company X got permission to issue 10,00,000 of its common shares of TK 10 par value at TK.
15 through private placement. Here, total premium per share in Tk. 5 (Tk. 15 Tk. 10) and total
amount of premium on sale will be Tk. 50,00,000 (10,00,000 shares @ Tk. 5). The company is
required to pay taxes on premium @ 3% and thus the amount of tax will be Tk. 150,000 (3% of
Tk. 50,00,000).
3.8
in relation to a person who is a resident, all income, from whatever source derived,
which(i)
(ii)
(iii) accrues or arises to him outside Bangladesh during that year, and
(b)
in relation to a person who is a non- resident, all income , from whatever source
derived, which(i)
(ii)
(2)
3.9
(2)
any income which falls under the head salaries, wherever paid if(a)
it is earned in Bangladesh; or
(b)
(b)
(c)
(3)
(4)
(5)
(a)
by the Government: or
(b)
by a person who is a resident, except where the interest payable in respect of any
debt incurred, or moneys borrowed and used, for the purposes of a business or
profession carried on by such person outside Bangladesh or for the purpose of
making or earning any income from any source outside Bangladesh; or
(c)
by the Government: or
(b)
by a person who is a resident, except where such fees are payable in respect of
services utilised in a business or profession carried on by any such person outside
Bangladesh or for the purpose of making or earning any income from any source
outside Bangladesh; or
(c) by a person who is non- resident, where such fees are payable in respect of services
utilised in a business or profession carried on by such person in Bangladesh or for
the purpose of making or earning any income from any source outside Bangladesh.
(6)
by the Government: or
(b)
(c)
When the person entitled to such income is not resident in Bangladesh, he may be charged to
tax in his own name or in the name of his agent. The Deputy Commissioner of Taxes must give
hearing to a person whom he wants to treat as agent of the non-resident person.
A person treated as an agent of a non-resident is empowered under the law to deduct and retain
any amount, which may be due as tax from the non-resident person.
However, in the case of a business all the operations of which are not carried out in Bangladesh,
only such part of the income as is reasonably attributable to the operation carried out in
Bangladesh shall be deemed to accrue or arise in Bangladesh.
3.10
Unexplained Cash Credit [Section 19(1)]: Where any sum is found credited in the
books of an assessee, maintained for any income year and the assessee offers no explanation
about the nature and source thereof, or the explanation offered is not in the opinion of the
Deputy Commissioner of Taxes, satisfactory, the sum so credited shall be deemed to be his
income for that income year classifiable under the head Income from other sources.
Unexplained expenditure [Section 19(3)]: Where, in any income year, the assessee has
incurred any expenditure and he offers no explanation about the nature and source of the
money for such expenditure, or the explanation offered is not in the opinion of the Deputy
Commissioner of Taxes, satisfactory, the amount of the expenditure shall be deemed to be
the income of the assessee for such income year classifiable under the head Income from
other sources.
Difference between fair value and payment against assets [Section 19(8)]: Where
any assets, not being stock-in-trade or stocks, and shares, purchased by an assessee from any
company and the Deputy Commissioner of Taxes has reason to believe that the price paid
by the assessee is less then the fair market value thereof, the difference between the price so
paid and the fair market value thereof, shall be deemed to be income of the assessee
classifiable under the head Income from other sources.
Salami or premia receipts [Section 19(9)]: Where any lump sum amount is received
or receivable by an assessee during any income year on account of salami or premia receipts
by virtue of any lease, such amount shall be deemed to be income of the assessee of the
income year in which it is received and classifiable under the head Income from other
sources. However, at the option of the assessee such amount may be allocated for the
purpose of assessment proportionately to the years covered by the entire lease period, but
such allocation shall in no case exceed five years.
expenses claimed was allowed in assessment for that year, if such trading liability was not
paid during the next 3 years (Assessment years 2002-03 to 2004-05), that trading liability
will be added back as income in assessment for the assessment year 2005-06 only and
not in any other year.
16 Profit from sale of fixed assets of business or profession [Section 19(16)]: Where
any building, machinery or plant having been used by an assessee for purpose of any business
or profession carried on by him is disposed of during any income year and the sale proceeds
thereof exceeds the written down value, so much of the excess as does not exceed the
difference between the original cost and the written down value shall be deemed to be the
income of the assessee for that income year classifiable under the head Income from
business or profession.
Illustrations
(a) Cost of an asset Tk. 100,00. Written down value on the year of sale- Tk. 60,000. Sale
of the asset Tk. 100,000. Profit on sale of fixed asset will amount to Tk. 40,000
(100,000 -60,000).
(b) Cost of an asset Tk. 100,000. Written down value on the year of sale Tk. 60,000. Sale
of the asset Tk. 120,000. In this case, profit on sale of fixed asset will amount to Tk.
40,000 and capital gain u/s 32 will amount to Tk. 20,000.
It is apparent that profit on sale of fixed asset (balancing charge) under no circumstances
shall exceed the difference between cost of the asset and written down value of the
asset. In other words, tax department takes by way of revenue what it has allowed as
depreciation allowance in the past. In may be noted that no depreciation allowance is
allowable in the year when the asset is sold as per income tax provision.
Question
ABC Ltd, purchased a machine in the year 2002 at Tk. 5,000,000 and sold the same in
November 2006 at Tk. 3,500,000. The written down value is Tk. 3,000,000. The year end of
the company is December.
Calculate the business profit or losses and also the capital profit or losses, if any, for the
relevant assessment year. (PE I Session May June, 2005)
Solution
Sale of the machine
Less: Written down value
Profit on Sale (Balancing charge)
Assessment year
(2007-08)
=Tk. 3,500,000
3,000,000
500,000
It is assumed that written down value of Tk. 3,000,000 was worked out as per fiscal rate.
Profit on sale is within the difference between the original cost and written down value of
the asset sold.
Note
This section mentions profit from sale of building, machinery or plant. Hence any profit on
sale of furniture will remain outside the ambit of taxation under Income Tax Ordinance
1984. On the same token, any loss on sale of furniture is not an allowable expense.
17 Profit from sale of agricultural assets [Section 19(17)]: Where any machinery or
plant exclusively used by an assessee for agricultural purposes has been disposed of in any
income year and the sale proceeds thereof exceeds the written down value, so much of the
excess as does not exceed the difference between the original cost and the written down
value shall be deemed to be the income of the assessee for that income year classifiable
under the head Agricultural income
18 Profit out of insurance, salvage or compensation money from fixed assets of
business or profession [Section 19(18)]: Where any insurance, salvage or compensation
moneys are received in any income year in respect of any building, machinery or plant having
been used by an assessee for purpose of any business or profession is discarded demolished
or destroyed and the amount of such moneys exceeds the written down value of such
building, machinery or plant so much of the excess as does not exceed the difference
between the original cost and the written down value less the scrap value shall be deemed to
be the income of the assessee for that income year classifiable under the head Income from
business or profession.
Example
WDV of machine discarded
Original cost of the machine
Insurance money received
Tk.
20,000
80,000
30,000
Here the difference between insurance money and the WDV is Tk. 10,000 which would be
treated as business income. If salvage or insurance money received were Tk. 100,000, entire
depreciation allowed earlier i.e. (80,000-20,000) = Tk. 60,000 would be treated as business
income and the difference between insurance or salvage value and original cost, would be
capital gain i.e. (100,000-80,000) = Tk. 20,000.
19 Profit out of insurance, salvage or compensation money from agricultural assets
[Section 19(19)]: Where any insurance, salvage or compensation moneys are received in
any income year in respect of any building, machinery or plant which having been used by the
assessee exclusively for agriculture purpose is discarded, demolished or destroyed and the
amount of such moneys exceeds the written down value of such machinery or plant so much
of the excess as does not exceed the difference between the original cost and the written
down value less the scrap value shall be deemed to be the income of the assessee for that
income year classifiable under the head Agricultural income
20 Profit on sale of capital items of scientific research [Section 19(20)]: Where an
asset representing expenditure of a capital nature of scientific research within the meaning of
section 29(1)(xx) is disposed of during any income year, so much of the sale proceeds as
does not exceed the amount of the expenditure allowed under the said clause shall be
deemed to be the income of the assessee for that income year classifiable under the head
Income from business or profession.
21 Loan Receipt otherwise than by cross cheque [Section 19(21)]: Where any sum, or
aggregate of sums exceeding taka fifty thousand is claimed or shown to have been received
as loan by an assessee during any income year from any person, not being a banking company
or a financial institution, otherwise than by crossed cheque drawn on a bank, has not been
paid back in full within three years from the end of the income year in which it is claimed or
shown to have been received, the said sum or part thereof which has not been paid back,
shall be deemed to be the income year of the assessee for the income year immediately
following the expiry of the said three years and be classifiable under the head Income from
other sources. However, where the loan referred to in section 19(21) is paid back in a
subsequent income year, the amount so paid shall be deducted in computing the income in
respect of that subsequent year.
22 Loan or Gift Receipt [Section 19(21A)]: Where any sum is claimed to have been
received by an assessee as loan or gift during any income year from a person who has
transferred the sum from the initial capital of his business or profession shown in his return
filed under section 83A, the amount of such loan or gift so was received by the assessee shall
be deemed to be his income of the year in which such loan or gift was received and shall be
classifiable under the head Income from other sources.
23 Transfer of Initial Capital [Section 19(21B)]: Where any sum, shown as initial capital
of business or profession in return of income filed under section 82BB, is transferred by a
person partly or fully within the period of limitation stipulated in the said section, the sum so
transferred shall be deemed to be his income of the year in which such sum was transferred
and shall be classifiable under the head "Income from other sources".
24 House Rent Security Deposit [Section 19(22)]: Where an assessee, being the owner
of a house property, receives from any person to whom such house property or any part
thereof is let out any amount which is not adjustable against the rent payable, the amount so
received shall be deemed to be income of the assessee for the income year in which it is
received and be classifiable under the head Income from house property. However, where
such or part thereof is refunded by the assessee in a subsequent income year the amount so
refunded shall be deducted in computing the income of the assessee in respect of that
income year.
25 Export Quota [Section 19(23)]: Where during any income year an assessee, being an
exporter of garments, transfers to any person, the export quota or any part thereof allowed
to him by the Government, such portion of the export value of the garments exportable
against the quota so transferred as may be prescribed for this purpose shall be deemed to be
income of the assessee for that income year, classifiable under the head Income from
business or profession. For the purposes of section 19(23) of the Ordinance, an amount
equal to 3% of the export value of the garments exportable against the export quota
transferred by an assessee shall be deemed to be his income for the income year during
which the transfer took place[Rule 30A].
Example
Aklima Garments LTD. transferred its export quota of certain items to Taslima Garments
LTD. in the year 2003-2004. The export value of the quota transferred has been Tk. 10
million and for the transfer Aklima charged Tk. 4 million to Taslima.
As per Rule 30A the value of the transfer is 3% * 10 million = .3 million. Therefore, Tk.
3,00,000 would be Aklimas income for income year 2003-2004. But it has realized Tk. 400,000.
Tk. 300,000 is income from business. The balance Tk. 100,000 may not be taxed. However, it
is certain that the company will be taxed on full deemed value even when money received on
the transfer falls short of it.
There is a tax rebate of 50% on the export of garments by companies registered in
Bangladesh but Aklima cannot claim the rebate for the value received on the transfer of
quota since it has not exported therefore, the amount will be taxed at full rate.
26 Equity received from shareholders in cash [Section 19(24)]: Where an assessee,
being a private limited company or a public limited company not listed with a stock
exchange, increases its paid up capital by issuing shares in an income year, the amount so
received as increased paid up capital, not being received by crossed cheque or bank transfer,
shall be deemed to be the income of such assessee for that income year classifiable under
the head "Income from other sources.
27 Loan received without crossed check or bank transfer [Section 19 (26)]: Where
an assessee, being a company, receives any amount as loan from any other company
otherwise than by a crossed check or by bank transfer, the amount so received shall be
deemed to be the income of such assessee for that income year in which such loan was
taken and shall be classifiable under the head "Income from other sources".
28 Buying/Hiring motor car/jeep by a company [Section 19(27)]: Where an assessee,
being a company, purchases directly or on hire one or more motor car or jeep and value of
any motor car or jeep exceeds ten percent of its paid up capital, then fifty percent of the
amount that exceeds such ten percent of the paid up capital shall be deemed to be the
income of such assessee for that income year classifiable under the head "Income from other
sources".
3.11
Chapter 4
Income from salaries
Contents
Introduction
Examination context
4.1
4.2
4.3
4.4
4.5
4.6
Topic List
Heads of Income
Introduction
Learning objectives
Practical significance
Income from salary is very important for a lot of reasons. This is a common head of income for
most of the individual tax payers. It can even be said that individual taxation depends on this head
of income. Government collects a significant portion of tax under this head. Thus, taxation laws
covering income from salary is very rich and scope of learning is also enlarged. This chapter
carries significance for corporate practitioners also in a sense that this expense in certain
conditions cannot be shown as expense. The application of perquisites and its impact on
computing taxes is very important.
Income from salary is the first head of income. To compute taxable income of an individual, it
pays a significant role. Out if the seven heads, this is a very common head of income. Again, this
head encompasses different technical and conceptual issues like perquisites, provident funds and
other funds and like where clear understanding is very important as a tax practitioner and
professional.
Computing taxable income under the head income from salary, computing investment allowance
and testing the amount for maximum limit, computing tax rebate on investment allowance,
understanding the adjustment of tax deducted at sources and finally computing net tax liability of
an individuals are some mentionable points that is covered in this chapter and thus the chapter
become very significant for the students. This chapter lays the foundation of coming chapters
also.
You will find the details of the above issues in this chapter with some practical example.
Stop and think
Do you realize that the computation of taxable income under the head income from salary is
one of the basic requirements for determining tax liability? Can you determine the taxable
income from salary? Do you understand the application of investment allowance in computing
final tax liability?
Working context
In practice, as the accountants are sometime required to support to prepare their clients' tax
returns, they need to advise the clients on how to calculate the total taxable income for any
income year. Before advising the clients, accountants should have the clear concept relating to
the admissible and inadmissible expenses so that they can deduct or add the expenses in
determining the taxable income.
As individual assessees are abundant and most of the individual assessees have income under the
head, understanding this chapter becomes a must for working in practical life.
Syllabus links
The topics covered in this chapter are very important for computing taxable income which is
required for solving sample practical problems at this level.
Examination context
Exam requirements
In the examination, candidates may be required to:
Question practice
For question practice on these topics go to the suggested answers covering this chapter and also
this manual.
Examiner's comments on how students tackle questions
Candidates have to be prepared well for this area as this chapter consists of core concept on
computation of income which is vital for calculating tax liability. Clear concept and understanding
of each contents of this chapter will help candidates to resolve any problems relating to
computation of income.
4.0
4.1
4.2
Salaries.
Interest on securities.
Income from house property.
Agricultural income.
Income from business or profession.
Capital gains.
Income from other sources.
any salary due from an employer to the assessee in the income year, whether paid or
not;
(b)
any salary paid or allowed to him in the income year by or on behalf of an employer, .
though not due or before it became due to him; and
(c)
any arrears of salary paid or allowed to him in the income year by or on behalf of an
employer, if not charged to income tax for any earlier income year[Section 21].
Salary once included in any year on due basis or advance payment basis is not includible in the
income of any other year. It is not logical to pay taxes on same income in multiple years.
(ii)
Perquisites
Perquisite has been defined in the Oxford dictionary as any casual emolument, fee or profit
attached to an office or position, any addition to salary and wages. However, as per Section 2(45)
of IT Ordinance 1984, Perquisite means
Any payment made to an employee by an employer in the form of cash or in any other form
excluding basis salary, festival bonus, incentive bonus not exceeding ten percent of disclosed
profit of relevant income year, arrear salary, advance salary, leave encashment or leave fare
assistance and overtime, and
(ii)
(iii) allowances which are exempt from the payment of tax; and
(iv) allowances, perquisites, annuities and benefits as referred to in rule-33(1).
(b) "employee", in relation to a company, includes the managing director, or any other
director or other person, who irrespective of his designation, performs, any duties or
functions in connection with the management of the affairs of the company
240,000
3,00,000
1,80,000
1,80,000
60,000
1,20,000
2,40,000
1,20,000
20,000. How much will be added with taxable income due to availing this opportunity from
the employer?
Includible amount of House Rent with Taxable Income
25% of Basic (Tk. 40,000 12 months 25%)
Or, Rental value (Tk. 20,000 12 months)
Whichever is lower
Concessional rent paid (Tk. 10,000 12 months)
Amount to be added with taxable income
1,20,000
2,40,000
1,20,000
1,20,000
0
40,000
24,000
16,000
Illustration
Mr. X receives Tk. 3,000 monthly as conveyance allowance. He also enjoys a full time official
car for both his personal and office purpose. His basic salary is Tk. 48,000 per month. What
will be the impact for these benefits in cash and kind on computing taxable income of Mr. X?
Includible amount of Conveyance Allowance and Facility with Taxable Income
Actual allowance (Tk. 3,000 12 months)
36,000
7.5% of Basic (Tk. 48,000 12 months 7.5%)
43,200
Taxable income
79,200
Free or Concessional passage for travel abroad or within Bangladesh : Rule 33G
(1) Where free or concessional passage for travel abroad or within Bangladesh is provided
by the employer to an employee (including the members of his house-hold and
dependents), there shall be included in his income of the employee(i) Where the passage is provided in accordance with the terms of employment, an
amount equal to the sum by which the cash payments, if any made by the employer
exceeds the actual expenditure incurred by the employee; and
(ii) Where the passage is not in accordance with the terms of employment, the whole of
the amount paid in cash, if any, or if no cash payment is made, the amount which
would have been expended by the employee had the free or concessional passage, as
the case may be, not been provided by the employer;
Where free concessional passage for travel abroad is availed by the employee more than once
in two years, the whole of amount paid to him in cash, if any, for such additional passage or if
no cash payment is made, the amount which would have been expended by him had the
additional passage not been provided by the employer, shall be included in his income.
(2) Where the transport is provided free of cost or at a concessional rate by an
undertaking engaged in the transport of passengers or the carriage of goods to any
employee of the undertaking (including the members of his household and dependents) in
any conveyance owned or chartered by the undertaking for the purpose of the transport
of the passengers or carriage of goods, nothing shall be added in his income.
Illustration 1
Mr. X is an employee of GMG Airlines traveled to Bangkok recently along with his wife,
children and mother in law who is dependent on him. As a term of the service contract all
return tickets were provided by the employer. Besides he was also given Tk. 2,00,000 to
meet the expenditure abroad which also is a part of the service contract. The value of the
return tickets were Tk. 90,000. He has spent Tk. 1,50,000 on the trip. Here, himself, his
spouse, children and mother in law are all qualified to get the privilege under the service
contract. He has been given the return tickets free so nothing is to be added with salary but
cash amount of Tk. 2,00,000 would be fully included with the salary income since the above
rule provides for passage or passage money and not for other travel expenditure.
Illustration 2
Mr. X, an employee of a multinational in Dhaka, has been given Tk. 1,00,000 as a travel
passage to U.K. with his spouse as per terms of employment. On the return tickets he
saved Tk. 25,000 by flying the cheapest airlines available in the sector.
Excess of cash over the actual passage i.e. Tk. 25,000 would be added with his salary
income.
Illustration 3
Mr. X has been given 50% passage assistance to USA amounting to Tk. 40,000 which
however, was paid by his employer not as a lien of his contract but out of satisfaction on his
performance.
Since the concessional passage has not been a part of service contract the full amount
would be added with salary.
Entertainment Allowance: Rule 33H
Where any amount is payable to the employee by way of entertainment allowance, the
whole of the amount so payable shall be included in his income. No addition on this account
shall, however, be made if free tea, coffee, beverages or the like thereof are provided at the
office premises during the course of work.
Medical Expenses: Rule 33I
Where any amount is payable to the employee by way of hospitalization or medical
expenses, the amount, if any, by which the sum receivable by him exceeds the actual
expenditure incurred by him shall be included in his income. Any reimbursement of medical
expenditure will not be included in total income.
Illustration 1
Mr. X receives Tk. 5,000 per month as medical allowance. During a year, Mr. X produces
documents showing that his actual medical expenditure was Tk. 25,000. Thus, the excess
amount of Tk. 35,000 (Tk. 60,000 Tk. 25,000) will be included in taxable income.
Illustration 2
Mr. X, was seriously ill and hospitalized. His medical bill was Tk. 85,000 which was
reimbursed by his employer upon submission. In this situation, Mr. X will add nothing with
his taxable income.
Other Benefits: Rule 33J
Where any benefit or annuity not covered by the provisions of rule 33A to rule 33I is
provided to the employee, the members of his household or his dependents, there shall be
included in his income an amount equal to the amount which would have been expended by
the employee in obtaining such benefit or annuity from an independent source in the same
or near locality, had it not been so provided, as reduced by the amount, if any, expended
wholly, necessarily and exclusively in the performance of the duties of the office held by him
or actually paid by him in cash.
Under clause (b) of rule 33(2) a shareholder director of company is to be treated as an
employee and hence to be entitled to the above allowances. But these benefits can be
claimed from salary income of one company only.
Illustration 1
Mr. X, a director of a multinational in Dhaka, had to attend a regional management
conference arranged by the group in Singapore and has been paid Tk. 2,00,000 by the
company to meet his weeklong expenses in Singapore. He actually spent Tk. 1,70,000.
Here, the benefit of Tk. 2,00,000 has been given to Mr. X wholly, necessarily and exclusively
in the performance of his duty as a company director, out of which he spent Tk. 1,70,000.
Therefore, under this sub-rule, balance Tk. 30,000 unspent would be added with salary.
Illustration 2
Mr. X, a manager, has been given an annuity by his employer to pay him and his wife an
annuity of Tk. 1,00,000 for ten years after his retirement in two years time. The whole cost
was borne by the company which has been Tk. 5,00,000. Under this Rule the whole amount
would be added with the salary. If for instance, 50% of the annuity cost is borne by him then
balance 50% i.e. Tk. 2,50,000 would be added with his salary.
Test of Determent Perquisites
Particulars
Basic Salary
Dearness allowance
Festival bonus
Performance bonus
Leave encashment
Employers contribution to PF
Interest on PF
Gratuity credited
Special allowance in the performance of duties
Commission
Insurance premium borne by the employer
Incentive bonus by the employer
House rent cash
House free or at concession
Entertainment
Conveyance cash
Car for personal use
Free ride from office
Leave passage
Entertainment for the purpose of employer
Medical-cash allowance
Medical reimbursement
Travel reimbursement
House rent paid in cash
Any other obligation of the employee (House servant, mali
etc.)
Salary
Perquisites
None
Basic Principles
Anything paid in cash as fixed sum forms part of the salary and any obligation of the employee
borne by the employer is perquisite.
Illustration
From the following particulars of 5 employees of a company calculate the perquisites not
admissible (excess perquisites) as business expenditure U/S 30 (e).
Employee
Basic Salary
360,000
320,000
310,000
280,000
270,000
Festival Bonus
180,000
160,000
150,000
140,000
130,000
Conveyance Allowance
200,000
200,000
180,000
120,000
100,000
100,000
100,000
100,000
Contribution to RPF
36,000
32,000
31,000
28,000
27,000
Entertainment Allowance
48,000
36,000
36,000
36,000
30,000
Free Accommodation
Telephone Bill
12,650
9,800
10,800
Utilities
66,000
60,000
60,000
65,000
69,000
10
1,062,650
917,800
897,800
829,000
826,000
Salary (1+2+3+5)
576,000
712,000
691,000
628,000
427,000
Perquisites (4+6+7+8+9)
486,650
205,800
206,800
201,000
399,000
Perquisites Allowed
250,000
250,000
250,000
250,000
250,000
236,650
149,000
240,000
200,000
Notes:
(i) In the computation of total income of the company excess perquisites would be added U/S
29(e).
(ii)The basic principle is whatever paid in cash and in the form of a benefit monthly is a salary and
should not constitute perquisites.
(iii) U/S 29(e) perquisites are allowable up to Tk. 2,50,000 per employee.
4.3
Provident Fund:
Provident fund is the fund where funds are accumulated during the active period of employees
for his financial protection at the end of his service life, amount contributed by the employee or
the employer or both employee and employer. The amount lying in the fund is invested in trust
securities that yield fair but secured returns. When an employee leaves his service either on
retirement or for any other reason, he gets back the money standing to the credit of his
provident fund account. In case of death of the employee, the amount is refunded to his
nominee. Provident fund is a social security measure provided to employees for his rainy days of
post-employment period. There are three types of provident fund:
General Provident Fund
Statutory Provident Fund
Contributory Provident Fund
Provident Fund
Only, employers contribution to RPF and interest thereon are included in the total salary
income of the employee as per the rules.
Accumulated balance at the credit of employee in the RPF, when received shall be excluded
from total salary income under Para 21(b), Part A of Sixth Schedule of the ITO, 1984.
Ordinance, 1984 or under any other applicable acts or laws and is not approved by the
commissioner of taxes. In this fund, both the employees and employer contributes and generally
it is found in non-government organization. In this case, the employers contribution and interest
thereon is not included in the total income of the employee. At the time of the employees
retirement, the accumulated balance of the UPF except employees contribution and interest
thereon is included in the total income.
Points to remember at the time of tax computation:
a. Employer may contribute as well as employee to this provident fund, but nothing will be
added in the salary income.
b. At the time of employees retirement, the accumulated balance of this fund minus the
employees contribution plus interest thereon is taxable and will be added with salary.
Approved Superannuation Fund (ASF):
This type of fund is created for granting pension and other benefit to the employees on their
retirement, or after a specified age or his death. This fund is run by the individual name of the
employees. This fund is approved and run under the provisions of Part A, First Schedule of the
ITO, 1984. Both employee and employer contribute to the fund. The contribution of the
employer is added to the income of the employee. But interest on this fund and any amount
received from it is not added to income.
Approved Gratuity Fund (AGF):
If the employer agrees to constitute a gratuity fund for the employees on the contract of job,
then the employer contributes to the gratuity fund for the benefit of the employees in the event
of retirement. The approved gratuity fund is approved by NBR and run under the conditions
mentioned in in First Schedule, Part C. Employee contributes nothing in this fund. The
contribution of the employer is considered as income of employee. But interest on this fund and
any amount received from it is not added to income.
Workers Participation Fund (WPF):
It is established under the Companies Profit (workers participation) Act, 1968 (Act. XII of 1968).
Any payment received by an employee from this fund, subject to prescribed limits and
conditions, shall be excluded from the total income as provided under Para 21(d), Part A of Sixth
Schedule to the Income Tax Ordinance, 1984.
4.4
Any income from a provident fund established under the Provident Fund Act, 1925 or
workers participation fund. (Para 4)
Any special allowance, benefits or perquisite specifically granted to meet some official
expenses. (Para 5)
Pension (Para 8)
Gratuity (Para 20)
Any receipt from government and recognized provident fund, approved superannuation
fund and a workers participation fund. (Para 21)
Interest on recognized provident fund if it does not exceed 1/3rd of basic salary or
interest amount computed @ 14.5% per annum. (Para 25)
Any amount received by an employee of a government organization, a local authority, or
an autonomous or semi-autonomous body at the time of his retirement. (Para 26)
Any income deducted to a deferred annuity or for making provisions for his wife or children,
provided that the sum so deducted shall not exceed one-fifth of the salary. (Para 3)
Employees contribution to a Government/Statutory Provident Fund. (Para 4)
Employees and Employers contribution to a RPF. (Para 5)
Ordinary annual contribution to approved superannuation fund. (Para 6)
Employees contribution to a benevolent fund or group insurance scheme. (Para 17)
Basic Salary
Dearness Allowance
Bonus
Commission and fees
Advance salary
Accrued Salary
Leave encashment
Pension
Gratuity
Annuity
Profit in lieu of Salary
Profit in addition to Salary
Education Allowance for children
Employers contribution to RPF
Employers contribution to Approved
Superannuation Fund
Employers contribution to Approved
Gratuity Fund
Employers contribution to life
insurance policy
Entertainment Allowance
Medical Allowance
Traveling Allowance
Special Allowance
4.6
4.7
Worked Example 1
From the following data compute the total income and tax payable by Mr. Amit for the year ended
30 June 2011:Elements of Salary
Basic salary
Bonus
Free furnished accommodation
Employees contribution to RPF
Car
Rule
@ Tk 10,000 p.m.
2 months Basic Pay
Tk.
1,20,000
6,000
Mr. Amit
Income Tax Assessment Year 2011-12
Income for year ended on 30 June 2011
Computation of Total Income and Tax Liability
Income from salaries u/s 21:
Basic salary @ Tk. 10,000 p.m. for 12 months
Free Furnished Accommodation 25% of basic
Car @ 7.5% of basic salary (note 1)
Employers Contribution to RPF 10% of Basic
Bonus 2 months basic
Total taxable income
Tk.
1,20,000
30,000
9,000
12,000
20,000
1,91,000
0
1,650
1,650
3,000
2,000
Note 1:
Conveyance used partly for personal and partly for business is not exempted rather
added with salary to an amount that is equal to 7.5% of basic and thus taxable.
Note 2:
Tk.
Tk.
Maximum Limit:
20% of Tk. 179,000 (total taxable income excluding employers contribution to RPF) Tk.
35,800 or Tk. 1,00,00,000, whichever is less
Tk.
35,800
Thus, allowable investment allowance will be Tk. 30,000 on which 10% tax rebate is
calculated.
Note 3:
Minimum tax liability is Tk. 2,000 for individual. Thus tax liability, in no case can be lower
than Tk. 2,000.
Worked Example 2
Mr. Milky, CEO of a Multinational company in Bangladesh, has got the following income for the income
year ended 30 June 2011. You are required to calculate the total income and tax payable of Mr. Milky
(a)
(b)
(c)
Full time company car for 24 hrs for his own use and for his family.
(d)
Company pays Tk. 100,000 p/m. for his three school going children which is paid to the school
authority directly.
(e)
He received two festival bonuses equivalent to basic pay during the festival time which he spent
partly for his family and partly for the poor people in his village.
(f)
Driver's salary was Tk. 10,000 p/m paid to his driver's bank account.
(g)
Company paid Tk. 300,000 to him during the year being the reimbursement of various utility bills
of his house;
(h)
(i)
He was paid Tk. 1,000,000 for his overseas travels for the official trip out of which he saved 25%
during that income year;
(j)
(k)
(l)
He has got one house of his own at Baridhara and he received total Tk. 1200,000 as rent
(m)
(n)
He invested Tk. 1500,000 on Govt. bonds and primary shares of various companies;
(o)
(ICAB adapted)
Solution 2:
Mr. Milky
Income tax assessment year 2011-2012
Accounting year ended 30 June 2011
Computation of total income and tax liability
Income from salaries u/s 21:
Basic salary @ Tk. 150,000 p.m. for 12 months
Free Furnished Accommodation 25% of basic
Car @ 7.5% of basic salary (note 1)
Fee to school going children
Festival Bonus
Reimbursement of Utility Bills
Savings from Official Oversees Travel
Bills paid for International Club
Total income from salaries
Tk. 150,000 12
Tk. 18,00,000 25%
Tk. 18,00,000 7.5%
Tk. 1,00,000 12
Tk. 150,000 2
Tk. 10,00,000 25%
Tk.
18,00,000
4,50,000
1,35,000
12,00,000
3,00,000
3,00,000
2,50,000
2,50,000
46,85,000
1,66,667
12,00,000
3,00,000
9,00,000
1,66,667
59,18,334
0
30,000
60,000
60,000
11,84,584
13,34,584
1,18,367
12,16,217
16,667
16,667
33,334
11,82,883
Note 1:
Conveyance used partly for personal and partly for business is not exempted rather
added with salary to an amount that is equal to 7.5% of basic and thus taxable.
Note 2:
Tk.
Tk.
15,00,000
1,50,000
16,50,000
Maximum Limit:
20% of Tk. 59,18,334 (total taxable income excluding employers contribution to RPF)
Tk. 11,83,667 or Tk. 1,00,00,000, whichever is less
Tk.
11,83,667
Thus, allowable investment allowance will be Tk. 11,83,667 on which 10% tax rebate is
calculated.
Worked Example 3
Mr. Mallik is a service holder. Following are the particulars of his income from salary for the year
ended on 30th June 2011:
a.
b.
c.
d.
He has been provided with a rent-free quarter, the annual rectal value of which is
Tk. 50,000.
e.
He has been provided with a car for both office and private use.
f.
g.
h.
i.
j.
k.
l.
Solution 3:
Tk.
Tk.
Tk.
3,00,000
30,000
50,000
50,000
22,500
3,000
3,000
6,000
6,000
2,400
Total
4,54,900
'. Particulars
Employee's contribution to Statutory Provident Fund, 10% of B.S. (3,00,000x10%)
Employee's contribution to Group Insurance Scheme 1% of B.S. (3,00,000x1 %)
Contribution to DPS (500x12)
Total
30,000
3,000
6,000
39,000
Note:
1.
If actual expense regarding medical and travel is not given, then the full amount of
such allowances can be considered as expensed and be deducted as exemption.
2.
Employer i.e. the government does not contribute to the statutory provident fund.
Worked Example 4
On June 2011, Mr. Anil Ambani's basic salary falls on Tk. 10,200 in the scale of 9,600-200x1212,000.
His date of yearly increment is on 1st April. He received dearness allowance @ 10% of basic salary
and medical allowance Tk. 300 per month. During the year his actual amount of medical expense
was Tk. 3,000. He received two bonuses equivalent to one month's basic salary-one received before
the date of increment and another after increment. He contributes 10% of his basic salary to a
recognized provident fund from which he has also received an interest of Tk. 1,500 @ 15% interest.
His employer also contributes the same amount to the RPF. He has been provided with a rent-free
quarter and a car for both official and personal purpose. During the year he has also received an
entertainment allowance of Tk. 5,000 of which Tk. 4,500 has actually been spent. His investments
during the year were as follows:
a.
b.
c.
Payment of his life insurance premium Tk. 4,000 (Policy value Tk. 35,000)
d.
e.
Compute taxable income and tax liability of Mr. Anil Ambani for the assessment year 2011-12.
Solution 4:
Tk.
3,600
3,000
Tk.
Tk.
1,20,600
12,060
600
20,200
12,060
1,500
1,450
50
30,150
9,045
5,000
2,09,765
Amount (Tk.)
2,000
24,120
3,500
6,000
35,620
Maximum limit of the investment allowance: 20% of Total income excluding employer's contribution
to RPF and interest on the accumulated balance of RPF i.e. [(2,09,765 - 12,060 50) x 20%] = 41,953
or Tk. 10,00,00,000 whichever is less. So, the required amount of investment allowance on which
10% tax rebate will be applicable is Tk. 35,620.
Tax liability
On the first
Tk. 1,80,000
On the next
29,765
Total
2,09,765
Less: investment tax credit (35,620 x10%)
Rate
0%
10%
Amount (Tk.)
Nil
2,977
2,977
3,562
(585)
Since the computed tax liability is less than the minimum amount of tax i.e. Tk. 2,000, the net tax
liability of Mr. Syful Hoque for the assessment year 2011-12 will be Tk. 2,000.
Worked Example 5
Mr. Zaman Hoque was the HR Manager of Axiata Bangladesh Ltd. On July 2010, his basic salary was
Tk. 52,000 in the scale of 40,000-4,000x8-72,000. His date of yearly increment is on 26th March. He
was terminated from Axiata Bangladesh ltd on 30th April, 2011 and Joined Grameenphone Ltd on 1st
June of the same year. During the income year his income from salary from Axiata Bangladesh Ltd
and Grameenphone Ltd. Were as follows:
From Axiata:
He received dearness allowance @ 10% of basic salary and medical allowance Tk. 2000 per month.
He received two festival bonuses each equivalent to one month's basic salary in the month of
September and April respectively. He contributes 10% of his basic salary to a recognized provident
fund. He has been provided with a rent-free quarter and a full time car by the employer. During the
year he has also received an entertainment allowance of Tk. 1,000 per month. He has received
compensation for the termination of Tk. 2,00,000 and gratuity of Tk. 1,00,000. Moreover, his
accumulated balance from the RPF was Tk. 1,80,000.
From Grameenphone:
His basic is Tk. 60,000 per month with 40% house rent allowance and Tk. 5,000 medical allowance
per month. He is also entitled to receive Tk. 4,000 conveyance allowance per month. He contributes
10% of his basic salary to a recognized provident fund, his employer also contributes the same.
His taxable income from other sources were Tk. 2,00,000 during the year. During the year the total
IDS from various sources of his income was Tk. 20,000. Moreover, his refund claims of Tk. 10,000
for additional payment of tax in the last assessment year was to be adjusted with current years tax
liability. His investments during the year were as follows:
a.
b.
Payment of his life insurance premium Tk. 20,000 (Policy value Tk. 5,00,000)
c.
Compute taxable income and tax liability of Mr. Ahmed for the assessment year 2011-12.
Solution 5:
Tk. Tk.
5,84,774
52,477
25,000
25,000
1,08,000
58,477
1,00,000
1,00,000
1,80,000
1,80,000
1,31,194
39,358
10,000
2,00,000
.
-
24,000
15,000
4,000
24,000
9,000
.
--------11,93,280
2,00,000,
13,93,280
Amount (Tk,)
1,00,000
20,000
36,000
1,16,954
2,72,954
Maximum limit of the investment allowance: 20% of Total income excluding employers contribution
to RPF and interest on the accumulated balance of RPF i.e. ((13,93,280-58,477) x 20%) = 2,66,691or
Tk. 10,00,00,000 whichever is less, So, the required amount of investment allowance on which 10%
tax rebate will be applicable is Tk. 2,66,691.
Tax liability:
Amount
(Tk.)
Nil
30,000
60,000
60,000
53,320
2,03,320
(26,669)
(20,000)
(10,000)
Rate
On the first
Tk. 1,80,000
On the next
3,00,000
On the next
4,00,000
On the next
3,00,000
On the next
2,13,280
Total
13,93,280
Less: Investment tax credit (2,66,691 x10%)
TDS
Refund adjustment
0%
10%
15%
20%
25%
1,46,651
Note:
1.
Total Basic Salary:
From Axiata:
B. S. from July 10 to February 11 = [Tk. 52,000 x 8]
B. S. for the month March 11 = [(52,000"25/31) + (56,000"6/31)]
B. S. for the month April 11
From Grameenphone:
B. S. for the month June 11
Total Basic salary for the income year 2010-11
2.
3.
= Tk. 4,16,000
= Tk. 52,774
= Tk. 56,000
= Tk. 5,24,774
=
=
Tk. 60,000
Tk. 5,84,774
Since conveyance allowance is received from a separate company, the exemption limit has
considered.
In the month of May he was not employed. So, Basic salary for the month of May is not
available.
Chapter 5
5.1
5.2
5.3
5.4
5.5
5.6
5.7
5.8
Topic List
Introduction
Nature of Securities
Cum-Interest vs. Ex-Interest
Bond Washing Transactions
Types of Securities
Interest Grossing Up
Expenses Admissible
Exemption
Work
ed
Exam
ples
and
Soluti
ons
Introduction
Learning objectives
Practical significance
Income from interest on securities is the second head of income. It is very important to know
interest bearing securities traded in market and how this income is brought under the purview of
taxation. Though the revenue from this source is not so significant to the Government, still this
chapter comprises some technicalities over which professional accountants should have the
expertise.
Application of cum and ex interest and bond washing transaction in computing taxable interest
income is very important and necessitates professional judgment and competence. These topics
are explained in this chapter.
This chapter has practical significance in a sense that the students will interact with the capital
market directly. Approved commercial securities are traded in the market and thus the
professional accountants can play a significant role in computing tax liability of individuals and
corporate as well.
You will find the details of the above issues in this chapter with some practical example.
Stop and think
Do you realize that the computation of taxable income under the head interest on securities is
one of the seven heads of total income and includes some complexity? Do you feel that you are
in a position to compute tax liability under this head independently? Can you visualize the scope
of tax avoidance and remedies in this regard?
Working context
In practice, as the accountants are sometime required to support to prepare their clients' tax
returns, they need to advise the clients on how to calculate the taxable income from different
heads for the income year. Before advising the clients, accountants should have the clear concept
relating to the admissible and inadmissible expenses and exemptions so that they can deduct or
add the expenses in determining the taxable income.
Syllabus links
The topics covered in this chapter are very important for computing taxable income which is
required for solving sample practical problems at this level.
You will be also using this knowledge when you tackle the taxation paper later on in the
Professional Stage and it will also underpin the technical aspects at the Advanced Stage.
Examination context
Exam requirements
In the examination, candidates may be required to:
Question practice
For question practice on these topics go to the suggested answers covering this chapter and also
this manual.
Examiner's comments on how students tackle questions
Candidates have to be prepared well for this area as this chapter consists of one concept on
computation of total taxable income which is vital for calculating tax liability. Clear concept and
understanding of each contents of this chapter will help candidates to resolve any problems
relating to computation of income.
5.0
INTEREST ON SECURITIES
Section Overview
There are seven heads of income.
The total income may not be taxable income.
There are some allowable, inadmissible and not permissible deductions under different heads
of income.
Computation of salary and business income has the most significance.
The perquisites and allowances need to be considered before determining salary income
Depreciation allowances is very important for determining some business profit
Tax shall be payable on capital gains in respect of any profits arising from the transfer of a
capital assets except some cases.
The two main methods of accounting are cash system and mercantile system.
An assessee may be allowed to set off and carry forwarded of losses.
5.1
Introduction
Scope
As per section 22 of ITO 1984, Income classifiable under the head Interest on Securities
includes:
(i)
(ii)
Section 22 deals with interest on securities issued by (i) the Government, (ii) a local authority,
or (iii) a company. Debentures or other securities issued by a company also fall within the scope
of this section.
Exclusion
All other securities, e. g. securities issued by a foreign Government, etc. are outside the ambit of
this section, and interest thereon would be charged u/s 28 or 33. The shares of a company
cannot be called securities for money. Dividends on shares would be taxable u/s 28 if they are
received in the course of carrying on a business in shares, and in other cases, under the residuary
head of sec. 33.
When Payable
Under Section 22, tax is payable in respect of interest receivable by the assessee on securities.
But interest on securities becomes income only when it is actually received and not when it is
due or capable of being received by the assessee. The word receivable in this section has
reference to the quantum of interest taxable and not to the date of taxability. If interest is
actually received some times after it become due and receivable, the date of taxability is the date
when it is received and not the date when it becomes due.
Allowable Deductions
Deductions permissible in the determination of income from interest on securities as per section
23 are:
(i)
Commission or charges deducted from interest by a bank realising the interest on behalf on
the assessee;
(ii)
Interest payable on money borrowed for the purpose of investment in the securities. To
claim relief for interest on borrowed fund, such fund must be borrowed solely for
investment in securities and should be so used throughout, even if the moneys borrowed
for business purpose are invested in securities for a period under some legal compulsion,
no deduction for interest under this section is allowed [Indian Steamship Co. V. CIT (1953) I.
T.R. 448].
5.2
Nature of Securities
Dealings of securities may have varied purpose from the part of the investors. For example, it
may take any of the following three natures:
Trading Securities
Securities
Trading securities are those types of securities where the main purpose is to earn profit through
trading (buying and selling) of securities. However, held to maturity securities are those types of
securities where investment is made for a long time period. However, available for sale securities
fall in between which is not an investment for long time or where the dealing is not so frequent.
The investors wait for a while to see how to maximize profit on the deal. As interest on
securities is a separate head of income, even if the securities are held as trading assets with in the
course of business undertaken by a bank or an insurance company or a stock broker, the
interest must be charged under this head and not under S. 28 as income from business or
profession or under S. 33 as income from other sources [Central Exchange Bank LTD. V. C.I.T.
(1955) I.T.R. 167].
5.3
the sale price of securities. There is wide scope to avoid tax through systematically buying and
selling securities just on the eve of the payment of interest and S.106 has given sufficient authority
to the DCT to handle those cases of tax avoidance. The basic principle to note however is that to
be assessed on the interest on securities the assessee does not have to be owner of the securities
throughout the period for which such interest arises and paid of. Even one day of ownership is
enough to attract the provisions of the section.
To understand the application of cum and ex interest, lets assume that it takes 10 days to close
books prior to coupon payment date. Therefore if the coupon date is the 31st December each
year, the books closed date would be listed as the 21st December (there are exceptions). The
day prior to the Books Closed date is known as the last date to register (LDR) - this is the date
on which the holders of the bond are designated to receive the coupon. Essentially, the issuer or
central depositary (or settlement agent) will establish who owns the bond on the LDR date and
the coupon will be paid to this person on the coupon date irrespective of whether they actually
own the bond on Coupon payment date.
Cum Interest
LCD
Ex Interest
LDR BCD
Where:
LDR = Last date to register
NCD = Next coupon date
NCD
This books closed period is referred to as the ex-interest period (or just ex period) i.e. the date
when the purchaser of the bond is not entitled to the next coupon. A bond which is trading cum
interest simply means that the purchaser will receive the next coupon, the whole amount.
Example:
Mr. X holds 15% debenture of BDT 500,000 on which coupon becomes due on 31st December
each year. On November 30, 2010, Mr. X sold the debenture to Mr. Y cum interest. Mr. X
charges the BDT as computed below.
Face Value
Interest Due at the date of transaction
Selling Price
[500,00015%9/12]
BDT
500,000
56,250
556,250
Mr. X will collect the interest due for the holding period (from January to November) from Mr.
Y. Mr. Y will receive the full amount of interest on December 31st and include the same with
taxable income on which tax will be payable by him at regular rate. However, Mr. X will pay no
taxes on interest as this is capital gain to him and this is not taxable.
5.4
To prevent the avoidance of tax in this manner, Section 106(1) of the ITO, 1984 provides that
where a security owner transfers the securities on the eve of due date of interest and reacquires
them eventually, the interest received by the transferee/purchaser will be deemed as income of
the transferor/seller and, accordingly, it will be included in the total income of the
transferor/seller and not the transferee/purchaser. There is wide scope to avoid tax in this way
and Section 106 has given sufficient authority to the DCT to handle those cases of tax avoidance.
5.5
Types of Securities
In terms of taxability, securities may be classified as either Government securities (securities
issued or approved by the Government) or Commercial securities (securities issue by others).
Tax Free
Government
Less Tax
Securities
Approved
Debenture
Commercial
Unapproved
Zero Coupon Bond
Example:
If you want to purchase a Company XYZ zero-coupon bond that has a BDT 1,000 face value and
matures in three years, and you would like to earn 10% per year on the investment, using the
formula above you might be willing to pay:
BDT 1,000 / (1+.05)6 = BDT 746.22
Thus the income from investment in zero-coupon bond here will be BDT 253.78 (BDT 1,000
BDT 746.22).
5.6
Interest Grossing Up
When interest is received after deducting tax at source, it is required to gross up. The amount of
interest received is not the total interest income and thus the amount of tax already paid should
be added back to compute actual interest income. The process is named as interest grossing up.
However, grossing up is not required if tax is not deducted at source. The following formulae
may be used to compute gross interest:
Gross Interest
Net Interest
1 Fraction of TDS Rate
Example:
Say, net interest received is BDT 9,000 after deducting taxes @ 10%. Gross interest is BDT
10,000 (BDT 9,000 / 1 - 0.1). Here,
5.7
BDT 9,000
BDT 10,000
Expenses Admissible
As per section 23 of ITO 1984, the following expenses are admissible for deduction to compute
income taxable under the head:
1. Bank commission/charges for collection of interest: If such interest is collected
through bank and eventually bank charges the client for collecting interest, such amount can
be deducted for computing taxable income with the following two exceptions:
a. This deduction is not permissible if such charge is made for collecting interest of such
securities on which tax cannot be imposed. Ex: tax free government securities, zero
coupon bond.
b. If bank commission is charged for purchasing securities, it will not be considered as an
allowable expense.
2. Interest on borrowed capital for investment in securities: Any interest on money
borrowed for the purpose of investment in the securities by the assessee will be an
allowable expense. But interest on borrowed capital for investment in tax-free government
securities and zero-coupon bond is not allowable expense as interest on these securities is
not taxable.
5.8
Exemption
Interest income is exempted from taxes in following occasions as per ITO, 1984:
Securities
Tax-free government securities
Zero-coupon bond
Exemption Limit
Fully exempted
Fully exempted
Reference
Sixth Schedule, Part A, Para 24
Sixth Schedule, Part A, Para 40
His bank charged Tk. 10,000 as commission for collecting interest. He paid Tk. 75,000 as interest on a
loan which he took for the purpose of purchasing Housing Bonds.
Calculate his income under Section 22 and 23.
Solution 1:
Ms. Ananyas
Income Tax Assessment Year 2011-12
Income for year ended on 30 June 2011
Computation of Interest Income under Section 22 and 23
1. 6% Government Securities
2. 8% DCC Debenture
3. 9% Housing Bonds
4. 6% Govt. Treasury Bills
Total Income
Less: Admissible Expenses
Bank Commission
Interest on Loan
Total Taxable Income
[800,000 6/100]
[600,000 8/100]
[1,200,000 9/100]
[1,400,000 6/100]
10,000
75,000
48,000
48,000
108,000
84,000
288,000
85,000
203,000
Worked Example 2:
Investment of Mr. Adil Rahman in different securities for the year ended June 30, 2011 is given below:
a)
b)
c)
d)
e)
f)
g)
h)
i)
Solution 2:
Mr. Adil Rahman
Assessment year: 2011-2012
Income year: 2010-2011
Computation of Total Income
Tk.
Income from Interest on securities (Sec - 22 & 23)
(i) Interest on tax free government securities
Interest on 13% tax free government securities (500,000 x 13%)
Less: exempted - full
(ii) Interest on less tax government securities (27,000 x 100/100 - 10)
Interest on 10% less tax government securities (400,000x10%)
Tk.
20,000
65,000
85,000
85,000
nil
30,000
40,000
70,000
30,000
20,000
50,000
9,000
18,000
22,000
22,000
27,000
Total
nil
147,000
Worked Example 3:
Information regarding investment made in different securities by Mr. X during the income
June 30, 2011 is given below:
Securities
Date of Investment
Investment
Tax-free Government Securities
March 28, 2009
120,000
Less-tax Government Securities
February 15, 2010
150,000
14% Approved Commercial Securities
November 21, 2010 480,000
12% Approved Commercial Securities
July 01, 2010
600,000
Zero Coupon Bond
July 01, 2009
480,000
XYZ Company Stock
January 15, 2011
260,000
year ended on
Interest
14,400
16,200*
72,000
Other Information:
1. 14% approved commercial securities were purchased ex-interest from the secondary market.
Interest on this security falls due on October 31 each year.
2. 12% approved commercial securities were purchased from primary market on which interest
falls due on June 30 each year.
3. Face value of zero coupon bond is was Tk. 500,000 and Tk. 20,000 was already reported as
interest in the year of purchase.
4. XYZ Company Stock is purchased through IPO.
5. All interest is collected through bank account and the bank charges Tk. 9,000 for the service.
6. Mr. X has made following borrowings for investment in different securities:
Securities
Tax-free Government Securities
Less-tax Government Securities
14%
Approved
Commercial
Securities
12%
Approved
Commercial
Securities
Zero Coupon Bond
XYZ Company Stock
Date of Borrowing
March 28, 2009
February 15, 2010
November 21, 2010
Amount of borrowing
100,000
150,000
400,000
Rate
8%
9%
10%
500,000
10%
400,000
200,000
12%
15%
Requirements:
Compute the amount of taxable income under the head interest on securities and also mention any item
of investment allowance.
Solution 3:
Mr. X
Assessment year: 2011-2012
Income year: 2010-2011
Computation of Total Income
Income from Interest on Securities (Sec - 22 & 23)
Interest on tax free govt. securities
Less: exempted full [note 1]
Interest on less tax govt. securities as grossed up (note 2)
Less: allowable expenses
Bank charges (note 3)
Interest on borrowing (9% of Tk. 150,000)
Interest on 12% approved commercial securities
Less: allowable expenses
Bank charges (note 3)
Interest on borrowing (10% of Tk. 500,000)
Tk.
Tk.
14,400
14,400
nil
18,000
(1,440)
(13,500)
3,060
72,000
(6,300)
(50,000)
15,700
18,760
Tk. 600,000
Tk. 260,000
Provided that the total amount doesnt exceed the maximum limit
Notes:
1. No deduction is allowed in tax free government securities as no tax is imposed on such income
and thus no deduction.
2. Interest on less tax government securities is grossed up as the amount of interest received is the
net interest after charging 10% taxes. Thus the gross interest income will be Tk. 18,000 (Tk.
16,200 / 1 0.9).
3. Total bank charges of Tk. 9,000 is allocated among different securities proportionately as
computed below:
Securities
Tax-free Government Securities
Less-tax Government Securities
12% Approved Commercial Securities
Total
Interest
14,400
16,200
72,000
102,600
Proportion
14%
16%
70%
100%
Bank Charges
1,260
1,440
6,300
9,000
4. There will be no interest income from 14% approved commercial securities as it has been
purchased ex-interest.
5. There will be no income from zero coupon bond during this income year.
6. Investment in stock is not within the scope of this chapter.
Worked Example 4:
Mr. Jamal Kaiser, a non-resident Bangladeshi, is a Permanent Resident of Canada. However, he has
investments in Bangladesh managed by his relatives. The information regarding his investments in securities
during the income year 2010-11 are given below:
1.
Tk. 100,000 in 10% Bangladesh Wage Earner's Development Bond (Purchased on 1" September,
2009).
2.
3.
Interest on 10% less lax government securities Tk. 2,700. The Bank has deducted Tk. 100 as
collection fee.
4.
14% Beximco Debentures were purchased from DSE at a cost of Tk. 230,000 on 1st January, 2011
(Face value is Tk. 200,000). In this regard, he has sold 13% ACI Debenture at Tk. 150,000 on the
same day (The acquisition price was Tk. 130,000, Face value Tk. 125,000). Interest is paid on 30th
June each year by the companies on an annual basis. The bank has charged him Tk. 500 as
transaction fee.
5.
12% debentures of ABC Ltd. of the face value of Tk. 500,000 (interest is payable on 31st December
on an annual basis) were sold ex-interest on December 01, 2010 and Tk. 700,000 15% debenture of
XYZ ltd was purchased ex-interest, borrowing the additional sum from NCC Bank @ 10% interest.
The Bank has charged him Tk. 1,000 as commission for the settlement of the purchase and sales and
Tk. 1,500 for collecting interests. The due dates of payment of interest on 15% XYZ Debenture are
September 30 and March 31.
6.
The DCT identified that he has transferred 10% unapproved debenture of Tk. 100,000 to his friend
on 15th June, 2011 (interest is paid on 30th June on an annual basis) and bought it back on 3rd July,
2011 at Tk. 105,000. The DCT has identified the matter as Bond Washing.
7.
On 31" March, 2011 3 years Zero Coupon Bond of Tk. 50,000 was matured and he has received the
amount as maturity value, whether the acquisition price of the same was Tk. 35,000. The collection
fee of Tk. 500 was charged in this regard by his bank.
Determine tax payable income for Mr. Jamal Kaiser from interest on securities for the income year 2010 2011.
Solution 4:
Mr. Jamal Kaiser
Assessment year: 2011-2012
Income year: 2010-2011
Computation of Total Income
Tk.
Income from Securities (Sec: 22 & 23):
Interest form tax free government securities
Less: exemption (full)
Tk.
10,000
10,000
-
3,000
100
2,900
-
80,500
10,979
69,521
10,000
15,000
15,000
Total
82,421
Tk.
700,000
Add: Payment for accrued interest for the period October 01, 10 to November 30, 10 [Tk.
700,000 x 15% x 2/12]
Total cost
Less: Amount received from sale of ABC Debenture
Borrowings from Bank (On December 01, 2010)
17,500
717,500
555,000
162.500
(d) After the acquisition, interest on 15% XYZ debentures received in the I/Y 2010-11 is only on 31st
March, 2011 for six months, as he receives the interest on a semi-annual basis. So, the interest
amount received on 15% debentures is (700,000 x 15% x 1/2) - Tk. 52,500. The next interest will be
received on September 30, 2011 which doesn't fall in I/Y 2010-11.
(e) So, the Total interest received from approved debentures in the 1/Y 2010-11 will be:
Interest on 14% Beximco Debenture
Tk. 28,000
Tk. 52,500
Tk. 80,500
Admissible expenses:
Bank collection fee for interests
Tk. 1,500
Tk. 9,479
Tk. 10,979
4. As the sale of unapproved debentures is considered as bond washing transaction by the DCT, the
interest amount will be considered as the income of Mr. Jamal Kaiser.
Self-Assessment Question
1. (a)
(b)
What incomes are included in Interest on Securities under the Income Tax Ordinance 1984. Is
interest on private loan is an interest on securities?
What deductions are allowable from such income under the Ordinance?
Chapter 6
Income from house property
Contents
Introduction
Examination context
6.1
6.2
6.3
6.4
6.5
6.6
Topic List
Introduction
Annual Value
Self Occupancy
Allowable Deductions
Non Assessable Income
Tax Deduction at Source from House Property
ons
Work
ed
Exam
ples
and
Soluti
Introduction
Learning objectives
Identify the income under the head Income from House Property.
Compute the total taxable income under the head.
Knowing annual value and its computation.
Identify the allowable deduction under the head.
Identify non-assessable income under the head.
Explain tax deducted at sources under the head in different situations.
Compute net tax liability.
Practical significance
Income from house property is the third head of income and very significant for income tax
professionals. It includes some conceptual issues and technicalities that require clear
understanding about the topic.
Annual value is the value representing the income from house property. It is the higher value of
actual rent and municipal value. Actual rent is again adjusted for different expenses and TDS.
These computations require some rationality on part of the tenants and landlords.
Scope of allowable deductions is another difficulty. Capitalized expenses cannot be deducted and
in case of partly let out properties, expenses are deducted proportionately. Repairs and
maintenance is considered separately depending on the status of the property as either
commercial or residential due to its significance. Advance receipts from the tenants are
considered as income and at the time of refund, it has got separate treatment. All of these
adjustments are very technical and sometimes require professional judgment and this is the
reason why the chapter is practically significant.
You will find the details of the above issues in this chapter with some practical example.
Stop and think
Do you realize that the computation of taxable income under the head Income from House
Property is one of the basic requirements for determining tax liability? Can you determine the
taxable income under the head? Do you understand application of tax deducted at sources by
the tenants?
Working context
In practice, as the accountants are sometime required to support to prepare their clients' tax
returns, they need to advise the clients on how to calculate the taxable income for any income
year under different heads. Before advising the clients, accountants should have the clear concept
relating to the admissible and inadmissible expenses in different heads of income so that they can
deduct or add the expenses in determining the taxable income.
Syllabus links
The topics covered in this chapter are very important for computing taxable income which is
required for solving sample practical problems at this level.
You will be also using this knowledge when you tackle the taxation paper later on in the
Professional Stage and it will also underpin the technical aspects at the Advanced Stage.
Examination context
Exam requirements
In the examination, candidates may be required to:
Question practice
For question practice on these topics go to the suggested answers covering this chapter and also
this manual.
Examiner's comments on how students tackle questions
Candidates have to be prepared well for this area as this chapter consists of core concept on
computation of income under the head income from house property which is vital for
calculating total tax liability. Clear concept and understanding of the contents presented in this
chapter will help candidates to resolve any problems relating to computation of income from the
head.
6.0
6.1
Introduction
Scope
House Property
Let Out
Fully
Self Occupied
Partly
Taxable
Residential
Not Taxable
Commercial
Taxable Income
Annual Value (AV)
Less
Admissible Expenses:
Repair & Maintenance
For Residential 25% of AV
For Commercial 30% of AV
Other Expenses
Less
Allowances:
Vacancy Allowance
Allowance for Uncollectible Rent
Equals
Taxable Income
Section 24 is confined to buildings and lands appurtenant thereto which may be conveniently
called house properly. Tax under this section is levied upon owner, legal or beneficial, and not
upon the occupant. It is levied not upon the actual income from the property but upon statutory
or artificial income represented by bonafied annual value of the property.
Income from house property is taxable on the basis of its annual value of any property, whether
used for commercial or residential purposes consisting of any building, furniture, fixture, fittings etc.
6.2
Annual value
Annual value has been defined in Section 2(3) of the Ordinance. Under Section 2(3) (a) annual
value shall be deemed to be - (a) in relation to any property let out-(i) the sum for which property
might reasonably be expected to let from year to year and includes any amount received by letting
out furniture, fixture, fittings etc; or (ii) where the annual rent in respect thereof is excess of the
sum referred to in section 2(3)(a)(i), the amount of the annual rent.
Thus, annual value is not necessarily be the annual rental income disclosed by an assessee but the
value determined as such by the tax authorities. If the annual rent is higher than the value as
determined by the tax authorities on the basis of the expected rent, annual rent is considered as
the annual value.
Where the property is owned by two or more persons and their respective shares are definite
and ascertainable, the owners are assessable on their respective share of income from the
property and not as an association of persons.
Thus the annual value will be the higher one between actual rent and municipal value. Actual rent
is the amount of rent received or deemed to be received by the owner. It may require some
adjustments as shown below:
Annual Value
Higher one
Actual Rent
Municipal Value
Adjusted for
1. Tenants expense born by the landlord
2. Landlords expense born by the tenants
3. Tax Deducted at Sources
Less
Add
Add
Quick Guide
Tenants Expenses
occupancy)
(Expenses
for
temporary
Illustration 1
Mr. Brahman owns a 5 storied residential house with 3 flats in each story. This is a fully let out
house property and monthly rent of each flat is Tk. 8,000. Municipal value of the house is Tk.
1,600,000. Compute annual value.
Annual Value:
Actual Rent [Tk. 8,000 3 5 12]
Municipal Value
Tk. 1,440,000
Tk. 1,600,000
Tk. 1,600,000
Illustration 2
Mr. Brahman owns a 5 storied residential house with 3 flats in each story. He occupied all the
flats in second floor for residence purpose. Other flats are let out for residential purpose and
monthly rent of each flat is Tk. 8,000. Municipal value of the house is Tk. 1,600,000. Compute
annual value.
Annual Value:
Actual Rent [Tk. 8,000 3 4 12]
Municipal Value [(Tk. 1,600,000 15)/12]
Annual Value, whichever is higher
Tk. 1,152,000
Tk. 1,280,000
Tk. 1,280,000
Illustration 3
Mr. Brahman owns a 5 storied residential house with 3 flats in each story. He occupied all the
flats in second floor for residence purpose. Other flats are let out for residential purpose and
monthly rent of each flat is Tk. 8,000 including Tk. 1,000 for water, gas and electricity bill.
Municipal value of the house is Tk. 1,600,000. Compute annual value.
Annual Value:
Actual Rent [Tk. 8,000 3 4 12]
Less: Tenants expense born by landlord [Tk. 1,000 3 4
12]
Actual Rent after Adjustment
Municipal Value [(Tk. 1,600,000 15)/12]
Annual Value, whichever is higher
Tk. 1,152,000
Tk. 144,000
Tk. 1,008,000
Tk. 1,280,000
Tk. 1,280,000
Illustration 4
Mr. Brahman owns a 5 storied residential house with 3 flats in each story. He occupied all the
flats in second floor for residence purpose. Other flats are let out for residential purpose and
monthly rent of each flat is Tk. 8,000. In addition to monthly rent, tenants also bear property
taxes and other taxes at the rate of Tk. 10,000 per tenant annually. Municipal value of the house
is Tk. 1,600,000. Compute annual value.
Annual Value:
Actual Rent [Tk. 8,000 3 4 12]
Add: Landlords expense born by tenant [Tk. 10,000 3 4]
Actual Rent after Adjustment
Municipal Value [(Tk. 1,600,000 15)/12]
Annual Value, whichever is higher
Tk. 1,152,000
Tk. 120,000
Tk. 1,272,000
Tk. 1,280,000
Tk. 1,280,000
Illustration 5
Mr. Brahman owns a 5 storied building which is let out to a business house. After deducting
taxes, Mr. Brahman receives Tk. 1,900,000 annually. Mr. Brahman is responsible to pay for all gas,
electricity and water bills which amount to Tk. 80,000 annually. However, as per the agreement,
the business house is required to pay all taxes and insurance premium for the building which
amounts to another Tk. 180,000. Municipal value of the house is Tk. 2,000,000. Compute
annual value. [Note: Applicable TDS rate is 5%]
Annual Value:
Actual Rent
Add: Landlords expense born by tenant
Add: Tax deducted at sources [(Tk. 1,900,000/1-0.05) 0.05]
Less: Tenants expense born by landlord
Actual Rent after Adjustment
Municipal Value
Annual Value, whichever is higher
6.3
Tk. 1,900,000
Tk. 180,000
Tk. 100,000
(Tk. 80,000)
Tk. 2,100,000
Tk. 2,000,000
Tk. 2,100,000
Self Occupancy
The house property may be occupied by the owner either for residential or business purpose. In
such cases, the following points are important to note down:
a) If self occupied for residential purpose: Annual value is not required to be determined since
there is no income from house property and no tax as well.
b) If self occupied for business purpose: It is assessed under the head income from business and
profession as per section 28. He is not entitled to claim deductions under this section,
however, can claim depreciation on such property.
6.4
Allowable Deductions
As per section 25, while determining the net income under Income from house property, the
following deductions are allowable:
(i) Any sum payable to Government as land development Tax or rent on account of the land
comprised in the property.
(ii) Any premium paid to insure the property against risk of damage or destruction
(iii) Interest on mortgage or other capital charge for the purpose of reconstruction, extension or
improvement of the house property.
(iv) Annual charge not being a capital charge
(v) Ground rent.
(vi) Interest payable on capital borrowed for the purpose of acquisition, construction,
reconstruction, repair or renovation of the house property.
Provided that where the property or a portion thereof is self occupied and acquired, constructed,
renewed or reconstructed with borrowed capital, the amount of any interest, payable on such
borrowed capital not exceeding taka twenty lakh, shall be deducted from total income;
(vii) Where the property has been constructed with borrowed capital and no income was earned
during the period of construction, interest payable during that period on such capital, in
three equal proportionate installments for subsequent 3 years for which income is assessable
from that property.
(viii)
In respect of expenditure for repairs, collection of rent, water and sewerage, electricity
and salary of darwan, security guard, pump-man, lift-man and caretaker and all other
expenditure related to maintenance and provision of basic services:
(a)
an amount equal to 25% of the annual value of the property in respect of all expenses
mentioned in (i) above where the property is used for residential purpose;
(b) an amount equal to 30% of the annual value of the property in respect of all expenses
mentioned in (i) above where the property is used for commercial purpose.
(vi) Proportionate vacancy allowance of the period for which the property remains wholly
unoccupied and in case of partly let out property such portion of annual value appropriate to
the vacant part as is proportionate to the period of the vacancy of such part.
Interest or annual charge payable outside Bangladesh shall not be allowed as deduction on
which tax has not been paid or deducted at source.
6.5
6.6
Amount of payments
Rate of TDS
Nil
3%
5%
Cost of repairs
Alterations expenses
Interest on mortgage
Fire insurance premium
Municipal taxes
Legal action to recover unpaid rent which was later realized Tk. 6,000.
Required: Calculate his income under Section 24 of the Ordinance
Solution 1:
Mr. Mushtaque Ahmed
Income Tax Assessment Year 2011-12
Income for year ended on 30 June 2011
Computation of Total Income under Section 24
Annual value:
Actual Rent (Tk. 10,000 12 months)
Municipal value
Whichever is higher
Less: Allowable Deductions
Repair and Maintenance 25% of Tk. 120,000
Interest on Mortgage
Fire Insurance Premium
Municipal Taxes
Vacancy Allowance (Tk. 10,000 3)
Total Deductions
Taxable income under the head
120,000
nil
120,000
30,000
12,000
5,000
10,000
30,000
87,000
33,000
Worked Example 2:
Mr. Faruq owns a residential house at Santinagar, Dhaka, which was constructed 10 years back with a
15% loan of Tk. 20,00,000 from House Building Finance Corporation. The house has been let out for
commercial purpose at Tk. 150,000 per month. The municipal value of the house is Tk. 15,00,000.
The following expenses were incurred in the income year 2010 - 2011 for that house:
1. Repair expense Tk. 44,000;
2. City Corporation tax Tk. 35,000;
3. Rent collection expenses Tk. 12,000;
4. Fire insurance premium Tk. 8000 per quarter;
Compute income from house property for the assessment year 2011-12.
Solution 2:
Mr. Faruq
Income year: 2010 - 2011
Assessment year: 2011-2012
Calculation of Total Income
Computation of Total Income under Section 24
Annual value:
Actual Rent (Tk. 150,000 12 months)
Municipal value
Whichever is higher
Less: Allowable Deductions
Repair and Maintenance 30% of Tk. 18,00,000
City Corporate Tax
Fire Insurance Premium (Tk. 8,000 4 )
Interest on borrowed fund (15% of Tk. 20,00,000)
Total Deductions
Taxable income under the head
18,00,000
15,00,000
18,00,000
450,000
35,000
32,000
300,000
817,000
983,000
Notes:
1. Since the house is let out for commercial purpose, repair and maintenance expense is considered as
30% of the annual value. Here actual spending for repair expenses and collection expenses is not
relevant.
2. Annual expenses should be deducted from the annual value of the house. So fire insurance premium
is converted to annual figure by multiplying 4 with quarterly premium.
Worked Example 3:
Mr. Marwari has a house at Mohakhali C/A with an area of 4,800 square feet. He let out this house to a
computer firm at an annual rent of Tk. 600,000. The municipal value per square feet at
Mohakhali
C/A is Tk. 120. The following expenses were incurred in the income year 2010 - 2011 for that house:
1. Repair expense Tk. 90,000;
2. City Corporation tax Tk. 15,000;
3. Fire insurance premium Tk. 9,000;
4. Night guard's salary Tk. 7,000;
5. Installation of electricity line Tk. 25,000;
During the year Mr. Marwari paid installment of loan to HBFC Tk. 67,500 (principal amount is Tk.
64,000). According to the agreement the owner bears the water and gas bill of the tenant which
amounted to Tk. 20,000 for the year. Compute income from house property for the income year ended
30th June 2011.
Solution 3:
Mr. Marwari
Income year: 2010-2011
Assessment year: 2011-2012
Calculation of Total Income
Computation of Total Income under Section 24
Annual value:
Actual Rent
Less: Tenants expense born by the landlord
Revised Actual Rent
Municipal value (4,800 Tk. 120)
Whichever is higher
Less: Allowable Deductions
Repair and Maintenance 30% of Tk. 5,80,000
City Corporate Tax
Fire Insurance Premium
Interest on borrowed fund (Tk. 67,500 Tk. 64,000)
Total Deductions
Taxable income under the head
6,00,000
20,000
5,80,000
5,76,000
5,80,000
174,000
15,000
9,000
3,500
2,01,500
3,78,500
Notes:
1. Since the house is let out for commercial purpose, repair and maintenance expense is considered as
30% of the annual value. Here actual spending for such a purpose is not considerable.
2. Installation of electricity line is a capital expenditure, so this is not admissible.
Worked Example 4:
Mr. Pakrasi is the owner of three houses at Gulshan, Dhaka; Khulsi, Chittagong; and Mia Bazar, Comilla.
Details of these houses are given below:
Details
Number of stories
Number of flats in each story
Rental status
House at
Gulshan
3
2
Fully let out
Tk.
9,00,000
12,000
House at
House at
Khulsi
Mia Bazar
1
2
1
4
Self Occupied Partly let out
Tk.
Tk.
1,20,000
7,00,000
7,000
Solution 4:
Mr. Pakrasi
Income year: 2010 - 2011
Assessment year: 2011-2012
Calculation of Total Income
8,64,000
9,00,000
9,00,000
225,000
2,000
8,000
14,400
5,000
25,000
2,79,400
620,600
5,04,000
5,25,000
5,25,000
157,500
4,500
4,500
3,000
1,69,500
355,500
976,100
Notes:
1. House at Khulsi is occupied by the owner, so it is fully exempted.
2. The flats occupied by the son are exempted as they are fully dependent on the owner.
Worked Example 5:
Mr. Jamilur Rahman is the owner of a five-storied building at Lalmatia. He resides with his family in the 2nd
floor and all other floors (in each floor there are two units) are let out for residential purpose at a
monthly rent of Tk. 10,000 per flat including Tk. 1,000 as WASA and DESA bill. The municipal value of
the house is Tk. 1,000,000. Mr. Jamilur Rahman also receives Tk. 450,000 as advance from the tenant of
the units during the income year ended on June 30, 2011.
Mr. Rahman presents the following information for deduction:
1. Repair expenses Tk. 130,000;
2. Land development tax Tk. 22,000;
3. Insurance premium Tk. 16,000;
4. Caretaker and Night guard salary Tk. 24,000;
9,60,000
96,000
8,64,000
8,00,000
8,64,000
4,50,000
13,14,000
216,000
22,000
16,000
2,000
18,000
9,000
270,000
5,53,000
7,61,000
Note 1: The amount received in advance is deemed to be the income of the assessee for the income
year in which it is received and be classified under the head Income from House Property.
Worked Example 6:
Mr. Rana Mazumder is the owner of a two-storied building at Dhanmondi where he stays with his family
in ground floor and another floor has been let out to a government authority at a gross monthly rent of
Tk. 30,000. However, he has taken a 13% loan of Tk. 500,000 on November 01, 2010 from HBFC for
modernization of the building and the floor remained vacant for two months during the modernization
period. It is again let out to the same authority from January 1, 2011 at a gross monthly rent of Tk.
50,000. The government authority deducts tax at source at prescribed rates before paying the rent to
him. The municipal value of the house is Tk. 900,000.
The following expenses were incurred in the income year 2010 - 2011 for that house:
1. Repair expenses Tk. 50,000;
2. City Corporation tax Tk. 22,000;
3. Insurance premium Tk. 16,000;
Solution 6:
Mr. Rana Mazumder
Income year: 2010 - 2011
Assessment year: 2011 - 2012
Calculation of Total Income
Computation of Total Income under Section 24
Annual value:
Actual Rent (Tk. 21,900 6) + (Tk. 47,500 6)
Municipal value (9,00,000 1/2)
Whichever is higher
Less: Allowable Deductions
Repair and Maintenance 30% of Tk. 4,50,000
City Corporation Tax
Insurance Premium
Land Revenue
Vacancy Allowance (Tk. 4,50,000 2/12)
Interest on borrowed fund (note 1)
Total Deductions
Taxable income under the head
4,16,400
4,50,000
4,50,000
135,000
22,000
16,000
2,000
75,000
36,111
2,86,111
1,63,889
Note 1: Interest for the vacant period will be charged in three equal installments in three consecutive
years. However, interest for the other months (from January 11) will be charged in this income year.
Interest on loan for the vacant period 2 months [(Tk. 500,000 13% 2/12) 1/3]
Interest for occupancy period [(Tk. 500,000 13% 6/12)
Total interest charged for the year
3,611
32,500
36,111
However, Tk. 3,611 of interest will again be accounted for in next two years.
Worked Example 7:
Ms. Rosnee Roy owns two houses; one at Sutrapur and another at Lalbagh. From the following
particulars compute her income form house property for the income year 2010-2011 and also tax liability
for the assessment year 2011 - 2012.
House at Sutrapur: This is a three storied building (in each floor there are two flats). One of the flats
in first floor is used as residence by Ms. Roy and the other flat in the same floor is used by her daughterin-law who pays nothing for it. All other flats were let out at a monthly rent of Tk. 8,000 each. The
municipal value of the house is Tk. 4,80,000. She has also received Tk. 1,00,000 as advance from the
tenants which is not adjustable to rents. Expenses of the house for the year were as follows:
White wash expense
Tk. 20,000
3,000
2,400
12,000
500
42,500
Installation of generator
15,000
The owner bears the water and gas bill of the tenants which amounted to Tk. 30,000 for the year. One
flat remains vacant for two months during the year and she likes to claim vacancy allowance.
House at Lalbagh:
The house is let out to a private bank branch and received monthly rent of Tk. 47,500 net of TDS @ 5%.
'The municipal value of the house is Tk. 6,25,000. Expenses of the house for the year were as follows:
Fire insurance premium
Tk. 25,000
Municipal taxes
12,000
Cost of alteration
55,000
Ground rent
10,000
Legal expenses
12,000
According to the terms of the agreement the tenants are to bear the cost of repair which amounted to
Tk. 15,000 for the year. During the year, Ms. Roy incurred the following investments and expenses:
Family expenses
Tk. 3,50,000
Insurance premium:
Own (policy value Tk. 5,00,000)
40,000
60,000
25,000
20,000
6,000
30,000
Donation to a Mosque
10,000
Solution 7:
Ms. Rosnee Roy
Income year: 2010 - 2011
Assessment year: 2011-2012
Calculation of income from house property
Computation of Total Income under Section 24
House at Sutrapur:
Annual value:
Actual rent (8000 x 5 x 12)
Less: Tenants expenses paid by landlord
Revised actual rent
Municipal Value (4,80,000 x 5/6)
Whichever is higher
Add: Advance Received
Less: Allowable Deductions
Repair & maintenance (4,50,000 X 25%)
City Corporation Tax (2400 x 4 x 5/6)
Land revenue paid (12000 x 5/6)
Interest paid to HBFC (4,200 x 5/6)
Vacancy allowance {(4,50,000/5) x 2/12)}
4,80,000
30,000
4,50,000
4,00,000
4,50,000
1,00,000
5,50,000
1,12,500
8,000
10,000
3,500
15,000
25,000
Total Deductions
1,74,000
3,76,000
House at Lalbagh:
Annual value:
Actual Rent [Tk. 47,500 x 12]
Add: TDS [5,70,000 x 5/100-5]
Landlords expense paid by tenant
Actual Rental Value
Municipal value
5,70,000
30,000
15,000
6,15,000
6,25,000
Whichever is higher
6,25,000
1,87,500
25,000
12,000
10,000
2,34,500
3,90,500
7,66,500
Total income
Calculation of investment allowance for tax credit:
Actual Investment:
Insurance premium
Own
Maximum limit (5,00,000 x 10%)
40,000
50,000
40,000
Spouse
Maximum limit (5,00,000 x 10%)
60,000
50,000
50,000
20,000
30,000
1,40,000
1,53,300
100,00,000
153,300
140,000
14,000
Tk. 2,00,000
3,00,000
2,66,500
7,66,500
Rate
0%
10%
15%
Amount (Tk.)
Nil
30,000
39,975
69,975
14,000
55,975
30,000
25,975
Self-Assessment Questions
(a)
Define Annual Value of a property under the Income Tax Ordinance 1984.
(b)
Is the Annual value of a property determined when it is occupied by its owner for residential
purposes?
(c)
What are the allowable deductions from annual value in determining the Income from house
property under the Ordinance?
Chapter 7
Agriculture income
Contents
Introduction
Examination context
7.1
7.2
7.3
7.4
7.5
7.6
7.7
7.8
Topic List
Basics of Agricultural Income
Introduction
Learning objectives
Practical significance
The head Income from Agriculture has huge potential for maximizing the revenue to the
Government in Bangladesh due to its significance. Bangladesh is an agricultural country and its
agriculture sector has significant contribution to GDP every year. But collection of tax from this
head is insignificant. Here, professional accountants can play an important role by devising the
way of collecting tax under the head through simplification and modernization of tax laws and
process.
This chapter presents different form of agricultural income, allowable deductions, non-assessable
income under the head, non-agricultural income, and other related topics. A clear understanding
on each topics presented in the chapter will make the students expert to give opinions to their
cliens=ts in tax related issues.
You will find the details of the above issues in this chapter with some practical example.
Stop and think
Do you realize that the computation of taxable income under the head income from agriculture
is one of the basic requirements for determining tax liability? Can you determine the taxable
income under the head? Can you compute net tax liability of an assessee having income under
the head?
Working context
In practice, as the accountants are sometime required to support to prepare their clients' tax
returns, they need to advise the clients on how to calculate the total taxable income for any
income year. Before advising the clients, accountants should have the clear concept relating to
the admissible and inadmissible expenses so that they can deduct or add the expenses in
determining the taxable income.
Syllabus links
The topics covered in this chapter are very important for computing taxable income which is
required for solving sample practical problems at this level.
You will be also using this knowledge when you tackle the taxation paper later on in the
Professional Stage and it will also underpin the technical aspects at the Advanced Stage.
Examination context
Exam requirements
In the examination, candidates may be required to:
Question practice
For question practice on these topics go to the suggested answers covering this chapter and also
this manual.
Examiner's comments on how students tackle questions
Candidates have to be prepared well for this area as this chapter consists of core concept on
computation of income which is vital for calculating tax liability. Clear concept and understanding
of each contents of this chapter will help candidates to resolve any problems relating to
computation of agricultural income.
7.0
7.1
Income
Agricultural Income
Non-agricultural Income
Agricultural Land
7.2
Through
With
Agricultural
Process
Building
Without
Agricultural
Process
Fully
Agricultural
Income
Partly
Agricultural
Income
Other
Agricultural
Income
Paddy, Potato,
Jute, Cereals,
Vegetables etc
Tea, Rubber,
and Other Semi
agricultural
produce
Leasing
Rent
Adhi
Borga
Bhag
7.3
Reference
60%
40%
Sec 26(2)
Rule 31
100%
Nothing
60%
40%
Sec 26(3)
Rule 32
In the case of income which is partially agricultural income and partially income from business, in
determining that part of income which is from business, the market value of any agricultural
produce which has been raised by the assessee or received by him in kind and which has been
utilized as raw material in such business or the sale proceeds of which are included in the
accounts of the business shall be deducted and no further deduction shall be made in respect of
any expenditure incurred by the assessee as a cultivator or receiver of the produce in kind.
For the purpose, market value in respect of agricultural produce, means(a)
where such produce is ordinarily sold in the market in its raw state or after application of
any process employed by a cultivator to render it fit to be taken to the market, the value
calculated according to the average price at which it has been sold during the year previous
to that in which the income derived from such produce first becomes assessable; and
(b) where such produce is not ordinarily sold in the market in its raw state, the aggregate of(i)
(ii)
(iii) such amount as the Deputy Commissioner of Taxes finds, having regard to the
circumstances of each case, to represent a reasonable rate of profit on the sale of the
produce in question as agricultural produce
In computing such income from business, an allowance shall be made in respect of-
(a)
the cost of planting bushes in replacement of bushes that have died or become permanently
useless in an already planted area, unless such area has previously been abandoned:
(b) the expenditure incurred in the income year by the assessee in connection with the
development of the new areas for bringing them under tea cultivation.
Other Agricultural Income: Other than the agricultural income specified above, some other
income may be generated from typical agricultural process due to the expanded definition of
agriculture in agricultural economics. This type of income will fall under this classification. Some
of such agricultural income is exemplified below:
(i)
(ii)
(iii)
(iv)
(v)
(vi)
(vii)
(viii)
(ix)
(x)
(xi)
7.4
(x)
(xi)
(xii)
(xiii)
(xiv)
(xv)
(xvi)
(xvii)
(xviii)
(xix)
(xx)
(xxi)
(xxii)
7.5
Income from sale of forest trees, flowers, bamboo, wild grass, reeds or fruits produced
naturally without any agricultural work
Sale of stones from quarries
Income from salary for working as an agricultural supervisor / manager
Income from sale of crops which has been purchased from others for resale
Income from dairy firm established for business purpose
Income from poultry firm established separately for business purpose
Income from fisheries established for business purpose
Fish hunting, ship anchor etc.
Income derived from butter and cheese making
Income received as commission for working as middleman in agro products
Remuneration received by managing agent at a fixed percentage of net profit from a
company having agricultural income.
Interest received by an assessee against loan in the form of agricultural produce
Dividend paid by a company out of its agricultural income
7.6
Allowable Deductions
As per section 27 of IT Ordinance 1984, the following expenditures are admissible deductions at
the time of determining income from agriculture:
(i)
any land development tax or rent paid in respect of the land used for agricultural
purposes.
(ii)
(iii)
where the land is subject to a mortgage or other capital charge for the purposes of
reclamation or improvement, the amount of any interest paid in respect of such
mortgage or charge.
(iv)
any sum paid in respect of the maintenance of any irrigation or protective work or other
capital assets. Such rate is given below:
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
10.
11.
12.
13.
14.
Assets
Pucca building
Kutcha and Pucca Building
Kucha building
Temporary structure
Pucca walls
Fencing of substantial material
Tube-well
Tanks
Pucca irrigation channel
Kucha irrigation channel
Kucha irrigation wells
Pucca irrigation wells
Bullock drawn iron implements
Bullock drawn wooden or leather implements and small other
hand/implements
Rate
10%
15%
20%
N/A*
5%
10%
15%
10%
15%
20%
33.33%
5%
15%
25%
15.
16.
17.
18.
19.
20.
21.
22.
Weighing machine
Tractors and oil engines and thin implements
Power pumping machinery
Factor made cart of iron material with rubber tyre
Country cart
Steam engine
Workshop tools
General (machinery, implements, plants and other assets) not provided
above
10%
15%
20%
15%
20%
10%
15%
10%
(vi)
any sum paid as premium in order to effect any insurance against loss of, or damage to,
such land or any crops to be raised or cattle to be reared thereon.
(vii)
(viii)
any expenditure incurred in performing any process for rendering the produce of such
land fit to be taken to market .
(ix)
(x)
(xi)
any interest paid in respect of capital borrowed for the purpose of acquisition,
reclamation and improvement of such land.
(xii)
(xiii)
where the agricultural income is derived according to the local barga or bhag or adhi
system, no deduction on account of cost of production shall be admissible under this
clause.
(xiv)
in respect of any machinery or plant used exclusively for agricultural purpose which has
been sold, transferred by way of exchange, acquired, discarded, demolished or
destroyed in the previous year, the loss on sale of such plant and machinery will also be
allowed subject to certain conditions as provided for in the Ordinance.
(xv)
any other expenditure not being in the nature of capital or personal expenditure, laid
out wholly and exclusively for the purpose of deriving such income from such land.
Deduction in respect of interest will not be allowed unless tax has been paid or deducted in
accordance with the provisions of Chapter VII of the Ordinance.
7.7
Tk. 20,000 only. His non-assessable income is Tk. 230,000 (Tk. 180,000 + Tk. 50,000). It is
assumed that Mr. Rajib doesnt fall in elderly citizen or disable category.
2. Any income including agricultural income of an indigenous Hillman of any of the hill districts
of Rangamati, Bandarban and Khagrachari, which has been derived solely from economic
activities undertaken within the said hill districts [Sixth Schedule, Part A, Para 27].
3. Subject to the conditions made hereunder any income from poultry for the period from the
first day of July, 2011 to the thirtieth day of June, 2013 [Sixth Schedule, Part A, Para
42](a) if such income exceeds Tk. 1,50,000/- an amount not less than 10% of the said
income shall be invested in the purchase of Government bond or securities within
six month from the end of the income year;
(b) the person shall file return in accordance with the provisions of Section 75(2)(c) of
the ITO, 1984; and
(c) no such income shall be transferred by way of gift or loan within five years from the
end of the income year.
4. Agricultural produce used for self consumption.
7.8
Tk. 40,000
65,000
15,000
25,000
7,000
5,600
3,000
2,800
Solution 1:
(a)
90,000
80,000
65,000
42,000
20,000
30,000
3,27,000
1,41,000
4,400
5,600
3,000
2,800
1,56,800
1,70,200
28,000
1,98,200
90,000
80,000
65,000
42,000
20,000
30,000
3,27,000
40,000
65,000
15,000
25,000
1,45,000
7,000
5,600
3,000
2,800
1,63,400
1,63,600
28,000
1,91,600
Worked Example 2
Mr. Rupom Mojumder is a farmer who own agricultural land which is used three times a year to produce
agricultural goods. Such cultivation is mainly done for commercial purpose; however, a very insignificant
part is consumed by him. He is an elderly citizen (age more than 65 years) and has reported income from
no other sources. During the income year ended on June 30, 2011, he has reported following information
relating to income from agriculture:
Agricultural Produce
Paddy
Potato
Cereals
Volume of Production
215 maunds
112 maunds
835 kgs
Self Consumption
15 maunds
12 maunds
35 kgs
Market price
Tk. 700 per maund
Tk. 180 per maund
Tk. 115 per kg
In addition to above income, he also produced seasonal vegetables (beans) during winter on the
surroundings of his agricultural land. Total production was 256 kgs and sold at the rate of Tk. 16. Out of
the total production, 16 kgs are used for self consumption and reported Tk. 1,200 as cost of bean
production.
He also has reported Tk. 95,000 income from poultry firm and fulfills all conditions to be non-assessable.
He has also reported Tk. 180,000 income from fisheries.
Expenses relating to these incomes are as follows:
Cost of seeds and fertilizer
Labor charge
Maintenance costs of agricultural equipments
Union parisad tax
Crop insurance premium
Depreciation on tractor @ 20%
Tk. 36,500
40,000
4,000
5,800
8,200
14,000
Mr. Mojumder has borrowed Tk. 50,000 from Rajshahi Krisi Unnayon Bank at an interest rate of 12% per
annum on 15th October 2010. Allowable depreciation for tractor as per the Third Schedule of the ITO,
1984 is at the rate of 15%. Cost of seeds and fertilizer includes Tk. 1,500 spent against Borga. He
maintains books of accounts properly.
Solution 2:
Mr. Rupom Mojumder
Income year: 2010-2011
Assessment year: 2011-2012
Calculation of Total Income
Income from Agriculture (Section - 26 & 27):
Income from sale of paddy (200 x 700)
Income from sale of potato (100 x 180)
Income from seasonal vegetables (240 x16)
Income from poultry farm
Less: exemption (full)
Income from fisheries (considered separately at the time of
computing tax liability at a reduced rate of 5%)
1,40,000
18,000
3,840
95,000
95,000
180,000
3,41,840
36,500
40,000
4,000
80,500
5,800
8,200
10,500
4,250
1,200
1,10,450
231,390
50,000
181,390
Total
Less: exemption (up to 50,000)
Total income
Notes:
Sale of Paddy:
250 maunds @ Tk. 500 per maund
Sale of Jute:
100 maunds @ Tk. 400 per maund
Sale of Rabi Crops:
Annual lease rental from leasing agricultural land
Sale of forest timber and bamboo
Income from Tea garden
Income from Rubber garden
Income from Tobacco industry
Income from Sugar industry
Tk.
125,000
40,000
50,000
20,000
6,000
30,000
40,000
30,000
50,000
10.
11.
12.
13.
35,000
3,000
6,000
5,000
Tk. 25,000
5,000
3,000
500
2,000
Jute
Tk. 7,000
2,000
1,000
500
Mr. Karmaker maintains proper book for Rice and Rabi crops, however, he maintains no book for jute.
Other expenses as incurred were as follows:
Union parisad tax
Land revenue
Crop insurance premium
Allowable depreciation
Maintenance cost of irrigation plant
Insurance Premium - Tractor
Tk. 2,000
1,000
2,500
9,000
4,000
7,000
He had a pump machine which was purchased at Tk. 25,000. It has become obsolete and has been
discarded at Tk.12,000. As on the date of discard, the written down value after charging depreciation on
the basis of prescribed rate at the ITO, 1984 amounted to Tk. 10,000.
He has taken agricultural loan of Tk. 50,000@ 8% interest per annum from Bangladesh Krishi Bank.
Mr. Karmaker has a tractor purchased for Tk. 250,000 on which he has an active insurance policy. During the
income year, the tractor becomes out of order and he filed a claim with insurance company. After proper
scrutiny, he receives Tk. 82,000 from insurance company as coverage. However, depreciation charged so far on
the tractor as per IT Ordinance is Tk. 150,000.
Solution 3:
Mr. Jibon Karmaker
Income year: 2010-2011
Assessment year: 2011-2012
Calculation of Total Income
Income from Agriculture (Section - 26 & 27):
Sale of rice (250 x 600)
Sale of Jute (100 x 400)
Sale of rabi crops
Annual lease rental
Income from tea garden (30,000 x 60%)
Income from rubber garden (40,000 x 60%)
Income from Tobacco industry (30,000 x 60%)
Income from Sugar industry (50,000 x 60%)
Income from poultry Farm
(-) exemption (full)
Income from cattle rearing
Income from sale of Palm and Date juice
1,25,000
40,000
50,000
20,000
18,000
24,000
18,000
30,000
35,000
35,000
3,000
6,000
5,000
2,000
3,41,000
25,000
5,000
3,000
500
2,000
35,500
24,000
59,500
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
8.
2,000
1,000
2,500
9,000
4,000
7,000
18,000
4,000
47,500
107,000
2,34,000
12,000
16,000
12,000
20,000
60,000
6,000
3,00,000
Worked Example 4
Compute taxable income and tax liability of Mr. Ekhlash Mia from the following particulars related to the
income year ended on 30th June, 2011:
Particulars
Sale of Paddy [200 maunds @ Tk. 400 per maund]
Sale of Jute [150 maunds @ Tk. 600 per maund]
Sale of Rabi Crops
Income from agricultural cooperative society which was organized for farming
Income from lease of agricultural land
Income from Barga
Income from sale of herbal or medicinal plants
Income from lease of storehouse used for storing crops
Income from sale of tobacco to BATC
Income from sale of sugarcane to Government Sugar mill
Income from fisheries
BDT
80,000
90,000
60,000
25,000
100,000
125,000
30,000
20,000
20,000
35,000
150,000
Mr. Ekhlash Mia had a drum seeder which was purchased for Tk. 40,000. However, he has sold the
seeder for Tk. 30,000 when the accumulated depreciation of the machine was Tk. 20,000 in his book.
Moreover, he also had a weighing machine which' was purchased at Tk. 18,000. It has become obsolete
and has been discarded at Tk. 9,500. At the time of sale the written down value of the machine was Tk.
13,000.
He didn't maintain the books of accounts properly. Expenses claimed by him are as follows:
Production costs
Land revenue paid
Interest on loan
Union parisad tax
Purchase of tractor
Maintenance of the irrigation plant
200,000
8,000
2,500
4,000
70,000
12,000
In addition to it, during the year Mr. Ekhlash Mia also incurred the following investments and expenses:
Family expenses
Life Insurance premium (policy value Tk. 200,000)
Purchase of unlisted company's share
Donation to president's relief fund
Donation to a local club
Donation to Government Zakat fund
Purchase of Gold
50,000
25,000
25,000
20,000
6,000
30,000
27,000
Solution 4:
Mr. Ekhlash Mia
Income year: 2010 - 2011
Assessment year: 2011 - 2012
Calculation of Total Income
Income from Agriculture (Section - 24):
Income from sale of Paddy (200 x 400)
Income from sale of Jute (150 x 600)
Sale of Rabi Crops
Income from Agricultural Co-operative Society
Income from lease of agricultural land
Income from Barga
Income from sale of herbal or medicinal plants
Income from lease of storehouse used for storing crops
Income from sale of tobacco to BA TC
Income from sale of sugarcane to Government Sugar mill
Gain on sale of drum seeder [Tk. 30,000 (Tk. 40,000-Tk.20,000)]
Income from fisheries (considered separately at the time of computing tax
liability at a reduced rate of 5%)
80,000
90,000
60,000
25,000
100,000
125,000
30,000
20,000
20,000
35,000
10,000
150,000
7,45,000
189,000
8,000
2,500
4,000
12,000
3,500
Total income
2,19,000
526,000
Tk. 25,000
20,000
Tk. 20,000
20,000
30,000
70,000
131,5000
Tk. 70,000
Tk. 7,000
Income Slab
Tk. 1,80,000
1,96,000
Rate
0%
10%
Amount (Tk.)
Nil
19,600
1,50,000
5,26,000
5%
7,500
27,100
7,000
20,100
80,000
90,000
60,000
30,000
20,000
35,000
315,000
Tk. 13;000
9,500
3,500
3. Since further processing- was absent in case of tobacco and sugarcane, the entire amounts have
been considered as agricultural income.
Self-Assessment Questions
1. Define Agricultural income under the Income Tax Ordinance 1984.
2. Discuss the allowable deductions as per section 27 of the Ordinance in computing the taxable
income under the head Agricultural income.
3. How will you compute the income in respect of Tea and Rubber industries?
4. What are the different types of agricultural income?
5. On what categories of agricultural income, taxes are imposed at a reduced rate?
Problem:
Compute taxable income and tax liability of Mr. Julhash Khan, a 67 years old farmer, from the following
particulars related to the income year ended on 30th June, 2011:
Sale of Paddy
Sale of Jute
Sale of Rabi Crops
Income from agricultural co-operative society which was
organized for farming
Income from lease of agricultural land
Income from Barga
Income from sale of herbal or medicinal plants
Income from lease of storehouse used for storing crops
Income from tobacco industry
Income from sale of sugar
Income from sale of tea
Mr. Athar Ali had a pump machine which was purchased for Tk. 40,000. To acquire an advance
technology in the irrigation plant he has sold the pump machine for Tk. 42,000. At the time of sale the
amount of accumulated depreciation of the pump machine was Tk. 18,000. Moreover, he also had a
weighing machine which was purchased at Tk. 18,000. It has become obsolete and has been discarded at
Tk. 9,500. At the time of sale the written down value of the machine was Tk. 13,000.
He didnt maintain the books of accounts properly. Expenses claimed by him are as follows:
Production costs
Land revenue paid
Interest on loan
Union parisad tax
Installation of irrigation plant
Maintenance of the irrigation plant
200,000
8,000
2,500
4,000
70,000
12,000
In addition to it, during the year Mr. Athar Ali also incurred the following investments and expenses:
Family expenses
Life Insurance premium (policy value Tk.
3,00,000)
Purchase of debenture from primary market
Donation to Aga Khan Development
Network
Donation to a local mosque
Donation to Government Zakat fund
Purchase of Furniture
Tk. 50,000
25,000
25,000
20,000
6,000
30,000
27,000
Chapter 8
Income from business or profession
Contents
Introduction
Examination context
Topic List
8.1
8.2
8.3
8.4
8.5
8.6
8.7
Work
ed
Exam
ples
and
Introduction
Learning objectives
Practical significance
The head Income from Business and Profession is very important to taxing authority. A
significant part of tax revenue government collects from this head. This head also includes lot of
complex issues on which clear understanding is required to practice tax. This chapter lays the
basic foundation of corporate assessment and taxation.
This chapter presents an idea of how conventional profit and loss account can be adjusted with
applicable tax laws. It presents the scope of income under the head, admissible expenses,
inadmissible expenses and other related issues.
Some expenses are admissible up to a certain limit. These are explained with some examples.
Other complex issues like perquisites, balancing charge etc. are simplified with examples.
You will find the details of the above issues in this chapter with some practical example.
Stop and think
Do you realize that the computation of taxable income under the head income from business
and profession is one of the basic requirements for determining tax liability? Can you determine
the taxable income under the head? Can you compute net tax liability of an assessee having
income under the head?
Working context
In practice, as the accountants are sometime required to support to prepare their clients' tax
returns, they need to advise the clients on how to calculate the total taxable income for any
income year. Before advising the clients, accountants should have the clear concept relating to
the admissible and inadmissible expenses so that they can deduct or add the expenses in
determining the taxable income.
Syllabus links
The topics covered in this chapter are very important for computing taxable income which is
required for solving sample practical problems at this level.
You will be also using this knowledge when you tackle the taxation paper later on in the
Professional Stage and it will also underpin the technical aspects at the Advanced Stage.
Examination context
Exam requirements
In the examination, candidates may be required to:
Question practice
For question practice on these topics go to the suggested answers covering this chapter and also
this manual.
Examiner's comments on how students tackle questions
Candidates have to be prepared well for this area as this chapter consists of core concept on
computation of income which is vital for calculating tax liability. Clear concept and understanding
of each contents of this chapter will help candidates to resolve any problems relating to
computation of income from business and profession.
CA in Bangladesh
www.facebook.com/cainbd
8.0
8.1
mastering of particular intellectual skill acquired through rigorous education and training;
b.
c.
Profession is therefore, a broader term different from a vocation, trade or commerce. The
characteristics mentioned above are absolutely essential to call any activity as professional which
may not be so rigorously required in a vocation, occupation or trade. Further in a profession
mental and intellectual contents are much higher than mechanical skill required in a vocation or
occupation.
8.2
Scope of Income under the head Income from Business and Profession
Scope of income under the head Income from Business and Profession encompasses the
following areas as per different sections of IT Ordinance, 1984:
(a) Fully Income from Business or Profession
Section 28(1)(a) profits and gains of any business or profession carried on by the assessee
Section 28(1)(b) income derived from any trade or professional association or other
association of like nature
Section 28(1)(c) value of any benefit or perquisite arising from business or the exercise of a
profession
Section 28(1)(d) receipt of any loss, bad debt or expenditure already charged; unpaid amount
& Section 19(15) of interest or share of profit to certain banks after three years of charge;
benefit derived in respect of trading liability that remains unpaid for three
years
Section 28(1)(e) income from the disposal of any building, machinery or plant used for
& Section 19(16) purpose of any business or profession carried on by him
Section 28(1)(f) income from any insurance, salvage or compensation moneys received in
& Section 19(18) respect of any building, machinery or plant used for the purpose of business
or profession
Section 28(1)(g) Income from the disposal of an asset representing expenditure of a capital
& Section 19(20) nature on scientific research
Section 28(1)(h) Income from the transfer of export quota by an assessee being an exporter
& Section 19(23) of garments
(b) Partly Income from Business or Profession
Section 26(2) & Income from the sale of Tea
Rule 31
Section 26(3) & Income from the sale of Rubber /Tobacco / Sugar / Other similar products
Rule 32
8.3
The profits and gains from insurance business and the tax payable
thereon
The profits and gains of any business which consists of or includes the
exploration and extraction of such mineral deposits of wasting nature,
not being petroleum and natural gas, as may be specified
The amount of interest which is not brought in the profit and loss account and kept in suspense
account relating to classified bad and doubtful debts of Bangladesh Shilpa Bank, Bangladesh Shilpa
Rin Sangstha, Investment Corporation of Bangladesh and any commercial bank including the
Bangladesh Krishi Bank and the Rajshahi Krishi Unnayan bank shall be chargeable to tax in the
income year in which it is credited to the profit and loss account for that year or as the case may
be, it is actually received, whichever is earlier [Section 28(3)].
8.4
Allowable Deductions
The expenditures which are deductible in determining income from business or profession liable
to tax have not been enumerated exhaustively. A few heads of allowable expenditures have been
specified under Section 29(1) but many other expenses can be claimed to be admissible under
section 29(1) (xxvii) which is generally known as omnibus clause.
The allowable deductions which have been specifically mentioned in section 29(1) are mentioned
below:
(i)
Rent for the premises used for the purpose of business or profession [Section 29(1) (i)].
Provided that if a substantial part of the premises is used by the assessee as a dwelling house, the
amount shall be a proportionate part of the rent having regard to the proportionate annual value
of the part so used.
(ii)
Repairs to hired business premises is the assessee bears the expense [Section 29(1) (ii)].
Provided that if a substantial part of the premises is used by the assessee as a dwelling house, the
amount shall be a proportionate part of the sum paid for such repair having regard to the
proportionate annual value of the part so used.
(iii)
Bank interest paid or any profit shared with a bank run on Islamic principles in respect of
capital borrowed of the purpose of business or profession [Section 29(1) (iii)].
Provided that if any part of such capital relates to replenishing the cash or to any other asset
transferred to any other entity, when lending of money is not the business of transferor, the
amount shall be proportionate part of the interest so paid or the profit so shared having regard to
the proportion of such capital so used.
(iv)
Share of profit paid by a bank run on Islamic principles [Section 29(1) (iv)].
(v)
An amount not exceeding 5% of the profit transferred to Special Reserve by banks and
financial institutions approved by the Government [Section 29(1) (v)].
(vi)
Repairs to own buildings, plants, machinery, furniture or other fixed assets [Section 29(1)
(vi)].
(vii)
Insurance premium for insurance against risk of damage etc. of buildings, plant furniture or
other fixed assets used in business or profession [Section 29(1) (vii)].
(viii) Depreciation of building, machinery, plant or furniture being owned by the assessee and
used for business or profession as per Third Schedule [Section 29(1) (viii)].
(ix)
Investment allowance for a passenger vessel or a fishing trawler which is entitled to special
depreciation is allowable at 20% of the original cost subject to stipulated conditions
[Section 29(1) (ix)].
(x)
Where any building, machinery or plant which, after having been used by the assessee for
the purpose of his business, has been discarded, demolished or destroyed in any income
year or any such asset has been sold, transferred by way of exchange or compulsorily
acquired by a legally competent authority or exported outside Bangladesh in any income
year, an obsolescence allowance to the extent and computed in the manner specified in
paragraph 10 of the Third Schedule [Section 29(1) (xi)].
(xi)
Obsolescence allowance and allowance on account of death or useless animals used for
the purpose of business or profession otherwise than as stock in trade [Section 29(1)
(xii)].
(xii) Land development tax or rent, local rate or municipal tax [Section 29(1) (xiii)].
(xiii) Bonus paid to employees including festival bonus [Section 29(1) (xiv)].
(xiv) The amount of bad debt which is established to have become irrecoverable, under the
stated circumstances [Section 29(1) (xv)].
(xv) The amount of bad debt written off as irrecoverable but deduction not allowed on the
ground that it was not then irrecoverable, the amount which was established to be
irrecoverable [Section 29(1) (xvi)].
(xvi) The amount of bad debt having been irrecoverable in an earlier year is allowable for the
earlier year under certain circumstances and with the consent of the assessee [Section
29(1) (xvii)].
(xvii) In respect of provision for bad and doubtful debt made by Bangladesh Shilpa Bank or
Bangladesh Shilpa Rin Songstha for overdue loan, a sum equal to five percent of such
overdue loan or the amount of actual provision for such bad or doubtful debt in the books
of the assessee, whichever is the less [Section 29(1) (xviiia)].
Provided that the deduction shall be allowed only in respect of the assessment years 1987-99,
1988-89 and 1990-91.
Provided further that if any amount out of the amount so allowed is ultimately recovered, the
same shall be deemed to be a profit of the year in which it is recovered.
(xviii) Provision for bad and doubtful debt and interest thereon made by a commercial bank
including the Bangladesh Krishi Bank and the Rajshahi Krishi Unnayan Bank of a sum equal
to 1% of the outstanding loan including interest thereon or the amount of actual provision,
whichever is less, subject to the specified conditions [Section 29(1)(xviiiaa)].
Provided that the deduction shall be allowed only in respect of the assessment years 1990-91,
1991-92, 1992-93, 1993-94, 1994-95, 1995-96, 1996-97, 1997-98, 1998-99, 1999-2000,
2000-2001, 2001-2002, 2002-2003, 2003-2004, 2004-2005, 2005-2006 and 2006-2007.
Provided that the provision of this clause shall apply only in respect of loan which the Bangladesh
Bank has classified as bad and doubtful debts.
If any amount out of the provision for bad and doubtful debt and interest thereon which has been
allowed is ultimately recovered, the amount so recovered shall be deemed to be profit of the year
in which it is recovered.
Provided that no deduction under this clause shall be allowed in respect of a) Any amount representing grant allowed by the Government in the form of 15-Year
Special Treasury Bonds.
b) Any loan advanced to any Government Organization or Body Corporate or any other
loan guaranteed by the Government.
c) Any debt representing loans advanced to any director of the bank, his nominees or
dependents.
(xix) Any expenditure, not being capital expenditure, laid out or expended on scientific research
related to the business [Section 29(1) (xix)].
(xx) Any expenditure of a capital nature laid out or expended on scientific research related to
the business subject to the stipulated conditions [Section 29(1) (xx)].
(xxi) Any sum paid to scientific research institute or other specified bodies carrying out
scientific research approved by the Board subject to the stipulated conditions [Section
29(1) (xxi)].
(xxii) Any sum, not being of capital nature laid out or expended on any educational institute or
hospital established for the benefit of employees subject to the stipulated condition
[Section 29(1) (xxii)].
(xxiii) Expenditure (including capital expenditure incurred on any educational institution or
hospital for the benefit of employees and their dependents is deductible provided no
charge is made for the services rendered by such hospital or institution. Expenditure
incurred on the construction, maintenance or running of any institute for the training of
industrial workers will be similarly deductible [Section 29(1) (xxiii)].
(xxiv) Any expenditure laid out or expended on the training of citizens of Bangladesh in
connection with a scheme approved by the National Board of Revenue [Section 29(1)
(xxiv)].
(xxv) Expenses incurred in connection with visits abroad in a Trade Delegation sponsored by
Government [Section 29(1) (xxv)].
(xxvi) Subscriptions paid to registered trade organizations annual membership subscription paid
to registered trade organization or to a recognized professional institution is allowable
expenditure for the purpose of computation of income from business [Section 29(1)
(xxvi)].
(xxvii) Any expenditure, not being in the nature of capital expenditure or personal expenses of
the assessee laid out or expended wholly and exclusively for the purpose of the business
or profession of the assessee [Section 29(1)(xxvii)].
8.5
Payment of salaries if tax is not deducted at the time of payment and paid thereon in
accordance with section 50 of Chapter VII [Section 30(a)].
(b)
Any payment made by an assessee to any person if tax thereon has not been deducted
and credited in accordance with the Chapter-VII and Vat thereon has not been collected
or deducted and credited in accordance with the VAT Ordinance 1991[Section 30(aa)].
(b)
(c)
Brokerage or commission paid to a non-resident if tax has not been deducted there
from under section 56 [Section 30(c)].
(d)
Payment to a provident or other fund unless effective arrangement has been made for
deduction of tax at source while making the payments from the fund which are taxable
under the head Salaries [Section 30(d)].
(e)
Amount of perquisites or other benefits paid to any employee in excess of Tk. 250,000
[Section 30(e)].
In this regard, perquisite means i. Any payment made to an employee by an employer in the form of cash or in any
other form excluding basic salary, festival bonus, arrear salary, advance salary, leave
encashment or leave fare assistance and over time, and
ii. Any benefit, called by whatever name, provided to an employee by an employer,
whether convertible into money or not but other than contribution to(a) recognized provident fund;
(b) approved pension fund;
(c) approved gratuity fund;
(d) approved superannuation fund.
(f)
(g)
Any expenditure exceeding ten percent of the profit under the head of Head Office
expenses by a company not incorporated in Bangladesh under Company Act, 1994;
Any payment by way of royalty, technical services fee, technical know-how fee or
technical assistance fee exceeding six percent of the profit;
Any payment by way of salary or remuneration made otherwise than by crossed check
or bank transfer by a person to any employee having gross monthly salary of taka fifteen
thousand or more;
Any expenditure by way of incentive bonus exceeding ten per cent of the disclosed net
profit;
Any expenditure by way of overseas traveling exceeding one percent of the disclosed
turnover.
(h)
(i)
(j)
(k)
8.6
Revenue Expenditure
All expenditure incurred in buying goods for resale or converting raw materials to manufactured
articles or incidental to the conduct and financing of the business, is treated as revenue
expenditure. Cost of goods purchased for the business in which a person deals, sums paid as
rent, salaries and wages, repairs etc. are instances of revenue expenditure. Expenditure incurred
for any of the following purposes will be regarded as revenue expenditure:
(1) For purchasing assets with a view to re-selling them at profit or manufacturing them in a
saleable condition, e.g. goods, raw materials and stores;
(2) For maintaining capital assets in good working order, e.g. repairs and renewals of buildings;
(3) For meeting day-to-day expenses of carrying on a business, e.g. salaries, wages, rents etc.
Tests for determining an expenditure as either capital or revenue nature
If the money comes from circulating capital, it will be revenue expenditure; if it emanates from
fixed capital, it will be capital expenditure.
If the answer to any of the following questions is in the affirmative, it is a capital expenditure,
otherwise it is revenue expenditure:
(2)
(3)
(4)
(5)
The following expenses which, prima facie, are of a revenue nature, become capital under certain
circumstances as under:
(1) Raw materials and stores when utilized in making a fixed asset;
(2) Wages and salaries when paid in connection with the installation or construction of a fixed
asset. Thus, when a company manufactures a machine for its own use, the wages and salaries
of persons employed on the work will be capital expenditure;
(3) Carriage and freight expenses incurred in connection with the acquisition of fixed assets;
(4) Cost of repairs incurred in putting a second hand fixed assets into a proper operational
state;
(5) Legal charges incurred in connection with the acquisition of fixed assets, e.g. building,
machinery, plant etc. and expenses incurred in clearing encumbrances thereon.
A particular item of expenditure may be of both capital and revenue nature, e.g., the combined
cost of repairs, renewals etc. The amount should be apportioned after deciding how much of the
total expenditure represents cost of improvements or additions etc. and how much of it is in the
nature of pure repairs.
The following types of expenditure have been held to be capital expenditure:
(1) Preliminary expenses incurred for floating or acquiring a business;
(2) Expenses incurred for raising of capital;
(3) Cost of shifting of business from one place to another with a view to increasing its revenueearning capacity;
(4) Lump sum payments made to retiring directors of a company in order to restrain them from
entering into competition with the business of the company.
8.7
Sale
Proceeds
Revenue Gain
(Total gain
Capital gain)
Loss (WDV
Sale proceeds)
(a) 120,000
64,000
20,000
44,000
nil
(b) 90,000
34,000
nil
34,000
nil
(c) 50,000
nil
nil
nil
6,000
Total Gain
(Compensation
Received - WDV)
Capital Gain
(Compensation
Received - cost)
Revenue Gain
(Total gain
Capital gain)
Loss (WDV
Compensation
Received)
(a) 130,000
74,000
30,000
44,000
nil
(b) 100,000
44,000
nil
44,000
nil
(c) 40,000
nil
nil
nil
16,000
Fractional income in Certain Cases (export value of garments, tea, rubber, tobacco)
In certain cases, income from business or profession is assessed as a certain percentage of total
income. These are:
a) Part of income from tobacco, sugar or other agricultural products that needs industrial
process to make it marketable. Here, income from business will be: Final Sale Proceeds
Fair value of the raw materials produced. (Rule 30)
b) 3% of the export value of the garments exportable against the export quota as transferred
to any assessee (Rule 30A)
c) 40% of the income derived from the sale of tea grown and manufactured by the seller in
Bangladesh (Rule 31)
d) 40% of the income derived from the sale of rubber grown and manufactured by the seller in
Bangladesh (Rule 31)
Lets assume that XYZ Company has income from the following sources as mentioned below:
a) The company has a tobacco field where tobacco leaves are produced and transferred to the
manufacturing plant to produce cigarettes and other tobacco goods. It is assumed that the
fair value of tobacco leaves would be Tk. 450,000 and the company sold the tobacco goods
for Tk. 1,150,000.
b) The company has transferred a part of its export quota of garments to another company
that may generate a total of Tk. 1,500,000 export value.
c) Income derived from the sale of tea grown and manufactured by the company, Tk. 500,000.
d) Income derived from the sale of rubber grown and manufactured by the company, Tk.
300,000.
Sources
From sale of Tobacco
Computation
Income
Business
from
Tk. 700,000
3% of Tk. 1,500,000
45,000
200,000
120,000
Tk. 1,065,000
Entertainment Expenses
Any amount representing entertainment expense is not allowed for deductions. For allowable
deductions under the head, the following bases and percentages are prescribed in Rule 65.
Income, profits and gains of the business and profession (before
charging such allowance)
Allowable rate
4%
2%
For example, XYZ Company reports Tk. 8,900,000 as profit for the year ended June 30, 2011
after charging Tk. 150,000 as entertainment allowance. Compute the amount of allowable
entertainment expense.
On first profit of Tk. 1,000,000
@ 4%
Tk. 40,000
@ 2%
161,000
201,000
as a deduction unless such payment is made by a crossed check on a bank or by a crossed bank
draft (Rule 65A).
Consider the following information to compute the allowable amount of foreign travel allowance
for Mr. X who has joined the company during the year and availing the benefit for the first time.
Basic Salary of Mr. X
Tk. 60,000
Actual Expenditure
200,000
Tk. 180,000
Tk. 150,000
Whichever is less
Tk. 150,000
Thus, Tk. 200,000 is not allowable rather Tk. 150,000 will be allowable expense.
Free Sample Distribution
Expenditure on distribution of free sample is admissible up to the percentage as given below
(Rule 65C):
In respect of
In Respect of
Ceiling of Turnover
Pharmaceutical
Other
Industries
Industries
(a) For a turnover up to Taka 5 crore at the rate of
2%
1.50 %
(b) For a turnover in excess of Taka 5 crore but up
to Taka 10 crore at the rate of
1%
0.75%
(c) For a turnover in excess of Taka 10 crore at the
rate of
0.50%
0.375%
For example, lets assume that the turnover of XYZ Company is given in the table below.
Assuming the company as pharmaceutical and others, the allowable deduction for free sample
distribution would be:
Turnover
a) If turnover is Tk. 4,00,00,000
b) If turnover is Tk. 8,00,00,000
c) If turnover is Tk. 12,00,00,000
Pharmaceutical
Rate
Amount (Tk.)
2%
8,00,000
1%
8,00,000
0.50%
6,00,000
Rate
1.50%
0.75%
0.375%
Others
Amount (Tk.)
6,00,000
6,00,000
4,50,000
Perquisites
Perquisite to any employee is allowed up to Tk. 250,000. If actual perquisite given to an
employee exceeds Tk. 250,000; such amount exceeding Tk. 250,000 is not allowed [(Section
30(e)].
For example, lets assume that Mr. X enjoys the following benefits during the income year ended
30th June, 2011 from his employer:
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
Basic Salary
House rent allowance
Festival bonus equal the two months basic salary
Leave encashment
Conveyance allowance
Contribution to Recognized Provident Fund @ 10%
Tk. 504,000
300,000
84,000
42,000
30,000
50,400
7.
Servants wages
8.
Children educational allowance
9.
Leave fare assistance
10.
Bungalow utilities
Compute the amount of perquisite disallowed.
20,000
50,000
40,000
25,000
Tk. 300,000
30,000
20,000
50,000
25,000
4,25,000
2,50,000
1,75,000
This clearly tantamount to double taxation, once in the hands of the employee (excess
allowances received over allowable limit) and again by the employer.
Expenses Allowed up to a Certain Percentage
It is important to remember that some expenses, where there is a scope of reporting higher
amount, are permitted but up to certain limit. Amount exceeding that limit is not allowed and
thus taxable. These expenses are reported below:
Reference
Expenses
Allowable
limit
Section 30(g) Head Office Expenses by a company not incorporated in
10% of Profit
Bangladesh
Section 30(h) Royalty, technical services fee, technical knowhow fee or
8% of Profit
technical assistance fee
Section 30(j)
Incentive bonus
10% of profit
Section 30(k) Overseas traveling expense
1% of turnover
Instances of some expenses which are capital as per Generally Accepted Accounting
Principles but allowable as revenue expenses as per Income Tax provision
Particulars
Accounting
Principle
Income Tax
Provision
(a)
Capital
Revenue under
Rule 31 and 32
(b)
Capital
(c)
Capital
Stock-in-trade was lost in fire, amounting to Tk. 12,000 and was debited to Profit and Loss
Account.
2.
Amount spent on a successful suit filed against a person for infringing trade mark of the
assessee - Tk. 10,000;
3.
Interest paid to bank Tk. 15,000 in connection with overdraft obtained for paying dividend;
4.
Overseas traveling expense Tk. 50,000; The amount of disclosed turnover and disclosed net
profit is Tk. 40,00,000 and Tk. 20,00,000 respectively;
5.
Incentive bonus Tk. 3,00,000; The amount of disclosed turnover and disclosed net profit is Tk.
40,00,000 and Tk. 20,00,000 respectively;
6.
Salary paid to two employees @ Tk. 20,000 per month; one is paid in cash and another
through bank transfer.
7.
Royalty paid Tk. 2,00,000; The amount of disclosed turnover and disclosed net profit is Tk.
40,00,000 and Tk. 20,00,000 respectively;
8.
Salary expense of a firm Tk. 100,000 of which Tk. 40,000 is paid to a partner as salary;
9.
10.
11.
Repair expense of the hired premises paid Tk. 50,000, The building is used both for office and
residence at an equal proportion.
12.
Insurance premium paid Tk. 25,000, of which Tk. 5,000 is the life insurance premium of the
owner.
Solution 1:
1.
2.
Litigation / legal expense is an admissible expense and is allowed to the full amount as it is
spent for protecting business interest. Any legal expense for illegal purpose is not allowable.
3.
Interest expense on overdraft taken to meet business expenses is admissible expense and
allowed to the full amount.
4.
5.
Incentive bonus is admissible up to 10% of the disclosed net profit, so here the admissible
amount is up to Tk. 200,000 (10% of Tk. 20,00,000) and rest of Tk. 100,000 is inadmissible.
6.
Of total salary expense Tk. 480,000, Tk. 240,000 is admissible as it has been paid through bank
transfer and rest of Tk. 240,000 is inadmissible as it has been paid in cash.
7.
Royalty is admissible up to 8% of disclosed net profit, so here of total Tk. 200,000 admissible
amount is up to Tk. 160,000 (8% of Tk. 20,00,000) and rest of Tk. 40,000 is inadmissible.
8.
Of total salary expense Tk.100,000, Tk 60,000 is admissible as it has been paid to employees
and rest of Tk. 40,000 is inadmissible as it has been paid to a partner of the firm.
9.
10.
11.
Of total repair expense of Tk. 50,000, Tk. 25,000 is admissible which is for the proportion of
office use and the rest Tk. 25,000 is inadmissible as half proportion of the house has been used
for residence.
12.
Of total insurance premium of Tk. 25,000, Tk. 20,000 is admissible which is for the protection
of business interest and the rest of Tk. 5,000 is inadmissible as it is given for personal interest
of the owner.
Worked Example 2:
The Profit and Loss Account of Janani Traders owned by Mr. Rajon Mojumder for the year ended on June
30, 2011 is given below:
Janani Traders
Profit and Loss Account
For the year ended on June 30, 2011
Debit
Salary
Commission
Rent of Premises
Fund Embezzlement
Donations
Taka
380,000
70,000
132,000
30,000
150,000
Bad debt
80,000
50,000
40,000
38,000
Repair expense
26,000
Gross Profit
Interest on Securities
Taka
1,950,000
180,000
32,000
18,000
27,000
4,000
37,000
Bonus
80,000
Royalty
70,000
45,000
Household expenses
22,000
Net Profit
Credit
953,000
2,207,000
2,207,000
Other Information:
1. Salary includes Taka 87,000 paid to the owner.
2. Fund embezzlement occurred after office hour.
3. Donations include Taka 80,000 paid to a charitable hospital that is approved under Paragraph
11A of Part B of the Sixth Schedule of ITO, 1984.
4. Life insurance premium is the payment against the insurance policy purchased in the owner's
name.
5. Tax depreciation amounts to Taka 30,000.
6. Furniture sold for Tk. 78,000 that was originally purchased for Tk. 70,000. Written down value
of the furniture on the date of sale was Tk. 51,000.
Required: Compute the income from business or profession of Mr. Shaiham for the year ended on
June 30, 2010.
Solution 2:
Assessee: Janani Traders
Income Year: 2010-11
Assessment Year: 2011-12
Particulars
Income from Business and Profession:
Profit as per P/L Account
Add: Inadmissible Expenses
1. Salary
2. Fund Embezzlement
3. Donations
4. Life insurance premium
5. Depreciation Expense (to be treated later on)
6. Provision for Income Tax
7. Penalty and fine
8. Household expense
Less: Depreciation Expense (As per ITO)
Less: Non-Business Income
1. Interest on Securities
2. Interest on Bank deposit
3. Capital Gain on Sale of Furniture
Taxable Income from Business or Profession
Taka
Taka
953,000
87,000
30,000
70,000
50,000
40,000
38,000
37,000
22,000
180,000
32,000
8,000
374,000
1,327,000
30,000
1,297,000
220,000
1,077.000
Notes:
1.
2.
3.
Donations of Taka 70,000 are not made to the approved organization and so these are not
allowed.
4.
5.
Royalty is admissible up to an amount equal to 8% of the disclosed net profit i.e. 8% of Tk.
953,000, i.e. Tk. 76,240. Thus actual payment is admissible.
6.
Bonus is admissible up to an amount equal to 10% of the disclosed net profit i.e. 10% of Tk.
953,000, i.e. Tk. 95,300. Thus actual payment is admissible.
7.
Capital gain on sale of furniture was Tk. 8,000 (Tk. 78,000 Tk. 70,000). This amount should be
considered as income under the head Capital Gain.
Worked Example 3:
The Trading and Profit & Loss Account of Jahur and Brothers for the year ended on June 30, 2011
is given below:
Jahur and Brothers
Trading & Profit and Loss Account
For the year ended on June 30, 2011
Debit
Opening Stock
Purchases
Taka
80,000
700,000
Wages
60,000
Depreciation on Machinery
15,000
10,000
Gross Profit
Credit
Sales
Closing Stock
1,450,000
160,000
745,000
1,610,000
Salaries
Taka
120,000
1,610,000
Gross Profit
745,000
18,000
Compensation Received
80,000
40,000
27,000
Legal Expenses
15,000
25,000
Underwriting Commission
30,000
80,000
Purchase of Trademarks
80,000
60,000
Bad Debts
30,000
Commission
28,000
Accounting Fees
40,000
35,000
18,000
50,000
Gratuity to Employees
136,000
35,000
18,000
70,000
Miscellaneous Expense
30,000
Net Profit
280,000
1,045,000
1,045,000
Other information:
1. Salaries include Taka 20,000 as salaries paid to the owner.
2. Recovered amount of bad debt was previously allowed as bad debt expense.
3. Legal expense is incurred for filing and continuing a case against competitor for protecting the
interest of the business.
4. Fines and penalties were due to avoidance of tax payment at an earlier period.
5. Annual membership fee is the fee paid to union for the interest of the business.
6. Compensation money is received from insurance company against a claim lodged due to destroy
of machinery originally purchased for Tk. 70,000 with a written down value of Tk. 50,000.
7. Tax depreciation was calculated as follows:
a. Depreciation on Machinery
Taka 25,000
Taka 50,000
Required: Compute the income from business or profession and total taxable income of Jahur and
Brothers for the year ended on June 30, 2011.
Solution 3:
Assessee: Jahur and Brothers
Income Year: 2010-11
Assessment Year: 2011-12
Particulars
Income from Business and Profession:
Net Profit as per Profit and Loss Account
Add: Inadmissible Expenses
(1) Salaries
(2) Underwriting Commission
(3) Purchase of Trademarks
(4) Fines and Penalties
(5) Advance income tax
(6) Dowry paid to the Daughter
(7) Depredation Expenses (to be treated later on)
On Machinery
On Office Building
Taka
Taka
280,000
20,000
30,000
80,000
18,000
35,000
70,000
15,000
35,000
303,000
583,000
25,000
50,000
80,000
10,000
60,000
80,000
80,000
75,000
508,000
150,000
358,000
nil
10,000
60,000
428,00
Worked Example 4:
For the income year ended on June 30, 2011, Gaco Pharmaceutical Company reports net profit of Tk.
17,983,000. A close scrutiny of its books of accounts reveals the following items:
1.
Director 2
Director 3
Director 4
Director 5
Tk. 180,000
Tk. 250,000
Tk. 280,000
Tk. 325,000
Tk. 230,000
2.
Amount paid to a contractor of Tk. 85,000 without deducting VAT at prescribed rate.
3.
Profit includes Tk. 85,000 as gain on sale of asset. The original cost of the asset was Tk. 70,000
and on the date of sale, the written down value of the asset was Tk. Tk. 50,000.
4.
The company lodged a claim against the demolishing of an asset and recovered Tk. 70,000. The
cost was Tk. 80,000, however, the written down value of the asset was Tk. 50,000.
5.
The company has income of Tk. 420,000 from tea grown and manufactured in Bangladesh
which was not considered at the time of computing profit.
6.
The company has transferred export quota of garments to another company whose export
value is estimated as Tk. 800,000. No income is reported in profit and loss account.
7.
8.
Finance director received foreign travel allowance of Tk. 500,000 and charged against the
profit. He has also received an allowance in last year and it was deducted for tax purpose.
9.
Expense for free sample distribution is shown as Tk. 340,000. Reported turnover for the year
is Tk. 87,953,000.
10.
11.
Compute taxable income from business and profession, considering the information above.
Solution 4:
Particulars
Income from Business and Profession:
Net Profit as per Profit and Loss Account
Add: Inadmissible Expenses
1. Salaries (perquisites exceeding Tk. 250,000)
2. Paid to contractor
3. Gain on sale of asset (Capital gain: Tk. 85,000 Tk. 70,000)
4. Entertainment expense
5. Foreign travel allowance
6. Expenses of free sample
7. Depredation Expenses (to be treated later on)
Taka
17,983,000
105,000
85,000
15,000
70,340
500,000
10,176
253,000
1,038,516
19,021,516
180,000
18,841,516
Taka
168,000
240,000
408,000
19,249,516
Notes:
1. Allowable entertainment expense is 1,000,000 @ 4% + 16,983,000 @ 2% = 40,000 + 339,660
= Tk. 379,660. Thus, entertainment expenses disallowed is Tk. 70,340.
2. Foreign travel allowance is allowed for once in every two years. As last year, the director
received the allowance and deducted, this year this expense is not allowed.
3. Expense for free sample distribution allowed is Tk. 329,824 (0.375% of Tk. 87,953,000). Thus,
disallowed expense is Tk. 10,176 (Tk. 340,000 Tk. 329,824).
4. Royalty expense allowed is Tk. 1,438,640 (8% of Tk. 17,983,000). Thus, the whole amount is
admissible.
Self-Assessment Questions
1. State the main provisions of Sections 28 and 29 of the Income Tax Ordinance 1984 relating to
computation of income under the head income from business or profession.
2. State the provisions of the Income Tax Ordinance 1984 relating to:
(i)
(ii)
3. (a)
It is said that the list of allowances under Section 29 of the Income Tax Ordinance for
computation of income under the head income from business or profession is not exhaustive.
Write your comments on the above statement.
4. The Income Statement with selective notes thereon of Zian Ltd for the year ended on June 30, 2011 is
as under:
Zian Ltd
Income Statement
For the year ended on June 30, 2011
Particulars
Taka
Net Sales
15,000,000
8,800,000
Less: Cost of Goods Sold
Gross Profit
6,200,000
Add: Gain on Sale of Building (Note 1)
2,200,000
4,000,000
Less: Administrative and Selling & Distribution Expenses (Note 2)
2,400,000
Net Profit
1,600,000
Other information:
1. The Cost of the Building was Taka 8,000,000 and the amount of accumulated depreciation up to
the date of sale was Taka 2,700,000 and sold for Taka 7,500,000.
2. Administrative and Selling & Distribution Expenses:
Salaries and Wages
Fines and Penalties
Rents, Rates & Taxes
Provision for Bad and Doubtful Debts
Legal Charges
Underwriting Commission
Taka
1,562,000
125,000
80,000
60,000
37,000
120,000
Incentive Bonuses
Cost of Issuing Shares
Audit Fees
Overseas Traveling Expense
Depreciation Expense
Total
40,000
100,000
60,000
100,000
116,000
2,400,000
3. Salary and wages includes Taka 180,000 as payment to the owners and Taka 520,000 as payment
classified as perquisites.
4. The fines and penalties are charged by a local court for involvement in illegal business
transactions.
5. Legal charges have been incurred for defending a suit for alleged breach of a trading contract.
6. Tax depreciation amounts to be Taka 80,000.
Required: Compute the income from business or profession of Zian Ltd for the year ended on June 30,
2011.
Chapter 9
Capital gains
Contents
Introduction
Examination context
Topic List
9.1
9.2
9.3
9.4
9.5
9.6
9.7
9.8
Work
ed
Exam
ples
and
Soluti
ons
Introduction
Learning objectives
Practical significance
The head capital gain is very significant in terms of understanding and applications. Transfer of
capital assets is very common in business. Thus, in what situations, transfer of capital assets will
result capital gain, what may happen if the gain is reinvested within a certain time limit, what are
the powers of DCT regarding the value of declared sale proceeds are some important points
covered in the chapter.
Capital gain tax rate is different than the regular rates applicable to individuals and other
assesses. Thus, the assessment and computation of tax liability is to a greater extent different in
case of capital gain. These points are also addressed with due importance.
The chapter, as usual, also presents the scope of income under the head, admissible expenses,
inadmissible expenses and other related issues.
You will find the details of the above issues in this chapter with some practical example.
Stop and think
Do you realize that the computation of taxable income under the head capital gain is one of the
basic requirements for determining tax liability? Can you determine the taxable income under
the head? Can you compute net tax liability of an assessee having income under the head?
Working context
In practice, as the accountants are sometime required to support to prepare their clients' tax
returns, they need to advise the clients on how to calculate the total taxable income for any
income year. Before advising the clients, accountants should have the clear concept relating to
the admissible and inadmissible expenses so that they can deduct or add the expenses in
determining the taxable income.
Syllabus links
The topics covered in this chapter are very important for computing taxable income which is
required for solving sample practical problems at this level.
You will be also using this knowledge when you tackle the taxation paper later on in the
Professional Stage and it will also underpin the technical aspects at the Advanced Stage.
Examination context
Exam requirements
In the examination, candidates may be required to:
Question practice
For question practice on these topics go to the suggested answers covering this chapter and also
this manual.
Examiner's comments on how students tackle questions
Candidates have to be prepared well for this area as this chapter consists of core concept on
computation of income which is vital for calculating tax liability. Clear concept and understanding
of each contents of this chapter will help candidates to resolve any problems relating to
computation of income from capital gain.
9.0
CAPITAL GAINS
Section Overview
There is no capital gain tax on personal effects and agricultural land (with certain
restrictions), shares including bonus shares in listed companies.
There is no capital gain tax on the transfer of land and buildings to a new company formed
to set up an industry.
In determining the transfer value, income tax authorities may consider the fair market value
if it considers appropriate.
Capital loss can only by set off against capital gain.
It is taxed at the rate of 15 % in the case of company.
Non-residents are exempt in case of capital gains on stocks and shares provided they enjoy
the same in their own countries.
9.1
9.2
Capital
Asset
Transfer
[As per
section
2(15)]
[Sale, exchange,
relinquishment]
[As per section
2(66)]
Capital
Gain
Capital
Gain Tax
[As per
sections 31,
32]
[As per
Para 2 of
Second
Schedule]
and are not used for purposes of the business or profession of the assessee or any member
of his family dependent on him; and
(c) Agricultural land in Bangladesh, not being land situated(i) in any area which is comprised within the jurisdiction of Dhaka, Narayanganj and
Gazipur districts, Chittagong Development Authority (CDA), Khulna Development
Authority (KDA), Rajshahi Development Authority (RDA), a City Corporation,
Municipality, Paurashava, Cantonment Board; or
(ii) in any area within such distance not being more than five miles from the local limits of
Rajdhani Unnayan Kartripakya (RAJUK), Chittagong Development Authority (CDA),
Khulna Development Authority (KDA), Rajshahi Development Authority (RDA), a City
Corporation, Municipality, Paurashava, Cantonment Board referred to in paragraph (i),
as the Government may having regard to the extent of, and scope for, urbanisation of
that area and other relevant considerations, specify in this behalf by notification in the
official Gazette; [Section 2(15)].
Fair Market Value
In relation to capital asset, fair market value means
(a) the price which such asset would ordinarily fetch on sale in the open market on the relevant
day, and, where such price is not ascertainable, the price which the Deputy Commissioner of
Taxes may, with the approval in writing of the Inspecting Joint Commissioner, determine;
(b) the residual value received from the lessee in case of an asset leased by a financial institution
having license from the Bangladesh Bank on termination of lease agreement on maturity or
otherwise subject to the condition that such residual value plus amount realised during the
currency of the lease agreement towards the cost of the asset is not less than the cost of
acquisition to the lessor financial institution [Section 2(30)].
Transfer
Transfer, in relation to a capital asset, includes the sale, exchange or relinquishment of the asset,
or the extinguishments of any right therein, but does not include:
a) Any transfer of the capital asset under a gift, bequest, will or an irrevocable trust;
b) Any distribution of the assets of a company to its shareholders on its liquidation; and
c) Any distribution of capital assets on the dissolution of a firm or other association of persons
or on the partition of a Hindu undivided family [Section 2(66)].
9.3
(b) For the purpose of section 32, cost of acquisition of the capital asset means(i) Where it was acquired by the assessee by purchase, the actual cost of acquisition; and
(ii) Where it becomes the property of the assessee(a) Under a deed of gift, bequest or will; or
(b) Under a transfer on a revocable or irrevocable trust; or
(c) On any distribution of capital assets on the liquidation of a company; or
(d) On any distribution of capital assets on the dissolution of a firm or other association
of persons or the partition of a Hindu undivided family.
The actual cost of acquisition to the previous owner of the capital asset as reduced by the
amount of depreciation, if any, allowed to the previous owner; and where the actual cost of
acquisition to the previous owner cannot be ascertained, the fair market value at the date on
which the capital asset became the property of the previous owner.
However, where the capital asset is an asset in respect of which the assessee has obtained
depreciation allowance in any year, the cost of acquisition of the capital asset to the assessee
shall be its written down value increased or diminished, as the case may be, by any adjustment
made under section 19(16) or (17) or section 27(1) (i) or section 29(1) (xi):
Where the capital asset became the property of the assessee by succession, inheritance or
devolution, the actual cost of acquisition of the capital asset to the assessee shall be the fair
market value of the property prevailing at the time the assessee became the owner of such
property.
If DCT opines
different fair value
than the value
stated by transferor
DCT will
determine the
value
Government may
offer to buy the
capital asset
Mr. Jashim declared the price of a piece of land as Tk. 3,000,000 on 15th July, 2010, however, the
DCT estimates the fair value of the land to be Tk. 3,500,000 i.e. more than 15% of the declared
value. He can with the prior approval of the IJCT, determine the fair value at Tk. 3,500,000 and
can compute capital gain or loss accordingly rejecting thereby Jashims declared value. Further
the Government may offer to buy the land when in the opinion of the DCT; the fair market
value of the said land is say, Tk. 4,000,000 i.e. at least 25% more than the declared value. It is not
clear whether in this case, Government would actually buy or uses the pre-emption right to
deter under-declaration.
Since the DCT is not the proper valuers, applications of the provisions may delay or complicate
the process of property transfer.
The manner to be followed in connection with the purchase of a capital asset by the
Government under section 32(4) of the Ordinance shall be as follows:
(1) Where the Deputy Commissioner of Taxes has reason to believe that any immovable
property is being transferred by a person (hereinafter referred to as the transferor) to
another person (person hereinafter referred to as the transferee) and the fair market value
of such property exceeds the declared value by more than twenty-five per cent, and the
consideration for such transfer as agreed to between the parties has not been truly stated in
the instrument of transfer with the object of facilitating the reduction or evasion of the
liability of the transferor to pay the tax under the Ordinance in respect of any income arising
from the transfer or any other taxes or duties, he may, subject to the provisions of this rule,
initiate proceedings for the acquisition of such property by the Government.
(2) The Deputy Commissioner of Taxes shall initiate proceedings for acquisition of immovable
property under rule 40 by giving a notice to that effect in the official Gazette and a copy of
such notice shall also be published in the two leading newspapers of wide circulation where
such property is located; a copy of such notice shall also be served on the transferor, the
transferee and the person in occupation of the property, if the transferee is not in
occupation thereof However, no such proceedings shall be initiated after the expiry of a
period of two years from the end of the month in which the instrument of transfer in
respect of such property is registered under the Registration Act, 1908.
(3) Objection against the acquisition of the immovable property in respect of which a notice has
been published in the official Gazette and the newspapers may be made in writing by the
transferor or the transferee to the Deputy Commissioner of Taxes within sixty days of the
publication of the notice in the official Gazette or newspapers.
(4) The Deputy Commissioner of Taxes shall fix a date and place for the hearing of the
objections against the acquisition and shall give notice of the same to every person who has
made such objection. However, notice shall also be given to the transferee of such property
even if he has not made any such objection.
(5) After hearing the objections, if any, after taking into account all the relevant materials on
record, if the Deputy Commissioner of Taxes is satisfied that(a) The fair market value of such property exceeds the consideration paid therefore by
more than twenty-five per cent of such consideration, and
(b) The consideration for such transfer as agreed to between the parties has not been truly
stated in the instrument of transfer with such object as is referred to in clause (1); he
may make an order for the acquisition of the property under this rule.
(6) Any person aggrieved by an order made under rule 40(5) may prefer an appeal under the
Ordinance to the Appellate Joint Commissioner of Taxes.
(7) As soon as may be after the order of acquisition of any immovable property has been made
under rule 40(5) and after the disposal of appeal, if any, the Deputy Commissioner of Taxes
may by notice in writing, order any person who may be in possession of the immovable
property to surrender or deliver possession thereof to him or any other person duly
authorized by him in writing in these behalf within 30 days of the service of the notice.
(8) If any person refuses or fails to comply with a notice under rule 40(7), the Deputy
Commissioner of Taxes or any other person duly authorized by him under that clause may
take possession of the immovable property and may, for that purpose, requisition the
services of any police officer to assist him and it shall be the duty of such officer to comply
with such requisition and may use such force as may be necessary.
(9) When the possession of the immovable property is surrendered or delivered under rule
40(7), the Deputy Commissioner of Taxes or the person duly authorised by him in that
behalf or, as the case may be, when the possession thereof is taken under rule 40(8), the
Government shall tender as consideration a sum equal to the aggregate of the amount of the
declared value for its transfer plus 10% of the said amount to the transferor and the
property shall vest absolutely in the Government free from all encumbrances. However,
nothing in rule 40(9) shall operate to discharge the transferor or the transferee or any other
person (not being the Government) from any liability in respect of such encumbrances, and
notwithstanding anything contained in any other law, such liability may be enforced against
the transferor or the transferee or such other person by a suit for damages.
(10) Notwithstanding anything contained in rule 40(9), if any dispute arises as to the
apportionment of the amount of consideration amongst persons claiming to be entitled
thereto, the Government shall deposit in the principal civil court of original jurisdiction the
amount required to be tendered under rule 40(9) and refer such dispute for decision of the
court and the decision of the court thereon shall be final.
Transfer of capital asset used in the business: Sec 32(5)
A capital gain arising from transfer of a capital asset being buildings or lands which immediately
before the date on which transfer took place was being used by the assessee for the purposes of
his business or profession shall be exempted from payment of the income tax up to the extent
and upon fulfillment of the conditions as mentioned below:(a) A new capital asset for the purposes of his business or profession has to be purchased within
a period of one year before or after the date of transfer.
(b) The declaration shall have to be filed for exemption before the assessment is made.
(c) When the capital gain is greater than the cost of the new asset, the capital gain up to the
extent of cost of acquisition of the new asset shall be exempted and the balance shall be
charged to tax. In determining the depreciation on such asset, cost shall be taken to be nil.
(d) When the capital gain is equal or less than the cost of the new asset, no tax shall be charged
on the capital gain.
The time-limit for purchase of the new asset can be extended by the Deputy Commissioner of
Taxes with prior approval of the Inspecting Joint Commissioner of Taxes.
Illustration 1:
Let us assume that a gain of Tk. 1,000,000 is realized by Company X on transfer of a building
which was used by the company for running its business. However, within one year, the company
has acquired another building costing Tk. 1,500,000. Show the implication of capital gain tax.
1,000,000
1,500,000
nil
500,000
However, if the new building was purchased for Tk. 1,000,000, then
Gain on transfer of building
Cost of the new building
Capital gain chargeable to tax
Depreciation allowance will be available on cost additional investment
1,000,000
1,000,000
nil
nil
Again, if the new building was purchased for Tk. 800,000, then
Gain on transfer of building
Cost of the new building
Capital gain chargeable to tax
Depreciation allowance will be available on cost additional investment
1,000,000
800,000
200,000
nil
Illustration 2:
XYZ Company sold a piece of land on 15 July, 2010 for Tk. 20 million. It incurred advertisement
cost of Tk. 80,000 and paid Tk. 300,000 brokerage commission. It bought the land 5 years back at a
cost of Tk. 3 million, stamp duty and legal costs were Tk. 400,000 and Tk. 90,000 respectively. On
30 November, 2010 it has bought another price of land in Dhaka at a cost of Tk. 10 million
inclusive of legal costs. The Company has duly informed the DCT about its intention to roll over
the capital gain to new land purchased.
XYZ Company
Assessment year 2011-2010
Computation of Capital gain:
Sale price of land
Less: Commission on sale
300,000
Advertisement
80,000
Net sale proceeds
Deduct Cost of acquisition:
Purchase price
3,000,000
Stamp duty
400,000
Legal costs
90,000
Capital gain
Investment made under Sec. 32(5)
Capital gain assessed
20,000,000
380,00
19,620,000
3,490,000
16,130,000
(10,000,000)
6,130,000
Tax value of new assets (WDV) would be Nil and capital gain tax is Tk. 919,500 i.e. 15% on Tk.
6,130,000.
Let us further assume that the cost of new land is Tk. 25 millions, all inclusive and now the rollover
would be:
Cost of new asset
Investment made under Sec. 32(5)
Tax written down value carried forward
Tk. 25,000,000
(16,130,000)
8,870,000
For second land, the acquisition cost would be Tk. 8,870,000 and on its disposal, if any, in future
capital gain would be calculated accordingly.
9.4
9.5
9.6
Situations
(a) company
(b) person other than
company
@ 15%
i)
9.7
Percentage
At regular rate
At regular rate or @ 15%,
whichever is lower
Special Tax Rates on income earned from selling shares and stocks
As per SRO 269-AIN/IT/2010 circulated on July 01, 2010, special tax rate is proposed for income
from sale of stocks and shares by specified persons as mentioned below:
The following reduced tax rates will be applicable on the income earned from transaction of
securities (excluding government securities) listed in the Stock Exchanges:
Sl.
(a)
(b)
(c)
Tax rate
10%
5%
5%
1. If a shareholder mentioned in Sl. (b) is a Company or Firm, then tax rate will be 10%, same as
mentioned in Sl. (a).
2. In case of transferring the shares by any Sponsor Shareholder / Director mentioned in Sl. (b),
tax will be deducted at the rate of 5% on the difference between transfer value and cost of
acquisition of the securities as per Section 53M of the ITO, 1984.
3. The income from trading of shares of all other types of taxpayers excluding those mentioned
in the above lists is exempted from tax.
4. Here, the term Securities will include any stocks, shares, mutual fund units, bonds,
debentures or other securities of any listed company tradable in the stock exchanges of the
country (excluding the securities issued by the government).
5. This SRO is effective from July 01, 2010.
9.8
Now capital gain and tax on capital gain will be computed as below:
Original Cost
Cost
65,000,000
Sale Proceeds
117,000,000
Capital gain assessed
52,000,000
Capital gain tax rate
Regular rate or 15%, whichever is lower
Improvements
35,000,000
63,000,000
28,000,000
15%
Improvement part has been disposed off within 5 years of acquisition and thus Tk. 28 million would
be included with the total income of the assessee. Original cost part has been held for 8 years and
the tax on it, would be the lower of tax payable on the total income including capital gain and 15%.
Worked Examples and Solutions
Worked Example 1:
Mr. Ershad has recorded the following transactions for the year ended on June 30, 2011. You are
required to comment on implication of capital gain and capital gain taxes on each of the following
transactions independently.
(a) He has sold a motorcar at Tk. 600,000 that he purchased in 2007 at a cost of Tk. 400,000 and used
solely for personal purposes.
(b) Sale of a 3-storied building for Tk. 3,000,000 in December 2010, which was purchased on March
2000 for Tk. 1,800,000. In January 2004, the building was extended at a total cost of Tk. 500,000. The
fair value of the building in December 2010 was Tk. 3,200,000.
(c) Sold an agricultural land situated outside the jurisdiction of Comilla Cantonment Board at a total
price of Tk. 2,000,000 which was purchased 5 years back at a total price of Tk. 1,000,000.
(d) Sold a machine, purchased at a price of Tk. 80,000 for the purpose of his business, at a price of Tk.
150,000 at fair market value. Another Tk. 30,000 was spent to improve the machine. At the time of
sale, the machine had accumulated depreciation amounting to Tk. 60,000.
Solution 1:
(a) The motorcar is a movable property and used exclusively for personal purposes. It does not fall
under the definition of capital asset as per section 2(15). Thus, he is not required to assess capital
gain on this transfer and no taxes as well.
(b) Calculation of capital gain from the sale of building:
Sale proceeds or fair market value whichever is higher
Tk. 3,200,000
Less:
Cost of acquisition
Tk. 1,800,000
Cost of extension
500,000
2,300,000
Capital Gain
Tk. 900,000
Here, capital gain will be taxed at regular rate or 15%, whichever is lower as transfer is made after 5
years both original cost and extension work.
(c) The land, being an agricultural land situated outside the jurisdiction of a cantonment board, does not
fall under the category of capital asset as per section 2(15). So, the capital gain arising from such
transfer will not be taxed.
(d) Calculation of capital gain from the sale of machine:
Sale proceeds or fair market value whichever is higher
Tk. 150,000
Less:
Cost of Acquisition
Tk. 80,000
Cost of improvement
30.000
Capital Gain
110,000
Tk. 40,000
Worked Example 2:
Mr. Ashiqur Rahman purchased an apartment in November 2007 for Tk. 1,600,000. He has paid 1%
brokerage fee and subsequently spent another Tk. 500,000 for the renovation of the house. On 1st July,
2010 he entered into an agreement to sell the property to Mr. Anowar for a consideration of Tk.
5,000,000 and received earnest money (advance money) of Tk. 100,000. As per the terms of the
agreement, the balance payment should be made within 90 days of the agreement and if not the earnest
money will be forfeited. As Mr. Anowar could not make the payment within the stipulated time the
amount of Tk. 100,000 was forfeited by Mr. Rahman. Subsequently on 10th June, 2011, Mr. Rahman sold
the apartment to Mr. Abdur Rahman for Tk. 5,500,000. He also paid 2% brokerage fee on sale of the
apartment. The fair market value of the house on the date of sale was Tk. 5,200,000. Calculate taxable
capital gains for the assessment year 2011-12.
Solution 2:
Calculation of Taxable capital gains:
Particulars
Income under "Capital Gains" (Sec 31):
Full value of consideration received against Capital Asset:
(including the forfeited amount of Tk. 100,000)
Fair Market Value at the Time of Transfer,
Disposal vale of the capital asset (whichever is higher)
Less - Allowable Deductions
Brokerage fee for sale (5,500,000 x 2%)
Cost of Acquisition [1,600,000 + (1,600,000 xl %)]
Cost of improvements of the asset
Capital Gain
Taka
Taka
5,600,000
5,200,000
5,600,000
110,000
1,616,000
500,000
2,226.000
3,374,000
Worked Example 3:
Mr. Jason runs a business of his own. He has purchased a piece of land at a cost of Tk. 10,000,000 on 1st
January 2004 within the jurisdiction of Chittagong Municipality. He has paid Tk. 50,000 as finders' fee and
another Tk. 120,000 as registration fee for the land. He has sold the land on July 15, 2010 at price of Tk.
22,000,000. For the sale, he has to pay brokerage fee @ 2% on the gross sales amount received. In DCTs
opinion, the fair market value of the land at the time of sale is Tk. 20,000,000. On June 30, 2011 he has
purchased another land at a cost of (a) Tk. 10,000,000 (b) Tk. 12,000,000 and expressed his intention of
getting roll over relief of capital gain on new land in writing to DCT. He also had Tk. 200,000 as taxable
income from interest on securities and Tk. 100,000 from income from other sources.
Solution 3:
Assessee: Mr. Jason
Assessment Year: 2011-12
Income Year: 2010-11
Particulars
Taka
Taka
Income under "Capital Gains" (See 31):
Sale Proceeds of Capital Assets, or
22,000,000
Fair Market Value at the Time of Transfer,
20,000,000
whichever is higher
22,000,000
(a) Taka
(b) Taka
Capital Gain
11,390,000
11,390,000
10,000,000
11.390,000
1,390,000
nil
nil
610,000
200,000
1,390,000
100,000
1,690,000
200,000
nil
100,000
300,000
10,610 000
1,80,000
3,00,000
4,00,000
3,00,000
5,10,000
16,90,000
1,80,000
1,20,000
Rate
Nil
10%
15%
20%
25%
3,00,000
Amount of Tax
Case (a)
Case (b)
00
30,000
60,000
60,000
127,500
2,77,500
16.42%
00
12,000
15.00%
15.00%
2,08,500
15.00%
nil
12,000
12,000
220,500
12,000
12,000
4.00%
Notes:
1. The land qualified as capital asset. Because, it is not an agricultural land and is situated within the
jurisdiction area as specified.
2. Expenditure incurred to transfer the capital asset, Taka 440,000 (brokerage fees @ 2% of Tk.
22,000,000.
3. Cost of acquisition, Tk. 10,170,000 (cost 10,000,000 + finders' fees 50,000 + registration Fees
120,000)
4. In case of (a) as the investment was less than the capital gain, there will be capital gains equivalent to
differential amount and tax have to pay on such amount though the tax value of the new asset will be
nil. But in case of (b) investment is more than the capital gain and so there will be no capital gain left
to charge under the head and the tax value of the new asset will be the difference between the cost
of new assets and capital gains rolled over (taka 12,000,000 - taka 11,390,00).
5. There is no revenue gain as the cost and written down value of the asset is same.
6. Here, the assessee is a person other than a company and the asset is sold after 5 years of purchase.
So, as per rule, tax rate will be the lower of average lax rate computed on tax on total income
including capital gain and 15% flat rate, whichever is lower. So in case (a), applicable tax rate on
capital gain (taka 1,390,000) will be 15% as this is the lower one and at regular rate on remaining
income. But in case of case (b), tax will be applied at regular rate as there is no income under the
head 'capital gain'.
Self-Assessment Question
1. Explain the terms capital asset, cost of acquisition and fair market value under the Income Tax
Ordinance 1984.
2. State the capital gains exempted from payment of Income Tax under the Ordinance.
3.
Mr. Hasan has purchased a machine at a total cost of Tk. 500,000 on 23'" April 2006 for the purpose of
his profession. In addition, he has paid Tk. 10,000 as legal fees. He has spent an additional sum of Tk.
50,000 for improvement of the machine. On 30th December 2009, he had sold the machine at a total
price of Tk. 600,000 when the balance of allowable accumulated depreciation was Tk. 126,000 in his
books of accounts. But the fair market value on that date amounts to Tk. 650,000 in the opinion of
DCT. He incurred advertisement cost of Tk. 20,000 and 1.5% as brokerage commission on the sale
value. He has taxable income of Tk. 230,000 from other sources. Compute capital gain, total taxable
income, and specify tax rate thereon.
Chapter 10
Income from other sources
Contents
Introduction
Examination context
Topic List
10.1
10.2
10.3
10.4
10.5
10.6
10.7
10.8
10.9
Introduction
Dividend
Interest Income other than Interest on Securities
Royalty
Fees for Technical Service
Income from Letting of Assets
Deemed Income under different sub-sections of Section 19
Allowable Deductions
Inadmissible Deductions
Work
ed
Exam
ples
and
Soluti
ons
Introduction
Learning objectives
Practical significance
The head income from other sources is very significant due to its importance as a residual head
of income. Income that doesnt fall under any other head comes under the scope of this head.
Thus, it is important to know different categories of income coming under the dead.
Dividend income, interest income (in specific cases), royalty income, fees for technical services,
income from letting machineries are some income coming under the head. Some deemed income
under section 19 will also be considered as income from other sources.
Tax is deducted at sources as per rules in some categories of income under the head. These
incomes are required to be grossed up before reporting them in return of income. Sometimes,
these are considered as final settlement of tax liability under section 82C and it is important to
know the impact on computing taxable income and tax liability as well.
The chapter, as usual, also presents the scope of income under the head, admissible expenses,
inadmissible expenses and other related issues.
You will find the details of the above issues in this chapter with some practical example.
Stop and think
Do you realize that the computation of taxable income under the head income from other
sources is one of the basic requirements for determining tax liability? Can you determine the
taxable income under the head? Can you compute net tax liability of an assessee having income
under the head?
Working context
In practice, as the accountants are sometime required to support to prepare their clients' tax
returns, they need to advise the clients on how to calculate the total taxable income for any
income year. Before advising the clients, accountants should have the clear concept relating to
the admissible and inadmissible expenses so that they can deduct or add the expenses in
determining the taxable income.
Syllabus links
The topics covered in this chapter are very important for computing taxable income which is
required for solving sample practical problems at this level.
You will be also using this knowledge when you tackle the taxation paper later on in the
Professional Stage and it will also underpin the technical aspects at the Advanced Stage.
Examination context
Exam requirements
In the examination, candidates may be required to:
Question practice
For question practice on these topics go to the suggested answers covering this chapter and also
this manual.
Examiner's comments on how students tackle questions
Candidates have to be prepared well for this area as this chapter consists of core concept on
computation of income which is vital for calculating tax liability. Clear concept and understanding
of each contents of this chapter will help candidates to resolve any problems relating to
computation of income from other sources.
10.0
10.1
Income from other sources is the last and residual head of income.
The total income may not be taxable income.
There are some allowable, inadmissible and not permissible deductions under the head.
Dividend, interest, royalty and fees for technical services are significant sources of income
under the head.
On some income under the head, tax is deducted at sources at specified rates.
Grossing up of income is important to report taxable income.
Sometimes tax deducted at sources is considered as final payment of tax liability under
section 82C.
There are some admissible and inadmissible deductions under the head.
Introduction
This is the residuary head of income as mentioned in Section 20 of the Income Tax Ordinance
1984.
The following income of an assessee is assessable under this head:
(1) Dividend and interest.
(2) Royalties and fees for technical services.
(3) Income from letting of machinery, plant or furniture and also of buildings if letting of
buildings is inseparable from the letting of the machinery, plant or furniture.
(4) Deemed income under section 19(1), (2), (3), (4), (5), (8), (9), (10), (11), (12), (13), (21),
(21A) or (24).
(5) Income of any kind or from any source which is not classifiable under any of the other
heads specified in Section 20.
From the above points, income from other sources can broadly be categorized as follows:
10.2
Categories
Particulars
References
Specified Income
Deemed income
Residual income
Section 33 (e)
Dividend
Section 2(26) defines dividend in this way Dividend includes (a) any distribution by a company out of accumulated profits, whether capitalized or not , if such
distribution entails the release by the company to its shareholders of all or any part of its
assets or reserves [Section 2(26)(a)];
(b) any distribution by a company, to the extent to which the company possesses accumulated
profits, whether capitalized or not, to its shareholders of debentures, debenture-stock or
deposit certificates in any form, whether with or without interest [Section 2(26)(b)];
(c) any distribution made to the shareholders of a company on its liquidation to the extent to
which the distribution is attributable to the accumulated profits of the company immediately
before its liquidation whether capitalized or not [Section 2(26)(c)];
(d) any distribution by a company to its shareholders on the reduction of its capital, to the
extent to which the company possesses accumulated profits whether such profits have been
capitalized or not [Section 2(26)(d)];
(e) any profit remitted outside Bangladesh by a company not incorporated in Bangladesh under
the Companies Act, 1994 [Section 2(26)(dd)];
(f) any payment by a private company of any sum (whether as representing a part of the assets
of the company or otherwise) by way of advance or loan to a shareholder or any payment by
any such company on behalf, or for the individual benefit, of any such shareholder, to the
extent to which the company, in either case, possesses accumulated profit, but does not
include (i) a distribution made in accordance with section 2(26)(c) or (d) in respect of any share
including preference share for full cash consideration, or redemption of debentures or
debenture-stock, where the holder of the share or debenture is not entitled in the event
of liquidation to participate in the surplus assets;
(ii) any advance or loan made to a shareholder in the ordinary course of its business, where
the lending of money is a substantial part of the business of the company;
(iii) any dividend paid by a company which is set off by the company against the whole or
any part of any sum previously paid by it an treated as dividend within the meaning of
section 2(26)(e) to the extent to which it is so set off.
(iv) any bonus share issued by a company [Section 2(26)(e)].
Exemption: Any income from dividend of a mutual fund or a unit fund is exempted up to Tk.
25,000 [Sixth schedule, Part A, Para 22A].
Tax Deducted at Sources: Tax on dividend income will be deducted at following rates:
Type of Assessee
Residential Status
Company
20%
10%
Non-resident foreigner
25%
TDS Rates
Grossing up: Yes. However, it is important to know the rate of TDS before grossing up.
Illustration:
Mr. Rolex is a non-resident foreigner and received Tk. 7,500 as dividend from a Public Limited
Company incorporated in Bangladesh. Here, rate of TDS was 25% and thus, after grossing up,
the amount of gross dividend will be Tk. 10,000 (7,500 100/75).
10.3
TDS rate
Exemption
No exemption
10%
10%
No exemption
No exemption
5%
10%
5%
No exemption
No exemption
Nil
Fully exempted
Nil
Fully exempted
10%
Nil
Nil
Grossing up: Grossing up is important for interest income across items 1, 2, 3, 4, 5 and 8
where TDS is applicable. It is not required for other 4 items (6, 7, 9 & 10) which is fully
exempted from tax and thus no tax is deducted at source.
Illustration
Lets assume that Mr. Arshad has reported interest income from the following
sources for the ended June 30, 2011. Compute grossed up income.
(i) Interest on fixed deposit Tk. 18,000.
(ii) Interest on savings account Tk. 9,000
(iii) Share of profit from Islami Bank Bangladesh Limited Tk. 13,500
(iv) Interest on Savings certificate Tk. 9,500
(v) Interest on Post Office Savings Bank Tk. 9,000
(vi) Interest on Wage Earners Development Bond Tk. 4,750
(vii) Interest on Non-Resident Foreign Currency Deposit Account Tk.
10,000
(viii) Interest on DPS Tk. 5,000
(ix) Interest on Bangladesh Industrial Development Bond
a) Tk. 20,000 and
b) Tk. 27,000
(x)
(xi)
TDS Rate
10%
10%
10%
5%
10%
5%
Formulae
Grossed up income
Tk. 18,000/1-0.1
Tk. 20,000
Tk. 9,000/1-0.1
Tk. 10,000
Tk. 13,500/1-0.1
Tk. 15,000
Tk. 9,500/1-0.05
Tk. 10,000
Tk. 9,000/1-0.1
Tk. 10,000
Tk. 4,750/1-0.05
Tk. 5,000
Fully Exempted
N/A
N/A
Fully Exempted
N/A
N/A
Fully Exempted
10%
Fully Exempted
Fully Exempted
N/A
Tk. 27,000/1-0.1
N/A
N/A
N/A
Tk. 30,000*
N/A
N/A
Tk. 3,000 of tax paid is the final tax liability on this income. No further taxes is due on this
income.
10.4
Royalty
As per section 2 (56) of ITO 1984, royalty means consideration (including any lump sum
consideration but excluding any consideration which is classifiable as income of the recipient
under the head "Capital gains") for (a) transfer of all or any rights, including the granting of a licence in respect of a patent,
invention, model, design, secret process or formula, or trade mark or similar property;
(b) the imparting of any information concerning the working of, or the use of, a patent,
invention, model, design, secret process or formula, or trade mark or similar property;
(c) the use of any patent, invention, model, design, secret process or formula, or trade mark or
similar property;
(d) the imparting of any information concerning technical, industrial, commercial, or scientific
knowledge, experience or skill;
(e) the transfer of all or any rights, including granting of a licence, in respect of any copyright,
literary, artistic or scientific work, including films or video tapes for use in connection with
television or tapes for use in connection with radio broadcasting, but not including
consideration for sale, distribution or exhibition of cinematograph films; or
(f) the rendering of any services in connection with any of the aforesaid activities
However, section 36, gives the guideline of how income from royalties, literary works, etc. can
be allocated among different income years depending on the time used for completing the works.
Briefly, the guideline is as follows:
Time taken to complete the work
Less than 12 months
More than 12 but less than 24
months
10.6
10.7
19(1)
Unexplained credits
Any sum credited in the books of an assessee maintained for any income year and
the assesses offers no explanation about the nature and source thereof, or the
explanation offered is not satisfactory
19(2)
Unexplained investments
Where the assessee has made investments or is found to be the owner of any
bullion, jewellery or other valuable article and the DCT finds that the amount
expended on making such investments or in acquiring such bullion, jewellery or
other valuable article exceeds the amount recorded in this behalf in the books of
account maintained by the assessee for any source of income and the assessee
offers no explanation about the excess amount or the explanation offered is not
satisfactory
19(3)
Unexplained expenditure
Where the assessee has incurred any expenditure and he offers no explanation
about the nature and source of the money for such expenditure, or the explanation
offered is not satisfactory
19(4)
Unrecorded investments
Where, in the financial year immediately preceding the assessment year, the
assessee has made investments which are not recorded in the books of account, if
any, maintained by him for any source of income, and the assessee offers no
explanation about the nature and source of fund for the investments, or the
explanation offered is not satisfactory
19(5)
19(8)
19(9)
19(10)
19(11)
Where any benefit or advantage, whether convertible into money or not, is derived
by an assessee during any income year on account of cancellation of indebtedness
the money value of such advantage or benefit
19(12)
19(13)
19(21)
Unpaid loan
Where any sum, or aggregate of sums exceeding Tk. 1,00,000 is claimed or shown
to have been received as loan by an assessee during any income year from any
person, not being a banking company or a financial institution, otherwise than by a
crossed cheque drawn on a bank, and has not been paid back in full within three
years from the end of the income year in which it is claimed or shown to have been
received, the said sum or part thereof which has not been paid back
19(21A)
19(21B)
19(24)
19(26)
19(27)
10.8
Allowable Deductions
As per section 34, followings are the allowable deductions from the income classifiable as income
from other sources as per section 33.
(1) Interest paid on money borrowed for the purpose of acquisition of shares of a company.
Interest payable outside Bangladesh on which tax has not been paid and from which tax has
not been deducted at source shall not however be admissible deduction.
(2) Any expenditure, not being capital expenditure or personal expenses, spent solely for the
purpose of making or earning the relevant income.
(3) Where income from other sources is derived from letting on hire any machinery, plant or
furniture is inseparable with buildings, allowance for repairs, insurance premium,
depreciation and obsolescence allowance are admissible in the determination of income from
business under section 29(1) (vi), 29(1) (vii), and 29(1) (xi), respectively as if the income
from such letting on hire were income from business or profession.
Provided that the provisions of section 19 (16) shall also be applicable for the determination
of any profits where the sale proceeds of such machinery, plants, furniture or building
exceeds the written down value thereof.
10.9
Inadmissible Deductions
As per section 34(4), following two expenses are not admissible:
(a) Any interest chargeable under the Ordinance which is payable outside Bangladesh on
which tax has not been paid and from which tax has not been deducted at source under
section 56; or
(b) Any payment which is chargeable under the head Salaries if tax has not been paid
thereon or deducted there from under section 50.
9,000
5,400
19,000
1,800
1,000
25,000
1,000
1,500
4,000
Remuneration as Director
10,000
5,000
2,000
During the year he has purchased jewellery of Tk. 125,000 the source of which has not been explained to
the DCT. During the year he has paid Tk. 200 as license renewal fee and Tk. 800 as interest on loan
taken to purchase the shares of private limited company.
Solution 1
Assessee: Mr. Abdur Rahman
Assessment year: 2011-2012
Income year: 2010-2011
Determination of total income
Income from Other Sources (Sec - 33):
1. Dividend from Pvt. Ltd. Co. (9,000/1-0.1)
2. Interest on Fixed Deposits (5,400/1-0.1)
3. Interest on Savings Certificate (19,000/1-0.05)
4. Interest on Post Office Savings Bank (1,800/1-0.1)
5. Remuneration for exam script evaluation
6. Prize of Prize bond lottery
7. Less: Final payment of tax as per 82(c)
8. Sale of Fish of Pond
9. Sale of forest tree and bamboo
10. Income from copyright and royalty
11. Remuneration as Director
12. Income from marriage anniversary
Less: Exempted (full)
13. Income from license
14. Unexplained investment to purchase jewellery
Less:
10,000
6,000
20,000
2,000
1,000
25,000
25,000
5,000
5,000
Allowable deductions:
License renewal fee
Interest on loan
200
800
1,000
1,500
4,000
10,000
2,000
125,000
1,82,500
1,000
Total
1,81,500
Notes:
1.
Assuming copyright and royalty has been received from a person, hence no TDS is allowed.
2.
Income from marriage anniversary is a gift hence exempted from income tax.
Worked Example 2
Mr. Joarder Hossain has reported the following incomes for the income year 2010-11 classifiable under
the head Income from Other Sources. Compute taxable income of Mr. Hossain.
Dividend from ICB Mutual Fund (gross amount)
30,000
2,700
30,000
2,000
l0,000
2,000
1,000
1,500
4,000
10,000
5,000
2,000
30,000
10,000
1,800
During the year he spent Tk. 200,000 on a party in Hotel Radisson, the source of expenditure remained
unexplained to the DCT. He has also visited Singapore incurring a total cost of Tk. 100,000 and
purchased a Diamond set of Tk. 200,000 for his wife for which the source of the money was not
satisfactory to the DCT. During the year he has paid Tk. 2,000 as commission for collecting the dividend
and Tk. 8,000 as interest on loan taken to purchase the shares of public limited company.
Solution 2:
Assessee: Mr. Joarder Hossain
Assessment year: 2011-2012
Income year: 2010 - 2011
Determination of total income
Income from Other Sources (Sec - 33):
1.
Dividend from ICB Mutual Fund
Less: Exempted Up to Tk. 25,000
2.
Profit on Islami Bank Scheme (2,700/1-0.1)
3.
Interest on Savings Certificate
4.
Income from royalty of a book
5.
Income received from a part-time job
6.
Prize of winning crosswords
Less: Final payment of tax as per 82(c)
7.
Income from letting out household machineries
8.
Sale of forest timber
9.
Income from rent of a shop
10. Gain from loan amortization
11. Income from newspaper column writing
12. Income from unused leased land
13. Honorarium for attending a Symposium
14. Income from private tuition in a Coaching Center
15. Royalty income from government (1,800/1-0.1)
Less: Final payment of tax as per 82(c)
16. Unexplained investments:
Party in hotel
Travel to Singapore
Purchase of Diamond jewellery
30,000
25,000
2,000
2,000
5,000
3,000
30,000
2,000
10,000
1,000
1,500
4,000
10,000
5,000
2,000
30,000
10,000
2,000
2,000
200,000
100,000
200,000
5,00,000
613,500
2,000
8,000
1,000
612,500
Total
Self-Assessment Question
1. What is meant by dividend under the Income Tax Ordinance 1984?
2. What are the incomes assessable as Income from Other Sources under the Ordinance?
3. Mr. Joynal Akand has earned the following incomes for the year 2010-11.
Dividend from preference shares of a Public Limited Company
45,000
18,000
30,000
40,000
27,000
10,000
36,000
48,000
15,000
40,000
20,000
50,000
Income from lump sum royalty of a book which took him two years to write the book
90,000
During the year he spent Tk. 200,000 to purchase a piece of land, Tk. 90,000 to purchase a motorcycle
and the explanation given regarding the source of expenditure was unsatisfactory to the DCT. Through
investigation, the DCT has also identified an FDR of Tk. 500,000 in a local bank source of which has also
remained explained. He has also visited India incurring a total cost of Tk. 100,000 and purchased a
Diamond set for Tk. 100,000 for his wife for which the source of the money was also unexplained.
During the year he has paid Tk. 1,500 as commission for collecting the dividend. His other expenditures
during the year were as follows:
Purchase of Books and Magazine
15,000
30,000
80,000
15,000
Purchase of a Laptop
130,000
200,000
Compute taxable income and tax liability of Mr. Joynal Akand for the assessment year 2011-12.
Chapter 11
Depreciation allowances
Contents
Introduction
Examination context
11.1
11.2
11.3
11.4
11.5
11.6
11.7
11.8
11.9
11.10
11.11
11.12
11.13
Topic List
Basics of Depreciation Allowances
Depreciation Allowance for Different Heads of Income
Depreciation allowance on assets used for agricultural purpose
Depreciation allowance on assets used in business or profession
Types of Depreciation Allowance
Normal depreciation allowance
Initial Depreciation Allowance
Other depreciation allowance
Investment allowance: Section 29(1) (ix) & (x)
Written down value of assets for the purpose of depreciation allowance: (Para 11(5)
(a) & (b) and 11(6) (a) of the third Schedule)
Disposal of assets and treatment of gains or losses thereof (Para 10, Third Schedule)
Limitation in respect of Depreciation Allowance (Para 9, Third Schedule)
Depreciation: Whether Compulsory or Optional?
Introduction
Learning objectives
Practical significance
Depreciation allowance is very important in computing income from business and profession. It
is an allowable deduction in computing income from agriculture and income from business and
profession. Thus, computing depreciation and understanding its implication is very significant.
Accounting depreciation and tax depreciation is not the same that generates deferred taxation.
And it is very important for professional accountants to practice deferred taxation. This chapter
presents different types of depreciation allowances, investment allowance and other related
topics.
It also presents a definition of written down value with the application of gain and loss on
disposal of assets. It also presents different exceptions to the common rule.
You will find the details of the above issues in this chapter with some practical example.
Stop and think
Do you realize that the computation of depreciation allowance is one of the important issues for
determining tax liability? Can you determine the taxable income under the heads income from
agriculture and income from business and profession after allowing depreciation allowance?
Working context
In practice, as the accountants are sometime required to support to prepare their clients' tax
returns, they need to advise the clients on how to calculate the total taxable income for any
income year. Before advising the clients, accountants should have the clear concept relating to
the admissible and inadmissible expenses so that they can deduct or add the expenses in
determining the taxable income.
Syllabus links
The topics covered in this chapter are very important for computing taxable income which is
required for solving sample practical problems at this level.
You will be also using this knowledge when you tackle the taxation paper later on in the
Professional Stage and it will also underpin the technical aspects at the Advanced Stage.
Examination context
Exam requirements
In the examination, candidates may be required to:
Question practice
For question practice on these topics go to the suggested answers covering this chapter and also
this manual.
Examiner's comments on how students tackle questions
Candidates have to be prepared well for this area as this chapter consists of core concept on
computation of income which is vital for calculating tax liability. Clear concept and understanding
of each contents of this chapter will help candidates to resolve any problems relating to
computation of income under the heads income from agriculture and income from business
and profession.
11.0
DEPRECIATION ALLOWANCE
Section Overview
Depreciation is allowed on cost but investment allowance is over the above cost and
depreciation allowance.
Any Government subsidy or any grant from any authority received for the purchase is to be
deducted from cost.
Sale value of motor car costing more than Tk. 10 lakhs is to be scaled down in proportion to
Tk. 10 lakhs limit and the same with assets used partly for business or profession and partly
for private purpose of the assessee.
Full depreciation is allowed in the year of purchase and none is allowed in the year of
disposal of asset.
Sale value exceeding original cost is capital gain and should be taxed accordingly.
Depreciation is calculated on reducing balance method (WDV) on all assets other than
accelerated depreciation or on ships and vessel when cost is used.
Balancing charge is the revenue gain and should be taxed separately.
Accounting depreciation and tax depreciation are different and it creates deferred taxes.
11.1
It is allowed on fixed assets other than land i.e. buildings, plant and machinery, furniture and
fittings, equipments etc.
(ii)
Assets must be used in the relevant income year in business or profession. It may be used
for the whole year or for just one day in the year. The allowance is given for the whole
year without time apportionment. However, it would be on proportionate basis when
assets or some of these are used for private purpose and business purpose.
(iii) Ownership of the assets must be with the concerned assessee in the income year. This
condition overrides prima facie that of use when in the case of lease, finance operative or
any other arrangement of hire purchase purpose, the lessor retains the ownership. He is
thus allowed full tax depreciation though the assets have been used by the assesee.
(iv) It is obligatory on the part of the asessee to furnish the prescribed particulars in respect of
depreciation claim (Rule 41). If the prescribed particulars are not furnished, the DCT may
even refuse to grant any allowance for depreciation. However, where the particulars
Aggregate depreciation allowed shall not exceed cost and the law deals with the subject of
cost elsewhere.
(vi) No depreciation is allowed in the year the asset is sold discarded or demolished even when
it was used for major or most part of the year. However, balancing allowances is allowed in
that year when WDV of the asset is greater than the proceeds.
(vii) Third Schedule prescribes different rates of depreciation allowances for different classes of
assets. On ocean going ships and vessels the rate of depreciation is based on actual cost, in
all other cases, it is bases on written down value (WDV) of the asset.
(viii) Cost of motor vehicle used in the business or profession is restricted to Tk. 10 Lakhs for
the purpose of depreciation allowance calculation.
(ix) No depreciation is allowed on assets before the commencement of business i.e. commercial
production.
(x) While acquiring the asset, the assessee receives any capital grant or Government subsidy or
any assistance from any other authority or person such amount shall be excluded from the
acquisition cost for the calculation of depreciation allowance.
(xi) Fluctuation in the foreign exchange rate is given effect to determine the cost base of any
asset acquired with money borrowed and payable in foreign currency.
(xii) Depreciation is not treated as an expense unlike the matching of cost with revenue by the
accountants. However, it is given as a specific case for the diminution in capital assets used
in business or profession. Since, it is not treated as a cost by the tax people, tax profit or
loss is calculated first without having regard to depreciation allowance. If there is any profit
depreciation is set off against that. If not or if insufficient to absorb the whole, the balance is
and can be carried forward indefinitely as unabsorbed depreciation. But in case of loss, it
can be carried forward only for six years and when cannot be set off within that, is
regarded a capital loss. This facility of carry forward of unabsorbed depreciation is extended
to all tax holiday or exempted enterprises when however, they cannot carry forward their
business losses beyond the holiday or exempt period.
11.2
11.3
Third Schedule
[Para 1]
Sl.
No.
1
1)
2)
3)
4)
5)
6)
7)
8)
9)
10)
11)
12)
13)
14)
15)
16)
17)
18)
19)
20)
21)
22)
11.4
Classification of irrigation or
protective work or other capital
assets.
2
Pucca buildings
Kutcha and pucca buildings
Kutcha buildings
Temporary structure
Pucca walls
Fencing of substantial material
Tube-well
Tanks
Pucca irrigation channel
Kutcha irrigation channel
Kutcha irrigation wells
Pucca irrigation wells
Bullock drawn iron implements
Bullock drawn wooden or leather
implements and other small
hand/implements.
Weighing machine
Tractors and oil engines and thin
implements.
Power pumping machinery
Factory made cart of iron material
with rubber tyre
Country cart
Steam engine
Workshop tools
General (machinery, implements,
plants and other assets) not provided
for above specifically.
Rate/percentage of the
written down value, except
as otherwise indicated.
3
10
15
20
-
Remarks
4
No rate is specified;
renewal will be
allowed as revenue
expenditure
5
10
15
10
15
20
33.33
5
15
25
10
15
20
15
20
10
15
10
(a) at the time of filing a return of total income such particulars as may be prescribed and
such further information or documents as the Deputy Commissioner of Taxes may
require, are furnished; and
(b) such building, machinery, plant or furniture or bridge or road or fly over of a physical
infrastructure undertaking has been so used during income year.
11.5
11.6
Types of Allowances
Normal depreciation allowance
Initial depreciation allowance
Accelerated depreciation allowance on machinery and plant
Accelerated depreciation allowance on machinery and plant
Special depreciation allowance on Ships
Classification of Assets
2
(a) Buildings (general)
(b) Factory Buildings
Furniture and Fittings
Machinery and Plant:
1. General Rate
2. Special Rate:
(a) Ships
i) Ocean going ships (new)
ii) Ocean going ships (second
hand), age at the time of
purchase - less than 10 years
- 10 years or more
iii) Inland ships including steamers,
motor vessels, sails, tug boats,
iron or steel flats for cargo
boats, wooden cargo boats,
motor launches and speed
boats
Rate/percentage of
the Written Down
Value, except as
otherwise indicated
3
10
20
10
Remarks
4
20
12
12
24
24
The allowance is
to be calculated
on the original
costs.
20
20
20
24
30
50
30
30
30
100
30
2
2
2
Note: Any asset that fall under the description Machinery and Plant having useful life not more
than one year, allowance is not allowed though the cost of renewal or replacement thereof shall
be allowed as a revenue expenditure. (Para 5, Third Schedule)
11.7
Notes:
1) Initial depreciation allowance will not be applicable in case of
a) any motor vehicle not plying for hire, and
b) any machinery or plant which has previously been used in Bangladesh.
2) Normal depreciation allowance will also be applied for subsequent years. Thus, application of
this depreciation allowance is only in addition to normal depreciation allowance.
11.8
The industrial undertaking must be set up between 1 July, 1977 and 30 June, 2012 (both
days inclusive)
(d) The industrial undertaking is owned and managed by a Bangladeshi company or a body
corporate formed under any law and having its registered offices in Bangladesh.
(e)
(f)
(g)
The particulars as required for the purpose of claiming the accelerated depreciation
allowance have been furnished.
(h) Application complete in all respects, is made to NBR within 6 months from the end of
the month of commercial production together with a declaration that the undertaking
is neither enjoying tax holiday nor has made any application thereof to NBR. (Rule 40)
NBR is to give decision on the application within 3 months of application. Machinery and plant
granted accelerated depreciation allowance would not be allowed any other depreciation
allowance.
Rate of accelerated depreciation allowance:
a.
For the purpose of this para industrial undertaking includes expansion of an existing unit if such
expansion constitutes:
Similar unit carrying on a identifiable industries but does not include an undertaking formed by
splitting up or reconstruction of an existing undertaking or by the transfer of plant or machinery
of an existing undertaking or by the transfer of plant or machinery of an existing business to a
new business in Bangladesh. Machinery and plant includes physical infrastructure which means:
generation, transformation, conversion, transmission and distribution or supply of electrical
energy, or hydraulic power or road, highway, bridge, airport or the system of railway or
telecommunication or such other public facility as may be specified by the Board by notification
in the official gazette.
(2) Accelerated depreciation allowance for expansion unit of and undertaking
exempted under Section 46A: (Para 7A)
Under Paragraph 7A, accelerated depreciation is also allowable on machinery and plant (other
than office appliances and road transport vehicles) which having not been previously used in
Bangladesh, has been or is used.
(b) in the expansion unit set-up between the first of July, 1995 and the thirtieth day of June,
2005 (both days inclusive) in any existing undertaking enjoying exemption from tax under
section 64A; or
(c) between the first day of July, 1995 and the thirtieth day of June, 2005 in the treatment and
disposal of toxic and environmentally hazardous wastes or in the collection or processing of
biodegradable wastes or in the research and development in any industrial undertaking
owned and managed by a company as defined in clause (20) of Section 2.
(i)
(ii)
The meaning of expansion unit for the purpose of this paragraph is the same as has been given
for the purpose of paragraph (7) of the Third Schedule.
An application in the prescribed form furnishing therein the prescribed particulars is required to
be submitted to the Board for the allowance under this paragraph, within six months from the
end of the month of commencement of commercial production or operation. (Rule 40A)
The Board shall decide on the application within three months from the date of receipt of the
application, failing which accelerated depreciation, shall be deemed to have been allowed.
If any person is aggrieved by the Boards decision, he may file application within four months of
the receipt of the decision for review of its earlier decision by the Board.
(3) Special depreciation allowance on ships (Para 8)
The allowance is admissible on inland passenger vessel, fishing trawler and ships ordinarily not
paying in inland water, owned by the assessee and brought into use for the first time in
Bangladesh on any day between 1st July, 1982 and 30th June 1995 (both days inclusive) at the
following rates:
(i) for the first year
(ii) for the second year
(iii) for the third year
The assets enjoying special depreciation will not be eligible for any other depreciation under the
Income Tax Ordinance. However, above provision has become absolute since not extended after
1995.
11.9
11.10 Written down value of assets for the purpose of depreciation allowance: (Para 11(5)
(a) & (b) and 11(6) (a) of the third Schedule)
written down value means
(a)
Note: In the case of motor vehicles, being passenger vehicles or sedan cars, not plying for hire,
the actual cost to the assessee shall be deemed not to exceed ten lakhs Taka.
11.11 Disposal of assets and treatment of gains or losses thereof (Para 10, Third Schedule)
Where in any income year, building, machinery or plant is disposed of by an assessee(a) No depreciation allowance shall be allowed in respect of year of disposal.
(b) When the sale proceeds exceed the written down value, the excess amount limited up to
the difference between the original cost and the written down value, shall be income of the
year from business or profession.
The principle underlying the provision is that the depreciation allowed in the past as
expenditure in determining income shall be treated as income in the year of sale when the
sale proceeds exceed the written down value.
(c) when the sale proceeds are less than the written down value of the assets, deficit shall be
expenditure deductible from the profits or gains of business or profession of that year.
(d) When sale proceeds exceed the original cost, difference between original cost and WDV i.e.
depreciation allowances previously granted would be business profit and amount exceeding
cost would be assessed under Sec. 31 as capital gain.
Partners right
A partner of a firm is entitled to set off his share of unabsorbed depreciation from a defunct firm
against his other business income.
Assignment of unabsorbed depreciation
The unabsorbed depreciation allowance cannot be assigned to the transferee of the business. If a
business is acquired by another, the unabsorbed depreciation allowance of the previous owner
becomes a capital loss and cannot be carried forward by the successor in business for set off
against profits of subsequent years.
Amalgamation, mergers etc.
When a company mergers into another and has unabsorbed depreciation or carried forward loss
from earlier years, the right to carry them forward is lost and the transferee company being a
different assessee, cannot claim to carry forward either the unabsorbed depreciation or the
losses of the merged company.
Change of shareholding or the constitution of firm
Disentitlement of carry forward of loss upon a change in shareholding in a company does not
apply in case of unabsorbed depreciation. Similarly change in the constitution of a firm does not
disentitle the firm from unabsorbed claim.
Depreciation Rate
Depreciation
2008-09
2009-10
2010-11
20%
20%
20%
400,000
320,000
256,000
Total Gain: Sale Proceeds Written Down Value = Tk. 2,500,000 Tk. 1,024,000 = Tk.
1,476,000
Capital Gain = Sale Proceeds Original Cost = Tk. 2,500,000 Tk. 2,000,000 = Tk. 500,000
Balancing Charge = Total Gain Capital Gain = Tk. 1,476,000 - Tk. 500,000 = Tk. 976,000
Notes:
1.
Difference between sale price and original cost is capital gain to be assessed in 2011-2012
assessment year, corresponding income year 2010-2011.
2.
Balancing charge equals allowances so far enjoyed i.e. Tk. 976,000 (400,000 + 320,000 +
256,000).
3.
The company received the allowances in 2008-2009 assessment year, for just buying the
machine one day before its year end. Had it been 1st April, 2008, the allowance would have
started from the assessment year 2009-2010 i.e. corresponding income year 2008-2009.
Similarly, on disposal giving rise to balancing charge and capital gain, it has delayed the tax
impact by one year just by completing the sale on 1st April, 2011 instead of 31 March,
2011.
It is assumed that the company is not entitled to initial, investment or accelerated
depreciation allowance.
4.
Worked Example 2
Company X bought a machine for Tk. 50 lakhs on 10th July, 2008 to be used in its expansion unit
in Savar, Dhaka. The investment is qualified for both accelerated depreciation under Third
Schedule and Investment allowance under Sec 29. It sold the machine on 15 January, 2011 for Tk.
20 lakhs, The Companys year ends on 30 June. Calculate depreciation and other admissible
allowance for the relevant assessment years.
Solution 2
Assessment year 2009-2010
Machine
Accelerated depreciation Allowance (3rd Schedule) (80%)
Investment allowance [Sec 29 (20%)]
Cost
5,000,000
4,000,000
Allowance
4,000,000
1,000,000
5,000,000
1,000,000
Nil
20,00,000
(20,00,000)
(20,00,000)
Notes:
(1) Balancing charge in the assessment year, corresponding to the year of sale being income year
2010-2011 would be treated as business profit or income.
(2) Investment allowance does not form part by definition, of the depreciation and therefore,
does not fall within maximum of cost for depreciation allowance. In other words, it is
allowed over and above 100% cost of qualifying assets.
(3) Since investment allowance is not depreciation, on disposal it is not recouped in the form of
balancing charge. It is a net gain for the clever assessee for making the judicial investment.
However, it appears to be defective provision in the tax law.
(4) In the year of purchase if the assets are sold, no depreciation is allowed overriding the
principle that depreciation is allowed even when the asset has been used for a day during the
income year.
Difference between accounting and tax profits arises mainly because of timing what accountants
charge in the accounts as depreciation and what tax people allow. Since, both the group
calculates on the cost as the upper limit, there would be no difference in the long run. However,
after tax results of companies differ significantly from year to year or across the industry because
of the taxation anomaly. To remove this problem and to show an even after tax results year
after year companies can maintain deferred taxation account in accordance with International
Accounting Standard No. 12 (Income Taxes).
Self-Assessment Question
1) What are the different types of depreciation allowance?
2) What is the basic difference between depreciation allowance and investment allowance?
3) An asset was bought some years back for Tk. 1 million, the WDV of which was Tk.
600,000. It was sold for Tk. 400,000. What is the implication of tax?
Chapter 12
Set off and carry forward of losses
Contents
Introduction
Examination context
Topic List
12.1
12.2
12.3
12.4
12.5
12.6
12.7
12.8
12.9
12.10
12.11
12.12
Introduction
Learning objectives
Practical significance
Set off and carry forward of losses is very important and practically significant to compute
taxable income of any year. These are the benefits enjoyed by assesses to cover up their losses
before paying taxes to the government.
Set off means the coverage of loss under one head against another heads in a specific year. Carry
forward is the transferring of loss of a year to the succeeding years for coverage if set off was
absent or insufficient. Such set off and carry forward facility can be availed provided that certain
conditions are fulfilled. This chapter presents such guidelines.
Losses from any head cannot be set off against income from any other heads. And losses cannot
be carried forward for unlimited period. Thus, professional accountants need clear understanding
on each topic of this chapter.
Subject to some conditions, an assessee is allowed to set off and carry forwarded of losses. The
carry forward of losses under different heads of income are varied.
You will find the details of the above issues in this chapter with some practical example.
Stop and think
Do you realize that the understanding of set off and carry forward of loses is important for
computation of total taxable income? Can you determine the taxable income from different
heads of income after set off and carry forward of losses?
Working context
In practice, as the accountants are sometime required to support to prepare their clients' tax
returns, they need to advise the clients on how to calculate the total taxable income for any
income year. Before advising the clients, accountants should have the clear concept relating to
set off and carry forward of losses in determining the taxable income.
The right practice of the option of set off and carry forward of losses sometime help the assesse
to reduce the current and future the tax liability.
Syllabus links
The topics covered in this chapter are very important for computing taxable income which is
required for solving sample practical problems at this level.
You will be also using this knowledge when you tackle the taxation paper later on in the
Professional Stage and it will also underpin the technical aspects at the Advanced Stage.
Examination context
Exam requirements
In the examination, candidates may be required to:
Question practice
For question practice on these topics go to the suggested answers covering this chapter and also
this manual.
Examiner's comments on how students tackle questions
Candidates have to be prepared well for this area as this chapter consists of core concept on
computation of income which is vital for calculating tax liability. Clear concept and understanding
of each contents of this chapter will help candidates to resolve any problems relating to set off
and carry forward of losses.
12.0
12.1
12.2
Further, for the purposes of this section, the Deputy Commissioner of Taxes shall in computing
any loss, deduct any amount received in cash as subsidy from the Government.
Provided further that any loss in respect of any income from business or profession shall not be
so set off, or be carried forward to succeeding assessment year or years for set off, against any
income from house property.
12.3
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
12.4
Salaries
Interest on securities
Income from house property
Agricultural income
Income
from
business
profession
Capital gain
Income from other sources
Speculation business
Income exempted from tax
or
(a) it shall be set off against the income, if any, from the business or profession for which the
loss was originally computed if such business or profession continued to be carried on by
him in the income year; and
(b) if the loss cannot be wholly so off, the amount of the loss not so set off shall be carried
forward to the next assessment year and so on for not more than six successive assessment
years.
12.5
12.6
Set off and Carry Forward of Loss under the Head Capital Gains: Sec 40
Where, in respect of any assessment year, the net result of computation of income from any
source under the head Capital gains is a loss, it shall be set off only against income from any
other source falling under that head and assessable for that year.
Where, for any assessment year, any loss computed under the head Capital gains has not been
wholly set off under section 40(1), so much of the loss as has not been so set off, or the whole
loss where the assessee has no income from any other source falling under that head, shall,
subject to the provisions of the Ordinance, be carried forward to the next following assessment
year, and(a) it shall be set off against income, if any, of the assessee under that head and assessable for
that year; and
(b) if the loss cannot be wholly so set off, the amount of loss not so set off shall be carried
forward to the next assessment year and so on for not more than six successive assessment
year.
Where, in respect of any assessment year, the loss computed under the head Capital gains does
not exceed five thousand taka it shall not be carried forward and where it exceeds five thousand
taka only so much of such loss shall be carried forward as exceeds five thousand taka under
section 40(3).
12.7
12.8
12.9
500,000
200,000
Adjusted profit
300,000
Let us assume the same facts as have been earlier excepting that A, B and C retired when D, E
and F took over the firm.
It is a case of succession since none of the old partners is in new firm and it is not allowed to set
off loss. To maintain continuity at least one partner must continue before and after the change in
partnership.
12.10 Carry Forward of Loss of Unabsorbed Depreciation
Where, in making an assessment for any year, full effect cannot be given to the depreciation
allowances referred to in section 29(1) (viii) owing to there being no profits or gains chargeable
for that year or such profits or gains being less than the allowance then, subject to the provisions
of sub-section (7), the allowance or part of the allowance to which effect has not been given, as
the case may be, shall be added to the amount of the allowance for depreciation for the following
year and be deemed to be part of that allowance or if there is no such allowance for that year,
be deemed to be the allowance for that year and so on for succeeding years [Section 42(6)] .
Where, under section 42(6), depreciation allowance is also to be carried forward, effect shall
first be given to the provisions of sections 38 and 39(2) [Section 42(7)].
12.11 Carry Forward of Loss of Tax Holiday Units: Sec 46A(6)
Where the assessee sustains a loss from a tax holiday undertaking, it shall be carried forward and
set off against the profits and gains of the said undertaking for the following year and where it
cannot be wholly set off, the amount of the loss not so set off, shall be carried forward for the
next year and so on, but no loss shall be carried forward beyond the tax holiday period specified
by the Board in the order issued under section 46A (3) or (4).
12.12 Procedures of Carry Forward
Losses from particular heads can be carried forward to particular number of years subject to the
provisions of IT Ordinance 1984. Following points are important to remember:
1. Losses generated under the heads Income from Business and Profession, Speculation
Business, Capital Gain and Agricultural Income can be carry forwarded up to a
period of six successive years.
2. In any assessment year, if the business losses (excluding losses of speculation businesses)
have not been wholly set off, it can be carried forwarded to set off from the income of
the same sources in subsequent six years.
3. The loss from any business or profession can be carried forwarded only if such business
or profession is continued to be carried on by the assessee in the subsequent income
years.
4. Losses from speculation business can only be carried forwarded to set it off only against
income from speculation businesses in subsequent six years.
5. Capital losses can be carried forwarded to set it off against the incomes under the head
Capital gain in subsequent six years. But the carried forwarded amount will only be the
excess of Tk. 5,000.
6. Losses under the head Agricultural income can be carried forwarded for a period of
six years and set off against agricultural income in subsequent six years.
7. A successor-in-Business otherwise than by inheritance cannot claim to carry forward the
loss incurred by his predecessor-in-Business.
Following table gives a birds eye view of carry forward of losses:
Losses originated from
Period of benefits
Six succeeding years
Six succeeding years
Six succeeding years
Six succeeding years
Within holiday period
Unlimited period
2008-2009
20,000
1,30,000
(1,70,000)
25,000
2009- 2010
30,000
1,20,000
(30,000)
(40,000)
-
2010-2011
20,000
1,30,000
40,000
50,000
-
Solution 1:
Mr. Amir Hossain
Income year: 2008-2009
Assessment year 2009-2010
Sources of income
Income from Securities
Income from House Property
Income available to set off losses from agriculture
Income from Agriculture
Income available after set off
Carry forward (losses from agriculture)
Income after set off & carry forward of losses
Income from Capital gain
Total income
Taxable
Income
20,000
1,30,000
1,50,000
(1,70,000)
Set Off
Carry
Forward
1,50,000
(1,70,000)
(20,000)
20,000
25,000
25,000
Taxable
Income
30,000
1,20,000
1,50,000
(30,000)
1,20,000
Set Off
Carry
Forward
1,50,000
(30,000)
1,20,000
20,000
40,000
1,20,000
Taxable
Income
20,000
1,30,000
1,50,000
20,000
10,000
1,80,000
Set Off
Carry
Forward
40,000
(20,000)
20,000
50,000
(40,000)
10,000
Worked Example 2
Mr. Jamshed Sowdagor reports the following income for the income year ended on June 30, 2011.
Tk. 500,000
100,000
50,000
80,000
However, he has some losses carried forward from earlier years (income years) with the following
details:
Heads
Income from Business and Profession
Income from Capital Gain
Income from Speculation Business
Unabsorbed depreciation
Amount of Losses
Tk. 80,000
50,000
40,000
50,000
Year of Origination
2007-08
2002-03
2003-04
2001-02
Solution 2:
Mr. Jamshed Sowdagor
Income year: 2010-2011
Assessment year: 2011-2012
Sources of income
Income from Business and Profession
Set off: Losses carried forward from 2007-08
Unabsorbed depreciation
Taxable Income from business and profession
Income from house property
Income from capital gain
Set off: not allowed as it exceed 6 years
Income from Speculation Business
Set off: Losses carried forward from 2003-04
Total taxable income
Tk.
80,000
50,000
Tk.
500,000
Tk.
130,000
370,000
100,000
50,000
80,000
40,000
50,000
40,000
560,000
Chapter 13
Exemption and allowances
(Tax holiday / exemption)
Contents
Introduction
Examination context
Topic List
13.1 Exemption Section 44 and Sixth Schedule: Part A & Part B
13.2
13.3
13.4
Tax holiday scheme for newly established industrial undertakings, tourist industry and
infrastructure facility
Exemption from Tax of Newly Established Industrial Undertakings Set-up Between the
Period of July, 2011 to June, 2013, etc. In Certain Cases. Sec 46B
Exemption from tax of newly established physical infrastructure facility set up between
the period of July, 2011 and June, 2013, etc. in certain cases. Sec 46C
13.5
13.6
13.7
13.8
Introduction
Learning objectives
Practical significance
Income from some newly established industrial undertakings are exempted from tax liability on
the basis of fulfilling some conditions. To get the facility of tax holiday the undertakings need to
comply with some conditions and if any conditions are not fulfilled in the course of making
assessment of an exempted assesse, the exemption will be withdrawn and the DCT shall
determine the tax payable for such year.
The tax holiday and special tax exemptions or tax concessions are provided to different types of
business and industrial undertaking to encourage those businesses and industries for overall
development of the country. Significant exemption on income from export sales also a good
initiative of government to promote the export oriented companies.
Stop and think
When you want to start a new business you can consider the opportunity of tax holiday or
special tax exemption given by the Government. You can be the part of the development of the
country and at the same time you can get the tax holiday facility to enrich your business.
Working context
Accountants are sometime required by the entrepreneur for giving advice on how the business
can be newly started or expanded along with the tax holiday or special tax exemption facility.
Being the mentors accountants can help their clients regarding new business or expansion of
their business in such way that the clients can enjoy the tax holiday opportunity to be benefited
economically.
Accountants should have the detailed knowledge on the area of tax exempted business and the
updates of the rules and regulation for getting tax holiday and other special tax exemptions
facility so that they can rightly advise their clients enjoying that facility in case of requirement.
Syllabus links
The topics covered in this chapter imply the area of industry and investments from where you
can get tax holiday benefit with the conditions for that benefit.
You will learn more about this area at application level and in case study of advanced stage.
Examination context
Exam requirements
In the examination, candidates may be required to:
Recognise the different industrial undertakings for taking tax holiday facility.
Illustrate the various conditions for getting tax holiday.
State the computation of tax holiday income.
Mention the reasons for withdrawal and cancellation of tax holiday.
Define the exemption of tax liability for exporting industries.
Mention the different types of business considered for special tax exemptions.
Question practice
For question practice on these topics go to the suggested answers covering this chapter.
13.0
TAX HOLIDAY
Section Overview
Assessee enjoys some non-assessable income.
Assessee enjoys tax rebate on investment allowances.
Some newly established industrial undertakings are enjoying tax holiday.
There are some conditions to get the tax holiday facility.
The purpose of tax holiday is to encourage industrial and other development of the country
in many sectors like tourism, infrastructural, textile, hospital, exporting industries etc.
Tax holiday Income shall be computed like the computation of income from business or
profession.
Tax holiday may be cancelled or withdrawn if one or more conditions not fulfilled.
13.1
Income from property held under trust [Para 1]: Any income derived from house
property held under trust or other legal obligation wholly for religious or charitable
purpose and if part of the house is so held, the income as set apart for application.
However, above provisions are not applicable to an NGO registered with NGO Affairs
Bureau. However, where any such income is not applied for charitable or religious
purposes during the income year, following conditions should be complied with to get the
tax exemptions:
(a)
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
There should be given a notice in writing to the DCT specifying purposes for which
the income is being accumulated or set apart. But the period of such accumulation
should not be more than 10 years.
(b) The money so accumulated or set apart is either invested in any Government Security
or deposited in any post office Bank Savings Account or deposited in any account with
scheduled bank of which fifty one percent or more shares are held by the government.
Income from micro credit operation of NGOs [Para 1A]: Any income derived from
operation of micro credit by an NGO registered with NGO Affairs Bureau.
Voluntary contributions received by the Religious or Charitable Institutions [Para 2]: Any
income of a religious or charitable institution derived from voluntary contributions and
applicable solely to religious and charitable purposes. It would however, not be applicable
to a private religious trust which does not ensure public welfare.
The income of a Local government [Para 3]
Income of provident and other funds [Para 4]: Any income accruing to, or derived by
a) a provident fund established under the Provident Fund Act, 1925.
b) A workers participation fund established under the Companies Profits (Workers
Participation) Act, 1968, subject to any such conditions and limits as may be
prescribed.
Special allowances [Para 5]: Any special allowance, benefit or perquisite specifically
granted to meet expenses wholly and necessarily incurred in the performance of the duties
of an office or employment of profit.
Income received by the trustees on behalf of specified funds [Para 6]: Any income
received by the trustees on behalf of a recognized provident fund, an approved
superannuation fund and an approved gratuity fund.
8.
Income of employees of Foreign Missions [Para 7]: Any income received by the following
persons:
a) Ambassadors, High commissioners, envoys, ministers, charge de affairs, commissioners,
counselors, consul de carriere, secretaries, advisors or attach of an embassy, high
commission, legation or commission of a foreign State.
b) Trade commissioners or other official representatives of foreign states, if the official
salary of the corresponding officials of Bangladesh Government enjoys a similar
exemption in that foreign country.
c) Staff members or other officials employed in the offices aforesaid provided they are not
engaged in any business or profession or other employment.
9. Pension [Para 8]: Any pension due to, or received by, an assessee.
10. Income from newly Constructed House [Para 14]: Income from a newly constructed
residential house subject to stipulated conditions and limits as prescribed in paragraph 14 of
Part A of the Sixth Schedule of the ITO, 1984.
11. Share of Capital gains of a partner of a firm [Para 18]: Any income received by a partner
out of capital gains on which tax has been paid by the firm.
12. Income of a member of a Hindu Undivided Family (HUF) [Para 19]: Any income received
by a member of HUF out of income of the said family.
13. Gratuity [Para 20]: Any income of an assessee representing payment received as gratuity.
14. Any payment received from Provident and other funds [Para 21]: Any payment from:
a) A provident fund to which the Provident Funds Act, 1925 applies.
b) A recognized provident fund, subject to any such conditions and limits as may be
prescribed.
c) An approved superannuation fund, subject to any such conditions and limits as may be
prescribed.
d) A workers participation fund established under the Companies Profits (Workers
Participation) Act, 1968, subject to any such conditions and limits as may be prescribed.
15. Dividend income from Mutual or Unit fund [Para 22A]: Income from dividend of a mutual
fund or a Unit fund up to Tk. 25,000.
16. Interest on Tax free government securities [Para 24]: Any interest classifiable under the
head Interest on securities receivable by an assessee on any security of the Government,
which is issued with the condition that interest thereon shall not be liable to tax.
17. Interest on the balance in a Recognized Provident Fund [Para 25]: Interest credited on the
accumulated balance of an employee in a recognized provident fund not exceeding onethird of the salary of the employee for the concerned year and it is allowed at 14.50% rate.
18. Payment received on Voluntary retirement [Para 26]: Amount received by an employee of
a Government organization, a local authority, an autonomous or semi-autonomous body
including the units or enterprises controlled by it, on a voluntary retirement scheme
approved by the government.
19. Income of indigenous hillman [Para 27]: Income received from economic activities
undertaken by indigenous Hillman in the hill districts of Rangamati, Bandarban and
Khagrachari.
20. Income from export business [Para 28]: An amount equal to 50% of the income of an
assessee other than a company registered outside Bangladesh derived from export business
excepting the assessees who are enjoying tax exemption or reduction thereon by any
notification.
21. Agricultural income [Para 29]: Agricultural income upto Tk. 50,000 of an individual
assessee whose only source of income is agriculture.
22. Income from IT business [Para 33]: Income derived from the business of software
development and Information Technology Enabled Services (ITES) for the period from July
01, 2008 to June 30, 2013. Provided that the person shall file income tax return in
accordance with the provisions of Section 75(2)(c).
23.
Income from fisheries, poultry etc. [Para 34]: Subject to the following conditions, any
income from fisheries, poultry, production of seeds, marketing of locally produced seeds,
cattle farming, dairy farming, horticulture, frog farming, mushroom farming, floriculture,
sericulture for the period from July 01, 2008 to June 30, 2011(a) If such income exceeds Tk. 1,50,000/- an amount not less than 10% of the said income
shall be invested in government bonds or securities within six month from the end of
the income year;
(b) The person shall file income tax return in accordance with the provisions of Section
75(2)(c) of the ITO, 1984; and
(c) No such income shall be transferred within five years from the end of the income
year: provided that income from fisheries as mentioned in this paragraph shall not
apply to a company.
24. Income from export of handicrafts [Para 35]: Any income derived from the export of
handicrafts for the period from July 01, 2008 to June 30, 2013.
25. Tax paid by the government on behalf of a petroleum company [Para 36]: Any amount
paid by the government as tax on behalf of a petroleum exploration company engaged in
exploration of petroleum products in Bangladesh under Production Sharing Contract (PSC)
with the Government of Bangladesh.
26. Income of agricultural educational activities [Para 37]: Income of any private Agricultural
College or private Agricultural University derived from agricultural educational activities.
27. Income of Building with specific characteristics [Para 38]: Any income derived from any
building, not less than five storied, having at least ten flats, constructed at any time between
July 01, 2009 to June 30, 2014 (both days inclusive), for ten years from the date of
completion of construction of the building, if it is situated in any area of Bangladesh other
than the areas of City Corporation, Cantonment Board, Tongi Upazila, Narayanganj
Paurashaba, Gazipur Pourashava and any Pourashaba under Dhaka district.
28. Income of SME [Para 39]: Income derived from any Small and Medium Enterprise (SME)
engaged in production of any goods and having an annual turnover of not more than taka
twenty four lakh. Provided that the person shall file income tax return in accordance with
the provisions of Section 75(2)(c).
29. Income from Zero Coupon Bond [Para 40]: Any income derived from Zero Coupon
Bond received by a person other than Bank, Insurance or any Financial Institution, subject
to the following conditions:
(a)
that the Zero Coupon Bond is issued by Bank, Insurance or any Financial Institution
with prior approval of Bangladesh Bank and Securities and Exchange Commission.
(b) that the Zero Coupon Bond is issued by any institution other than Bank, Insurance or
any Financial Institution with prior approval of Securities and Exchange Commission.
30. Income from poultry farming [Para 42]: Subject to the following conditions, any income
from poultry farming for the period from July 01, 2011 to June 30, 2013-
(a)
If such income exceeds Tk. 1,50,000/- an amount not less than 10% of the said income
shall be invested in government bonds or securities within six month from the end of
the income year;
(b) The person shall file income tax return in accordance with the provisions of Section
75(2)(c) of the ITO, 1984; and
(c)
No such income shall be transferred by way of gift or loan within five years from the
end of the income year.
2.
Life Insurance Premium Paid [Para 1]: Any sum paid in Bangladesh by an assessee to effect
an insurance or a contract for deferred annuity on the life of himself, spouse or minor child,
provided that such payment, in the case of insurance, shall not exceed 10% of the sum
assessed excluding bonus or other benefits.
Life Insurance Premium Paid by a Hindu Undivided Family [Para 2]: Any sum paid in
Bangladesh by a HUF to effect an insurance on the life of any male member of the family or
the wife of any such member.
3.
Deduction from the salary of Government employee for deferred annuity [Para 3]: Any
sum not exceeding one-fifth of the salary deducted from the salary payable by the
Government or on its behalf to any individual in accordance with the service conditions to
secure a deferred annuity for him or for his wife or children.
4.
5.
Employers and Employees contribution to a Recognized Provident Fund [Para 5]: Any
sum paid to a recognized provident fund by the assessee and the employer, where the
assessee is a participant subject to the limits laid down in Part B of the Sixth Schedule.
6.
Contribution to Superannuation Fund [Para 6]: Any sum paid by the assessee as ordinary
annual contribution to approved superannuation fund as a participant to the fund.
7.
Investment in Savings Certificate [Para 10]: Any sum invested by a non-company assessee
in the following if the investment are held for 5 years from the date of purchase / up to its
maturity:
a) Savings Certificates or instruments specified by the NBR;
b) Unit certificates and mutual fund certificates issued by ICB and its subsidiaries;
c) Govt. securities including development loans/Bonds as specified by the NBR;
d) Shares of Investment Companies as specified by the NBR.
8.
If the securities are disposed of by sale, transfer or in any other manner within 5 years from
the date of purchase or before the maturity thereof, the tax credit amount availed for such
investment will be cancelled. This amount has to be added to the tax payable amount of the
income year on which such certificate was disposed i.e. the assessee has to pay back the
money.
Contribution to Deposit Pension Scheme (DPS) [Para 11]: Any amount not exceeding
Tk.60,000 by an individual in any Deposit Pension Scheme sponsored by a Scheduled Bank.
9.
Donation to a Charitable Hospital [Para 11A]: Any sum paid as donation to a charitable
hospital established outside the city corporation, provided the donation is made after one
year of establishment of the hospital.
10. Donation to Organizations set up for the welfare of retarded people [Para 11B]: Any sum
paid as donation to an organization set up for the welfare of retarded people, provided the
donation is made after one year of establishment of the organization and is approved by the
Social Welfare Department and the NBR.
11. Donation to Zakat Fund [Para 13]: Any sum paid by an assessee as Zakat to the Zakat
Fund or charitable fund established by or under the Zakat Fund Ordinance, 1982.
12.
Contribution to Benevolent Fund and Group Insurance Scheme [Para 17]: Any sum paid
by an assessee to make provision for his spouse, children or other dependent person to a
benevolent fund or any premium paid under a group insurance scheme approved by the
NBR.
13. Contribution to Aga Khan Development Network [Para 21]: Any sum paid by an assessee
as donation to any socio-economic or cultural development institution established by the
Aga Khan Development Network in Bangladesh.
14. Contribution to Philanthropic or Educational Institution [Para 22]: Any sum paid by an
assessee as donation to Philanthropic or Educational Institution approved by the
government for this purpose.
15. Investment in Computer / Laptop [Para 23]: Any sum invested in the purchase of one
computer (Upto Tk. 50,000) or one laptop (Upto Tk. 1,00,000) by an individual assessee.
16. Donation to national level institution set up in memory of the liberation war [Para-24]: Any
sum paid by an assessee as donation to a national level institution set up in memory of
liberation war.
17. Donation to national level institution set up in memory of Father of the Nation [Para-25]:
Any sum paid by an assessee as donation to a national level institution set up in memory of
Father of the nation.
18. Donation to Prime Ministers Higher Education Fund [Para 26]
19. Investment in shares through IPO by an individual i.e. Primary share [Para 27] : Any sum
invested by an assessee, being an individual, in the acquisition, through Initial Public Offering
(IPO), of any stocks of shares of a company, mutual fund or debenture listed with any stock
exchange.
20. Investment in Government Treasury Bond [Para 28]: Any sum invested by an assessee,
being an individual, in the purchase of Bangladesh Government Treasury Bond.
21. Contribution to Presidents Relief Fund [SRO 254/L85]
22. Contribution to Prime Ministers Relief Fund [SRO 125/L91 dated 01.07.1991]
23. Contribution to Ahsania Mission Cancer Hospital [SRO 202/IT/2005 dated 06.07.2005]
24. Contribution to Sylhet Diabetic Society, Islamia Eye Hospital and M. A. Ispahani Institute of
Ophthalmology, Kidney Foundation; and National Heart Foundation of Bangladesh [SRO
109/IT/2006 dated 07.05.2006]
25. Contribution to Child Health Foundation Hospital; Child Hospital, Jessore; Hospital for Sick
Children, Sathkhira (Run by Child Health Foundation, Bangladesh); Digonto Memorial
Cancer Hospital, Dhaka; The ENT & Head-Neck Cancer Foundation of Bangladesh, Dhaka;
and National Development Foundation for Disables, Dhaka [SRO 316-AIN/2008]
26. Contribution to Jatir Janok Bangabondhu Sheikh Mujibur Rahman Memorial Trust, Dhaka;
Rafatullah Community Hospital (RCH), Thengamara, Bogra; and Salvation for the Deserving
(SFD), Manikgonj [SRO 33-AIN/2009 dated 09.03.2009]
27. Contribution to Asiatic Society of Bangladesh, Ramna, Dhaka [SRO 32-AIN/2009 dated
09.03.2009]
However, Para 15 and 16 is excluded from the above list as tax shall not be payable by an
assessee in respect of any income or any sum specified in those paragraphs as per section
44(2)(a). For Reference, these two paragraphs are presented below:
1.
Income from Association of Persons: Any sum received by the assessee out of the income
of an association of persons other than a Hindu Undivided Family, company or firm on
which tax has already been paid. [Para 15, Part B. Sixth Schedule]
2.
Income from a Firm: Any share of profit of a partnership firm if tax on such profit or
income has already been paid by the firm. [Para 16, Part B. Sixth Schedule]
As per section 44(2)(b) of the ITO, 1984, a resident and non-resident Bangladeshi assessee will
get tax rebate of an amount equal to 10% of the sums specified in Part B of the Sixth Schedule.
However, as per Section 44(3), maximum amount eligible for such rebate would be restricted to
the lower of the following:
20% of the total income excluding employers contribution to RPF and interest on the
accumulated balance of RPF and any income u/s 82C, or
Tk. 1,00,00,000.
Illustration
An assessee's total taxable income during income year 2010-2011 amounted to Tk. 1,000,000
(without deduction of investment allowance). He has made investments in allowable areas as per
Part B, Sixth Schedule amounted Tk. 400,000. Employers contribution to recognized provident
fund was Tk. 80,000 and he has no income on which tax is deducted at sources under section
82C. Compute tax rebate on investment allowance.
Actual investment made
: Tk. 400,000
Maximum limit:
20% of taxable income excluding employers contribution to RPF and interest on the
accumulated balance of RPF and any income u/s 82C: 20% of Tk. 920,000
: Tk. 184,000
Or,
: Tk. 1,00,00,000
Lower one
: Tk. 184,000
Thus, allowable amount for investment allowance is Tk. 184,000 and tax rebate will be 10% of
Tk. 184,000, i.e., Tk. 18,400.
13.2
Tax Holiday Scheme for newly established industrial undertakings, tourist industry
and infrastructure facility: Sec 46A
Profits and gains of an industrial undertaking, tourist industry or physical infrastructure facility
(hereinafter referred to as the said undertaking) set-up in Bangladesh between 1 July 1995 and 30
June 2008 (both days inclusive) shall be exempt from the tax payable under section 46A(1) of the
Ordinance for the period specified below(a)
if the said undertaking is set-up in, Dhaka and Chittagong divisions excluding the hill
districts of Rangamati, Bandarban and Khagrachari, for a period of 4 years beginning with
if the said undertaking is set-up in Rajshahi, Khulna, Sylhet and Barisal divisions and the
hill districts of Rangamati, Bandarban and Khagrachari, for a period of 6 years beginning
with the month of commencement of commercial production or operation of the said
undertaking.
Industrial undertaking, tourist industry, or physical infrastructure facility does not include
expansion of an existing undertaking for the purpose of this section (i)
"physical infrastructure facility" means sea or river port, container terminals, internal
container depot, container freight station, LNG terminal and transmission line, CNG
terminal and transmission line, gas pipe line, flyover, large water treatment plant &
supply through pipe line, waste treatment plant, solar energy plant, export processing
zone and any other category of physical infrastructure facility as the Government may by
notification in the official Gazette specify;
(iii)
"tourist industry" means residential hotel having facility of three star or more and any
other category of tourist industry facility as the Government may by notification in the
official Gazette specify.
in the said undertaking or in any new industrial undertaking during the period of exemption
or within one year from the end of the period to which the exemption under that subsection relates.
It is to be noted that income to be invested mentioned as above means total income for tax
purpose and not net profit as per profit and loss account.
Illustration
Total income as per Computation of Income for tax purpose
Less: dividend declared
Balance
Tk. 1,000,000
100,000
900,000
(i) to be invested in the said undertaking or in any new industrial undertaking @ 30%, i.e.,
Tk. 270,000
(ii) to be invested in the purchase of stock listed shares @ 10%, i.e., Tk. 90,000
(d) that the said undertaking is not formed by splitting up or by reconstruction or reconstitution
of business already in existence or by transfer to a new business of any machinery or plant
used in business which was being carried on in Bangladesh at any time before the
commencement of the new business;
(e) that the said undertaking is approved, and during the relevant income year, stands approved
by the Board for the purposes of section 46A; and
(f) that the application in the prescribed form for approval for the purposes of section 46A, as
verified in the prescribed manner, is made to the Board within 6 months from the end of the
month of commencement or commercial production or operation.
Computation of Tax Holiday Income
(1) The profits and gains of the undertaking to which section 46A applies shall be computed in
the same manner as is applicable to income chargeable under the head Income from
business or profession [Section 46A(5)]. However, in respect of depreciation, only the
allowances for normal depreciation specified in paragraph 3 of the Third Schedule shall be
allowed.
(2) The profits and gains of the said undertaking shall be computed separately from other
income, profits and gains of the assessee, if any, and where the assessee sustains a loss from
such undertaking, it shall be carried forward and set off against the profits and gains of the
said undertaking for the following year and where it cannot be wholly set off, the amount of
the loss not so set off, shall be carried forward for the next year and so on, but no loss shall
be carried forward beyond the period specified by the Board in the order issued under
section 46A(3) or (4) [Section 46A(6)].
(3) Unless otherwise specified by the Government, nothing contained in section 46A shall be so
construed as to exempt the following from tax chargeable under section 46A
(a) any dividend paid, credited or distributed or deemed to have been paid, credited or
distributed by a company to its share-holders out of the profits gains; and
(b) any income of the said undertaking classifiable as Capital gains chargeable under the
provisions of section 31;
(c) any income of the said undertaking resulting from disallowance made under section 30.
Note
A tax holiday company is liable to pay tax resulting from disallowance made u/s 30 in respect of
the following.
(a) Any payment of salaries chargeable to income tax, if tax at source has not been deducted
and paid to the Government Treasury.
(b) Any payment paid by an assessee to any person if deductible tax at source has not been
made and paid to the Government Treasury under Chapter VII (Section 49).
(c) Any excess perquisites u/s 30(e) has been paid to the employees.
Worked Example
A tax holiday companys Income was determined at Tk. 1,000,000 without considering
disallowances u/s 30 [under (a), (b) & (c) above] of Tk. 400,000.
Solution
The tax holiday company is liable to pay tax on Tk. 400,000.
Withdrawal and Cancellation of Tax Holiday
(1) Where any exemption is allowed under section 46A and in the course of making assessment,
the Deputy Commissioner of Taxes is satisfied that any one or more of the conditions
specified in section 46A are not fulfilled, the exemption will stand withdrawn for the relevant
assessment year and the Deputy Commissioner of Taxes shall determine the tax payable for
such year. [Section 46A(8)].
(2) Notwithstanding anything contained in this section(a) where the said undertaking enjoying exemption of tax under section 46A is engaged in
any commercial transaction with another undertaking or company having one or more
common sponsor directors, and
(b) during the course of making an assessment of the said undertaking if the Deputy
Commissioner of Taxes is satisfied that the said undertaking has purchased or sold
goods at higher or lower price in comparison to the market price with intent to reduce
the income of another undertaking or company.
The exemption of tax of that said undertaking shall be deemed to have been withdrawn
for that assessment year in which such transaction is made. [Section 46A(2A)].
(3) Any such undertaking approved under section 46A may, not later than one year from the
date of approval, apply in writing to the Board for the cancellation of such approval, and the
Board may pass such orders thereon as it may deem fit.[Section 46A(9)].
(4) Notwithstanding anything contained in section 46A, the Board may, in the public interest,
cancel or suspend fully or partially any exemption allowed under section 46A.[Section
46A(10)].
Tax Holiday not eligible in Certain Cases
A new industry, wherein investment of any sum by any person during the period between the
first day of January, 1997 and the thirty first day of December, 1999 is exempt from tax without
any question as to the source of the invested sum under section 19A shall not be eligible for tax
- holiday.
Such industry may however be considered for tax holiday if the assessee pays tax at the rate of
seven and a half per cent on the invested amount before the filing of return for the relevant
income year (Sec 19A).
Procedures of Tax Holiday
An application under section 46A(2)(f) of the Ordinance for approval for the purposes of that
section in respect of an industrial undertaking, tourist industry or physical infrastructure facility
shall be made in the prescribed form (Rule 59A (I), in duplicate, duly signed and verified by the
Managing Director or Director of the company.
13.3
Rate of Exemption
100% of income
50% of income
25% of income
(2) For the purpose of this section,Industrial undertaking means an industry engaged in the production of active pharmaceuticals
ingredient industry and radio pharmaceuticals industry, barrier contraceptive and rubber
latex, basic chemicals or dyes and chemicals, basic ingredients of electronic industry (e.g.
resistance, capacitor, transistor, integrator circuit), bio-fertilizer, biotechnology, boilers,
compressors, computer hardware, energy efficient appliances, insecticide or pesticide, petrochemicals, pharmaceuticals, processing of locally produced fruits and vegetables, radio-active
(diffusion) application industry (e.g. developing quality or decaying polymer or preservation
of food or disinfecting medicinal equipment), textile machinery, tissue grafting, or any other
category of industrial undertaking as the Government may, by notification in the official
Gazette, specify.
(3) Notwithstanding anything contained in sub-section (2), for the purpose of this section
industrial undertaking shall not include expansion of an existing undertaking.
(4) The exemption under sub-section (1) shall apply to the said undertaking if it fulfills the
following conditions, namely:(a) that the said undertaking is owned and managed by(i) a body corporate established by or under any law for the time being in force with its
head office in Bangladesh; or
(ii) a company as defined in the Companies Act, 1913 (VII of 1913) or Companies Act,
1994 (Act No. 18 of 1994) with its registered office in Bangladesh and having a
subscribed and paid up capital of not less than two million taka on the date of
commencement of commercial production or operation;
(b) that thirty percent of the exempted income under subsection (1) is invested in the said
undertaking or in any new industrial undertakings during the period of exemption or
within one year from the end of the period to which the exemption under that subsection relates and in addition to that another ten percent of the exempted income
under sub-section (1) is invested in each year before the expiry of three months from
the end of the income year in the purchase of shares of a company listed with any stock
exchange, failing which the income so exempted shall, notwithstanding the provisions of
the Ordinance, be subject to tax in the assessment year for which the exemption was
allowed:
Provided that the quantum of investment referred to in this clause shall be reduced by
the amount of dividend, if any, declared by the company enjoying tax exemption under
this section.
Provided further that, the provision for purchase of shares of a company listed with any
stock exchange referred to in this clause shall not be applicable in case of readymade
garments industry, if it invests forty per cent of the income exempted under sub-section
(1) in the said undertaking or in any new industrial undertaking during the period of
exemption or within one year from the end of the period to which the exemption under
that subsection relates.
(c) that the said undertaking is not formed by splitting up or by reconstruction or
reconstitution of business already in existence or by transfer to a new business of any
machinery or plant used in business which was being carried on in Bangladesh at any
time before the commencement of the new business;
(d) that the said undertaking is approved, and during the relevant income year, stands
approved by the Board for the purposes of this section;
(e) that the application in the prescribed form for approval for the purposes of this section,
as verified in the prescribed manner, is made to the Board within six months from the
end of the month of commencement of commercial production or operation;
(f) that the said undertaking obtained a clearance certificate for the relevant income year
from the Directorate of Environment;
(g) that the said undertaking maintains books of accounts on a regular basis and submits
return of its income as per provisions laid down in section 75 of this Ordinance.
(5) Notwithstanding anything contained in this section, where a undertaking enjoying
exemption of tax under this section is engaged in any commercial transaction with another
undertaking or company having one or more common sponsor directors, and during the
course of making an assessment of the said undertaking if the Deputy Commissioner of
Taxes is satisfied that the said undertaking has purchased or sold goods at higher or lower
price in comparison to the market price with intent to reduce the income of another
undertaking or company, the exemption of tax of that undertaking shall be deemed to have
been withdrawn for that assessment year in which such transaction is made.
(6) The Board shall give its decision on an application made under clause (e) of sub-section (4)
within forty five days from the date of receipt of the application by the Board, failing which
the undertaking shall be deemed to have been approved by the Board for the purposes of
this section:
Provided that the Board shall not reject any application made under this section unless the
applicant is given a reasonable opportunity of being heard.
(7) The Board may, on an application of any person aggrieved by any decision or order passed
under sub-section (6), if the application is made within four months of the receipt of such
decision or order, review the previous decision or order and pass such order in relation
thereto as it thinks fit.
(8) The income, profits and gains of the undertaking to which this section applies shall be
computed in the same manner as is applicable to income chargeable under the head
''Income from business or profession'':
Provided that in respect of depreciation, only the allowances for normal depreciation
specified in paragraph 3 of the Third Schedule shall be allowed.
(9) The income, profits and gains of the undertaking to which this section applies shall be
computed separately from other income, profits and gains of the assessee, if any, and where
the assessee sustains a loss from such undertaking it shall be carried forward and set off
against the profits and gains of the said undertaking for the following year and where it
cannot be wholly set off, the amount of the loss not so set off, shall be carried forward for
the next year and so on, but no loss shall be carried forward beyond the period specified by
the Board in the order issued under subsection (6) or (7).
(10) Unless otherwise specified by the Government, nothing contained in this section shall be so
construed as to exempt the following from tax chargeable under this section:(a)
any dividend paid, credited or distributed or deemed to have been paid, credited or
distributed by a company to its share-holders out of the profits and gains;
(b) any income of the said undertaking classifiable as ''Capital gains'' chargeable under the
provisions of section 31;
(c)
any income of the said undertaking resulting from disallowance made under section
30.
(11) Where any exemption is allowed under this section and in the course of making assessment,
the Deputy Commissioner of Taxes is satisfied that any one or more of the conditions
specified in this section are not fulfilled, the exemption shall stand withdrawn for the
relevant assessment year and the Deputy Commissioner of Taxes shall determine the tax
payable for such year.
(12) Any such undertaking approved under this section may, not later than one year from the
date of approval, apply in writing to the Board for the cancellation of such approval, and the
Board may pass such order or orders thereon as it may deem fit.
(13) Notwithstanding anything contained in this section, the Board may, in the public interest,
cancel or suspend fully or partially any exemption allowed under this section.
(14) The Board may make rules regulating the procedure for the grant of approval under subsection (6), review under sub-section (7), furnish information regarding payment of other
taxes by the said undertaking, and take such other measure connected therewith or
incidental to the operation of this section as it as it may deem fit.
13.4
Rate of
Exemption
For the first five years (first, second, third, fourth and fifth year)
100% of income
For the next three years (sixth, seventh and eighth year)
50% of income
25% of income
(2) For the purpose of this section, "physical infrastructure facility" means deep sea port,
elevated expressway, export processing zone, flyover, gas pipe line, Hi-tech park,
Information and Communication Technology (ICT) village or software technology zone,
Information Technology (IT) park, large water treatment plant and supply through pipe line,
Liquefied Natural Gas (LNG) terminal and transmission line, mono-rail, rapid transit,
renewable energy (e.g. energy saving bulb, solar energy plant, windmill), sea or river port, toll
road, underground rail, waste treatment plant, or any other category of physical
infrastructure facility as the Government may, by notification in the official Gazette, specify.
(3) The exemption under sub-section (1) shall apply to the said facility if it fulfills the following
conditions, namely:(a) that the said undertaking is owned and managed byii. a body corporate established by or under any law for the time being in force with its
head office in Bangladesh; or
iii. a company as defined in Company Act, 1994 with its registered office in Bangladesh
and having a subscribed and paid up capital of not less than two million taka on the
date of commencement of commercial production;
(b) that thirty percent of the exempted income under sub-section (1) is invested in the said
facility or in any new physical infrastructure facility during the period of exemption or
within one year from the end of the period to which the exemption under that subsection relates and in addition to that, another ten percent of the exempted income
under sub-section (1) is invested in each year before the expiry of three months from
the end of the income year in the purchase of shares of a company listed with any stock
exchange, failing which the income so exempted shall, notwithstanding the provisions of
this Ordinance, be subject to tax in the assessment year for which the exemption was
allowed:
Provided that the quantum of investment referred to in this clause shall be
reduced by the amount of dividend, if any, declared by the company enjoying
tax exemption under this section:
(c) that the said facility is approved, and during the relevant income year, stands approved
by the Board for the purposes of this section;
(d) that application in the prescribed form for approval for the purposes of this section, as
verified in the prescribed manner, is made to the Board within six months from the end
of the month of commencement of commercial operation;
(e) that the said facility maintains books of accounts on a regular basis and submits return of
its income as per provisions of section 75 of this Ordinance.
(4) The Board shall give its decision on an application made under clause (d) of sub-section (3)
within forty five days from the date of receipt of the application by the Board, failing which
the facility shall be deemed to have been approved by the Board for the purposes of this
section:
Provided that the Board shall not reject any application made under this section
unless the applicant is given a reasonable opportunity of being heard.
(5) The Board may, on an application of any person aggrieved by any decision or order passed
under sub-section (4), if the application is made within four months of the receipt of such
decision or order, review the previous decision, order or orders and pass such order in
relation thereto as it thinks fit.
(6) The income, profits and gains of the facility to which this section applies shall be computed in
the same manner as is applicable to income chargeable under the head "Income from
business or profession":
Provided that in respect of depreciation, only the allowances for normal
depreciation specified in paragraph 3 of the Third Schedule shall be allowed.
(7) The income, profits and gains of the facility to which this section applies shall be computed
separately from other income, profits and gains of the assessee, if any, and where the
assessee sustains a loss from such facility it shall be carried forward and set off against the
profits and gains of the said facility for the next year and where it cannot be wholly set off,
the amount of the loss not so set off, shall be carried forward for the following year and so
on, but no loss shall be carried forward beyond the period specified by the Board in the
order issued under sub-section (4) or (5).
(8) Unless otherwise specified by the Government, nothing contained in this section shall be so
construed as to exempt the following from tax chargeable under this section :(a) any dividend paid, credited or distributed or deemed to have been paid, credited or
distributed by a company to its share-holders out of the profits and gains;
(b) any income of the said facility classifiable as "Capital gains" chargeable under the
provisions of section 31;
(c) any income of the said facility resulting from disallowance made under section 30.
(9) Where any exemption is allowed under this section and in the course of making assessment,
the Deputy Commissioner of Taxes is satisfied that any one or more of the conditions
specified in this section are not fulfilled, the exemption shall stand withdrawn for the
relevant assessment year and the Deputy Commissioner of Taxes shall determine the tax
payable for such year.
(10) Any such facility approved under this section may, not later than one year from the date of
approval, apply in writing to the Board for the cancellation of such approval, and the Board
may pass such order or orders thereon as it may deem fit.
(11) Notwithstanding anything contained in this section, the Board may, in the public interest,
cancel or suspend fully or partially any exemption allowed under this section.
(12) The Board may make rules regulating the procedure for the grant of approval under subsection (4), review under sub-section (5), furnish information regarding payment of other
taxes by the said facility, and take such other measures connected therewith or incidental to
the operation of this section as it may deem fit.
13.5
so much of its income as is derived by it as a result of such of its dealings with its
members as involve sale of goods, the lending of money or the lease of buildings and
land which is for the personal use of such members, or where such member is a firm or
an association of persons, for the personal use of the partners or members thereof;
(b) the entire income from business carried on by it, if it is engaged in the following-(i)
(ii)
(iii)
(vi)
cottage industry means an enterprise, not being owned by a joint stock company
which fulfils the following conditions, namely
(i) it is basically an enterprise in which the owner is the investor, a fulltime worker
and the actual entrepreneur;
(ii) the capital invested in plant, machinery and equipment does not exceed Tk
3,00,000 at any time during the income year;
(iii) the number of workers, including the owner and the members of his family, shall
not on any one twenty-four hour day during the income year, exceed fifteen; and
(iv) the owner of the enterprise or any member of his family does not own any other
industrial or commercial enterprise either in his own name or in the name of any
other person; and
(b) member of his family, in relation to the owner of an enterprise, means the parents,
spouse and children dependent on the owner and employed in the enterprise, whether
working full-time, or whether for or without any wages, remuneration or
compensation in any form.
2) Nothing contained in section 47(1) shall apply to a co-operative society carrying on such
business of insurance as is carried on by a mutual insurance association in respect of its
profits and gains to which paragraph 8 of the Fourth Schedule applies.
13.6
Tax Holiday for Hospital: S.R.O. No. 204-Ain/It -2005 Dated 6 July 2005
A newly established private hospital will be eligible for exemption from income tax for five years
subject to the following conditions:
(1) The hospital is owned by a company registered under the Companies Act, 1913/1994.
(2) The hospital is established between the period from 1 July 2005 to 30 June 2008.
(3) The hospital is housed in a building constructed on the companys own land.
(4) The hospital has number of beds as mentioned below:
(a)
(b) 50 beds in the case of specialized hospital for heart, kidney and cancer patients.
(5) 10% of the beds must be kept reserved for treatment of poor patients free of charge.
The owner of the hospital enjoying exemption from tax shall file return of income to the
concerned Deputy Commissioner of Taxes along with statement of accounts and relevant
documents & evidences in respect of the concerned year of exemption and the Deputy
Commissioner of Taxes will determine the income under sections 28 and 29 along with the
owners income from other sources, if any, and make the income tax assessment accordingly.
13.7
13.8
(1)
(2)
Exemption of 50% of tax on export sales of industries: S.R.O. No. 267-L/86 dated 1 July
1986
(3)
(4)
(5)
[SRO
No
resident in Bangladesh, but not a Bangladeshi citizen if such income is brought into
Bangladesh under existing laws.
(g) SRO no. 200/-AIN/IT/2005 dated 06.07.2005 Any person having not previously declared
any income can declare the same undisclosed income from other sources during the period
from 01.07.2005 to 30.06.2006 on payment of 7.5% tax thereon and no question as to the
source of money shall be raised. The declared income shall not be added with any income
from other sources previously shown in the return and tax thereon have been paid at
normal rates in determination of total income declaring under the Ordinance and the
opportunity under this notification shall not constitute immunity from action if any taken
previously under section 93 of the I.T. Ordinance. The declaration has to be made in
prescribed form.
h) Exemption on Income from Fish Farming, Poultry Farming, Duckery, Cattle Farming, Dairy
Farming, Frog Farming, Horticulture, Cultivation of Mulberry, Cocoon, Mushroom and from
Floriculture: S.R.O. 309-/91 Dated 9 October 1991; S.R.O. No. 207-l/93 Dated 18 October
1993; S.R.O. 127-l/2000 Dated 11 May 2000; and S.R.O. 215/IT/2003 Dated 20 July 2003, SRO
206/Ain/It Dated 6th July 2005
Chapter 14
Payment of tax before assessment
Contents
Introduction
Examination context
14.1
14.2
14.3
14.4
14.5
14.6
14.7
14.8
14.9
Topic List
Deduction at Source and Advance Payment of Tax
Income Subject to Deduction at Source
Person Responsible for Tax Deduction at Source: Sec 49(3)
Time Limit for Payment of Tax Deducted at Source
Manner of Payment of Tax Deducted at Source
Issuance of Certificate for Tax at Source
Rates of TDS at a glance
Tax on income of certain persons (Final Settlement of tax liability)
Other Issues relating to TDS
Introduction
Learning objectives
Recognise different classes of income from where tax are deducted or collected at source.
Mention the time limit and manner of payment of tax deducted at source.
Explain the result of deduction or not deduction of tax at source where deduction is
required by law.
Define the computation, estimation and payment procedures of TDS.
Mention the income heads that come under final settlement of tax as per section 82C.
Practical significance
There are two methods of collecting taxes, one is direct method and another is tax deducted at
source. The ordinary method of collection is direct collection of tax from the assessee.
Deduction of tax at source is provided for in certain specified cases. The deducted tax shall be
credited accordingly with the final payment of tax. If default is made in the deduction of taxes at
source, the tax may be collected from the assessee directly, and further the person who is liable
to deduct but has not deducted the tax under this section, may be held personally liable and
treated as an assessee in default in respect of the tax.
This chapter presents areas of taxes deducted at source and related provisions as per income tax
ordinance. Section 82C and its application are detailed here. For computing taxable income, tax
liability the importance of this chapter is very significant.
Stop and think
There are so many sources where tax is required to be deducted or collected at the time of
payment. Do you think how both tax deducted at source and advance payment of tax are made?
Working context
In corporate sectors, normally there are many payments made every day where deductions of
tax at source are required by tax law. In some cases the accountants are asking for advice on
how and when the deductions need to be done. Accountants can provide the service to their
clients on tax deduction at source so that the clients can avoid any penalty for non-compliance of
tax law in this regard.
Detailed knowledge about the payment of tax before assessment in compliance with tax law can
help accountants to support their clients significantly.
Syllabus links
You will also meet this area of taxation at application level and at case study in advanced stage.
Examination context
Exam requirements
In the examination, candidates may be required to:
Identify the classes of income from where tax are deducted or collected at source.
Recognise the different amounts and rates of tax deducted at source.
Identify the responsibility for deduction of tax at source.
Define the time limit for payment of tax at source.
Mention the manner of payment of tax deducted at source.
Explain the result of deduction or not deduction of tax at source where deduction is
required by law.
Identify the areas where tax deducted at source is considered as final payment of tax liability
under section 82C.
Question practice
For question practice on these topics go to the suggested answers covering this chapter.
Examiner's comments on how students tackle questions
Candidates need to remember the different amount and rates of tax deducted at source while
preparing for exam. In practical problem at case study level both tax deduction at source and
calculation of advance tax may be asked.
14.0
There are two methods of collecting taxes, direct tax and tax deducted at source (TDS).
There are many classes of income from where tax are deducted or collected at source.
TDS shall be paid to the credit of the Government within three weeks from the date of such
deduction or collection except in case of salary.
Rate of TDS are varied.
The deducted tax shall be credited accordingly with the final payment of tax.
Tax deducting authority will be held liable for failing to deduct taxes and failing to deposit the
same with government.
The assessee shall get the credit for TDS.
14.1
14.2
(15) income derived on account of interest on saving deposits, fixed deposits and share of
profits on term deposits [Sec 49(1)(o)];
(16) income derived on account of insurance commission [Sec 49(1)(p)];
(17) income, classifiable under the head Capital gains[Sec 49(1)(q)];
(18) income derived on account of fees for professional or technical services[Sec 49(1)(r)];
(19) income derived on account of manufacture of cigarettes manually without any mechanical
aid whatsoever [Sec 49(1)(s)];
(20) income derived from compensation against acquisition of property [Sec 49(1)(t)];
(21) income derived on account of interest on saving instruments [Sec 49(1)(u)];
(22) income derived on account of running of brick field [Sec 49(1)(w)];
(23) income derived on account of services rendered by the doctors [Sec 49(1)(x)];
(24) income derived on account of commission of letter of credit [Sec 49(1)(z)];
(25) income derived on account of survey by a surveyor of general insurance company [Sec
49(1)(za)];
(26) income derived on account of commission, remuneration or charges as a foreign buyers
agent [Sec 49(1)(zc)];
(27) income from dividends[Sec 49(1)(zd)];
(28) income derived on account of rendering certain services [Sec (49)(1)(ze)];
(29) income derived on account of shipping business of a resident [Sec (49)(1)(zf)];
(30) income derived on account of business of real estate and land developer [Sec (49)(1)(zg)];
(31) income derived by an exporter on account of export of any commodity [Sec (49)(1)(zh)];
(32) income derived by a member of a stock exchange on account of transaction of shares,
debentures, mutual funds, bonds or securities [Sec (49)(1)(zi)];
(33) income derived on account of courier business of a non-resident [Sec (49)(1)(zj)];
(34) on account of issuance or renewal of trade licence [Sec (49)(1)(zm)];
(35) income derived on account of trustee fees [Sec (49)(1)(zn)];
(36) income derived on account of freight forward agency commission [Sec (49)(1)(zo)];
(37) income derived on account of rental power [Sec (49)(1)(zp)];
(38) income derived on account of interest of Post Office Savings Bank Account [Sec
(49)(1)(zq)];
(39) income derived on account of rental value of vacant land or plant or machinery [Sec
(49)(1)(zr)];
(40) income derived on account of advertisement [Sec (49)(1)(zs)];
(41) income derived by foreign technician serving in a diamond cutting industry [Sec
(49)(1)(zt)];
(42) on account of issue of share at a premium [Sec (49)(1)(zu)];
(43) income derived from transfer of securities or mutual fund units by sponsor shareholders
of a company etc. [Sec (49)(1)(zv)];
(44) deduction of tax for services from convention hall, conference centre, room or, as the
case may be, hall etc. [Sec (49)(1)(zw)]; and
(45) deduction of tax from residents for any income in connection with any service provided to
any foreign person [Sec (49)(1)(zx)].
14.3
(a) in the case of payments constituting income classifiable under head the Salaries not being
payment made by the Government, the employer himself or, if the employer is a local
authority, company or institution, such authority, company or institution, including the
principal officer thereof;
(b) in the case of payment constituting income classifiable under head Interest on securities
not being payment made by or on behalf of the Government, the authority, company or
other institution issuing the security; and
(c) in the case of payment of any other sum which constitutes an income of the payee
chargeable to tax under the Ordinance, the payer himself, or if the payer is a company or
other institution, such company or institution including the principal officer thereof.
14.4
14.5
Interest on saving deposits, fixed deposits and term deposits: Rule 17H
(1) For the purposes of making deduction of tax under section 53F of the Ordinance, each
branch of a scheduled bank including a co-operative bank shall deduct income tax on
interest or share of profit on saving deposits or fixed deposits or term deposits at the
time of credit or payment of the interest or the share of profit, whichever is earlier,
and report the total amount of tax deducted to its head office.
(2) The head office of each such bank shall deposit the total amount of tax deducted by all
its branches in the Bangladesh Bank, in lump sum under the head of account
1/1141/0000/011- Income Tax other than companies, giving particulars as
Deduction of income tax under section 53F of the Income Tax Ordinance 1984.
in the case of the district of Dhaka, the Commissioner of Taxes, Central Survey
Zone, Dhaka;
b. in the case of the district of Chittagong, the Commissioner of Taxes, Taxes Zone-3,
Chittagong;
c.
in the case of the district of Rajshahi, the Commissioner of Taxes, Taxes Zone,
Rajshahi;
d. in the case of the district of Khulna, Bagerhat and Satkhira, the Commissioner of
Taxes, Taxes Zone, Khulna;
e.
(d) The Commissioner of Taxes and the Deputy Commissioner of Taxes concerned shall
verify the amounts of tax so collected with challans received by them from the Treasury
Offices concerned.
(e) Others: Rule 14(1)
The person responsible for making deduction or collection under Chapter VII of the Ordinance
shall pay the amount of tax so deducted or collected to the credit of the Government by
remitting it within the time specified in rule 13 into the Bangladesh Bank or the Sonali Bank, as
the case may be, accompanied by an income tax challan, blank copies of which can be had from
the office of the Deputy Commissioner of Taxes for the purpose.
14.6
All paying authorities shall issue a certificate as required under section 58 of the Ordinance
to the person from whom tax has been deducted under 49(1)(c) (h) or (r) of the ordinance
within fifteen days of deduction.
(b) Others: Rule 18(2)
All paying and collecting authorities responsible for making deduction or collection of tax
under chapter VII of the Ordinance, except tax in respect of (a) supply of goods or
execution of contract or (b) rent of house property or (c) fees for professional or technical
services, shall furnish to the person from whom such deduction or collection has been made
a certificate in the prescribed form.
14.7
2.
3.
4.
Members of Parliament
Discount on the Real Value of
Bangladesh Bank Bills
Interest on Securities
Payments for Supply of Goods,
Execution of Contracts
Ref.
U/S 50
U/S 50B
U/S 50A
U/S 51
U/S 52
Rule 16
Sl.
Head of TDS
Ref.
5.
Indenting Commission
6.
7.
U/S 52(1)
Rule 17(1)
U/S 52(I),
Rule 17(2)
U/S
52A(1)
8.
9.
10.
11.
12.
13.
U/S
52A(2)
10%
U/S
52A(3)
10%
U/S 52AA
10%
U/S
52AAA
10%
U/S 52B
U/S 52C
14.
15.
U/S 52D
U/S 52F
16.
Commission on Letter of
Credit
Collection of Tax by City
Corporation or Pourashava at
the Time of Issuing and
Renewal of Trade License
Collection of Tax from Freight
Forward Agency Commission
Collection of Tax on Account
of Rental Power
Collection of Tax from a
Foreign Technician Serving in a
Diamond Cutting Industry
For services from convention
hall, conference centre etc.
Deduction of tax from resident
for any income in connection
with any service provided to
any foreigner
Collection of Tax from
Importers and Exporters
U/S 52I
U/S 52K
U/S 52M
15%
U/S 52N
4%
U/S 52O
5%
U/S 52P
5%
U/S 52Q
10%
U/S 53
5%
17.
18.
19.
20.
21.
22.
23.
Sl.
24.
Head of TDS
Deduction at Source from
House Property
Ref.
U/S 53A
Rule 17B
25.
U/S 53AA
26.
27.
28.
29.
30.
31.
32.
33.
34.
35.
36.
U/S 53B
Rule 17C
U/S 53BB
U/S 53BBB
0.10%
U/S
53BBBB
U/S 53C
Rule 17D
U/S 53CC
U/S 53D
10%
U/S 53E
10%
U/S 53EE
7.5%
U/S 53F,
Rule -17
10%
U/S 53FF
Sl.
Head of TDS
Ref.
37.
38.
39.
40.
41.
42.
43.
44.
45.
Insurance Commission
Remuneration or Fees of
Surveyors of General
Insurance Company
Collection of Tax on Transfer,
etc. of Property
U/S 53G
U/S 53GG
U/S 53 I
U/S 53 J
Rule 17BB
U/S 53 K
3%
U/S 53 L
3%
U/S 53 M
5%
U/S 54
Resident/non-resident Bangladeshi
Company @20%
Resident/non-resident Bangladeshi
Person other than company @10%
Non-resident (Other than Bangladeshi
U/S 53H
14.8
Sl.
Head of TDS
Ref.
46.
47.
U/S 55
U/S 56
Tax on income of certain persons (Final Settlement of tax liability) (U/s 82C)
Tax deducted on certain income is considered as final settlement of taxes as per section 82C of
IT Ordinance 1984. The provisions in this regard are as follows:
(1) Subject to sub-sections (3), (4), (5), (6), (7), (8) and (9), notwithstanding anything contained
in any other provisions of this Ordinance, tax deducted or collected at source in accordance
with the provisions mentioned in sub-section (2) shall be deemed to be the final discharge of
tax liability from that source.
(2) The provisions referred to in sub-section (1) shall be the following, namely(a) the amount representing the payments on account of supply of goods or execution of
contract to which tax is deductible under section 52;
(b) the amount representing the payment on account of royalty, fees for technical services
for which tax is deductible under section 52A(2);
(c) commission from clearing and forwarding agency business for which tax is deductible
under section 52AAA;
(d) the amount of the value of the banderols computed for the purpose of collection of
tax on account of the manufacture of cigarettes under section 52B;
(e) the amount of compensation against acquisition of property under section 52C;
(f)
the amount of salaries of a foreign technician serving in a diamond cutting industry, for
which tax is deductible under section 52O;
(g) the amount as computed for the purpose of collection of tax under section 53 in
respect of goods imported, not being goods imported by an industrial undertaking as
raw materials for its own consumption;
(h) the amount received or receivable from shipping business of a resident on which tax is
collectible under section 53AA;
(i)
the amount received on account of export of manpower on which tax is deductible
under section 53B;
(j)
the amount received on account of export of certain items on which tax is deductible
under section 53BB;
(k) the amount received on account of transaction by a member of a stock exchange for
which tax is collectible under section 53BBB ;
(l)
the amount of auction purchase on which tax is collectible under section 53C;
(m) the amount received on account of courier business of a non-resident u/s 53CC;
(n) the amount received from persons engaged in real estate or land development
business on which tax is collectible under section 53FF;
(o) the amount of remuneration or reward, whether by way of commission or otherwise
payable to an insurance agent on which tax is deductible under section 53G;
(p) the amount representing the payment on account of survey by surveyor of a general
insurance company on which tax is deductible under section 53GG;
(q) the amount of the value of the property as mentioned in section 53H for the purpose
of collection of tax under that section;
(r) the premium received from raising of share at a premium over face value under
section 53L;
(s)
(t)
Provided that provisions of sub-section (1) shall not be applicable in the case of clause (a) of this
sub-section with respect to a contractor of an oil company or a sub-contractor to the
contractor of an oil company as referred to in rule 39 of the Income-tax Rules, 1984.
(3) Tax deducted or collected at source from the sources mentioned in sub-section (2) shall not
be adjusted against refund due for earlier year or years or refund due for the assessment
year from any source other than those mentioned in sub-section (2).
(4) Income from the sources mentioned in sub-section (2) shall be determined on the basis of
the tax deducted or collected at source and the rate or rates of tax applicable for the
assessment year.
(5) Income computed in accordance with sub-section (4) shall not be set off with loss computed
under any other source for the assessment year or with loss of earlier year or years.
(6) Any income shown or assessed in excess of the amount determined in sub-section (4) shall
be liable to tax at the rate or rates applicable for the assessment year.
(7) Any amount not admissible as allowances under section 30 shall be added to the income as
referred to in sub-section (4).
(8) Income referred to in sub-sections (6) and (7) shall be taxable at the rate or rates applicable
for the year after determining income under sub-section (4).
(9) In addition to the tax mentioned in this section, in accordance with the provisions of the
Finance Act, if any, the assessee shall pay surcharge.
Illustration
Mr. B, owner of a Brokerage House, has presented the following information in the assessment
year 2011-12:
Tk. 250,000
Tk. 205,000
Tk. 50,000
Tk. 10,00,000
Determine the total income of Mr. X considering the provisions of the Section 82(C).
Solution
As TDS against brokerage commission is a finally settled tax liability, so the first step is to
calculate total income excluding any item where tax has been settled finally. So, total income
excluding finally tax settled item:
Income from House Property
Tk. 250,000
Income from other businesses
Tk. 205,000
Tk. 455,000
So, Tax on such income will be:
On 1st
On next
Tk. 180,000
Tk. 275,000
0%
Nil
10%
Tk. 27,500
Total
Tk. 27,500
Now, income against finally settled tax liability of Tk. 50,000 will be calculated as follows on the
basis of regular rate:
On the rest of 2nd slab (Tk. 300,000 Tk. 275,000) = Tk. 25,000 @ 10%
= Tk. 2,500
So, Tk. 47,500 tax will be for the 3rd slab where tax rate is 15%.
So, against this TDS of Tk. 47,500 the applicable income will be (47,500/15*100) = Tk. 316,667
So, income against which Tk. 50,000 finally settled TDS will be (Tk. 25,000 + Tk. 316,667 = Tk.
341,667.
But As brokerage commission Tk. 10, 00,000 income has been shown i.e. excess income has
been shown by (Tk. 10,00,000 - Tk. 341,667) = Tk. 658,333. So for this additional income of Tk.
658,333 tax will be charged on regular rate.
14.9
(b)
in addition to such tax, pay an amount at the rate of two percent per month of such tax
for the period commencing on the date following the expiry of the time within which it is
to be paid under section 59 and ending on the date of the actual payment of the tax.
Where the Deputy Commissioner of Taxes in the course of any proceedings under the
Ordinance finds any person, required by or under the provisions of this chapter to deduct,
collect or pay to the credit of the Government tax, who has failed to deduct, collect or pay the
tax in accordance with the provisions of this chapter, shall, notwithstanding the provisions of
section 137, take necessary action for realisation of such tax alongwith the additional amount
payable under clause (b) of sub-section (1) from the person deemed to be an assesssee in default
under clause (a) of that sub-section.
in any case where tax has not been deducted or collected as required by, and in accordance
with, the provisions of this Chapter ;
(b) in any case where the amount deducted or collected is found, after regular assessment, to
be less than the tax due from the assessee, to the extent of deficiency ; and
(c)
in the case of income in respect to which no provision has been made for deduction or
collection of tax under the provisions of this Chapter.
Self-Assessment Questions:
(a) Discuss the various types of income from which tax is required to be deducted or collected at
source under the provisions of the Income Tax Ordinance 1984.
(b) State the provisions regarding information to be furnished to the Tax Authorities in connection with
payment of salary, interest, dividend, collection of tax from property, payment to non-resident, and
other sources under the provisions of the Income Tax Ordinance 1984.
(c) Mention the application for final payment of tax liability under section 82C.
(d) What are the consequences of failure of deducting taxes in time at prescribed rates or failure of
depositing deducted taxes within time?
Chapter 15
Advance payment of tax
Contents
Introduction
Examination context
15.1
15.2
15.3
15.4
15.5
15.6
15.7
15.8
15.9
15.10
15.11
Topic List
Requirement to pay advance payment of tax
Computation of advance tax
Installments of advance tax
Estimate of advance tax
Advance payment of tax by new assesses
Failure to pay installments
Levy of interest for failure to pay advance tax
Credit of advance tax
Interest payable by Government on excess payment of advance tax
Interest payable by the assessee on deficiency in payment of advance tax
Payment of tax on the basis of return
Worked Examples and Solutions
Introduction
Learning objectives
Practical significance
Depending on assessed or provisionally assessed income, an assessee may require to pay advance
tax. In some cases the new assessee also requires to pay advance tax. The calculation of amount,
rate, estimation and installment of advance tax are guided by the Ordinance. The assessee shall
get the credit of advance tax. In case of excess or deficit payment of advance tax an assessee may
receive or pay the interest from or to the Government. Tax paid in advance shall be adjusted at
the time of tax payment on the basis of the return.
Payment of advance tax is important as failure of doing so will make the assessee being assessee
in default. Advance tax is a requirement and it reduces tax burden at the end of the year. Thus,
it is helpful to the assessee as a method of tax planning. Professional accountants are required to
help their clients in that regard. So the practical significance of this chapter requires no extra
mentioning.
Stop and think
Advance tax is required to pay on total income excluding income from agriculture and capital
gains. Both old and new taxpayers are required to pay advance tax if they fulfill the threshold set
by tax laws. Do you think how advance payment of tax is made?
Working context
In corporate sectors, advance payment of taxes is a must as it should exceed the threshold of Tk.
400,000. In some cases the accountants are asking for advice on how and when the advance
taxes should be paid. The service for estimation and calculation of advance tax is required by
some assessee. Accountants can provide the service to their clients on due payment of advance
tax so that the clients can avoid any penalty for non-compliance of tax law in this regard.
Detailed knowledge about the payment of advance tax in compliance with tax law can help
accountants to support their clients significantly.
Syllabus links
You will also meet this area of taxation at application level and at case study in advanced stage.
Examination context
Exam requirements
In the examination, candidates may be required to:
Question practice
For question practice on these topics, go to the suggested answers covering this chapter.
Examiner's comments on how students tackle questions
Candidates need to remember the methods of computing advance tax, bases of advance tax, 75%
test, computation of simple interest @ 10% on deficit amount of tax and other complexities. In
practical problem at case study level calculation of advance tax may be asked for with different
dates when installment falls due.
15.0
An assessee, both old and new, may require paying advance tax.
Advance taxes are paid on income excluding income from agriculture and capital gain.
The assessee shall get the credit for advance tax.
If the amount of advance tax paid along with TDS is less than 75% of due tax, assessee is
required to pay simple interest @10% on such deficit.
Government will also pay simple interest @10% if advance tax for any reason exceeds due
tax.
If the assessee fails to pay advance tax, he will be the assessee in default.
15.1
15.2
15.3
15.4
(51) The assessee may furnish a revised estimate of such amount at any time before any time
before any of such installments become payable and may thereby adjust any excess or
deficiency, by reference to the amount already paid by him under this section, in any
subsequent installment or installments payable in such financial year.
15.5
15.6
15.7
15.8
15.9
Tk. 400,000
Tk. 320,000
Tk. 80,000
Tk. 8,000
Note: Interest will be paid for a period from 1st July 2011 (first day of assessment year) to
June 30 2012 (day of regular assessment) or for a maximum of 2 years, whichever is shorter.
15.10 Interest Payable by the Assessee on Deficiency in Payment of Advance Tax: Sec 73
(54) Where, in any financial year, an assessee has paid advance tax on the basic of his own
estimate and the advance tax so paid together with the tax deducted at source, if any , under
this Chapter is less than seventy-five per cent, of the amount of tax payable by him as
determined on regular assessment, the assessee shall pay, in addition to the balance of tax
payable by him, simple interest at 10% per amount on the amount by which the tax so paid
and deduction falls short of 75% of the assessed tax.
(55) The period for which interest under section 73(1) shall be payable shall be the period from
the first day of July of the year in which the advance tax was paid to the date of regular
assessment in respect of the income of that year or a period of two years from the said first
day of July whichever is shorter.
(56) Notwithstanding anything contained in sections 73(1) and (2) i.
ii.
(57) Where, as a result of appeal, revision or reference, the amount on which interest was
payable under section 73(1) has been reduced, the amount of interest payable shall be
reduced accordingly and the excess interest paid, if any, shall be refunded together with the
amount of tax that is refundable.
Illustration
For the assessment year 2011-12, a certain assessee has latest assessed income of taka
1,000,000. But, he wants to pay advance tax for the year on the basis of his own estimates that
amounts to taka 800,000. Regular tax rate is 40%. During the year, tax deducted at source was
taka 50,000. Regular assessment for the assessment year 2011-12 was completed on February
28, 2012 resulting taka 1,200,000 profit including profit of taka 80,000 from capital gain and taka
220,000 from agricultural income. Calculate the amount of excess or shortfall and explain the
consequences for the same.
Income eligible to apply advance tax as per regular assessment is taka 900,000 (taka
1,200,000 taka 80,000 taka 220,000), excluding capital gain and agricultural income.
Tax liability as per regular assessment (40% of taka 900,000)
Tax paid in the form of Tax deducted at sources
Advance tax (40% of taka 800,000 taka 50,000) Tk. 270,000
Tk. 360,000
Tk. 50,000
Tk. 320,000
Shortfall/Deficit
Tk. 40,000
75% test: The deficit or shortfall is required to be tested for charging interest.
75% of tax liability as per regular assessment (75% of taka 360,000)
Tk. 270,000
Tax paid actually
Shortfall/Deficit
Tk. 320,000
nil
Consequence: In this case, the assessee is required to pay the shortfall of taka 40,000.
There is no question of interest resulting from 75% test.
Is the assessed
income likely to
exceed Tk.
400,000?
Does latest
assessed
income exceed
Tk. 400,000?
Yes
No
Advance
Tax Payable
No Advance
Tax Payable
Does advance
tax paid plus
TDS 75% of
tax determined?
Yes
Yes
No
Advance
Tax Payable
No Advance
Tax Payable
Does advance
tax paid plus TDS
75% of tax
determined?
No
Yes
No
Date of assessment
21st of February, 2008
10th of March, 2011
30th of May, 2010
15th of February 2011
Not yet assessed
Mr. Seikh, due to the changes of nature of income, wants to pay advance tax on the basis of his own
estimate in lieu of latest assessed income. According to his own estimate, total taxable income amounts
to taka 1,200,000 including taka 100,000 from capital gain and taka 200,000 from agricultural income.
Assessment for the income year 2010-11 has been completed on 28th February 2012 and his actual
income amounts to taka 1,800,000 excluding capital gain and agricultural income. For the income year
2010-11, his tax deducted at source was taka 100,000 and he has paid further tax of taka 150,000 on 31st
December 2011 U/s 74. Applicable tax rate for Mr. Seikh is 40%. Explain tax implications.
Solution 1:
Latest assessed income in this case would be taka 1,500,000 (IY 2007-08) if advance tax was based on
that. But, Mr. Seikh paid advance tax on the basis of his own estimate. So, let us first compute the amount
of advance tax paid.
Estimated income of Mr. Seikh excluding capital gain and agricultural income Tk. 900,000
Amount of advance tax payable (40% of taka 900,000)
Tk. 360,000
Advance Income Tax to be paid per installment (taka 360,000/4)
Tk. 90,000
Advance tax paid by Mr. Seikh on the date of assessment
Tk. 180,000
(Because only two installments are made on 15th September and 15th December respectively)
Let us calculate the amount of shortfall/deficit:
Tax liability as per regular assessment (40% of taka 1,800,000)
Tax paid in the form of
Tax deducted at sources
Tk. 100,000
Advance tax paid (as calculated above)
Tk. 180,000
Tk. 280,000
Shortfall/Deficit
Less: tax paid U/s 74
Remaining Liability
Tk. 440,000
Tk. 150,000
Tk. 290,000
Tk. 720,000
So, Mr. Seikh would be required to pay taka 290,000 as additional tax. Now let us use 75% test to decide
whether he would be charged interest on the shortfall or not.
75% of tax liability as per regular assessment (75% of taka 720,000)
Tax paid actually
Tk. 540,000
Tk. 280,000
Revised Shortfall/Deficit
Less: tax paid U/s 74
Tk. 260,000
Tk. 150,000
Remaining liability
Tk. 110,000
So, Mr. Seikh would be charged interest as per the 75% test for the following time period:
On taka 110,000; interest will be charged @ 10% for a period from 1st January 2012 to 28th February
2012 whereas on taka 150,000; interest will be charged at the same rate but for a period from 1st April
2011 to 31st December 2011. So, total interest payable by Mr. Seikh would be taka 13,083.33
[(11000010%2/12) + (15000010%9/12)]. Thus, total amount due by Mr. Seikh to the government
amounts to taka 3,03,083.33 (290,000 +13,083.33).
Self-Assessment Question
1. Discuss briefly the provisions of the Income Tax Ordinance 1984 with regard to the following:
(a) The assessees who are required to make advance payments of tax and the nature of incomes
which are to be left out of consideration for this purpose;
(b) The basis on which advance payments of tax should be calculated for old assessees and new
assessees, and the due dates of payment thereof;
(c) The interest payable by Government on excess payment and interest chargeable to assessee on
shortfall, in respect of advance payment of tax.
2. In what situation, government will pay interest to assessee?
3. Mr. Idris Mia calculated advance tax for the income year 2009-10 as per the latest assessed income of
taka 1,000,000. Regular assessment for the assessment year 2010-11 was completed on June 30, 2012
and profit assessed amounts to taka 700,000. Applicable tax rate is 40%. Calculate interest payable by
the government on excess amount.
Chapter 16
Return of income and statements
Contents
Introduction
Examination context
Topic List
16.1
Requirement to file return of income
16.2
16.3
16.4
16.5
16.6
16.7
16.8
Concurrent jurisdiction
16.9
16.10
16.11
16.12
16.13
16.14
Production of other information as per different Sections and Rules at the time of
Submission of Return or in other circumstances
Introduction
Learning objectives
Practical significance
Every person shall file or caused to be filed a return of his income or the income of any other
person in respect of which he is assessable to tax. There are some rules and guideline for
submission of return. The total procedures covering the time limitation for submitting the
return, filled forms, documents and information to be provided with the return of income. Duly
filed return need to have the declaration and authentication.
Production of accounts and documents, statements of assets and liabilities, income statement,
statement of individual regarding particulars of life style are the essential elements in case of
submission of return.
Learning of income tax is finally reflected in submitting the form of return where income from
different heads is reported and net tax liability is computed. This is the reporting of assesses to
the government authority disclosing relevant information.
Stop and think
Do you realize that submission of return is an obligatory responsibility for every assessee by any
means? Do you know that the production of supporting accounts, forms and documents and
timely submission of return with authenticated declaration about the true information are very
significant?
Working context
In case of submission of return, the accountants can guide their clients how to prepare their
return with all supporting documents. Accountants should have the clear understanding about
the legal procedures for submission of return.
Detailed understanding about the rules and procedures for filing return give the opportunity to
the accountants in practice to help their as tax advisers.
Syllabus links
The topics covered in this chapter are very important for students, accountants, tax advisers and
even for the assessee at large for compliance with the tax rules and procedures regarding
submission of return.
When you tackle the questions at application level and case study you will be expected to be
very familiar with the total procedures for submitting return.
Examination context
Exam requirements
In the examination, candidates may be required to:
Question practice
For question practice on these topics go to the suggested answers covering this chapter.
Examiner's comments on how students tackle questions
Candidates have historically prepared well for this area of the syllabus.
16.0
16.1
An assesse shall file or cause to be filed a return of income in the prescribed form.
The return of income shall be signed and verified
Return shall be submitted within due date.
The DCT can serve notice for filing return after the due date for submission of return.
The return shall be accompanied by certain documents including IT-10B and IT-10BB
Form of return for individual assessee and company is different.
Due dates of submitting return is different for different classes of assesses.
16.2
16.3
in the case of an individual, by the individual himself; where the individual is absent from
Bangladesh, by the individual concerned or by some person duly authorised by him in this
behalf; and when the individual is mentally incapacitated from attending to his affairs, by his
guardian or by any other person competent to act on his behalf;
(ii)
in the case of Hindu undivided family, by the Karta, and, where the Karta is absent from
Bangladesh or is mentally incapacitated from attending to his affairs by any other adult
member of such family;
(iii) in the case of a company or local authority, by the principal officer thereof;
(iv) in the case of a firm, by any partner thereof, not being a minor;
(v)
in the case of any other association, by any member of the association or the principal
officer thereof; and
(vi) in the case of any other person, by that person or by some person competent to act on his
behalf;
16.4
Illustration
For Assessee being a company
Accounting year ended on
Due date of Filing the Return
31.12.2010
By 15th July 2011
31.03.2011
By 30th September 2011
30.06.2011
By 31st Dec 2011
31.07.2011
By 15th July 2012
30.09.2011
By 15th July 2012
For Assessee being a person other than company
Income Year
Due date of Filing the Return
2010-11
By 30th September 2011
2011-12
By 30th September 2012
31-12-2010 (firm)
By 30th September 2011
16.5
in the case of an individual, a statement in the prescribed form and verified in the
prescribed manner giving particulars of his personal and family expenditure to be called life
style; and a statement in the prescribed form and verified in the prescribed manner giving
particulars specified in section 80 in respect of himself, his spouse, his minor children and
dependants; and
(ii)
16.6
16.7
16.8
16.9
any person, other than a company, to file a return of his total income as provided in that
section if, in the opinion of the Deputy Commissioner of Taxes the total income of such
person was, during the income year, of such amount as to render liable to tax;
b. any company to file a return of its total income, if it is not filed.
(2) The return under section 77(1) shall be filed within such period, not being less than twentyone days, as may be specified in the notice or within such extended period as the Deputy
Commissioner of Taxes may allow.
(c)
any assets transferred by the assessee to any person during the period or periods so
specified, and the consideration therefore;
(d) particulars of life style of the assessee.
(2) The statements to be filed under sub-section (1) shall be prepared in such form and verified
in such manner as may be prescribed.
16.14 Production of other information as per different Sections and Rules at the time of
Submission of Return or in other circumstances
U/s 108 & Rule - 23
U/s 109 & Rule - 20
U/s 110 & Rule - 19
Rule - 10
Rule - 12
Rule - 21
Rule 24 , Rule 25 &
25A
Rule - 41
Rule - 47
Rule 58B
Form of Return
For Individuals
IT 11GA
Form of return of income under the income tax ordinance 1984 for individual and
other taxpayers (Other than company)
IT 10B
Statement of Assets and Liabilities
IT 10BB
Statement under section 75(2)(d)(i) and section 80 of the Income Tax Ordinance,
1984 regarding particulars of life style
For Company
IT 11GHA Form of return of income under the income tax ordinance 1984 for Company
taxpayers only
Chapter 17
Assessment
Contents
Introduction
Examination context
Topic List
Introduction to Assessment
17.1
17.2
Provisional assessment
17.3
17.4
17.5
17.6
17.7
Spot assessment
17.8
17.9
17.10
17.11
17.12
Introduction
Learning objectives
Practical significance
Assessments of income and tax liability are very significant for every assessee. There are different
classes of assessment such as provisional assessment, assessment on correct return, assessment
under simplified procedures, assessment on the basis of return, universal self assessment,
deemed assessment for certain income of certain persons, spot assessment, assessment after
hearing, assessment on the basis of report of a chartered accountant, best judgement assessment
etc. Even there are various specialized assessments such as assessment in case of discontinued
business, persons leaving Bangladesh, deceased person, income escaping assessment etc. So there
is no way to avoid the assessment for any assessee.
For every classes of assessment there are either some conditions, rules and procedures specified
for assessee and/or for tax authorities. Some limitation for assessment also has significance.
Stop and think
Did you realise how important is the assessment for any assessee either individual or company? Do
you think nobody can avoid assessment in any way if he is required to be assessed under tax law?
Working context
Assessment of tax is very important for every assessee. An assessee must require to be assessed in
any way. Accountants have a great role to provide the technical assistance to their client in case of
assessment. As there are many conditions, rules and procedures for different types of assessments,
accountants support sometime very significant to complete the assessment of their clients.
Many clients are requiring the support for correct assessment from accountants in every year.
Detailed knowledge of accountants on conditions, rules and procedures for different assessments
has the importance in case of required support for clients tax assessment in many ways.
Syllabus links
The topics covered in this chapter have the significance for professional study as you can utilize
the knowledge throughout the application level and case study and also in your practical life.
Examination context
Exam requirements
In the examination, candidates may be required to:
Question practice
For question practice on these topics go to the suggested answers covering this chapter.
17.0
ASSESSMENT
Section Overview
There are different classes of assessment of total income and tax payable.
The conditions, rules and methods of various assessments are different.
It is not easy for any person to escape assessment who is required to be assessed.
There are certain limitations of assessment.
17.1
Introduction to Assessment
Assessment to tax is an important stage in the whole cycle for tax collection. It is used to mean,
sometimes, the computation of income, sometimes the determination of the amount of tax
payable and sometimes the whole procedure laid down in the Act for imposing liability upon the
tax payer [C.I.T.V Khemchand Rahdas. 1938 I.T.R 441, 416(PC)]. The meaning to be assigned to the
word assessment has to be understood in each section with reference to the context in which
it has been used [A.N. Lakshman Shenoy V.I.T.O. 958 I.T.R 275, 941(SC)].
17.2
17.3
17.4
17.5
(1) and refer the returns so selected to the Deputy Commissioner of Taxes for the purpose of
audit and the Deputy Commissioner of Taxes shall thereupon proceed, if so required, to make
the assessment under section 83 or section 84, as the case may be
Provided that a return of income filed under this section shall not be selected for audit
where such return shows at least twenty per cent higher income than the income assessed
or shown in the return of the immediate preceding assessment year and(a) does not have any income which is exempted from tax; or
(b) does not have receipt of Gift; or
(c) does not have loan other than from a bank or financial institution; or
(d) sum of accretion of net wealth and shown expenditure is covered by the income.
No question as to the source of investment made by a new assessee deriving income from
business or profession shall be raised, if he shows income at least not less than twenty five
percent of the capital invested in business or profession and pays tax on such income before
filing return.
The initial capital investment or any fraction thereof shall not be transferred in any manner or
lent out within five years from the end of the assessment year in respect of which assesse's
return of income has been filed under this section.
17.6
Table showing the TDS deemed to be the final discharge of tax liability
Sl. #
Head of TDS
1.
2.
3.
Ref. of
Sec/Rule
U/S 52
U/S 52A(2)
U/S
52AAA
Sl. #
Head of TDS
4.
5.
Cigarette Manufacturers
Compensation Against
Acquisition of Property
6.
7.
8.
9.
10.
11.
12.
13.
14.
Ref. of
Sec/Rule
U/S 52B
U/S 52C
U/S 52O
U/S 53
5%
U/S 53AA
U/S 53B
U/S 53BB
U/S 53BBB
0.10%
U/S 53C
U/S 53CC
U/S 53FF
Sl. #
Head of TDS
Ref. of
Sec/Rule
15.
16.
17.
18.
19.
20.
17.7
Insurance Commission
Remuneration or Fees of
Surveyors of General
Insurance Company
Collection of Tax on
Transfer, etc. of Property
U/S 53G
U/S 53GG
U/S 53L
U/S 53M
5%
U/S 55
20%
U/S 53H
Tk.1,200/-
Tk.3,500/-
(b) An assessee carrying on business within the limits of a Municipality of any Divisional
Headquarter or District Headquarter shall pay tax at the following rates:Rate of tax per annum
(i)
(ii)
(c)
Tk. 1,200/-
Tk. 2,500/-
An assessee carrying on profession as a lawyer or a doctor for a period exceeding five years
but not exceeding 10 years shall pay tax at the following rates:Rate of tax per annum
(i)
(ii)
Tk. 2,000/Tk.1,200/-
The assessee shall, with the help of the Deputy Commissioner of Taxes, fill up a return of
income in form B as prescribed in rule 24(1), which can be had from the Deputy Commissioner
of Taxes, and submit the same to the Deputy Commissioner of Taxes on the spot.
The tax fixed under rule 38B shall remain in force for two subsequent assessment years, and the
receipt of the payment of such tax shall be deemed to be an order of assessment under section
82 of the Ordinance.
17.8
In case of failure to serve any of the above notices, the assessment made under this section is
rendered defective and unenforceable. If the assessee files a revised return before the assessment
is completed, the DCT should issue fresh notices u/s 83(1) and 79.
17.9
Rate
of
Tax
Tk. 5,000
4,000
4,500
2,700
3,500
2,500
5,000
4,000
2,500
750
B. Rate of presumptive tax in the case of owners of bus, mini-bus, coaster, prime mover, truck,
tank lorry, pick-up van, maxi or auto-rickshaw used for transportation of goods after the
expiry of ten years from the date of registration:Category
For each bus having capacity of exceeding 52 seats
For each bus having capacity up to 52 seats
For each air-conditioned bus
For each mini-bus or coaster whether air-conditioned or not
For each prime-mover used as carrier of container
For each truck or tank lorry having capacity of exceeding 5 tons
For each truck or tank lorry having capacity of one and half ton but not
exceeding 5 tons
For each truck having capacity up to 1 and half ton or each pick-up van and all
kinds of human hauler, maxi or auto-rickshaw for transportation of goods
Rate
of
Tax
Tk. 2,000
1,500
1,800
1,000
2,500
2,000
1,000
300
b)
the amount of the total income on which the determination has been based; and
c)
the income of the year shall, for the purpose of inclusion in the total income of the
partners, be apportioned between the partners who, in such income year, were entitled
to receive the same; and
(b) when the tax assessed upon a partner cannot be recovered from him, it shall be
recovered from the firm as constituted at the time of making the assessment.
(2) For the purposes of this section, there is a change in the constitution of a firm(a)
where all the partners continue with a change in their respective shares or in the shares
of some of them, or
(b) where one or more persons who were partners continue to be so with a change by
cessation of one or more partners or addition of one or more new partners.
Assessment in Case of Constitution of New Successor Firm: Sec 87
Where, at the time of assessment on a firm, it is found that a new firm has been constituted to
succeed the firm to which the assessment relates and it cannot be covered by section 86, separate
assessments shall be made on the predecessor firm and the successor firm in accordance with the
provisions of section 88 relating to assessment in case of succession to business.
Assessment in Case of Succession to Business Otherwise than on Death: Sec 88
(1) Where, a person, carrying on any business or profession, has been succeeded therein
otherwise than on death by another person in any income year, and the successor continues
to carry on that business or profession(a) the predecessor shall be assessed, in respect of the income of the income year in which
the succession took place, for the period up to the date of succession, and
(b) the successor shall be assessed, in respect of the income of the income year, for the
period after the date of succession.
(2) Notwithstanding anything contained in section 88(1), where the predecessor cannot be found,
the assessment of the income year in which the succession took place up to the date of
succession and of the income year or years preceding that year shall be made on the successor
in the like manner and to the same extent as it would have been made on the predecessor; and
the provisions of the Ordinance shall, so far as may be, apply accordingly.
(3) Where any sum payable under this section in respect of the income of a business or profession
cannot be recovered from the predecessor, the Deputy Commissioner of Taxes shall record a
finding to that effect, and thereafter the sum payable by the predecessor shall be payable by
and recoverable from the successor who shall be entitled to recover it from the predecessor.
(6) Notwithstanding anything contained in this section, if the Deputy Commissioner of Taxes finds
after completion of the assessment of Hindu undivided family that the family has already
effected a partition, the tax shall be recoverable from every person who was a member of the
family before the partition; and every such person shall be jointly and severally liable for tax on
the income of the family so assessed.
(7) For the purposes of this section, the several liability of any member or group of members of a
Hindu undivided family shall be computed according to the partition of the property of the
undivided family allotted to him or it at the partition.
(8) The provisions of this section shall, so far as may be, apply in relation to the levy and collection
of any penalty, interest, fine or other sum in respect of any period up to the date of the
partition of a Hindu undivided family as they apply in relation to levy and collection of tax in
respect of any such period.
Assessment in Case of Persons Leaving Bangladesh: Sec 91
(1) Where it appears to the Deputy Commissioner of Tax that any person may leave Bangladesh
during the current financial year or shortly after its expiry and that he has no intention of
returning, an assessment may be made in that year, notwithstanding anything contained in
section 16, on the basis of the total income of such person if(a) he has been previously assessed, for the period from the expiry of the last income year of
which income has been assessed to the probable date of his departure from Bangladesh;
and
(b) he has not been previously assessed, of the entire period of his stay in Bangladesh up to
the probable date of his departure there from.
(2) Assessment under section 91(1) shall be made(a) in respect of each completed income year included in the period referred to in section
91(1), at the rate at which tax would have been charged had it been fully assessed; and
(b) in respect of the period from the expiry of the last of the completed income years to the
probable date of departure, at the rate in force for the financial year in which such
assessment is made and that financial year shall be deemed to be the assessment year in
respect of the income of the said period.
(3) For the purpose of making an assessment under this section, the Deputy Commissioner of
Taxes may serve a notice upon the person concerned requiring him to file, within such time,
not being less than seven days, as may be specified in the notice(a) a return in the same form and verified in the same manner as a return under section 75
setting forth, along with such other particulars as may be required by the notice, his total
income for each of the completed income years comprised in the relevant period referred
to in section 91(1); and
(b) an estimate of his total income for the period from the expiry of the last of such
completed income year to the probable date of his departure from Bangladesh.
(4) All the provisions of the Ordinance shall, so far as may, apply to the notice under section 91(3)
for purpose of assessment of tax as if it were a notice under section 77.
(5) Nothing in this section shall be deemed to authorise a Deputy Commissioner of Taxes to
assess any income which has escaped assessment or has been under assessed or has been
assessed at too low a rate or has been the subject of excessive relief under the Ordinance but
in respect of which he is debarred from issuing a notice under section 93.
Assessment in Case of Income of a Deceased Person: Sec 92
(1) Where a person dies, his legal representative shall be liable to pay any tax or other sum
payable under the Ordinance which the deceased would have been liable to pay if he had not
died, in the like manner and to the same extent as the deceased; and the legal representative of
the deceased shall, for the purposes of the Ordinance, be deemed to an assessee. However,
before deeming the legal representative of the deceased to be an assessee, a notice to that
effect shall be issued to him by the Deputy Commissioner of Taxes.
(2) For the purposes of making an assessment of the income of the deceased and recovery of tax(a) any proceeding taken against the deceased before his death shall be deemed to have been
taken against the legal representative and may be continued from the stage at which it
stood on the date of the death of the deceased; and
(b) any proceeding which could have been taken against the deceased, if he had not died, may
be taken against the legal representative; and all the provisions of the Ordinance shall, so
far as may be, apply accordingly.
(3) The liability of legal representative under the Ordinance shall be limited to the extent to which
the estate of the deceased is capable of meeting the liability.
(4) For the purposes of section 92 and other provisions of the Ordinance in which the rights,
interest and liabilities of the deceased are involved, legal representative includes an executor,
an administrator and any person administering the estate of the deceased.
Assessment in Case of Income Escaping Assessment: Sec 93
(1) If, for any reason, any income chargeable to tax for any assessment year has escaped
assessment or has been under assessed or has been assessed at too low a rate or has been the
subject excessive relief or refund under the Ordinance, the Deputy Commissioner of Taxes
may issue a notice to the assessee containing all or any of the requirements which may be
included in a notice under section 77 and may proceed to assess or determine, by an order in
writing, the total income of the assessee or the tax payable by him, as the case may be, and all
the provision of this Ordnance shall, so far as may be, apply accordingly. However, the tax shall
be charged at the rate or rates applicable to the assessment year for which the assessment is
made.
(2) No proceeding under section 93(1) shall be initiated unless definite information has come into
the possession of the Deputy Commissioner of Taxes and he has obtained the previous
approval of the Inspecting Joint Commissioner in writing to do so, except in a case where a
return has not been filed under section 75 or 77.
(3) A notice under section 93(1) may be issued by the Deputy Commissioner of Taxes(a) in any case in which he has reason to believe that the assessee or any other person on his
behalf has not filed a return under section 75 or 77, at any time;
(b) in any case in which he has reason to believe that the assessee has for any assessment year
concealed the particulars of his income or furnished inaccurate particulars thereof or
omitted or failed to disclose all material facts necessary for the assessment for such year,
within five years from the end of the assessment year for which the assessment is to be
made.
However, in a case where a fresh assessment is made for any assessment year in
pursuance of an order under sections 120, 121A, 156 or 159, the period of five years
referred to in this clause shall commence from the end of the year in which the fresh
assessment is made;
(c) in any other case, within two years from the end of the assessment year for which the
assessment is to be made.
(4) In computing the period of limitation for the purpose of making an assessment or taking any
other proceedings under the Ordinance, the period, if any, for which such assessment or other
proceedings has been stayed by any Court, Tribunal or any other authority, shall be excluded.
(5) Notwithstanding anything contained in section 93(3), where an assessment or any order has
been annulled, set aside, cancelled or modified, the concerned income tax authority may start
the proceedings from the stage next preceding the stage at which such annulment, setting
aside, cancellation or modification took place, and nothing contained in the Ordinance shall
render necessary the re-issue of any notice which has already been issued or the re-furnishing
or refiling of any return, statement or other particulars which has already been furnished or
filed, as the case may be.
Limitation for Assessment: Sec 94
(1) Subject to the provisions of sections 94(2) and (3), no order of assessment under the
provisions of this Chapter in respect of any income shall be made after the expiry of six
months from the end of the assessment year in which the income was first assessable.
(1A) Notwithstanding anything contained in section 94(1), no order of assessment under
sections 82BB shall be made(a) after the expiry of two years from the end of the assessment year in which the income
was first assessable; and
(b) after the expiry of the period of fifteen months from the end of the month in which the
return is submitted, whichever is earlier.
(2) Notwithstanding anything contained in section 94(1), assessment under section 93 may be
made(a) in the cases falling under section 93(3)(a) and (b), within two years from the end of the
year in which notice under the said section was issued; and
(b) in the cases falling under section 93(3)(c), within one year from the end of the year in
which notice under the said section was issued.
(3) Notwithstanding anything contained in section 94, limiting the time within which any action
may be taken, or any order or assessment may be made, order or assessment, as the case may
be, to be made on the assessee or any other person in consequence of, or to give effect to,
any finding or direction contained in an order under section 120, 121A,156, 159, 161 or 162
or, in the case of a firm, an assessment to be made on a partner of a firm in consequence of an
assessment made on the firm, may be made within 30 days from the date on which the order
was communicated and such revised order shall be communicated to the assessee within thirty
days next following.
However, where an order of assessment has been set aside by any authority in that case the
assessment shall be made within forty five days from the date on which the order was
communicated to him.
EXPLANATIONA I: Where, by an order under sections 120, 121A, 156, 159, 161 or 162, any
income is excluded from the total income of the assessee for an assessment year, and another
assessment of such income for another assessment year shall, for the purposes of this section,
be deemed to be one made in consequence of, or to give effect to, any finding or direction
contained in the said order.
EXPLANATION II: Where, by an order under sections 120, 121A, 156, 159, 161 or 162, any
income is excluded from the total income of one person and held to be the income of another
person, an assessment of such income of such other person, shall, for the purposes of this
section, be deemed to be one made in consequence of or to give effect to, any finding or
direction contained in the said order.
(4) Where the Deputy Commissioner of Taxes fails to give effect to any finding or direction
contained in an order referred to in section 94(3) within the period stipulated therein, such
failure of the Deputy Commissioner of Taxes shall be construed as misconduct.
Chapter 18
Assessment of individuals
Contents
Introduction
Examination context
Topic List
18.1
Definition of Individuals
18.2
18.3
18.4
Grossing Up of Income
18.5
18.6
Procedure of Assessment
18.7
Introduction
Learning objectives
Practical significance
Assessment of income and tax liability is very significant for every assessee. Assessing the income
of individual assessee and tax liability thereof is important for individual assesses. The chapter
recapitulates the taxable income, non-assessable income, tax credit income, grossing up of
income, applicable tax rates and related issues required for completing the assessment of
individuals. Application of double taxation relief, set-off and carry forward of losses, TDS as per
82C, rebate for income from a partnership firm are exemplified. Professional accountants are
required to have sufficient expertise on all of these issues.
Stop and think
Did you realise how important is the assessment for individual? Can you do the assessment of
individual assessees independently?
Working context
Assessment of tax is very important for every assessee. An assessee must require to be assessed in
any way. Accountants have a great role to provide the technical assistance to their client in case of
assessment. As there are many conditions, rules and procedures for different types of assessments,
accountants support sometime very significant to complete the assessment of their clients.
Many clients are requiring the support for correct assessment from accountants in every year.
Detailed knowledge of accountants on the technicalities of computation of taxable income and
tax liability thereof for individual assessee is very in case of required support for clients tax
assessment.
Syllabus links
The topics covered in this chapter have the significance for professional study as you can utilize
the knowledge throughout the application level and case study and also in your practical life.
Examination context
Exam requirements
In the examination, candidates may be required to:
Question practice
For question practice on these topics go to the suggested answers covering this chapter.
18.0
ASSESSMENT OF INDIVIDUALS
Section Overview
Definition of Individuals
The word individual has special meaning in income tax law. To look at the its reference in tax
law, we should look at two definitions, i.e. assessee and person.
"Assessee", means a person by whom any tax or other sum of money is payable under this
Ordinance, and includes (a) every person in respect of whom any proceeding under this Ordinance has been taken for
the assessment of his income or the income of any other person in respect of which he is
assessable, or of the amount of refund due to him or to such other person;
(b) every person who is required to file a return under section 75, section 89 or section 91;
(c) every person who desires to be assessed and submits his return of income under this
Ordinance; and
(d) every person who is deemed to be an assessee, or an assessee in default, under any
provision of this Ordinance [Section 2(7)].
"Person" includes an individual, a firm, an association of persons, a Hindu undivided family, a local
authority, a company and every other artificial juridical person [Section 2(46)].
Thus, the word assessee means a person that includes an individual who is liable to pay tax as
per Income Tax Ordinance, 1984. This chapter presents the assessment of income of individuals
and computation of tax liability of an individual assessee.
18.2
18.3
Consumption
Investment
Taxable
Allowable investment
Non-assessable
Disallowed investment
To reduce the tax burden, some specific income from specific sources is declared non-assessable
on which no tax is imposed. Again, to discourage consumption and motive investment, some
investments are allowed for claiming investment tax credit at the rate of 10%.
18.4
Grossing Up of Income
Another important issue is the grossing up of income which is received by the assessee after
deducting taxes at specified rate at sources. The equation used to gross up income is given
below:
Grossincome= Netincome X
100
100 Rateoftaxdeductedatsource
Thus, for grossing up income, it is important to know the rate of TDS. Only income received
after tax is required to gross up. Grossed up income should be included in calculating taxable
income, however, tax already paid will be claimed as credit at the time of computing net tax
liability.
18.5
Income tier
Rates
a
On the first
Tk. 1,80,000
Nil
On the next
Tk. 3,00,000
10%
On the next
Tk. 4,00,000
15%
On the next
Tk. 3,00,000
20%
On the balance
**** b
25%
Note:
a) The non-assessable income limit will be as follows:
For women and elderly citizens being more than 65 years of age
For disable persons
For others
Tk. 200,000
Tk. 250,000
Tk. 180,000
b) If the aggregate income of an individual exceeds Tk. 1,180,000 (Tk. 180,000 + Tk. 300,000 +
Tk. 400,000 + Tk. 300,000), he will be charged at maximum 25% on such income as it
exceeds Tk. 1,180,000.
c) However, the minimum tax would be Tk. 2,000.
d) If the assessee is an owner of any small and cottage industry or engaged in such kind of
activities in a NBR specified less developed / least developed area, he/she will be eligible to
have a tax rebate on such income:
If production / turnover increases by more
than 15% but less than 25% comparing to
previous year
If production / turnover increases by more
than 25% comparing to previous year
e) Only individual assessee having net wealth exceeding Tk. 2 (two) crore as per wealth
statement is liable to pay surcharge @10% on income tax payable effective from the
assessment year 2011-12.
f)
18.6
However, the rate of tax would be 25% (at maximum rate) if the individual assess is classified
as non-resident foreigner (NRF).
Procedure of Assessment
Step 1: Compute taxable income under different heads.
[Dont forget to exclude non-assessable income and grossing up of income at the time of
computing taxable income is specified areas]
Step 2: Compute allowable investments made
[Dont forget to test actual investment so that it must not exceed the maximum limit. If it
exceed maximum limit, allowable investment would be the lower one]
Step 3: Compute net tax liability
[Dont forget to consider tax credit due to TDS, refund adjustment, rebate, double taxation
relief, rebate on additional income and rebate on income from partnership firm]
18.7
Amount
***
***
Amount
***
***
***
***
***
***
***
***
***
***
***
***
***
***
***
***
***
***
***
***
***
***
***
***
***
***
***
***
***
***
***
***
**
**
***
***
***
**
**
***
***
Amount
***
***
**
**
***
***
***
***
***
***
***
***
***
(***)
***
***
***
***
***
***
***
***
***
***
***
***
***
***
***
***
***
***
***
***
***
***
***
***
***
***
6.
7.
8.
9.
10.
Depreciation
Interest on Mortgage Loan
Interest on Borrowed Capital
Losses due to sale of cultivable land
losses due to discard or demolish of agricultural
machineries
11. Other revenue expenses
***
***
***
***
***
***
***
***
***
***
***
(***)
***
***
***
***
***
***
***
****
***
***
***
****
*****
*****
***
***
(***)
***
***
***
(***)
(***)
***
***
***
***
***
(***)
***
***
***
***
***
***
***
***
***
***
***
***
***
***
***
***
***
***
***
***
Calculation of Tax liability:
Tk.
On first
1,80,000
On next
3,00,000
On next
4,00,000
On next
3,00,000
On remaining balance
******
Total
******
Less: Tax rebate on income from partnership firm
Less: Double taxation relief
Less: Special Rebate on additional income
Less: Investment tax credit @ 10%
Less: Tax deducted at source/Advance taxes
Less: Tax Refund adjustment
Net Tax liability
Rates
0%
10%
15%
20%
25%
Amount
(Tk.)
*****
*****
*****
*****
*****
*****
*****
*****
*****
*****
*****
*****
*****
Amount
1,80,000
1,98,000
1,80,000
Whichever is lower
1,80,000
Entertainment allowance @ 5%
Medical allowance (2,000 X 12)
Less: exempted (actual spending)
24,000
18,000
18,000
18,000
Amount
3,96,000
66,000
19,800
6,000
-
Amount
39,600
1,50,000
48,000
1,98,000
90,000
1,08,000
60,000
48,000
32,000
45,000
30,000
20,000
10,000
35,000
Total income
Calculation of Allowable investment
Life insurance premium (maximum up to 10% of policy value)
Investment in primary share
Contribution to RPF (Tk. 39,600 2)
Investment in savings certificate
Donation to:
Charitable hospital
Zakat fund
Actual investment
Maximum limit:
20% of taxable income excluding contribution to RPF (7,47,400 39,600)
Or,
Whichever is lower
Thus, the amount of allowable investment is
5,27,400
Amount
Tk. 20,000
60,000
79,200
30,000
10,000
5,000
2,04,200
141,560
1,00,00,000
141,560
141,560
Amount
Tk. 30,000
40,110
70,110
14,156
55,954
5,000
50,954
8,500
42,454
1,40,000
7,47,400
Notes:
1. Actual allowable investment by Mr. Jamshed Hasan for the year is Tk. 2,04,200 which exceeds the
maximum limit of allowable investment. Maximum limit here is 20% of (7,47,400 39,600) i.e., Tk.
1,41,560 or Tk. 1,00,00,000 whichever is lower, i.e., Tk. 1,41,560 and rebate is computed on the basis
of this figure.
2. Tax deducted at source includes Tk. 3,000 on interest from bank deposit, Tk. 1,000 on savings
certificate and Tk. 1,000 on divided income.
Worked Example 2
Mrs. Jarin Huq is the general manager of a private company. Her sources of income for the year ended
30th June, 2011 were as follows:
Income from Salary:
Basic salary per month
Medical allowance per month
House rent allowance per month
Conveyance allowance per month
Employers Contribution to RPF
Medical allowance (actual expenditure Tk. 15,000)
Income from Securities:
Interest received from tax free government securities
Interest received from less tax government securities
Tk. 45,000
2,000
25,000
2,500
10% of Basic
Tk. 20,000
Tk. 25,000
36,000
Tk. 1,00,000
8,000
Tk. 3,00,000
Tk. 2,80,000
3,00,000
During the year, Mrs. Huq incurred the following investment and expenses:
Life insurance premium
Donation to local mosque
Purchase share from primary market
Tk. 48,000
40,000
44,000
As per the list of asset and liability for the assessment year 2011-12, Mrs. Huqs net asset value exceeds
Tk. 2 crores. From the above particulars of Mrs. Huq calculate total taxable income and tax liability for
the assessment year 2011-12.
Solution 2:
Amount
Amount
Amount
5,40,000
24,000
19,000
5,000
3,00,000
2,70,000
1,80,000
Whichever is lower
1,80,000
1,20,000
30,000
24,000
6,000
54,000
7,25,000
2. Income from Securities (section: 22 & 23):
Interest from tax free government securities
Less: exempted (full)
25,000
25,000
-
40,000
40,000
2,80,000
3,00,000
75,000
8,000
3,00,000
83,000
2,17,000
3,00,000
1,80,000
1,20,000
11,02,000
Amount
Tk. 48,000
1,08,000
44,000
2,00,000
2,09,600
54,000)
Or,
whichever is lower
Thus, the allowable investment allowance is the actual one
1,00,00,000
2,09,600
2,00,000
Amount
Tk. 30,000
60,000
40,400
1,30,400
20,000
1,10,400
2,208
1,12,608
4,000
1,08,608
Notes:
1. Medical allowance is exempted upto actual spending so the amount saved from it is taxable.
2. It is assumed that the house property has been let out for residential purpose and so the repair and
maintenance expense is considered as 25% of annual value.
3. Production cost is considered as 60% of the selling price of the crops.
4. Though tax has already been deducted at source from the less tax government securities, at the time
of calculating net tax liability TDS of Tk. 4,000 (40,000 36,000) has been adjusted.
5. As actual investment does not exceed maximum limit of investment, here allowable investment for
tax credit is the amount of actual investment.
Worked Example 3
Mr. Anu Ahmed has the following income for the income year ended on 30th June, 2011:
Income from Salary
Mr. Anu Ahmed received basic salary of Tk. 18,500 in the month of June, 2011 following the scale of his
salary 17,000 1,500 20,000. The date of annual increment of his salary is 1st April. Besides basic salary
he received dearness allowance @ 15% of basic salary; Entertainment allowance and Medical allowance
@ 20% and @10% of basic salary respectively; Annual bonus and fees Tk. 36,000; house rent allowance
Tk. 11,000 per month; conveyance allowance Tk. 1,250 per month. He contributes 10% of basic salary to
a recognized provident fund (RPF) and his employer also contributes the same in the fund. During the
year he received Tk. 15,000 as interest on provident fund and the rate of interest was 15%. He
contributes to old age fund @ 5% of basic salary.
Income from Interest on Securities
Mr. Ahmed invested Tk. 40,000 in 12% tax free government securities, Tk. 50,000 in 10% less tax
government securities, Tk. 4,00,000 in 15% approved commercial securities (purchased on 1st January
2011) and Tk. 60,000 in 15% unapproved commercial securities. He financed Tk. 1,00,000 by taking a 8%
loan to purchase approved commercial securities. Bank charge Tk. 2,415 as collection fee of these
interests.
Income from Business and Profession
Due to the economic problem and huge competition, his business results a loss of Tk. 80,000 this year
which he like to set off against income from the sources mentioned above.
Income from Capital Gain
He has sold a machine before the expiry of 5 years which was purchased at a price of taka 80,000 for the
purpose of his business, at a price of taka 150,000 at fair market value. Another taka 30,000 was spent to
improve the machine. At the time of sale, the machine had accumulated depreciation amounting to taka
60,000.
Mr. Ahmed made and incurred the following investment and expenses during the said year:
1. Life insurance premium Tk. 6,000; value of the policy worth Tk. 70,000.
2. Purchase of Books Tk. 6,000 and purchase of scientific instruments Tk. 10,000.
3. Purchase of Primary Shares of Public Limited Company Tk. 20,000.
4. Donation to religious institutions Tk. 8,000; donation to Govt. Zakat Fund Tk. 7,500; donation to
president relief fund Tk. 28,000; donation to a local club Tk. 9,000; donation to a blind school Tk.
15,000;
5. Purchase of a piece of land worth Tk. 70,000 in the name of his wife and a sum of Tk. 5,000 was
spent for its registration.
6. Spent a sum of Tk. 15,000 as educational expenses of his children.
7. Purchase of ICB certificate Tk. 20,000.
8. Purchase of Gold Tk. 20,000.
9. Contribution to group insurance Tk. 2,000.
Ascertain his total income and tax to be paid in the assessment year of 2011 2012.
Solution 3:
Amount
20,850
20,850
1,32,000
1,04,250
1,80,000
1,04,250
15,000
15,000
15,000
14,500
Amount
Amount
2,08,500
31,275
41,700
36,000
27,750
20,850
500
3,66,575
4,800
4,800
5,000
225
4,775
30,000
(1,500)
(4,000)
24,500
9,000
450
8,550
(80,000)
60,000
37,825
(20,000)
150,000
80,000
30,000
110,000
40,000
4,24,400
Amount
Tk. 6,000
7,000
Amount
Tk. 6,000
20,000
7,500
28,000
15,000
20,000
2,000
41,700
10,425
1,50,625
80,610
1,00,00,000
80,610
80,610
1,80,000
2,44,400
4,24,400
Rates
0%
10%
Amount
Tk. 24,440
24,440
8,061
16,379
500
15,879
Notes:
1. After increment on April 1, 2010 Mr. Ahmed receives basic salary of Tk. 18,500 whereas before
increment he received basic salary of Tk. 17,000. So his basic Salary for the income year is (17,000 X
9 + 18,500 X 3) = Tk. 2,08,500.
2. As nothing mentioned, full medical allowance has considered as actual spending for such purpose.
3. Bank charge collection fees for the amount of interest collected by the bank. Here, in less tax
government securities total interest income is Tk. 5,000 but bank collected interest of Tk. 4,500 as
such interest is subject to TDS @ 10%.
4. Total bank charge of Tk. 2,415 was charged for collection of total interest of Tk. 48,300 (4,800 +
4,500 + 30,000 + 9,000). So a proportionate bank charge is deducted from each source of interest as
an admissible expense except in case of tax free government securities.
5. Though tax has already been deducted at source from the less tax government securities, at the time
of calculating net tax liability TDS of Tk. 500 (5,000 X 10%) have been adjusted.
6. As the capital asset is sold within 5 years of acquisition, it is included with other taxable income and
charged at regular rates.
7. It is assumed that the revenue gain on sale of machinery is not included in income from business and
profession. Thus the business loss of Tk. 80,000 is set off against other income under the same head.
And the balance is set off against income from either salary or interest on securities.
Worked Example 4
Mr. Joynal Abedin works as an officer in a Multinational Corporation, headquartered in USA. His sources
of income for the year ended on 30th June, 2011 were as follows:
a.
8.
9.
10.
11.
Travel allowance as a part of his contract Tk. 1,00,000; from where he saved Tk. 10,000.
He contributes 10% of his basic salary to a Recognized Provident Fund.
During the year, he received interest of Tk. 1,800 @ 18% on RPF.
He has taken one months basic salary as advance in the month of June to meet up some of his
financial difficulties.
b.
Interest on Securities:
1. Interest on tax-free government securities Tk. 3,000.
2. Interest on less-tax government securities Tk. 2,700.
3. Interest on approved debentures Tk. 27,300. He has borrowed Tk. 20,000 @ 10% interest to
purchase it. Bank also charged Tk. 400 to collect the interest.
c.
d.
Tk. 2,000
Tk. 4,000
Tk. 1,500
Tk. 1,000
Tk. 5,000
Agricultural income:
Sale of crops
Income from borga
Tk. 5,000
Tk. 2,000
e.
Tk. 10,000
f.
Tk. 40,000
g.
He has won a lottery income of Tk. 3,00,000 (tax deducted @ 20% - Tk. 60,000)
h.
During the year Mr. Abedin visited South Korea as a consultant and generated Tk. 5,00,000 and he
paid income tax @ 25% in South Korea as per DTA. From another visit to Russia he generated Tk.
3,00,000 and paid income tax @ 20%.
i.
j.
Tk. 4,500
Tk. 900
Tk. 31,500
Tk. 1,800
Tk. 2,000
Based on the above information, calculate Mr. Abedins taxable income and tax liability for the assessment
year 2011 - 2012.
Solution 4:
Amount
12,000
10,000
45,000
80,000
Amount
1,80,000
18,000
30,000
2,000
2,400
13,500
45,000
1,00,000
90,000
Advance salary
Employers contribution to RPF (10% of Tk. 180,000)
Interest from RPF
Less: exempted lower of:
Interest @ 14.50% [(1,800/.18)*.145] = 1,450
Or, 1/3 of basic salary [1,80,000/3]
= 60,000
Amount
10,000
15,000
18,000
1,800
1,450
350
3,34,250
3,000
3,000
27,300
(400)
(2,000)
1,08,000
1,00,000
27,000
2,000
750
250
18,000
3,000
24,900
1,08,000
48,000
27,900
60,000
5,000
2,000
7,000
3,000
4,000
4,000
1,000
3,000
10,000
40,000
35,000
25,000
5,000
1,000
10,000
2,000
2,000
20,000
4. Foreign Income:
Income from South Korea :
brought through banking channel
Less: exemption
Income didnt brought through banking channel
Income from Russia:
2,50,000
2,50,000
2,50,000
3,00,000
5,50,000
10,49,150
3,04,470
13,53,620
Amount
Tk. 8,000
5,000
3,000
2,500
36,000
54,500
2,06,160
1,00,00,000
2,67,054
54,500
1,80,000
3,00,000
4,00,000
3,00,000
Rates
0%
10%
15%
20%
Amount
Tk. 30,000
60,000
60,000
On balance Tk.
Total
Less: Investment tax credit (54,500 10%)
1,73,620
13,53,620
25%
43,405
193,405
(5,450)
187,955
(1,429)
186,526
64,600
120,926
114,320
6,606
Notes:
1. TDS includes Tk. 300 on interest on less-tax government securities, Tk. 500 on interest on fixed
deposit, Tk. 100 on profit from Islami Bank, Tk. 3,500 on dividend from ICB mutual fund, Tk. 200 on
dividend of public limited company and Tk. 60,000 on winning of lottery.
2. Employees contribution to statutory provident fund is an investment allowance.
3. Purchase of books, shares of co-operative society and furniture is not considered as investment
allowance.
4. Average rate of tax = (193,405 / 13,53,620) 100 = 14.29%
5. Double taxation relief:
Average tax rate in Bangladesh is (1,93,405/13,53,620) i.e. 14.29%
Tax relief
On income from South Korea (as per DTA) 25% of 5,00,000
=
Tk.
125,000
Maximum relief for DTA country is at an average rate of the country
(5,00,000 X 14.29%)
=
71,450
On income from Russia (no DTA exists):
20% or average whichever is lower i.e. 14.29% of 3,00,000
=
42,870
Total double taxation relief = (71,450 + 42,870) = Tk. 114,320
6. As TDS against lottery is a finally settled tax liability, so the first step is to calculate total income
excluding lottery income where tax has been settled finally. So, total income excluding lottery income
is Tk. 10,49,150.
So, Tax on such income will be:
On 1st
On next
On next
On next
Tk. 180,000
Tk. 300,000
Tk. 400,000
Tk. 169,150
0%
Nil
10%
Tk. 30,000
15%
Tk. 60,000
20%
Tk. 33,830
Total
Tk. 123,830
Now, TDS on lottery is Tk. 60,000 and income against this tax will be calculated as follows on the
basis of regular rate using the back calculation approach:
Tax on the rest of 4th slab (Tk. 300,000 Tk. 169,150) = Tk. 130,850 @ 20%= Tk. 26,170
So, for the rest of the amount of tax (Tk. 60,000 Tk. 26,170) = Tk. 33,830, tax slab will be the 5th
slab where tax rate is 25%.
So, against this TDS of Tk. 33,830 the applicable income will be (33,830/25*100) = Tk. 135,320
So, lottery income against which Tk. 60,000 finally settled TDS will be shown as (Tk. 169,150+ Tk.
135,320) = Tk. 304,470.
Chapter 19
Assessment of partnership firms
Contents
Introduction
Examination context
Topic List
19.1
Assessment of Firms
19.2
19.3
19.4
19.5
19.6
19.7
Introduction
Practical significance
Assessment of firm and tax liability is very significant for every assessee. Assessing the income of
firm and tax liability thereof is important for persons owning partnership firm and managing it.
The chapter recapitulates the scope of taxable income, non-assessable income, tax credit
income, grossing up of income, applicable tax rates and related issues required for completing
the assessment of firms. Application of tax rebate by partners on income from partnership firm is
exemplified. Professional accountants are required to have sufficient expertise on all of these
issues.
Stop and think
Did you realise how important is the assessment for firms? Can you do the assessment of firms
independently?
Working context
Assessment of tax is very important for every assessee. An assessee must require to be assessed in
any way. Accountants have a great role to provide the technical assistance to their client in case of
assessment. As there are many conditions, rules and procedures for different types of assessments,
accountants support sometime very significant to complete the assessment of their clients.
Many clients are requiring the support for correct assessment from accountants in every year.
Detailed knowledge of accountants on the technicalities of computation of taxable income and
tax liability thereof for individual assessee is very in case of required support for clients tax
assessment.
Syllabus links
The topics covered in this chapter have the significance for professional study as you can utilize
the knowledge throughout the application level and case study and also in your practical life.
Examination context
Exam requirements
In the examination, candidates may be required to:
Question practice
For question practice on these topics go to the suggested answers covering this chapter.
19.0
Assessment of Firms
The word firm includes a partnership firm. Like individuals, a firms income is also assessed
to compute tax payable by the firm. One point is very important to remember is that
assessment of partnership firm and partners are done separately. In taxation laws,
partnership and partners are totally different, have different income though the tax rates are
same with some exceptions.
19.2
19.3
(3) The profit so computed will be taxable profit of the firm and taxable in the hand of the firm.
However, such profit will be distributed among the partners as per their respective profit and
loss sharing ratio.
(4) The profit as calculated above is taxable provided that the total income exceeds the
exemption limit, i.e., Taka 1,80,000.
(5) The firm may also claim tax rebate @ 10% on allowable investments as individuals.
For Partners
(6) Partners taxable income will be a total of salary, interest, commission etc. earned from the
firm and share of profit or loss as computed in step 3. The total income will be taxed as per
the individual tax rates. Income from firm is to be considered as tax free income because tax on
this part is already paid by the firm, and partners will get rebate at average rate on their
partnership income from tax so computed. They may also claim rebate for qualifying amount of
investment allowance, if any, in normal way.
Note: Firms may not be required to pay tax due to income less than Taka 1,80,000 or carry
forward and set off of previous years losses. In such a situation, partners will pay tax in a normal
way but cannot claim any rebate on profit received from firm, as firm has not paid taxes on such
profit.
19.4
19.5
19.6
19.7
Liability of a Firm for Unrecoverable Tax due from Partners (U/s - 98):
Where any tax payable by partner of a firm in respect of his share of the income from the
firm cannot be recovered from him, the Deputy Commissioner of Taxes shall notify such
amount of the tax to the firm. Upon notification, the firm so notified shall be liable to pay
the said tax and, for the purposes of recovery thereof, shall be deemed to be an assessee
in respect of such tax.
Amount (Tk.)
72,000
48,000
88,000
22,000
20,000
Particulars
Gross Profit
Amount (Tk.)
8,00,000
80,000
50,000
4,20,000
8,00,000
Other Information:
1. Rent includes Tk. 26,000 paid to Mr. Ranob who partially owns the business premises.
2. Tk. 25,000 of commission is given to Mr. Manob for his special assignment.
3. Partners have income from different sources as follows:
8,00,000
Sources
Income from House Property
Income from Interest on Securities
Agricultural Income
Income from other sources (Dividend)
Mr. Ranob
60,000
50,000
25,000
Mr. Sanob
80,000
25,000
Mr. Manob
40,000
50,000
25,000
Required:
1. Compute the taxable income of the firm
2. Compute the amount of tax liability of the firm.
3. Show the amount of distribution to the partners.
4. Compute the amount of taxable income of the partners.
5. Compute the amount of net tax liability of the partners.
Solution 1:
Requirement 1: Taxable income of the firm
Particulars
Net Profit as per Profit and Loss A/C
ADD: Distribution to the Owners:
Interest on Capital:
Ronob 30,000
Sanob 20,000
Manob 30,000
Amount (Tk.)
Amount (Tk.)
4,20,000
80,000
Salaries:
Ronob 26,000
Manob 24,000
50,000
Commission:
Manob 25,000
Total Taxable Income of the Firm
25,000
1,55,000
2,65,000
Tax Rate
Amount (Tk..)
0%
10%
Nil
8,500
8,500
30,000
26,000
36,666
20,000
24,000
36,667
30,000
25,000
36,667
80,000
50,000
25,000
1,10,000
92,666
80,667
91,667
2,65,000
Amount left to
be Distributed
2,65,000
1,85,000
1,35,000
1,10,000
Ronob
50,000
Sanob
80,000
80,667
25,000
1,85,667
30,000
20,000
91,667
25,000
1,66,667
45,000
92,666
25,000
2,12,666
Manob
(b)
(c)
The firm owns a commercial building partly (one half) occupied by the firm to operate its own
business and partly (another half) let out at a monthly rent of TK 35,000. Corporate taxes are paid
@ 10% on the municipal value of TK 800,000. During the year, the firm has also earned TK 40,000
as advance and TK 10,000 as first years rent from a joint stock company by letting its top floor to
hoard a commercial advertisement.
The firm is engaged with trading of garments supplies which resulted following gross margin
amount for the year:
Particulars
Amount (TK)
Amount (TK)
Sales
5,000,000
Less: Cost of Goods Sold
Beginning Inventory
800,000
+ Purchase
4,200,000
Cost of Goods Available for Sale
5,000,000
1,000,000
- Ending Inventory
Cost of Goods Sold
4,000,000
Gross Margin
1,000,000
Other relevant information is given below:
Stocks are always valued at 2% above cost. Analysis also reveals that purchase amount is
overstated by TK 200,000 for the year. Total operating expenses charged during the period
amounted to TK 450,000 which included following items among other things:
(i) Maintenance to Building:
Amount (TK)
30,000
20,000
Amount (TK)
50,000
Municipal Taxes: Total amount of municipal taxes paid for the year was TK 40,000 out of
which the tenant bears TK 10,000.
(iii) Annual contribution to Cotton Dealers Association, a trade association is TK 10,000.
(iv) Contribution to Aga Khan Development Network was TK 50,000.
(v) All of the partners were active and took part in running business. Salaries paid to the
partners were TK 40,000 to Asha, TK 50,000 to Pasha and TK 30,000 to Rasha.
(vi)
Legal charges amounts to a total of TK 50,000 including a fine of TK 10,000 charged due to
its attachment with illegal form of business.
(vii) The firm charged TK 15,000 against profit to write off uncollectible amount of receivable
which is not allowed.
(viii) The firm incurred a loss of TK 50,000 from speculative business.
(ix) Accounting depreciation charged was TK 38,000 which was TK 3,000 higher than tax
depreciation.
(ii)
(d)
(e)
(f)
Asha had no other income during the year; however, Pasha and Rasha were also partners of
another firm. The respective income of Pasha and Rasha from the firm for the year ended 30th June
2011 were as under:
Partners
Salary
Interest
Profit/ (Loss)
Pasha
TK 40,000
TK 10,000
TK (50,000)
Rasha
TK 60,000
TK 20,000
TK 20,000
Asha had income from a house property at London amounting to TK 500,000 (after deduction of
15% tax at source).
Rasha had income from interest on approved commercial securities of TK 30,000. Bank charged
TK 300 as collection fee and TK 3,000 as interest on borrowing, money borrowed from the bank
for investment in approved commercial securities.
Compute tax liability of Asha, Pasha & Rasha Associates for the year as per Finance Act 2011 and total
taxable income in the hands of partners from all sources.
Solution 2
(a) Computation of total taxable income of the firm:
Particulars
(1) Income from house property (U/s - 24)
Annual Value
Actual rent (12 months @ TK 35,000)
ADD: municipal tax paid by the tenants
OR
Municipal Value (800,000/2)
Taka
Taka
420,000
10,000
430,000
400,000
430,000
Whichever is higher
Less:
repairs and maintenance (30% of annual value)
municipal tax for let-out portion (1/2 of TK 40,000)
Taka
129,000
20,000
149,000
281,000
1,000,000
15,686
200,000
215,686
19,608
196,078
1,196,078
450,000
746,078
8,000
10,000
1,20,000
10,000
15,000
50,000
38,000
251,000
997,078
35,000
962,078
50,000
1,293,078
Tk.
50,000
Maximum Limit:
20% of total taxable income, i.e., 20% of 12,93,078 = Tk. 2,58,616
Or Tk. 1,000,000 whichever is less
Tk. 2,58,616
Tk. 50,000
Tax Rate
Amount (Tk..)
Nil
30,000
60,000
60,000
28,270
178,270
5,000
1,73,270
Asha
Partners
Pasha
Rasha
40,000
3,91,026
4,31,026
50,000
3,91,026
4,41,026
30,000
3,91,026
4,21,026
Total
1,20,000
11,73,078
12,93,078
Amount left to
be Distributed
12,93,078
11,73,078
Asha
Pasha
Rasha
4,31,026
4,41,026
4,21,026
1,00,000
26,700
4,31,026
4,41,026
5,47,726
Chapter 20
Assessment of companies
Contents
Introduction
Examination context
Topic List
20.1
Companies
Residential Status of Companies
20.2
Submission of Return
20.3
Set off and Carry Forward of Losses
20.4
Withholding of Tax
20.5
Advance Payment of Tax
20.6
Applicable Tax Rates for Companies
20.7
Tax Rebate
20.8
Corporate Social Responsibility
20.9
Scope of Income
20.10
Worked Examples and Solutions
Introduction
Practical significance
Corporate assessment is full of complexities that require special skill to handle. Understanding
corporate accounting and converting it in line with the requirements of taxing authorities is the
first hurdle. Assessable income, non-assessable income, rebate, application of CSR, applying
different rates for capital gain, dividend income and other income are some of the complexities.
As professional accountants mostly serve corporate houses, this chapter becomes mostly
significant for them. Again, corporate tax planning, now-a-days, becomes a norm which
necessitates extra skill on part of the qualified accountants. Government also requires this type
of services from professional accountants due to the reasoning of maximizing its income.
Other common requirements like TDS, set off and carry forward of losses, DTA, grossing up of
income are also applied in this chapter.
Stop and think
Did you realise that the assessment of companies is very important from every perspective? Are
you confident enough to have the assessment of companies independently?
Working context
Assessment of tax is very important for every classes of assessee. An assessee must require to be
assessed in any way. Accountants have a great role to provide the technical assistance to their
client in case of assessment. As there are many conditions, rules and procedures for different types
of assessments, accountants support sometime very significant to complete the assessment of their
clients. When the client is a corporate, this chapter becomes very significant.
Many clients are requiring the support for correct assessment from accountants in every year.
Detailed knowledge of accountants on the technicalities of computation of taxable income and
tax liability thereof for corporate assessee is important in case of required support for clients
tax assessment.
Syllabus links
The topics covered in this chapter have the significance for professional study as you can utilize
the knowledge throughout the application level and case study and also in your practical life.
Examination context
Exam requirements
In the examination, candidates may be required to:
Question practice
For question practice on these topics go to the suggested answers covering this chapter.
20.0
ASSESSMENT OF COMPANIES
Section Overview
Companies
Assessment of companies means applying the assessment procedures on the income of
companies. Company has a definite meaning in income tax ordinance and other acts. For the
purpose of assessment, some of such definitions are produced below:
"Company" means a company as defined in the Companies Act, 1913 (VII of 1913) or Companies
Act, 1994 and includes (a) A body corporate established or constituted by or under any law for the time being in force;
(b) Any nationalized banking or other financial institution, insurance body and industrial or
business enterprise;
(c) An association or combination of persons, called by whatever name, if any of such persons is
a company as defined in the Companies Act, 1913 (VII of 1913) or Companies Act, 1994;
(d) Any association or body incorporated by or under the laws of a country outside Bangladesh;
and
(e) any foreign association or body, not incorporated by or under any law, which the Board
may, by general or special order, declare to be a company for the purposes of this
Ordinance [U/s 2(20)].
Companies Act 1994 defines Company to mean a company formed and registered under the act
or an existing company [U/s 2(c) of Companies Act, 1994]. Again, existing company means a
company formed and registered under any law relating to companies in force at any time before
the commencement of the act, and is in operation after commencement of the act [U/s 2(h) of
Companies Act, 1994].
However, at the time of prescribing the rates of taxes, companies are classified as
a)
b)
a)
b)
a)
b)
As per the prescription of Income Tax Ordinance of computing profit and loss through
schedules, companies are classified as
Fourth Schedule
Fifth Schedule Part A
20.3
Submission of Return
A company assessee shall have to furnish a return setting forth therein its total income by the
15th day of July each year or within 6 months from the end of the income year whichever is later.
However, on application from the company, the DCT may extend the return filing period up to
three months from the date so specified and he may further extend the date up to three months
with the approval of Inspecting Joint Commissioner. The return should be signed by the principal
officer as defined in section 2(48) of IT Ordinance [U/s 75(2)(b)(iii)]. And the return of income
for companies should be submitted in prescribed form (Form: IT 11-GHA).
20.4
20.5
Withholding of Tax
Finance Act 2011 introduces the submission of withholding tax return by inserting a new section
(75A: Return of withholding tax). Every person, being a company, shall file a return of
withholding tax collected or deducted with the Deputy Commissioner of Taxes where he is
being assessed. The return shall be prepared in prescribed form and signed and verified by the
principal officer. Such return shall be filed quarterly, by the fifteenth day of October, January,
April and July of the financial year for which the tax is deducted or collected; and it must
accompany a statement of deduction or collection of tax along with copy of treasury challans or
payment orders. However, the last date for the submission of return may be extended by the
Deputy Commissioner of Taxes up to fifteen days from the date so specified.
20.6
20.7
Illustration
Zerox Machine is a Private Limited Co. registered in Bangladesh. Following information is
related to the income year 2010-11:
Net operating income
Tk. 12,50,000
Interest income
Tk. 2,50,000
Total assessed income
Tk. 15,00,000
Sales revenue / turnover for the year is reported as Tk. 2,00,00,000. Applicable income tax rate
is 37.5%. Calculate income tax liability of X Ltd. for the year.
Income tax @ regular rate i.e. 37.5% is Tk. 562,500 (15,00,000 X 37.5%).
Gross receipts of the company: (Tk. 2,00,00,000 + Tk. 250,000) = Tk. 2,02,50,000
Minimum tax amount = (Tk. 2,02,50,000 X 0.50%) = Tk. 101,250.
Since, the regular tax is greater than the minimum tax amount; the tax liability of X Ltd. will be
Tk. 562,500.
Corporate Tax Rate at a Glance
Types of
Company
Bank, Insurance,
Financial
Institutions
Types of Income
(1) Capital gain
arising out of
(2) Dividend
income
Mobile Phone
Operator
Company
Cigarette
Manufacturing
Company
Other Company
(3) Other
income
(1) Taxable
Income
(2) Taxable
Income
(1) Taxable
Income
(1) Taxable
Income
(1) Capital gain
arising out of
(2) Dividend
income
(3) Other
10%
10%
15%
15%
20%
20%
42.5%
42.5%
45%
45%
35%
35%
n/a
42.5%
n/a
35%
10%
10%
15%
15%
20%
20%
income
37.5%
37.5%
n/a
24.75%
-Other situation
27.5%
27.5%
Non-publicly traded company, local
authority and private limited
37.5%
37.5%
company and other companies as
per sec 2(20).
But minimum tax for companies will be zero point five zero (0.50%) per cent of the amount
representing such company's gross receipts from all sources for that year.
20.8
Tax Rebate
If any publicly traded company other than bank, insurance, financial institutions declare dividends
at the rate of more than 20%, it will enjoy 10% of tax rebate on applicable tax.
If any company engaged in the production of goods and registered under the companies act
1994, it will enjoy tax rebate at a rate as mentioned below:
Particulars
Rate of Rebate
10%
of
expenditure
such
Areas of CSR: Finance Act 2011 withdraws 5 areas and inserts 3 new areas of CSR giving it a
total of 20 areas expenditure in which the companies can claim 10% rebate due to its CSR
activities provided that it does not exceed the maximum limit. These areas are:
1. Donation through any government bodies to reduce the misery of people of areas affected
by natural calamities like Cyclone, Earthquake, Hurricane, Flood etc.;
2. Donation to the institutions engaged in the establishment of old home and its management;
3. Donation to any social organization engaged in the Welfare of mentally or physically disable
people;
4. Donation to the educational institutions engaged in educating street / homeless children;
5. Donation to such institutions engaged in housing projects for people living in slums;
6. Donation to social organizations involved in building public awareness on women-right and
against dowry system;
7. Donation to organizations involved in feeding and rehabilitating orphan / homeless children;
8. Donation to organizations involved in research on liberation war, campaign to uphold the
spirit of liberation war and welfare of freedom fighters;
9. Donation to organizations engaged in maintaining healthy sewerage systems in Chittagong hill
tract, alluvial land, river breakage areas;
10. Donation to organizations engaged in the treatment of hare-lipped, cataract; cancer, leprosy;
11. Donation to individuals and organizations engaged in providing Medicare services to the
Acid Victims
12. Donation to specialized hospital providing free medical services to poor patients and work
for improving the quality of treatment e. g., hospitals for Cancer, Lever, Kidney, Thalasemia,
Eye and Cardio.
13. Donation to public universities;
14. Donation to any government recognized educational institution established for providing
educational scholarship and financial assistance to poor freedom fighters children along with
promoting technical and vocational education to the poor meritorious students;
15. Donation to government or MPO included private educational institution engaged in
establishing lab for training computer or IT or implementing English education programs;
16. Donation to organizations engaged in providing technical and vocational training to unskilled
or semi-skilled workers for exporting manpower;
17. Donation to organizations engaged in the development of infrastructure and training for
sports at national level;
18. Donation to national level museum established or to be established for preserving the
memory of education war;
19. Donation to national level institutions engaged in protecting the memory of the father of the
nation; and
20. Donation to the Prime Ministers Higher Education Fund.
(a)
Salary includes Tk. 3,30,000 paid to a Director working at the head office at California. He has never
visited Bangladesh and no taxes, as such, has been deducted at the time of making the payment.
(b) Head office expenses charged Tk. 11,00,000. No evidence could be produced for this other than
HO auditors certificates.
(c)
Fine of Tk.11,000 paid for violation of customs law charged to P & L Account.
(d) Two Nissan Petrol Jeeps purchased for Tk. 45,00,000 during the year. Depreciation @ 20% charged
on the full cost of the vehicles.
(e)
To procure business Tk.10,00,000 has been paid as commission to a local agent. In making the
payment, the provision of section 53E of IT Ordinance, 1984 has not been complied with.
(f)
The company sold a motor vehicle for Tk. 4,65,000. Original cost of the vehicle was Tk. 5,25,000
and the written down value was Tk. 3,25,000. This has not been reflected in the accounts.
(g)
(h) Miscellaneous expenses include Tk. 72,000 paid as salaries to three servants who are working at the
residence of the Managing Director.
(i)
Conveyance expenses include Tk. 2,20,000 paid for the plane fare of the wife and son of the
Managing Director for the visit of the neighboring countries.
(j)
Interest expense claimed at Tk. 33,50,000. The company has outstanding bank loan of Tk. 2.10
crores. The company advanced Tk. 75,00,000 interest-free loan to a sister-concern in Bangladesh.
From the above information compute the total income of the company for tax purpose.
Solution 1
M/s John Morris Inc.
Assessment year 2011-2012
Particular
Net income
Add: Inadmissible Expenses
Directors Salary
Excess Depreciation Charged
Donation not approved
Excess Perquisites
Profit on sale of Motor Car
Fine
Interest on Bank Loan
Head Office Expense
Adjusted Profit
Deduct: Head office expense 10% of profit
Taxable Income
Amount (Tk.)
330,000
500,000
15,000
42,000
140,000
11,000
1,196,429
1,100,000
Amount (Tk.)
3,000,000
3,334,429
6,334,429
633,443
5,700,986
Notes:
(1) Salary paid to a non-resident director without deduction of tax at source is inadmissible. Tax at the
maximum rate of 25% should have been deducted at source.
(2) Fine or penalty for breach of law is not allowed.
(3) Interest on borrowed capital 'is generally allowed when taken for business purposes. But borrowed
fund given to the sister concern is not for the business and therefore, proportionate interest has
been disallowed. Ref CIT v United Breweries.
(4) Section 53E of IT, 1984 requires deduction at source on the payment of commission for distribution
of assessee's products, not for procurement of business for the company.
(5) Difference between sale proceeds of the motor vehicle and its written down value of Tk. 1,40,000 is
a business profit.
(6) Under the Third Schedule for depreciation purpose cost of motor vehicle is restricted to Tk.
l0,00,000 and 20% depreciation on two cars therefore should be Tk. 4,00,000 whereas on Tk.
45,00,000 the company claimed Tk. 9,00,000, Excess of Tk. 5,00,000 has been added back.
(7) Servant's salary and travel plane fare are perquisites to the managing director of a total sum of Tk.
2,92,000 under section 30(e) perquisites are allowable up to Tk.250,000. Therefore, the excess has
been added back.
(8) Head office expenses is allowed up to 10% of the adjusted profit u/s 30(g).
Worked Example 2
The profit and loss account of Care Pharmaceuticals for the year ended on June 30 2011 reports net
income of taka 20,00,000. A careful scrutiny of accounts and supporting documents revealed the
following facts:
(a) During the year the company sold some of its pharmaceutical supplies that remained unused for a
long time in the storeroom. The company sold the supplies for a loss of taka 150,000 as the expiry
period is very close and charged such loss against current years profit.
(b) The company recovered taka 20,000 from bad debt that was written off earlier and was allowed. The
amount so recovered was credited to sundry debtors account.
(c) The company had taka 80,000 interests due to Bangladesh Shilpa Rin Sangstha in the year 2004 and
such interest was shown as allowable deduction in that year. Still, such interest remains unpaid.
(d) The company has a trading liability with one overseas company to the tune of taka 1,50,000 which
has been totally waived by the overseas company under special agreement during this year.
(e) During the year, the company sold one equipment for taka 1,80,000 which was purchased at a total
cost of taka 1,30,000 and had a written down value of taka 90,000 on the date of sale. The company
reports taka 90,000 as gain on sale of equipment in the credit side of profit and loss account.
(f) Due to a sudden fire on the factory building, the extended portion of the building is totally destroyed
and compensation received from the insurance company totaled taka 2,50,000. In addition, the
company realized an additional sum of taka 30,000 by selling the scrap. The extension was
constructed at a total cost of taka 4,00,000 and depreciation charged to date amounts to taka 50,000.
(g) The company sold a scientific apparatus used for scientific research for taka 80,000 which was originally
purchased at taka 1,50,000 and fully depreciated. The sale proceed is not recorded at all.
(h) The company have had export quota for exporting garments to EU countries. As the company has
recently changed the line of operation (switched from garments manufacturing to pharmaceuticals), it
transferred the export quota to another garments manufacturer for an annual sum of taka 70,000.
Such income is not reported at all.
(i) The company claimed investment allowance for new machinery installed during the year costing taka
10,00,000 which is entitled to accelerated depreciation.
(j) Bonus and commission to the field representatives at the rate of 4 months pay taka 3,00,000
including 1 months pay as festival bonus. But the general practice of bonus and commission for the
similar business is two months pay.
(k) Sum of taka 1,20,000 paid to an institution for scientific research which is not approved by NBR.
(l) Sum of taka 5,00,000 expended for establishing a hospital for the benefit of employees without any
charge. The company has not claimed any other deduction or allowance.
(m) Salary of taka 5,00,000 and rent of taka 80,000 were paid without deducting tax at source.
(n) Payment of brokerage and commission of taka 60,000 made to a non-resident without deducting tax
at source.
(o) Annual perquisites enjoyed by MD, Chairman and 5 members of BOD amounts to taka 22,00,000.
(p) Accounting depreciation charged to the account is taka 2,50,000 but tax depreciation amounts to
taka 3,00,000 excluding the amount of accelerated depreciation on machinery.
(q) Value of the free sample distributed was taka 2,00,000. Annual turnover during the year was taka
80,00,000.
(r) Expenditure on foreign travels for holidaying and recreation of the employees and their dependants to the
extent of the amount equivalent to three months basic salary of taka 3,60,000; actual expenditure being taka
4,00,000 and that the travel was not oftener than once in two years.
(s) Sum of taka 50,000 expended to train employees (Bangladeshi citizen) in connection with a scheme
approved by the Board.
(t) The company expensed a sum of taka 2,00,000 for visits abroad as a member of trade delegation
sponsored by the government.
(u) Annual membership fee of taka 1,50,000 is paid to Bangladesh Pharmaceutical Society which is a
professional institution recognized by the Board.
(v) Expenditure on publicity and advertisement, taka 3,00,000.
(w) Entertainment expenditure, taka 1,50,000.
Required: Compute the taxable income of the company.
Solution 2:
Care Pharmaceuticals
Status: Resident Company
Income Year: 2010-11
Assessment Year: 2011-12
Particulars
Income from Business or Profession:
Net Profit as per Profit and Loss Account
Add:
Inadmissible Expenses
Excess Bonus paid to Field Representatives
Amount paid for conducting scientific research
Salary and Rent paid without TDS
Payment to Non-resident without TDS
Excess amount of Perquisites
Depreciation
Excess cost of Free Sample
Excess amount in Holidaying and Recreation
Less:
Add:
Add:
Taka
20,00,000
1,20,000
1,20,000
5,80,000
60,000
8,00,000
2,50,000
40,000
60,000
8,00,000
3,00,000
20,000
80,000
1,50,000
80,000
70,000
Less:
Taka
40,000
90,000
20,30,000
40,30,000
11,00,000
29,30,000
4,00,000
33,30,000
40,000
33,70,000
90,000
32,80,000
1,50,000
34,30,000
88,600
33,41,400
50,000
33,91,400
Notes:
1. Loss on sale of supplies is an allowable deduction as such supplies does not fall under capital asset as
per the definition given in sec 2(15).
2. Amount of bad debt recovered will be the current years profit and should be credited to the profit
and loss account as such bad debt was allowed earlier.
3. As the interest due to Bangladesh Shilpa Rin Sangstha is not paid within three years, such interest will
be deemed to be current years income [U/s 19(15)(aa)].
4. As the company received waiver of a trading liability during this year, it should be shown as deemed
income of the year [U/s 19(15) (b)].
5. Computation of Gain, Capital Gain and Revenue Gain from the sale of equipment:
Particulars
6.
7.
8.
9.
10.
11.
12.
Taka
1,80,000
1,30,000
Taka
1. Sale Proceeds
2. Initial Costs
3. Capital Gain (1-2)
50,000
90,000
4. Written Down Value (2-4)
5. Revenue Gain
40,000
6. Gain on Sale of Equipment as shown in P/L Account (1-4)
90,000
As the insurance compensation received (taka 2,50,000) is less than the amount of written down
value of the building (taka 3,50,000), it is not taxable [U/s 19(15)].
Sale proceed of the asset used for scientific research shall be the deemed income in the year of sale
under section 19(20).
The rate of accelerated depreciation on machinery for the first year is 80%.
Calculation of amount of excess bonus paid to field representatives: Payment for 1 months, taka
60,000(taka 3,00,000/5). So, allowable bonus will be taka 1,80,000 (2 months bonus and 1 months
festival bonus). Excess amount paid is taka 1,20,000 (taka 3,00,000 taka 1,80,000).
The amount expensed for hospital is allowable deduction as it charges nothing against services from
the employees and the company claims no deduction or allowance in this regard.
Allowable amount of perquisites to MD, Chairman and 5 Directors will be taka 14,00,000 (taka
2,00,000 7). Thus, excess amount of perquisite is taka 8,00,000 (taka 22,00,000 taka 14,00,000)
that is not allowed.
The allowable rate of free sample for a pharmaceutical industry is 2% for annual turnover upto taka 5
crore. The turnover of the company were taka 80,00,000 and free sample allowed is taka 1,60,000
(2% of taka 80,00,000). Thus, excess amount was taka 40,000 (taka 2,00,000 taka 1,60,000) that is
not allowed.
13.
Three (3) moths basic salary
taka 3,60,000
th
th
3/4 of actual expenditure (3/4 of 4,00,000)
3,00,000
Excess amount paid that is not allowed
60,000
Note 14: Amount of admissible entertainment allowance:
On the first taka 10,00,000
@ 4%
taka 40,000
On the balance taka 24,30,000
@ 2%
48,600
On total income of taka 34,30,000
taka 88,600
Assessment of Banks
According to Income Tax Ordinance, 1984, banks may have earnings from two different sources:
a) Income from business or profession; and
b) Interest on securities.
To assess the income of a bank, some special points are required to be considered carefully.
1. Provision for bad and doubtful debt and interest thereon made by a commercial
bank including the Bangladesh Krishi Bank and the Rajshahi Krishi Unnayan bank, is
allowed as deductions to the extent of 1% of the total outstanding loan including
interest thereon or the amount of actual provision for such bad and doubtful debt and
interest thereon in the books of the assessee, whichever is less. If any amount out of
the amount so deducted is ultimately recovered the same shall be deemed to be a
profit of the year in which it is recovered. [Sec29(xviiiaa)]
2. When a banking company operating under Bank Company Act, 1991 shows profit in its
return of income at an amount exceeding 50% of its capital and reserve, the bank shall
pay an excess profit tax for that year at the rate of 15% on such excess profit (Sec
16C). For the purpose of capital and reserve computation, Bangladesh Bank BRPD
circular is relevant.
3. In the case of Bangladesh Shilpa Bank, Bangladesh Shilpa Rin Sangstha, Investment
Corporation of Bangladesh and any commercial bank including Bangladesh Krishi Bank
and Rajshahi Krishi Unnayan Bank, the income by way of interest in relation to such
categories of bad and doubtful debt as the Bangladesh Bank may classify, shall be taxed
in the income year in which it is credited to the profit and loss account or in the
income year in which it is actually received, whichever is earlier. [Sec 28(3)]
Worked Example 3
ABC Bank Ltd., a bank incorporated in Bangladesh, has submitted the following audited income statement
showing profit before tax of TK 258,000 for the income year 2010-11. You have been provided with the
notes supporting the figures to compute the tax liability of the bank for the respective assessment year:
Particulars
Amount (Tk.) Amount (Tk.)
Interest Income
650,000
Interest Paid on Deposits & Borrowings etc.
200,000
450,000
Net Interest Income
100,000
60,000
Income from investments
81,000
Commission, Exchange and Brokerage
691,000
Other Operating Income (20+61)
Total Operating Income (A)
Less: Operating Expenses
215,000
Payment to Employees
5,000
Postage and Telegrams
11,000
Rent, Rates & Insurance, etc.
2,000
Legal Charges
2,000
Directors Fees
1,000
Auditors Fees
60,000
Repairs to Premises
72,000
Stationery, Printing and Advertisements
3,000
Stamps
5,000
Charges on Loan Losses
15,000
Other Expenses of Business
Total Operating Expenses (B)
391,000
Profit / (Loss) before Provision (C=A-B)
300,000
Provisions:
12,000
Specific Provision
30,000
General Provision
Total Provision (D)
42,000
Total Profit / (Loss) before Taxes (C-D)
258,000
Supporting Information:
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
Accounting depreciation charged was Tk. 50,000 whereas tax depreciation is Tk. 80,000.
Inadmissible expenses have been found as follows:
Perquisites
Tk.
50,000
Printing and Advertisement (capital nature)
40,000
Other expenses (tax is not deducted at sources)
10,000
Balance Sheet (extract):
Paid up Capital
Tk.
2,000,000
Statutory Reserve
750,000
Retained Earnings
250,000
Dividend Equalization Fund
200,000
Classification of Loans and Advances:
Unclassified
Tk.
2,100,000
Sub-standard
850,000
Doubtful
1,145,000
Bad/Loss
10,250,000
Entertainment Expenses amounts to TK 65,000 for the period.
Solution 3:
ABC Bank Limited
Assessment Year: 2011-12
Computation of Taxable Income and Tax Liability
Particulars
Net Profit as per audited accounts
Less: Income to be considered separately
Income from Investment
Add: Expenses to be considered separately
Accounting Depreciation
Provision for Bad and Doubtful Debt
Entertainment Expenses
Taka
50,000
42,000
65,000
50,000
40,000
10,000
100,000
158,000
157,000
315,000
100,000
415,000
80,000
42,000
Taka
258,000
Tk.
Tk.
169,776
nil
169,776
122,000
293,000
100,000
393,000
15,720
377,280
Notes:
1. Total loans outstanding irrespective of classifications amounted to Tk. 143,45,000. Thus, 1% of the
loan amounts to 143,450. But, actual provision made amounts to Tk. 42,000 which is less and
therefore allowed.
2. The rate for allowable entertainment expenses is 4% on income of first Tk. 10,00,000 and 2% on rest,
if any. Thus, in this case entertainment expense will be Tk. 15,720 (4% of Tk. 393,000).
3. Calculation of Excess Profit under section 16C of the IT Ordinance 1984:
Tier 1: Core Capital
Paid up capital
Tk. 20,00,000
Statutory Reserve
7,50,000
Tk. 30,00,000
Retained Earnings
2,50,000
Tier 2: Supplementary Capital
General Provision on Unclassified Loan (1%)
Tk. 21,000
Dividend Equalization Fund
200,000
2,21,000
Total Capital
Tk. 32,21,000
Profit: 50% thereof
Tk. 16,10,500
Actual Profit
Tk. 3,77,280
Excess Profit
nil
Assessment of Leasing Companies
A lease is an arrangement whereby the lessor confers the right to use an asset in return for a payment or
series of payments. In a lease transaction legal ownership of the leased assets rests with the lessor
through in substance the leasee is the owner for the purposes.
Basically there are two types of lease (i) finance lease (ii) operating lease.
A lease is classified as a finance lease if it transfers substantially all the risks and rewards incidental to
ownership. All other leases are classified as operating leases.
Lessee under a finance lease is the owner of the asset for all practical purposes excepting that in legal
form he is not the owner until the asset is finally transferred to him at the end of the lease period.
Operating leases are just like hire purchase transactions and the lessee is the owner in no sense of the
term, legal or economic.
Some Specific Provisions usable for Leasing Companies:
(i)
Since ownership of the asset remains with the lessor in both types of lease, under our tax law he
would be entitled to claim depreciation allowances on the qualified assets leased out.
(ii)
Whole of rental received is credited as lessor's income without differentiating capital receipts
thereon. For the lessee all the rents payable are also treated as allowable expenditure. If rents
received and rents paid neutralize each other for tax purpose, it is only the tax depreciation that is
allowed to the lessor. Any way there is no revenue loss.
(iii)
Section 2(30) (b) defines fair value of assets leased by leasing companies or financial institution.
The residual value of leased asset on termination or maturity of lease agreement, plus the rental
realised during the lease period shall not be less than the cost of acquisition. In other words, no
capital loss or balancing allowance in the case of leased assets is allowed.
(iv)
Under section 29(v), transfer to a special reserve not exceeding 5% of the total income until the
reserve fund equals the paid up capital of the financial institution is an admissible deduction.
(v)
The third schedule, Para 3 Sub-para 4: No allowance on depreciation shall be made for leasing
company on such machine, plant, vehicle or furniture given to any lessee on financial lease.
Worked Example 4:
Prime Leasing is a public limited company listed with Dhaka Stock Exchange. It has recently submitted its
income tax return for the accounting year ending on 31 December, 2010 showing a net profit before tax
of Tk. 11,37,25,000.
Further examination of the file, records and documents revealed the following:
(a) Depreciation on leased assets charged in the accounts of Tk. 3,80,50,000 and loss on disposal of
leased assets was Tk. 29,88,000 this arose out of the shortage of residual value of returned or
repossessed assets plus rentals received on the lease of these assets over the original cost of the
assets.
(b) Provision for used assets and term finance has been made in the accounts at Tk. 51,35,500 and
Tk.19,13,900 respectively. This has been provided in accordance with FID Circular No. 8 issued by
the Bangladesh Bank.
(c) Tax depreciation for the relevant year is 5,85,00,000.
(d) Balances of statutory reserve and paid up share capital on 1.1.2010 were Tk. 1,86,00,000 and
Tk.12,00,00,000 respectively.
(e) Excess perquisites amounted to Tk. 6,95,000 and legal expenses included Tk. 80,000 for professional
fees for the acquisition of company's new office at Dhanmondi.
(f) Net profit included dividend received on investments of Tk. 19,98,000.
You are required to compute the (a) total income and (b) tax liability of the company for the relevant
assessment year.
Solution 4
Prime Leasing
Assessment Year: 2011-2012
Computation of Total Income and Tax liability
Particulars
Net income
Less: Dividend Income (to be considered separately)
Amount (Tk.)
Amount (Tk.)
11,37,25,000
19,98,000
11,17,27,000
3,80,50,000
29,88,000
51,35,500
19,13,900
6,95,000
80,000
4,88,62,400
6,28,64,600
5,85,00,000
43,64,600
19,98,000
63,62,600
6,36,260
57,26,340
19,98,000
43,64,600
63,62,600
@ 20.00%
@ 42.50%
3,99,600
18,54,955
22,54,555
Notes:
(1)
(2)
(3)
Sections 22 and 23 relating to the computing of income chargeable under the head "Interest on
Securities".
b. Sections 24 and 25 relating to the computation of income chargeable under the head "Income from
House Property".
c.
Sections 28, 29 and 30 relating to the computation of profits and gains from business or profession.
d. Sections 31 and 32 relating to the computation of income chargeable under the head capital gains".
e.
Section 33 and 34 relating to the computation of income under the head "Income from Other
Sources".
f.
Thus the profits and gains of insurance business from all sources are to be computed artificially as one
income in accordance with the provisions in the Fourth Schedule and not under different heads of
income.
In the Schedule assessment of insurance business has been discussed under three different heads:
Para 2
Para 6
Para 7
any surplus or deficit included therein which was made in any earlier inter valuation period
and
(ii)
any expenditure or allowance which is not deductible under the provisions of sections 29 and
30 in computing income chargeable under the head 'Income from business or profession'.
Thus the assessable profits under the first method would vary from year to year. The annual average actuarial
surplus under the second method would be constant during the particular inter valuation period.
Gross external incomings:
The expression 'gross external incomings' is defined in Para 9 of the Schedule as meaning the full amount
of incomings from interest, dividends, fines and fees and all other incomings from whatever source
derived including profits from revisions and on the sale or granting of annuities but excluding the
following:
(a) premium received on policy;
(b) interest and dividends in any annuity funds and
(c) profits on the realisation of investments
Management Expenses:
The expression "management expenses" has been defined in Para 9 of the Schedule as meaning the full
amount of the expenses including commissions, incurred exclusively for the purpose of life insurance
business plus a fair proportion of the expenses incurred in the general management of the whole
business. The following expenses are excluded from the above definition:
(a) bonuses or other sums paid to or reserved on behalf of policyholders
(b) depreciation of and losses on the realisation of investments and
(c) any other expenditure or allowance other than those allowed U/S 29.
However, the maximum limit of such management expense is prescribed in Para 2:
(a) 7.5 percent of the premium on single premium life insurance policies,
Plus
(b) 7.5 percent of the first year's premiums on policies under which less than 12 annual
premiums are payable,
Plus
(c) 90 percent of the first year's premium in respect of all other life insurance policies,
Plus
(d) 12 percent of all renewal premiums received during the income year.
The first adjustment to be made to the surplus is to allow 75% of the amounts paid to or reserved for or
expended on behalf of policyholders as a deduction there from. If the amount so kept for policyholders
which was allowed as a deduction in the past is not actually so paid, the amount so allowed in the past
will be added back to the profits for the period in which the amount ceases to be so reserved.
(b)
Any amount either written off or reserved by the insurance company in the accounts or through the
actuarial valuation balance to meet depreciation or loss on the realisation of investments should be
allowed if the same is wiped out by a rise in a subsequent year either within or after the same intervaluation period.
(c)
Interest received in respect of any securities of the Government which have been issued with the
condition that interest thereon shall not be liable to tax.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
Management expenses claimed and admitted by the DCT are Tk. 2,50,000. During the undervaluation
period the company paid income tax at source of Tk. 3,00,000. Some of the share investments have
depreciated in value during the year by Tk. 60,000. Determine the income of life insurance business of
the company for the income year 2010-2011.
Solution 5
Pioneer Life Insurance Co. Ltd.
Assessment Year: 2011-12
Actuarial surplus:
Surplus as per 2010 valuation
Add: Deficit on earlier valuation
Add: Income tax deducted at source
Less: Reserve for bonus (75% x 10,00,000 x 60%)
Adjusted surplus
Annual average surplus
Add: Profit on sale of shares
Less: Depreciation of share investment
Adjusted annual average
Gross external earnings
Interest on securities
Dividends
Fines and Fees
Profit on annuities and reversions
Less: Management expenses
Net external earnings
Amount (Tk.)
10,00,000
3,00,000
13,00,000
3,00,000
16,00,000
4,50,000
11,50,000
2,30,000
90,000
3,20,000
60,000
2,60,000
1,00,000
1,50,000
80,000
1,50,000
4,80,000
2,50,000
2,30,000
For income tax purpose for the assessment year 2011-2012, adjusted annual average of Tk. 2,60,000
being higher of the two would be the assessed amount.
Assessment of General Insurance Company
(1)
Forth Schedule governs the computation of increase of insurance business both life and general.
(2)
(3)
Para 6(2) of Forth Schedule permits a general insurance company to transfer 10% of the net
premium income of that year to a fund created to meet exceptional losses and such transfer is an
admissible deduction.
(4)
Para 6(3) of Forth Schedule sets the mechanism for the upper limit of the fund which is, the
amount of the fund should be equal to the premium income of the year or average premium of the
immediate 3 years preceding whichever is higher.
Worked Example 6
Following is the profit and loss account of Sonar Bangla Insurance Co. Ltd. for the year 31 December
2010:
Directors' fee
Audit fees
Registration, renewal etc.
Advertisement
Depreciation
Interest on overdraft
Balance transferred to Appropriation
Account
Amount
48,000
1,35,000
2,05,331
32,40,251
7,92,127
1,81,198
3,23,57,906
3,70,09,813
Amount
1,97,26,029
1,72,73,952
9,832
3,70,09,813
Further scrutiny of the relevant papers, files and documents revealed the following:
(1)
Gross premium received during the year was Tk.125607426 and in three years immediately
preceding were Tk. 131212308, Tk. 136887085 and Tk. 135580109 respectively.
(2)
Net premium income of the year was Tk. 64441296 and the balance brought forward on reserve
for exceptional loss was Tk.101945720.
(3)
Accounting depreciation has been Tk. 792127 whereas as per tax law this has been computed as
Tk. 919029.
(4)
Gratuity provided in the accounts was for Tk. 779845 and paid actually Tk. 6,25,860.
(5)
Analysis of the dividend, rent etc. revealed that an amount of Tk. 6488284 being interests on
various bank deposits has been included therein.
Calculate the taxable profit and tax liability of the company for the relevant assessment year:
Particulars
Net profit per accounts
Less: Income for separate treatment
Dividends
Interest
1,32,37,745
64,88,284
7,92,127
7,79,845
9,19,029
6,25,860
64,44,130
Amount (Tk.)
3,23,57,906
1,97,26,029
1,26,31,877
15,72,022
1,42,03,899
79,89,019
62,14,880
1,32,37,745
64,88,284
2,59,40,909
Business Income
Dividend Income
Income from other source-interest etc.
Total Income
Computation of Tax Liability
Tax on dividend income
Tax on Balance income
Tax on other income
Total Tax Liability
1,32,37,745
62,14,880
64,88,284
@ 20.00%
@ 42.50%
@ 42.50%
26,47,549
26,41,324
27,57,521
80,46,394
Notes:
(1)
(2)
(3)
12,56,07,426
Since average of three years premium income is higher than the premium of Tk.1256607426 (current
year's gross premium), the reserve for exceptional losses can be built up to that amount.
Opening balance in exceptional loss reserve
Transfer admissible - l 0% of net premium income of Tk. 6444l296
Balance carried forward
TK. 10,19,45,720
64,44,130
10,83,89,850
Non-resident carrying insurance business in Bangladesh : (Para 7) the profits and gains of the
branches in Bangladesh of a nonresident insurance company may be deemed to be the proportion of the
total world income of the company corresponding to the proportion which its premium income derived
from Bangladesh bears to its total premium income. The total world income of nonresident life insurance
companies whose profits are periodically ascertained by actuarial valuation shall be computed in the
manner laid down in these paragraphs for the computation of profits and gains of the life insurance
business carried on in Bangladesh.
For example, ALICO Bangladesh Ltd. is incorporated in USA and it carries on insurance business in
Bangladesh for several years through branches. For the year ended 31 March 2011 its audited world
income has been taka 950 million against a total premium income for the same year of taka 3250 million.
In Bangladesh it earned premium income of taka 60 million. Therefore, profits earned in Bangladesh is
computed as taka 17.54 million (950/325060).
Chapter 21
Liability in Special cases and Assessment of
Non-residents
Contents
Introduction
Examination context
Topic List
21.1
Liability of representative in certain cases
21.2
21.3
21.4
Liability of firm or association for unrecoverable tax due from partners or members
21.5
21.6
21.7
21.8
21.9
Introduction
Learning objectives
Practical significance
There is no option to avoid the liability for payment of tax. In certain cases the representative of
any person in respect of income is liable to take some defined responsibilities especially for
assessment. There is a list of persons who shall be treated as agent in relation to a non-resident.
Representative who paid tax on account of his liability has some right to recover the sum so paid
from the person on whose behalf it is paid.
There are different types of defined liabilities stated in this chapter. Firm or association has
liability for unrecoverable tax due from partners or members. Partners, etc., have liability for
discontinued business of a firm, etc. Directors have liability for unrecoverable tax of private
companies. Liquidator has liability for tax of private companies under liquidation. The principal or
the agent has liability to tax in case of air transport business of non-residents.
Stop and think
It is obvious that liability of tax cannot be ignored under tax law. The agents or representative or
other persons in certain cases are liable to pay tax on behalf of other persons.
Working context
The agents or representative or other person as defined in this chapter in relation to liabilities
are sometime seeking tax expert support as clients to resolve this issue. Accountants can give
support to these clients. As tax experts accountants can also help in recovering tax liability from
the representative or agents by providing his expertise in this regard.
Syllabus links
The topics covered in this chapter are fundamental to your understanding of income tax.
You will be using this knowledge again when you tackle the Taxation paper later on in the
Professional Stage and it will also underpin the technical aspects at the Advanced Stage.
Examination context
Exam requirements
In the examination, candidates may be required to:
Question practice
For question practice on these topics go to the suggested answers covering this chapter.
Examiner's comments on how students tackle questions
Candidates have to remember to recognize the different types of liabilities of representative,
agents and persons in different cases.
21.0
21.1
be subject to the same duties, responsibilities and liabilities as if such income were
received by, or accruing to, or in favour of, him beneficially;
be liable to assessment in his own name; and
be deemed, subject to other provisions of this Chapter, to be the assessee for all
purposes of this Ordinance.
(2) A person, who is assessed in pursuance of this section as a representative in respect of any
income, shall not, in respect of the same income, be assessed under any other provision of
this Ordinance.
(3) Nothing in this section shall prevent either the direct assessment of the person for whom,
or on whose behalf or for whose benefit, the representative is entitled to receive any
income or recovery from such person of the tax payable in respect of such income.
As per section 95, the following categories of persons may act as the representative of persons
as specified:
Represented by the guardian or manager or trustee
the Administrator-General, the Official
Trustee, or any receiver, manager or other
person appointed by or under any order of a
Court,
the trustee or trustees appointed under a
trust
Agent
21.2
21.4
force, be liable to pay the said tax and shall, for the purposes of recovery thereof, be
deemed to be an assessee in respect of such tax; and the provisions of this Ordinance shall
apply accordingly.
21.5
21.6
21.7
Liability of Liquidator for Tax of Private Companies Under Liquidation: Sec 101
(1) A liquidator of a private company which is wound up, whether under the orders of a court
or otherwise, shall, within thirty days after he has become such liquidator, give notice of his
appointment as such to the Deputy Commissioner of Taxes having jurisdiction to assess the
company.
(2) The Deputy Commissioner of Taxes shall, after making such enquiries or, calling for such
information as he may consider necessary, notify to the liquidator, within three months of
the date of receipt of the notice under sub-section (1), the amount which, in his opinion,
would be sufficient to provide for any tax which is then, or is likely thereafter to become,
payable by the company.
(3) On being notified under sub-section (2), the liquidator shall set aside an amount equal to the
amount so notified and shall not, before he sets aside such amount, part with any of the
assets of the company except for the purpose of payment of tax payable by the company or
for making payment to secure such creditors as are entitled under the law to priority of
payment over debts due to the Government on the date of liquidation.
(4) The liquidator shall be personally liable for payment of the tax on behalf of the company to
the extent of the amount notified, if any, under sub-section (2), if he a) fails to give notice as required by sub-section (1): or
b) contravenes the provisions of sub-section (3)
(5) Where there are more liquidators than one, the obligations and liabilities of a liquidator
under this section shall attach to all the liquidators jointly and severally.
(6) This section shall have effect notwithstanding anything to the contrary contained in any other
law for the time being in force.
Explanation In this section, liquidator includes any person who has been appointed to be
the receiver of the assets of the company under liquidation.
21.8
21.9
chargeable to tax under the head Income from business or profession, and tax thereon
shall be charged at the rate of three percent of such income.
(2) The principal or an agent authorized by him in this behalf shall prepare and furnish to the
Deputy Commissioner of Taxes, within forty-five days from the last day of each quarter of
every financial year, that is to say, the thirtieth day of September, the thirty-first day
December, the thirty-first day of March and the thirtieth day of June, respectively, return in
respect of each quarter as aforesaid showing (a) the amount paid or payable whether in or out of Bangladesh to the principal, or to any
person on his behalf, on account of the carriage of passengers, livestock, mail or goods
loaded at the said airport; and
(c) the amount received, or deemed to be received, in Bangladesh by, or on behalf of, the
principal on account of the carriage of passengers, livestock, mail or goods at any airport
outside Bangladesh.
(3) On receipt of the return, the Deputy Commissioner of Taxes may, after calling for such
particulars, accounts or documents, as he may require, determine the aggregate of the
amounts referred to in sub-section (2), and charge tax as laid down in sub-section (1).
(4) Where, the principal fails to pay the tax payable under sub-section (1) for more than three
months, the Commissioner of Taxes may issue to the authority by whom clearance may be
granted to that aircraft, a certificate containing the name of the principal and the amount of
tax payable by him; and on receipt of such certificate, the said authority shall refuse
clearance from any airport in Bangladesh to any aircraft owned or chartered by such person
until the tax payable has been paid.
(5) Nothing contained in this Ordinance shall be so construed as to allow any expense against
the aggregate amount of receipts as determined under sub-section (3).
(6) The tax paid under this section shall be deemed to be the final discharge of the tax liability of
the assessee under this Ordinance, and the assessee shall not be required to file the return
of total income under section 75 nor shall he be entitled to claim any refund or adjustment
on the basis of such return.
Thus, sections 102 and 103A of IT Ordiance 1984, prescrives the tax rates on income of nonresidents involved with shipping and air transport business which may be pointed out below:
Business
Shipping
Air Transport
Return submitted by
Master of ship
Principal or agent
Status
Final discharge of tax liability
Final discharge of tax liability
Chapter 22
Special Provisions relating to avoidance of tax
Contents
Introduction
Examination context
Topic List
22.1
22.2
22.3
22.4
22.5
CA in Bangladesh
www.facebook.com/cainbd
Introduction
Learning objectives
Identify the measure in case of avoidance of tax through transactions with non-residents
Define the avoidance of tax through transfer of assets and transaction in securities
Recognise the conditions and rules for tax clearance certificate required for persons leaving
Bangladesh.
Demonstrate the different forms for tax clearance and exemption certificate.
Mention the conditions for exemption from production of tax clearance certificate.
Practical significance
The tax authorities have some measures in case of avoidance of tax through transactions with
non-residents, transfer of assets and transaction in securities. The tax authorities can determine
the reasonable amount of income in certain cases of such avoidance.
Subject to some exceptions and conditions, a person who is not domiciled in Bangladesh, or a
person who being domiciled in Bangladesh at the time of his departure is required to obtain a tax
clearance certificate or an exemption certificate.
Stop and think
There are some measures with tax authorities in case of avoidance of tax in certain cases. Do
you think that any person can still avoid tax by any means?
Working context
In case of avoidance of tax through transaction with non-resident or otherwise, either intentional
or unintentional, the tax clients are facing many problems from tax authorities. Sometime they
think that the measures taken by tax authorities are not in line with justice. In such a case
accountants can help them by providing the expert service in this regard.
The accountants also can support by giving advice to his client in case of tax clearance/exemption
certificate required for him while leaving Bangladesh.
Syllabus links
The topics covered in this chapter are fundamental to your understanding of income tax.
You will be using this knowledge again when you tackle the Taxation paper later on in the
Professional Stage and it will also underpin the technical aspects at the Advanced Stage.
Examination context
Exam requirements
In the examination, candidates may be required to:
Identify the measure in case of avoidance of tax through transactions with non-residents
Define the avoidance of tax through transfer of assets.
Define the avoidance of tax through transaction in securities.
Mention the conditions and rules for tax clearance certificate required for persons leaving
Bangladesh.
Exhibit the different forms of tax clearance and exemption certificates
Recognise the conditions for exemption from production of tax clearance certificate.
Question practice
For question practice on these topics go to the suggested answers covering this chapter.
22.0
22.1
22.2
(a) such income is in fact so dealt with as to be calculated to ensure at any time for the
benefit of such person in any form; or
(b) the receipt or accrual of such income operates to increase the value of any assets held
by such person or for his benefit; or
(c) such person receives or is entitled to receive at any time any benefit provided or to be
provided(i) out of such income; or
(ii) out of money which is, or will be, available for the purpose by reason of the effect
or successive effects of associated operations on such income and on any assets
representing the income; or
(d) such person has, by means of the exercise of any power of appointment, revocation or
otherwise, power to obtain for himself, with or without the consent of any other
person, the beneficial enjoyment of such income; or
(e) such person is able to control, directly or indirectly, the application of such income, in
any manner whatsoever.
(6) In determining whether a person has power to enjoy income, regard shall be had to the
substantial result and effect of the transfer and any associated operation, and to all benefits
which may at any time accrue to such person as a result of the transfer and associated
operations irrespective of the nature or form of the benefit.
Explanation: For the purposes of this section
(a) assets includes property or rights of any kind and transfer in relation to assets being rights,
includes creation of those rights;
(b) associated operation, in relation to any transfer, means an operation of any kind effected by
any person in relation to(i) any of the assets transferred; or
(ii) any income arising from such assets; or
(iii) any assets representing, directly or indirectly, any of the assets transferred, or the
accumulation of the income arising from such assets;
(c) benefit includes a payment of any kind;
(d) references to assets representing any assets transferred, or any income or accumulation of
income arising therefrom, includes references to shares in or obligation of any company to
which, or the obligation of any other person to whom, any such assets or that income or
accumulation of income is or has been transferred, and
(e) any body corporate incorporated outside Bangladesh shall be treated as if it were a nonresident.
22.3
securities accrued from day to day, and been apportioned to the said period, then the
income from such securities for the said period shall be deemed to be the income of such
person.
(3) Where, any person carrying on a business which consists wholly or partly in dealing in
securities buys or acquires any securities from any other person and either sells back or retransfers those securities, or sells or similar securities, to such other person, and the result
of the transactions is that the interest becoming payable in respect of the securities bought
or acquired by him is receivable by him but is not deemed to be his income by reason of the
provisions of section 106(1), no account shall be taken of the transactions in computing for
any of the purposes of this Ordinance, any income arising from, or loss sustained, in the
business.
(4) The Deputy Commissioner of Taxes may, by notice in writing, require any person to furnish
him, within such time, not being less than twenty eight days, as may be specified in the
notice, such particulars in respect of all securities of which such person was the owner, or in
which he had beneficial interest at any time during the period specified in the notice, as the
Deputy Commissioner of Taxes may consider necessary for the purpose of ascertaining
whether tax has been borne in respect of the interest on all those securities and also for
other purposes of this section.
Explanation: For the purposes of this section(a) interest includes dividend;
(b) securities includes stocks and shares; and
(c) securities shall be deemed to be similar if they entitle their holders to the same right against
the same persons as to capital and interest and the same remedies for the enforcement of
these rights, notwithstanding any difference in the total nominal amounts of the respective
securities or in the form in which they are held or in the manner in which they can be
transferred.
22.4
Tax Clearance Certificate Required for Persons Leaving Bangladesh: Sec 107
Requirement for Tax Clearance/Exemption Certificate
(1) Subject to such exceptions as the Board may make in this behalf, a person who is not
domiciled in Bangladesh, or a person who being domiciled in Bangladesh at the time of his
departure is not, in the opinion of an income tax authority likely to return to Bangladesh,
shall not leave Bangladesh without obtaining from the Deputy Commissioner of Taxes
authorised in this behalf by the Board(a) a tax clearance certificate, or
(b) if he has intention of returning to Bangladesh, an exemption certificate which shall be
issued only if the Deputy Commissioner of Taxes is satisfied that such person has such
intention; and such exemption certificate may be either for a single journey or for all
journeys within the period specified in the certificate [Section 107(1)].
(2) The owner or charterer of any ship or aircraft, who issues any authority to any person
referred to in section 107(1) for travel by such ship or aircraft from any place in Bangladesh
to any place outside Bangladesh unless such person has a certificate required by that section,
shall(a) be liable to pay the amount of tax, if any, which has or may become due and payable by
such person and also to a penalty which may extend to two thousand taka; and
(b) be deemed, for the purposes of recovery of such tax and penalty, to be an assessee in
default, and all the provisions of this Ordinance shall apply accordingly [Section 107(2)].
Explanation: For the purposes of section 107(a) exemption certificate, in relation to any person, means a certificate to the effect that
such person is exempt from the requirement of having a tax clearance certificate for the
purpose of the journey or journeys specified therein;
(b) owner or charterer includes any representative, agent or employee who may be
empowered by the owner or charterer of a ship or aircraft to issue an authority to travel by
the ship or aircraft; and
(c) tax clearance certificate, in relation to a person, means a certificate to the effect that
such person has no liability under the Ordinance, the Income tax Act, 1922, the Gift-tax Act,
1963 or, or the Wealth-tax Act, 1963, or that satisfactory arrangements have been made for
the payment of all or any of such taxes which are or may become payable by which person.
22.5
7.
8.
Place:
Date:
9.
10.
11.
Destination
12.
Office/Branch
Office
TIN
........
Circle
........
Book No.
Serial No.
Book No.
Serial No.
TAXES DEPARTMENT
Certificate under section 107 of The Income
Tax Ordinace, 1984 (XXVI of 1984)
Office of the Deputy Commissioner of Taxes
_______ Circle _________
Place _______________________________
Date ________________________________
This is to certify that ________________
of __________ (whose signature
or thumb impression is affixed below) has no
liability made satisfactory arrangements for
his/her liabilities under the Income Tax
Ordinance,1984 (XXXVI of 1984), the Income
tax Act, 1922 (XI of 1922), the Gift-tax Act,
1963 (XIV of 1963) Gift Tax Act, 1990 (XLIV of
1990) or the wealthtax Act, 1963 (XV of 1963).
This certificate is valid up to
__________________________________
Signature _____________________________
Deputy Commissioner of Taxes, Signature
of left-hand /Circle. Thumb impression of the
Person named In the Certificate
Book No.
Serial No.
Book No.
Serial No.
TAXES DEPARTMENT
Certificate under section 107 of The Income
Tax Ordinace, 1984 (XXVI of 1984)
Office of the Deputy Commissioner of Taxes
Place _______________________________
Date ________________________________
This is to certify that________________
of ________________ (whose signature
(2)
passengers who can show by the dates stamped on their passports or by other reliable
evidence; thatI. they have not spent more than ninety days at a time in Bangladesh; and
II. they have not spent more than ninety days in any financial year in Bangladesh [rule
63(b)];
(3)
(4)
all officers and employees of foreign Government visiting Bangladesh on duty [rule 63(g)];
(5)
the wives and dependants of persons covered by rules 63(f) and (h) [rule 63(h)];
(6)
woman who gives a declaration to the effect that she is wholly dependent upon her husband,
parent or guardian and has no independent source of income [rule 63(i)].
Chapter 23
Contents
Introduction
Examination context
Topic List
Introduction
23.1
23.2
23.3
23.4
Power of survey
23.5
23.6
23.7
23.8
23.9
23.10
23.11
23.12
Introduction
Learning objectives
Identify the power of respective income tax authorities to call for information.
Identify the power to inspect the registers of company
Recognise the power of survey.
Demonstrate the additional power of enquiry and requiring the production of documents.
Power of search and seizure.
Power to verify the deduction and collection of taxes.
Right to retain the seized assets and application thereof.
Power of revision of orders.
Power to take evidence on oath.
Practical significance
To carry out the responsibilities and ensure compliance in adopting different rules, respective
income tax authorities have been given sufficient powers. This chapter presents such power of
income tax authorities in different situation. Such powers may be to call for information, inspect
the registers, conduct survey, require for documents, search and seizure, verify deduction and
collection of taxes, retaining seized assets, revise orders and take evidence of oath.
For different assesses, this chapter is very important as they require to know the power of
authorities so that they can comply with the specific requirements.
Stop and think
Respective income tax authorities enjoy required powers to carry out their job smoothly. Do
you think that you know all of such powers applicable to different income tax authorities?
Working context
Powers of income tax authorities are very important for both income tax authorities and
assesses. Accountants can provide valuable advises to clients in case of non-compliance and any
type of failures if they know the power of income tax authorities properly. It will be helpful for
the client to avoid excessive penalty or other types of punishment. It is also an important part of
tax planning.
The accountants can also support by giving advice to his client in case of powers already
exercised by income tax authorities for non-compliance or failures.
Syllabus links
The topics covered in this chapter are fundamental to your understanding of income tax.
You will be using this knowledge again when you tackle the Taxation paper later on in the
Professional Stage and it will also underpin the technical aspects at the Advanced Stage.
Examination context
Exam requirements
In the examination, candidates may be required to:
Question practice
For question practice on these topics go to the suggested answers covering this chapter.
23.0
23.1
Introduction
Income tax authorities enjoy the power of search and seizure of books of accounts, records,
documents and moveable properties after searching through the business premises, residential
building, vessel, aircraft, or any other places belonging to a person. This chapter covers required
provisions under IT Ordinance regarding such power of income tax authorities.
23.2
Assessee
Firm
(b)
(c)
(d)
23.3
(e)
(f)
Requirements
a statement of the names and addresses of the partners and
their respective shares
a statement of the names and addresses of the manager and
the members of the family
a statement of the names and addresses of the persons for
or of whom he is trustee, guardian or agent
a statement of the names and address of all persons to
whom he has paid in any income year any rent, interest,
commission, royalty or brokerage, or any annuity, not being
an annuity classifiable under the head "Salaries", amounting
to more than three thousand taka, together with particulars
of all such payment
a statement of the names and addresses of all persons to
whom he or the Exchange has paid any sum in connection
with the transfer of capital assets, or on whose behalf or
from whom he or the Exchange has received any such sum,
together with the particulars of all such payments and
receipts
information in relation to such points or matters, or such
statements or accounts giving such particulars, as may be
specified in the notice (Provided that no such notice on
a banking company shall be issued by the Deputy
Commissioner of Taxes or the Inspector, without
the approval of the Commissioner)
23.5
23.6
(6) Where any books of accounts, documents, electronic records and systems, money, bullion,
jewellery or other valuable article or thing is found in the possession or control of any
person in the course of a search, it may be presumed that(a) the books of accounts, documents, electronic records and systems, money, bullion,
jewellery, article or thing belongs to such person;
(b) the contents of the books of accounts and documents, the books of accounts,
documents, electronic records and systems, are true; and
(c) the signature on, or the handwriting in, any such books or documents is the signature or
handwriting of the person whose signature or handwriting it purports to be.
(7) The person from whose custody any books of accounts or other documents or electronic
records and systems, are seized under sub-section (2) may make copies thereof, or take
extracts therefrom, in the presence of the authorised officer or any other person designated
by him, at such place and time as the authorised officer may appoint in this behalf.
(8) The books of accounts or other documents or electronic records and systems, seized under
sub-section (2) shall not be retained by the authorised officer for a period exceeding one
hundred and eighty days from the date of the seizure unless for reasons recorded in writing,
approval of the Commissioner, the Director General, Central intelligence Cell has been
obtained for such retention:
Provided that the Commissioner, the Director General, Central intelligence Cell
shall not approve such retention for a period exceeding thirty days after all the
proceedings under this Ordinance in respect of the years for which the books of
accounts or other documents, [electronic records and systems, as are relevant,
have been completed.
(9) If any person, legally entitled to the books of accounts or other documents or electronic
records and systems, seized under sub-section (2) objects to the approval given by the
Commissioner the Director General, Central Intelligence Cell under sub-section (8), he may
make an application, stating therein the reasons for his objection, to the Board for the return
of the books of accounts or other documents; or electronic records and systems, and the
Board may, after giving the applicant an opportunity of being heard, pass such orders
thereon as it may think fit.
(10) Subject to the provisions of this Ordinance and the rules, if any, made in this behalf by the
Board, the provisions of the Code of Criminal Procedure, 1898 (Act V of 1898), relating to
search and seizure shall apply, so far as may be, to search and seizure under sub-section (2).
Explanation- For the purposes of this section, the word "proceeding" means any proceeding in
respect of any year under this Ordinance which may be pending on the date on which a search is
authorised under this section or which may have been completed on or before such date and
also includes all proceedings under this Ordinance which may be commenced after such date in
respect of any year.
23.7
23.8
Deputy Commissioner of Taxes, forward a report thereof, together with all relevant papers,
to the Deputy Commissioner of Taxes.
(2) Where he has seized any asset under section 117 or, as the case may be, he has received a
report under sub-section (1), the Deputy Commissioner of Taxes shall, after giving the
person concerned a reasonable opportunity of being heard and making such enquiry as the
Directors-General of Inspection or the Commissioner may direct, within `ninety days of the
seizure of the assets, and with the previous approval of the Commissioner,iii.
estimate the undisclosed income (including income from the undisclosed property), in a
summary manner to the best of his judgment on the basis of such materials as are
available with him;
iv.
calculate the amount of tax payable under this Ordinance on the income so estimated;
and
v.
specify the amount that will be required to satisfy any existing liability under this
Ordinance, the Income tax Act, 1922 (XI of 1922), the Gift tax Act, 1963 (XIV of 1963),
and the Wealth-tax Act, 1963 (XV of 1963), in respect of which such person is in default
or is deemed to be in default:
Provided that if, after taking into account the materials available with him, the Deputy
Commissioner of Taxes is of the view that it is not possible to ascertain to which particular
income year or years such income or any part thereof relates, he may calculate the tax on such
income or part, as the case may be, as if such income or part were the total income chargeable
to tax at the rates in force in the financial year in which the assets were seized.
Explanation- In computing the period of ninety days for the purposes of sub-section (2),
any period during which any proceeding under this section is stayed by an order or
injunction of any Court shall be excluded.
(3) After completing the proceedings under sub-section (2), the Deputy Commissioner of Taxes
shall, with the approval of the Commissioner, make an order requiring the person
concerned to pay the aggregate of the amounts referred to in sub-section (2) (b) and (c) and
shall, if such person pays, or makes satisfactory arrangement for the payment of, such
amounts or any part thereof, release the assets seized under section 117 or such part
thereof as he may deem fit in the circumstances of the case.
(4) Where the person concerned fails to pay, or to make satisfactory arrangements for the
payment of, any amount required to be paid in pursuance of the order under sub-section (3)
or any part thereof, he shall be deemed to be an assessee in default in respect of the amount
or part, and the Deputy Commissioner of Taxes may retain in his custody the assets seized
under section 117 on any part thereof as are in his opinion sufficient for the realisation of
the said amount or, as the case may be, of such part thereof as has not been paid.
(5) If the Deputy Commissioner of Taxes is satisfied that the assets seized under section 117 or
any part thereof were held by a person for or on behalf of any other person, he may
proceed under this section against such other person, and all the provisions of this section
shall apply accordingly.
(6) If any person objects, for any reason, to an order made under sub-section (3), he may, within
thirty days of the date of such order, make an application, stating therein the reasons for his
objection, to the Commissioner for appropriate relief in the matter; and the Commissioner
may, after giving the applicant an opportunity of being heard, pass such orders thereon as he
may think fit.
23.9
movable property may be sold by a Tax Recovery Officer for the recovery of tax; and
for this purpose he shall have all the powers of a Tax Recovery Officer under this
Ordinance.
(2) Nothing contained in sub-section (1) shall preclude the recovery of the amount referred to
in section 118 (4) by any other mode provided in this Ordinance for the recovery of any
liability of an assessee in default.
(3) Any assets or proceeds thereof which remain after the discharge of the liability in respect of
the amount referred to in section 118 (4) shall forthwith be made over or paid to the
persons from whose custody the assets were seized.
23.10 Power of Inspecting Joint Commissioner to revise orders of Deputy Commissioner
of Taxes (Section 120)
(1) The Inspecting Joint Commissioner may call for from the Deputy Commissioner of Taxes
and examine the record of any proceeding under this Ordinance, and , if he considers that
any order passed therein by the Deputy Commissioner of Taxes is erroneous in so far as it
is prejudicial to the interests of the revenue, he may, after giving the assessee an opportunity
of being heard, and after making or causing to be made, such inquiry as he thinks necessary,
pass such order thereon as in his view the circumstances of the case would justify, including
an order enhancing or modifying the assessment or canceling the assessment and directing a
fresh assessment to be made.
(2) No order shall be made under sub-section (1) after the expiry of four years from the date of
the order sought to be revised.
23.11 Revisional power of Commissioner (Section 121A)
(1) The Commissioner may on an application made by the assessee, call for the record of any
proceeding under this Ordinance in which an order has been passed by any authority
subordinate to him and may make such enquiry or cause such enquiry to be made and,
subject to the provisions of this Ordinance, may pass such order thereon, not being an order
prejudicial to the assessee, as he thinks fit.
(2) The application for revision of an order under this Ordinance passed by any authority
subordinate to the Commissioner shall be made within sixty days of the date on which such
order is communicated to the assessee or within such further period as the Commissioner
may consider fit to allow on being satisfied that the assessee was prevented by sufficient
cause from making the application within the said sixty days.
(3) The Commissioner shall not exercise his power under sub-section (1) in respect of any
order16. where an appeal against the order lies to the Appellate Joint Commissioner or to the
Commissioner (Appeals) or to the Appellate Tribunal and the time within which such
appeal may be made has not expired or the assessee has not waived his right of appeal;
or
17. where the order is pending on an appeal before the Appellate Joint Commissioner or it
has been made the subject of an appeal to the Commissioner (Appeals) or to the
Appellate Tribunal.
(4) No application under sub-section (1) shall be entertained unlessi.
it is accompanied by a fee of two hundred taka; and
ii.
the undisputed portion of the tax has been paid.
Explanation- The "undisputed portion of the tax" means the tax payable under section 74.
(5) For the purposes of this section, an order by the Commissioner declining to interfere shall
not be construed as an order prejudicial to the assessee.
(6) Notwithstanding anything contained in this Ordinance, an application for revision made
under sub-section (1) shall be deemed to have been allowed if the Commissioner fails to
make an order thereon within a period of sixty days from the date of filing the application.
Explanation- For the purposes of this section, the Appellate Joint Commissioner of Taxes shall
be deemed to be an authority subordinate to the Commissioner to whom the Deputy
Commissioner of Taxes, whose order was the subject-matter of the appeal order under revision,
is subordinate.
23.12 Power to take evidence on oath, etc. (Section 122)
(1) The Deputy Commissioner of Taxes, the Joint Commissioner of Taxes, the Commissioner,
the Director General, Central Intelligence Cell, the Commissioner (Appeals) and the
Appellate Tribunal shall, for the purposes of this Ordinance, have the same powers as are
vested in a Court under the Code of Civil Procedure, 1908 (Act V of 1908), when trying a
suit in respect of the following matters, namely:
iii.
discovery and inspection;
iv.
enforcing the attendance of any person and examining him on oath or affirmation;
v.
compelling the production of accounts or documents (including accounts or documents
relating to any period prior or subsequent to the income year); and
vi.
issuing commissions for the examination of witness.
(2) The Deputy Commissioner of Taxes shall not exercise his powers under this section for the
purpose of enforcing the attendance of an employee of a scheduled bank as a witness or
compelling the production of books of account of such a bank except with the prior
approval of the Commissioner.
(3) Any authority mentioned in sub-section (1) may impound and retain in its custody for such
period as it considers fit, any books of accounts or other documents produced before it in
any proceeding under this Ordinance.
(4) Any proceeding under this Ordinance, before any authority mentioned in sub-section (1),
shall be deemed to be a judicial proceeding within the meaning of section 193 and 228, and
for the purposes of section 196, of the Penal Code (Act XLV of 1860).
Chapter 24
Imposition of Penalty
Contents
Introduction
Examination context
Topic List
24.1
Introduction
24.2
24.3
24.4
24.5
24.6
24.7
24.8
24.9
24.10
Summary of Penalties
24.11
24.12
24.13
24.14
Introduction
Learning objectives
Mention the different non-compliances of tax law for which penalties are imposed.
Identify the penalties due to non-compliance of tax law in certain cases.
Define the measures against any order of penalty.
Practical significance
If any person without any reasonable cause failed to comply tax law in certain cases the tax
authorities may impose penalty on that person. There are requirements by tax law such as
maintaining of accounts in the prescribed manner, filing of return, certificate, statements,
accounts or information, payment of advance tax, compliance with notice, payment of tax on the
basis of return etc. Non-compliance of these requirements may cause to penalties payable by the
persons made such non-compliances. Concealment of income and default in making payment of
tax are also caused to penalties.
No penalties mentioned here shall be made on any person unless such person has been heard or
has been given a reasonable opportunity of being heard. The imposition of any penalty on any
person shall be without prejudice to any other liability.
Stop and think
Did you realize how important it is to ensure the compliance of the requirements of tax law
mentioned in this chapter for avoiding penalties? The penalties can be quite extensive in some
cases.
Working context
You need to know the consequences for non-compliance of the requirements of tax law in this
chapter. You must keep it in mind that the penalties may be massive and imposition of penalties
for such non-compliance can also harm the reputation of the assessee and his financial
sustainability.
The accountants can help the clients to comply with all the requirements of tax law in this
regards so that the clients can avoid any such penalties and retain the esteem from tax
authorities and stakeholders.
Syllabus links
The topics covered in this chapter are very important as it is dealt with the legal requirement of
tax law.
You will be using this knowledge again when you tackle the Taxation paper later on in the
Professional Stage and it will also support the technical aspects at the Advanced Stage.
Examination context
Exam requirements
In the examination, candidates may be required to:
Identify the penalty for not maintaining accounts in the prescribed manner.
Identify the penalty for failure to file return, certificate, statement, accounts or information.
Recognise the penalty for failure to pay advance tax and failure to pay tax on the basis of
return.
Identify the penalty for non-compliance with notice, concealment of income and default in
payment of tax.
Mention the bar to imposition of penalty without hearing.
Demonstrate the authority and procedures for imposition of penalty.
Question practice
For question practice on these topics go to the suggested answers covering this chapter.
Examiner's comments on how students tackle questions
Candidates have to remember the requirements of tax law in relation to imposition of penalty in
case of non-compliance with the amount or rate of penalties.
24.0
IMPOSITION OF PENALTY
Section Overview
Penalties can be imposed on any person for non-compliance of certain tax law.
The amount and rate of penalties can be varied in case to case.
Unless hearing or a reasonable opportunity of being heard, no penalties shall be
imposed.
24.1
Introduction
Penalty is the outcome of non-compliance of any provisions of IT Ordinance in any manner. Such
penalties are important to encourage compliance and establish equity at the time of imposing
penalty. As per chapter XV of income tax ordinance, a penalty may be imposed on following
grounds:
a) for not maintaining accounts in the prescribed manner
b) for failure to file return, certificate, statement, accounts or information
c) for using fake Tax-payer's Identification Number (TIN)
d) for failure to pay advance tax
e) for non-compliance with notice
f)
Penalty for not Maintaining Accounts in the Prescribed Manner (Section 123)
Where any person has, without reasonable cause, failed to comply with the provisions of any
order or rule made in pursuance of, or for the purposes of section 35(2), the Deputy
Commissioner of Taxes may impose on him a penalty
(a) of a sum not exceeding one and a half times the amount of tax payable by him; and
(b) where the total income of such person does not exceed the maximum amount on which tax
is not chargeable, of a sum not exceeding Tk. 100.
24.3
(2) Where any person has, without reasonable cause, failed to file or furnish or, as the case may
be, obtain and display within the time laid down therefor,(a) any certificate, statement, accounts or information required by or under sections 58,
108, 109, or 110; or
(b) the tax-payer's identification number (TIN) certificate under section 184C the Deputy
Commissioner of Taxes shall impose upon such person a penalty of Tk. 500 and in the
case of a continuing default a further penalty of Tk. 250 for every month or fraction
thereof during which the default continues.
Provided that where any person has, without any reasonable cause, failed to furnish information
as required under section 113 , the Deputy Commissioner of Taxes may impose a penalty of Tk.
25,000 and in case of a continuing default a further penalty of Tk. 500 for each day.
24.4
24.5
24.6
24.7
24.8
(a) concealed particulars of his income or furnished inaccurate particulars of such income;
or
(b) understated the value of any immovable property in connection with its sale or transfer
with a view to evading tax, he or it shall impose upon such person a penalty of ten
percent of tax which would have been avoided had the income as returned by such
person or as the case may be, the value of the immovable property as stated by him
been accepted as correct:
Provided that if the concealment referred to in clause (a) and (b) of this sub-section or subsection (2) is detected after a period of more than one year from the year in which the
concealment was first assessable to tax, the amount of penalty shall increase by an additional ten
percent for each preceding assessment year.
(2) For the purpose of section 128(1), concealment of particulars of income or furnishing of
inaccurate particulars of income shall include (a) the suppression of any item of receipt liable to tax in whole or in part, or
(b) showing any expenditure not actually incurred or claiming any deduction therefor.
24.9
24.10
Summary of Penalties
In line with the above provisions, a summary of penalties may be drawn as below:
Ref.
Sec
123
Reasons of Penalty
for not maintaining accounts
in the prescribed manner
Authority
DCT with
approval from
IJCT
Penalty
Sum not exceeding one and a half times the
amount of tax payable by him, however, such
amount must not exceed Tk. 100 where the
total income does not exceed the nonassessable limit, say, Tk. 180,000
Sec
124
DCT
DCT
DCT
Sec
124A
Sec
125
DCT with
approval from
IJCT
DCT with
approval from
IJCT
Sec
126
for non-compliance
notice
Sec
127
Sec
128
Sec
137
24.11
with
DCT with
approval from
IJCT
DCT with
approval from
IJCT
DCT, AJCT,
Commissioner
(Appeals) or
Appellate
Tribunal
DCT
24.12
24.13
24.14
Chapter 25
Recovery of Tax
Contents
Introduction
Examination context
Topic List
25.1
Notice of demand
25.2
25.3
25.4
25.5
25.6
25.7
25.8
25.9
25.10
Introduction
Learning objectives
Practical significance
A notice of demand in the prescribed form shall be served upon the assessee specifying the sum
payable and the time within which it is payable where any tax is payable in consequence of any
assessment made or any order passed under or in pursuance of the Ordinance.
An assessee in default or is deemed to be in default in making payment of tax may be directed to
pay penalty in addition to tax in arrears. For recovery of tax from an assessee in default, a
certificate for recovery of tax may be issued. The Tax Recovery Officer upon receipt of that
certificate can recover the tax in compliance with the method and mode of recovery as specified.
Tax can also be recovered by the Collector of Districts or through Special Magistrates. There
are other modes of recovery mentioned in this chapter.
Stop and think
Do you have the idea about the method and mode of recovery of tax by tax authority? Do you
know about notice of demand and penalty for default in payment of tax?
Working context
The tax authority has some procedures to recovery of taxes. They can serve notice of demand,
they can issue certificate for tax recovery. They can recover tax even through Collector of
District or Special Magistrate. They have also other modes of recovery. So it is not easy for any
assessee to get rid of from payment of tax. Besides an assessee in default or is deemed to be in
default in making payment of tax may be penalized.
Accountants can suggest their clients to pay the tax on the basis of assessment in due time. They
can aware the clients that making default in payment of tax may cause to penalty in addition to
tax payable.
Syllabus links
The topics covered in this chapter are fundamental to your understanding of income tax.
You will be using this knowledge again when you tackle the Taxation paper later on in the
Professional Stage and it will also underpin the technical aspects at the Advanced Stage.
Examination context
Exam requirements
In the examination, candidates may be required to:
Question practice
For question practice on these topics go to the suggested answers covering this chapter.
25.0
RECOVERY OF TAX
Section Overview
Notice of demand can be served upon the assessee for recovery of tax
Default assessee may be directed to pay penalty in addition to tax in arrears.
Certificate of recovery may be issued for tax recovery from default assessee.
Tax can also be recovered by the Collector of Districts or through Special Magistrates.
There are different methods and modes of recovery of tax.
25.1
actually incurred by the assessee outside Bangladesh or if the income, whether capitalized or not,
has been brought into Bangladesh in any form.
25.2
b. Where, as a result of any final order, the amount of tax, with respect to the default in
the payment of which the penalty was levied, has been wholly reduced, the penalty levied
shall be cancelled and the amount of penalty paid shall be refunded.
25.3
Upon receipt of certificate forwarded to him under section 138, the Tax Recovery
Officer shall, notwithstanding anything contained in any other law for the time being in
force, proceed, in accordance with the rules made in this behalf by the Board, to
recover from the assessee the amount specified in the certificate by one or more of the
following modes, namely-
(a) attachment and sale, or sale without attachment, of any movable or immovable property
of the assessee;
(b) arrest of the assessee and his detention in prison;
(c) appointment of a receiver for the management of the movable and immovable
properties of the assessee.
b. While recovering under sub-section (1) the amount specified in the certificate
forwarded to him, the Tax Recovery Officer may also recover in the same manner from
the assessee in default, in addition to such amount, any cost and charges, including
expenses on the service of any notice or warrant, incurred in the proceedings for the
recovery of the tax in arrears.
c.
25.5
If the Tax Recovery Officer to whom a certificate is forwarded under section 138 is not
able to recover the entire amount by the sale of movable and immovable properties of
the assessee within his jurisdiction, but has information that the assessee has property
within the jurisdiction of another Tax Recovery Officer, he may send the certificate to
such other Tax Recovery officer or to the Tax Recovery Officer within whose
jurisdiction the assessee resides; and the Tax recovery Officer to whom the certificate
has been so sent shall proceed to recover under Chapter XVI the amount remaining unrecovered as if the certificate was forwarded to him by the Deputy Commissioner of
Taxes.
Notwithstanding the issue of a certificate for recovery under section 138, the Deputy
Commissioner of Taxes shall have power to withdraw, or correct any clerical or
arithmetical error in the certificate by sending an intimation to that effect to the Tax
Recovery Officer.
b. Where the order giving rise to a demand of tax for which a certificate for recovery has
been issued has been modified in appeal or other proceedings under this Ordinance and,
as a consequence thereof, the demand is reduced but the order is the subject matter of
further proceedings under this ordinance, the Deputy Commissioner of Taxes shall stay
the recovery of such part of the amount of the certificate as pertains to the said
reduction for the period for which the appeal or other proceedings remain pending.
c.
Where a certificate for recovery has been issued and subsequently the amount of
outstanding demand is reduced as a result of appeal or other proceedings under this
Ordinance, the Deputy Commissioner of Taxes shall, when the order, which was the
subject matter of such appeal or other proceeding, has become final and conclusive,
amend the certificate or withdraw it, as the case may be.
d. The Deputy Commissioner of Taxes shall communicate to the Tax Recovery Officer any
orders of cancellation, correction, stay of proceeding, withdrawal or amendment, as the
case may be, of a certificate for recovery.
25.6
25.7
The Deputy Commissioner of Taxes may forward to the Collector of District in which
the office of the Deputy Commissioner of Taxes is situate or the district in which the
assessee resides or owns property or carries on business or profession, a certificate
under his signature specifying the amount of arrears due from an assessee, and the
Collector, on receipts of such certificate, shall proceed to recover, from such assessee
the amount specified therein as if it were an arrear of land revenue.
b. Without prejudice to any other powers which the Collector of District may have in this
behalf, he shall, for the purposes of recovery of the amount specified if the certificate for
recovery forwarded to him under section 142(1), have the powers which a Civil Court
has under the Code of Civil Procedure, 1908, for the purposes of recovery of an
amount due under a decree.
c. The Deputy Commissioner of Taxes may, at any time, recall from the Collector of
District a certificate forwarded to him under section 142(1) and upon such recall, all
proceeding commenced in pursuance of the certificate shall abate. However, the recall
of a certificate shall not affect any recoveries made by the Collector before the recall as
if the certificate had not, to the extent of such recovery, been recalled; nor shall the
recall of a certificate issued at any time prevent the recovery, by issue of a fresh
certificate, of any amount which was recoverable at the time the certificate so recalled
was issued.
25.8
Without prejudice to the provisions of section 142, the Deputy Commissioner of Taxes
may forward to a Magistrate of the First Class, specially empowered in this behalf by the
Government, hereinafter referred to as the Special Magistrate, a certificate under his
signature specifying the amount of arrears due from the assessee, and the Special
Magistrate shall, on receipt of such certificate, proceed to recover from the assessee the
amount specified therein as if it were an arrear of land revenue and the Special
Magistrate were a Collector of District.
b. Without prejudice to any other powers of a Collector of District which the Special
Magistrate may have in this behalf, he shall, for the purposes of recovery of the amount
specified in the certificate for recovery forwarded to him under section 142A(1), have
the powers which a Civil Court has under the Code of Civil Procedure, 1908, for the
purposes of recovery of an amount due under a decree.
c.
25.9
The Deputy Commissioner of Taxes may, at any time, recall from the Special Magistrate
a certificate forwarded to him under section 142A(1) and upon such recall, all
proceedings commenced in pursuance of the certificate shall abate. However, the recall
of a certificate shall not affect any recoveries made by the Special Magistrate before the
recall as if the certificate had not, to the extent of such recovery, been recalled; nor shall
the recall of a certificate issued at any time prevent the recovery, by issue of a fresh
certificate of any amount which was recoverable at the time the certificate so recalled
was issued.
Notwithstanding the issue of a certificate for recovery of tax under section 138 or
section 142, the Deputy Commissioner of Taxes may also recover the tax in the manner
provided in section 143(1A) or (2).
(1A)For the purpose of recovery of tax payable by an assessee which is not disputed in appeal to
any appellate forum, the Deputy Commissioner of Taxes may, with the previous approval of the
Commissioner, after giving the assessee an opportunity of being heard, stop movement of any
goods and services from the business premises of such assessee and also shutdown such business
premises till the recovery of the tax referred to above or any satisfactory arrangement has been
made for the recovery of such tax.
b. For the purposes of recovery of any tax payable by an assessee, the Deputy
Commissioner of Taxes may, by notice in writing, require any person
i. from whom any money or goods is due or may become due to the assessee, or who
holds, or controls the receipt or disposal of, or may subsequently hold, or control the
receipt or disposal of, any money or goods belonging to, or on account of, the assessee,
to pay to the Deputy Commissioner of Taxes the sum specified in the notice on or
before the date specified therein for such payment; or
ii. who is responsible for payment of any sum to the assessee classifiable as income of the
assessee under the head Salaries, to deduct from any payment subsequent to the date
of the notice, any arrear of tax due from the assessee, and to pay the sum so deducted
to the credit of the Government.
c.
A person who has paid any sum as required by section 143(2)(a) shall be deemed to
have paid such sum under the authority of the assessee and the receipt by the Deputy
Commissioner of Taxes shall constitute a good and sufficient discharge of the liability of
such person to the assessee to the extent of the sum specified in the receipt.
d. A person who has deducted any sum as required by section 143(2)(b) shall be deemed
to have deducted the tax under section 50 and the relevant provisions of Chapter VII
shall apply accordingly.
e.
If the person to whom a notice under section 143(2) is sent fails to make payment or to
make deductions in pursuance of the notice, he shall be deemed to be an assessee in
default in respect of the amount specified in the notice and proceedings may be taken
against him for realization of the amount as if it were an arrear of tax due from him; and
the provisions of this Chapter shall apply accordingly.
f.
The Deputy Commissioner of Taxes may at any time amend or revoke any notice issued
under section 143(2) or extend the time for making any payment in pursuance of such
notice.
g.
In any area with respect to which the Commissioner has directed that any arrears may
be recovered by any process enforceable for the recovery of an arrear of any municipal
tax or local rate imposed under any enactment for the time being in force in any part of
Bangladesh, the Deputy Commissioner of Taxes may proceed to recover the amount
due by such process.
h. The Commissioner may direct by what authority any powers or duties incident under
any such enactment as aforesaid to the enforcement of any process for the recovery of a
municipal tax or local rate shall be exercised or performed when that process is
employed under section 143(7).
Explanation: For the removal of doubts, it is hereby clarified that the several modes of
recovery specified in Chapter XVI are neither mutually exclusive nor affect in any way any other
law for the time being in force relating to the recovery of debts due to Government, and it shall
be lawful for the Deputy Commissioner of Taxes, if for any special reasons to be recorded by
him, to have recourse to any such mode of recovery notwithstanding that the tax due is being
recovered from an assessee by any other mode.
25.10
Self-Assessment Questions
Discuss briefly the salient features of the various provisions of the Income-tax Ordinance, 1984
relating to recovery of tax by the Tax Authorities.
Chapter 26
Double Taxation Relief
Contents
Introduction
Examination context
Topic List
26.1 Double Taxation Some Basic Concepts
26.2
26.3
26.4
26.5
Tax Treaty
26.6
Introduction
Learning objectives
Practical significance
The Government of Bangladesh may enter into an agreement with the Government of any other
country for the avoidance of double taxation and the prevention of fiscal evasion with respect to
income taxes. The agreement can provide some provisions for implementation such as relief
from the tax payable, recovery of tax leviable under the Ordinance and under the corresponding
law in force in that country etc.
If any person who is resident in Bangladesh in any year proves that he has paid tax on any income
for any income year outside Bangladesh in any country with which there is no reciprocal
agreement for relief or avoidance of double taxation, tax shall be deducted from the tax payable
by him under the Ordinance, a sum equal to the tax calculated on such doubly taxed income at
the average rate of tax of Bangladesh or the average rate of tax of the said country, whichever is
the lower.
Stop and think
Do you realize the impact of agreement to avoid double taxation? Do you know the list of
countries with whom Bangladesh has agreement to avoid double taxation? Do you know about
the relief in respect of income arising outside Bangladesh?
Working context
Accountant can help their clients by giving advice with procedures to avoid double taxation. They
should have the updated knowledge on various agreements for avoidance of double taxation with
different countries. Based on the provisions of these agreements they can support their clients in
this regard.
Syllabus links
You will be using this knowledge again when you tackle the Taxation paper later on in the
Professional Stage and it will also underpin the technical aspects at the Advanced Stage.
Examination context
Exam requirements
In the examination, candidates may be required to:
Question practice
For question practice on these topics go to the suggested answers covering this chapter.
26.0
26.1
Article
Heading
1.
Scope of the convention
2.
Taxes covered
3.
General definitions
Main Contents
To whom applicable
Specific taxes covered
Person, company, enterprise, international traffic,
competent authority
Article
Heading
Main Contents
Resident of a contracting state who can access the
treaty
What constitutes /does not constitute PE
4.
Resident
5.
6.
7.
Business profits
8.
9.
Associated enterprises
10.
Dividends
II.
Interest
12.
Royalties
13.
Capital gains
14.
15.
16.
17.
18.
19.
20.
21.
Other income
22.
24.
Non-discrimination
25.
26.
Exchange of information
27.
28.
29.
Termination of treaty
Besides the above clauses, DTAAs normally contain a Protocol or Memorandum, which is like a
supplement to the Treaty. This is attached normally at the end of the Treaty, which clarifies
borderline issues, and also rectifies unintended omissions.
The other model, OECD model, is mostly followed amongst 29 OECD countries. The
fundamental difference between these two is essentially one; UN model is based on taxing the
income on source principle where as OECD model is on resident principle. Since FDI flows from
developed to developing countries, the latter tends to benefit the developed countries.
What impact double taxation in general, would have on global economic activities?
a)
It
hampers free flow of capital and technology across borders and
b)
It
becomes a prohibitive burden on concerned taxpayers leading to decline in foreign
investments.
What are the effects of Double Tax Avoidance Agreements (DTAA) in Bangladesh?
The effects of an agreement entered into by virtue of section 144 of Income Tax ordinance 1984
would be:
(i)
if no
tax liability is imposed under the Ordinance, the question of resorting to DTAA would not
arise. No provision of DTAA can possibly fasten a tax liability which is not imposed by the
Ordinance. The treaties with all intent and purpose, can lessen the vigor of double taxation
cannot however, enhance it.
(ii)
In
case of a difference in the provisions of the Ordinance and those of the DTAA, to the extent
they are more beneficial to the provisions of the Ordinance, will override the ordinance
which is the fundamental concept in treaty override.
What are the differences between double tax relief and double tax avoidance?
Double tax relief means granting of relief in respect of income on which income tax has been
paid under the Bangladesh tax laws and also in other country.
Double taxation avoidance means avoidance of double taxation of income under the tax laws of
the two countries. One important distinction between the two is that in the case of avoidance of
double taxation the assesee does not have to pay the tax first to claim refund later but he would
be obliged to do so in the case of relief against double taxation. The other distinction is that no
benefit is given unless otherwise stipulated in the DTAA but relief can be awarded unilaterally
against double tax even when there exists no DTAA. Section 145 of Bangladesh Income Tax
Ordinance 1984 empowers the DCT to grant such relief.
Firstly, as per section 144 of Income Tax Ordinance 1984, where Bangladesh Govt. has entered
into any DTAA, the provisions of that agreement would normally apply to the case of an
assessee covered by such agreement. However if the relevant provisions in the Bangladesh
Income Tax Ordinance are more favourable, then to that extent he can seek applications of the
provisions of the Ordinance as against those of the agreement.
26.2
Income tax policy section of NBR is entrusted to negotiating the Double Taxation Agreement
(DTA) with foreign countries to promote foreign direct investment in Bangladesh. DTA is an
agreement between two countries seeking to avoid double taxation by defining the taxing rights
of each country with regard to cross border flows of income, providing for tax credits or
exemptions to eliminate double taxation.
At present, Government of Bangladesh has entered into Double Taxation Avoidance Agreement
(DTAA) with 32 countries as stated below:
Sl.
SRO
Name of the
No.
Date
[assessment year
commencing on or after]
1. United Kingdom of
Great Britain and
Northern Ireland
227-L/80
08/07/1980
01/07/1978
2. Singapore
124-L/82
21/04/1982
01/01/1980
3. Sweden
382-L/83
19/10/1983
01/07/1984
4. Republic of Korea
433-L/84
02/10/1984
01/07/1984
5. Canada
247-L/85
06/06/1985
01/07/1982
6. Pakistan
221-L/88
11/07/1988
01/01/1980
7. Romania
348-L/88
23/11/1988
01/07/1989
8. Sri Lanka
365-L/88
10/12/1988
01/07/1989
9. France
2-L/89
04/01/1989
01/07/1989
10 Malaysia
67-L/90
15/02/1990
01/01/1982
1 Japan
235-L/91
06/08/1991
01/07/1992
12 India
45-L/93
27/02/1993
01/07/1993
13 Germany
1-L/94
01/01/1994
01/01/1990
14 The Netherlands
267-L/94
14/09/1994
01/07/1995
15 Italy
63-L/97
12/03/1997
01/07/1980
16 Denmark
72-L/97
17/03/1997
01/07/1997
17 China
114-L/97
13/05/1997
01/07/1998
18 Belgium
11-L/98
14/01/1998
01/07/1998
19 Thailand
222-L/98
07/09/1998
01/07/1999
20 Poland
39/L/99
03/03/1999
01/07/2000
2 Philippines
56-L/2004
04-03-2004
01-07-2004
22 Vietnam
301-L/2004
18-10-2004
01-07-2005
23 Turkey
308-L/2005
31-10-2005
01-07-2005
24 Norway
20- L/2006
12-02-2006
01-07-2006
25 USA
71-L/2007
10-05-2007
01-07-2007
26 Indonesia
60-L/2007
26-04-2007
01-07-2007
10-12-2007
01-07-2010
Country
27 Switzerland
28 Oman
26.3
16-L/2009
02-02-2009
01-07-2009
29 Mauritius
21-12-2009
01-07-2010
30 Myanmar
07-10-2008
01-07-2011
3 Saudy Arabia
04-01-2011
01-07-2011
32 UAE
17-01-2011
01-07-2011
26.4
Income
Arises from those
countries with whom
there is DTAA
Section
Avoidance
of Double
Taxation
Section 145
Relief
Tax advantages
Tax calculated as per the rate in the
agreement, but it will not be more than
the tax amount calculated on the basis of
the average tax rate applicable in
Bangladesh (considering foreign income
in total income) on the foreign income.
Tax calculated on such doubly taxed
income at the average rate of tax of
Bangladesh or the average rate of tax of
the said country, whichever is lower.
Illustration 1:
Mr. Nazim, a Bangladeshi resident, received interest income of Tk. 450,000 from Indonesia after
deduction of 10% of tax at source during the year ending on 30 June, 2011. His other income in
Bangladesh amounts to Tk. 300,000 for the same year. Compute the net tax liability of Mr.
Nazim.
Mr. Nazim
Assessment year: 2011-2012
Heads of Income
Income from Bangladesh sources
Foreign income (Tk. 450,000/1-0.1)
Total taxable income
Amount (Tk.)
300,000
500,000
800,000
Tk. 180,000
300,000
320,000
Tk. 800,000
Rate
Nil
10%
15%
Amount (Tk.)
Nil
30,000
48,000
78,000
Thus, the average tax rate in Bangladesh is 9.75% (Tk. 78,000 / Tk. 800,000 100). So, the
maximum limit of tax credit will be Tk. 48,750 (Tk. 500,000 9.75%) though he already paid Tk.
50,000 tax in Indonesia. Mr. Nazim will have to pay Tk. 29,250 (Tk. 78,000 Tk. 48,750) as
remaining tax in Bangladesh.
Illustration 2:
Mrs. Asma Jahan records the income for the income year 2010 - 11 as income from Bangladesh
Tk. 2,000,000; income from Sweden Tk. 600,000; income from Singapore Tk. 400,000; and
income from Russia Tk. 1,000,000. The income tax rate for foreigners in Sweden is 30%, but he
has paid tax @ 25% as per DTA. 20% tax has been paid in Russia for the income generated in
Russia and 25% tax has been paid in Singapore for the income generated in Singapore. Show the
application of double taxation relief due to these foreign incomes for the assessment year 2011 12.
Mrs. Asma Jahan
Computation of total income
Particulars
1. Income from Bangladesh
2. Income from Sweden
3. Income from Russia
4. Income from Singapore
Tk.
Total Income
Tk.
2,000,000
600,000
1,000,000
400,000
4,000,000
Rate.
0%
10%
15%
20%
25%
Tk.
30,000
60,000
60,000
7,00,000
8,50,000
4,12,500
4,37,500
Notes:
26.5
Unil
ateral relief
(ii)
Bilat
eral relief
(iii)
Mult
ilateral relief
(iv)
Non
-tax treaties
Unilateral relief
Under this system whether the income is subject to tax abroad or not is immaterial, relief is
given by way of tax credit for the tax paid abroad.
Under Section 145 of the Income Tax Ordinance 1984, tax credit method is followed. A resident
in Bangladesh who has paid income tax in any country with which Bangladesh does not have a
treaty for the relief or avoidance of double taxation is allowed credit against his Bangladesh
income tax for an amount equal to Bangladesh coverage rate i.e. average rate or the foreign rate
whichever is lower, applied to the doubly taxed income. This is done as follows:
a.
Wh
ere the foreign tax is equal to Bangladesh tax, full amount of foreign tax will be given credit.
b.
Wh
ere the foreign tax exceeds the Bangladesh tax, the liability to Bangladesh tax is nil.
However, no refund in respect of the excess amount is allowed.
c.
Wh
ere foreign tax is less than Bangladesh tax, the difference would be payable by the taxpayer.
The basic principle to remember is that credit/relief will never exceed the Bangladesh income tax
on the concerned income calculated at average rate.
Bilateral relief
It may take one of the following two forms:
Firstly, the treaty may apply exempting method, the country in question refraining from
exercising jurisdiction to tax a particular income.
For instance, the country of source where PE is located is assigned an exclusive jurisdiction to
tax the profits of the establishment. In turn it may agree to refrain from exercising its jurisdiction
to tax the owner of these profits.
Alternatively, the treaty may provide relief from double taxation by redacting the tax ordinarily
due in one or both of the contracting states on that income which is subject to double taxation.
For instance, the country, which is the source of a dividend, often agrees to reduce the
withholding rate normally applicable to dividends paid to non-resident and the country of
residence agrees to give tax credit or similar relief for the tax paid in the source country. In such
a case, both the countries exercise the rights to jurisdiction, while mutually agreeing for
adjustments, many DTAAs combine both the methods of relief.
Multilateral treaties
These are similar to bilateral treaties achieved through agreement between many countries i.e.
EEC.
Non-tax treaties
These are not direct treaties of tax but are of friendship, co-operation cultural exchange, political
and diplomatic relations, but which consequently may reflect upon tax matters.
26.6
Tax Treaty
What is a tax treaty and how does it work?
Treaty as commonly understood is a formally concluded and ratified agreement between
independent nations. Tax treaties are generally a matter of bargain and prolonged negotiations
centering on economic interests of the countries involved.
What is the scope of tax treaties in determining jurisdiction?
Normally tax treaty between two countries covers(i) Persons (ii) Taxes (iii) Territory (iv) Time
The treaty, generally applies to residents of the contracting states. Each country retains the
power to tax its citizens and residents on their total world income (Status jurisdiction) and tax
others, non citizens, non-residents only on their income in the country (Source jurisdiction).
However, the treaty provisions protect the taxpayer from suffering double taxation on the same
income.
How does a treaty become law?
The agreement entered into becomes a part of domestic law only when it has sanction of the
constitutions of the nations which are parties to it. The power to legislate is conferred on our
Parliament and therefore, the Government has authority to enter into DTAA. However, all
treaties are also required to be formally approved by official gazette notification.
26.7
Tax Havens
Tax haven nations are those with nil or moderate level of taxation and/or offering liberal tax
incentives for export activities, shipping business. These tax havens attract investments as the
corporate tax rate is low. They may also exempt dividends and capital gains on the transfer or
exchange of movable assets like shares and sometime immovable properties like land, building,
plants etc. Besides tax haven countries may also pursue absolute secrecy and easy exchange
control policies to attract offshore investors.
There are two types of tax haven
1. Nil tax haven
2. Nil tax outside haven countries
Treaty shopping
Just as the domestic law can, sometimes, be used more than fairly to the advantage of a taxpayer,
the DTAA too can be exploited through popularly known means of Treaty Shopping. A nonresident seeking shelter under a DTAA is still open to domestic assessment when the tax
authorities feel that, he is taking an undue advantage of provisions of the DTAA or has
structured the commercial arrangement in such a way so as to avail the DTAA benefit otherwise
not available to him. The authorities may then deny the benefits of the DTAA. The most
common form of Treaty Shopping is setting up of a dummy enterprise. This is set up by say,
Company A, in one of the Contracting States, to avail DTAA benefits, which the company, not
being a resident of either Contracting States, would otherwise not be entitled to. In such a case,
the Court can lift the corporate veil.
Attribution Rule
The basic requirement to bring the business profits to tax they should be capable of being
attributable to the Permanent Establishment (PE) or residency. The question to be asked is the
enterprise trading with the country on a regular basis? If yes, what is the nature of establishment
in Bangladesh? If the income arises out of the business activity carried on in that state and if it can
be attributed to the PE, it can be taxed in that extent of attribution. Certain established and
accepted rules are to be followed in the determination of such income. Generally the expenses
that can or cannot be considered will depend upon the taxation laws of each state.
Force of attraction rule
It means all income arising from all source in a country where the foreign enterprise maintains a
PE is subject to tax in that country irrespective of whether the said income is attributable to the
PE or not. Therefore, profits arising from transactions outside PE are also taxable. As per this
rule not only the profits attributable to the sale of same or similar kind of goods is brought to
tax and any other income from sources within the country are also regarded income attributable
to the PE.
Students should carefully note the following main objectives of Double Taxation
Agreement:
a) Any income earned by a resident of a contracting state in the other contracting state cannot
escape from tax assessment in both the contracting states.
b) Any income earned by a resident of a contracting state in the other contracting state cannot
be taxed in the both the contracting states.
Chapter 27
Refunds
Contents
Introduction
Examination context
Topic List
27.1
27.2
Entitlement to refund
27.3
27.4
27.5
27.6
27.7
27.8
Introduction
Learning objectives
Practical significance
When any amount of tax is refundable by tax law the DCT shall issue refund voucher unless such
return is set off against tax. The refund shall be entitled when the amount of tax paid exceeds the
properly chargeable tax or when income of one person included in income of another person.
Where through death, incapacity, insolvency, liquidation or other cause, a person, is unable to
claim or receive any refund due to him, the legal representative shall be entitled that refund. In
case of refund on the basis of orders in appeal, the amount is payable within 30 days. Interest is
also payable if there is delay in payment of refund more than 2 months from the claim of refund.
In certain cases the refundable amount can be adjusted against tax.
Stop and think
Excess payment of tax is refundable or adjustable against tax. Do you realize that refundable tax
can be received or adjusted even in some cases with interest?
Working context
Excess payment of tax by a taxpayer may be incurred in many ways. Refund of such tax is a legal
right for that taxpayer. Accountants support to calculate and claim the refundable tax on behalf
and in favour of the clients that is sometime very essential.
Detailed knowledge on the refund procedures can help accountants to provide this service to
their clients.
Syllabus links
You will be using this knowledge again when you tackle the Taxation paper later on in the
Professional Stage and it will also underpin the technical aspects at the Advanced Stage.
Examination context
Exam requirements
In the examination, candidates may be required to:
Question practice
For question practice on these topics go to the suggested answers covering this chapter.
Examiner's comments on how students tackle questions
Candidates have historically prepared well for this area of the syllabus. Better prepared
candidates are able to perform well in the more difficult areas.
27.0
REFUNDS
Section Overview
DCT shall issue refund voucher when any amount of tax is refundable unless such return is
set off against tax.
Legal representative of an unable person shall be entitled for refund.
Refund on the basis of orders in appeal is payable within 30 days of such order.
Interest is also payable in case of delay in payment of refund for more than 2 months @
7.5%.
Refundable amount can be adjusted against tax.
27.1
27.2
27.3
27.4
or to ask for a review of the same, and the claimant shall not be entitled to any relief on any such
issue raised except refund of the tax paid in excess.
27.5
27.6
27.7
27.8
Question
A refund of tax becomes due to an assessee on reduction of total income in appeal filed by him, but the
Deputy Commissioner of Taxes does not take any action to make the refund. What are the remedies
open to the assessee? (PE I Session May June 2001)
Answer
1.
The aggrieved assessee can file appeal to the Appellate Joint Commissioner of Taxes or the
Commissioner (Appeals) against the refusal of the Deputy Commissioner of Taxes to make the
refund.
2.
The assessee can apply to the Deputy Commissioner of Taxes to adjust the refundable amount
against his arrear tax demand, if any, u/s 152 of the Income Tax ordinance 1984.
3.
The assessee can take administrative action, such as, applying to the Commissioner of Taxes
requesting him to direct the Deputy Commissioner of Taxes to make the refund.
4.
The assessee can apply to the National Board of Revenue, requesting to direct the concerned
Commissioner of Taxes for taking necessary measures to make available the refund.
Chapter 28
Appeal and Reference
Contents
Introduction
Examination context
Topic List
28.1
First Appeal
28.2
28.3
Second Appeal
28.4
28.5
28.6
Introduction
Learning objectives
Identify the conditions and procedures for different appeal and references.
Mention the different orders of tax authorities for which an assessee may be aggrieved.
Define various appeals to the different tax authorities in different situations.
Identify the decisions or results of appeal come from different stages of tax authorities.
Practical significance
An assessee not being a company or an assessee being a company in respect of certain cases
aggrieved by any order of a DCT or IJC can appeal to the AJC or the Commissioner (Appeal)
against such order. Appeal can also be made to the AJC against the order of tax recovery officer.
An assessee may appeal to the Appellate Tribunal if he is aggrieved by an order of an AJC or the
Commissioner (Appeal) in respect of concealment of income or decision in appeal by them. The
Appellate Tribunal may, after giving both the parties to the appeal an opportunity of being heard,
pass such orders on the appeal as it thinks fit. The Appellate Tribunal may dispose the appeal if
the appellant does not appear when the appeal is called for hearing. The assessee or the
Commissioner may refer any question of law arising out of the order of the Appellate Tribunal
communicated to him to High Court Division. The High Court Division shall pass such orders as
are necessary to dispose of the case in conformity with the judgement delivered by it.
For the appeal and reference, the appellant need to comply some conditions and maintain some
procedures to make his appeal valid.
Stop and think
The aggrieved parties in certain cases can appeal to the different tax authorities. Do you think
that the appeal and reference procedures are enough to get the proper judgment by the
aggrieved parties under the Ordinance?
Working context
The appeal and reference procedure under tax law is the most complex and risky area for the
aggrieved parties. The assessee being a client is sometime very much required the service from
an accountant. Accountants being tax expert can provide the practical and useful advice and
service to their clients in such cases.
Detailed and reasonable knowledge on appeal and reference can help accountants to provide
practical service to their clients in this regard.
Syllabus links
You will be using this knowledge again when you tackle the Taxation paper later on in the
Professional Stage and it will also underpin the technical aspects at the Advanced Stage.
Examination context
Exam requirements
In the examination, candidates may be required to:
Identify the conditions for appeal made by assessee against order of DCT.
Recognise the procedures of appeal before AJC or the Commissioner.
Demonstrate the decision in appeal by the AJC on/or the Commissioner.
Identify the appeal against order of Tax Recovery Officer
Define the appeal to the Appellate Tribunal.
Identify the disposal of appeal by the Appellate Tribunal.
Define the reference to the High Court Division.
Mention the decision of the High Court Division.
Identify the appeal to the appellate division
Question practice
For question practice on these topics go to the suggested answers covering this chapter.
Examiner's comments on how students tackle questions
Candidates have historically prepared well for this area of the syllabus. Better prepared
candidates are able to perform well in the more difficult areas.
28.0
28.1
Problem
Can the first appellate authority dismiss an appeal for non-appearance of the appellant on the
hearing date of appeal?
Answer
The first appellate authority is not empowered to dismiss an appeal for having the appellant
absent on the appeal hearing date. The appellate authority should pass an appellate order on
merit after examination of the assessment records made available by the concerned Deputy
Commissioner of Taxes.
28.2
28.3
28.4
Reference application to the Supreme Court: Sec. 160, 161 and 162
The assessee or the Commissioner may within ninety days from the date of receipt of the order
of the appellate Tribunal refer to the High Court Division in the prescribed form and manner,
question of law arising out of the order of the tribunal. Provided that no reference by an
assessee shall be entertained unless the assessee has paid the following tax at the rate ofa.
twenty five per cent of the difference between the tax as determined on the basis of the
order of the Taxes Appellate Tribunal and the tax payable under section 74 where tax
demand does not exceed one million taka;
b. fifty per cent of the difference between the tax as determined on the basis of the order of
the Taxes Appellate Tribunal and the tax payable under section 74 where tax demand
exceeds one million taka.
Provided that the Board may, on an application made in this behalf, modify or waive, in any case,
the requirement of such payment.
An appeal shall lie to the Appellate division from a judgment of the High Court Division if the
High Court certifies the order to be fit for appeal to the Appellate Division.
Provision of the Code of Civil Procedure, 1908 relating to the appeals to the Appellate Division
shall so far as may be, apply in regard to the appeals under Section 162 in the like manner as they
apply in the case of appeals from decrees of the High Court Division.
28.5
Inspecting Joint
Commissioner
Appellate Joint
Commissioner or the
Commissioner (Appeals)
the Appellate Tribunal
28.6
Appeal by
Appeal to
Time limit
Inspecting Joint
Commissioner
Within 30
days
Appellate Joint
Commissioner
Appellate Joint
Commissioner
Commissioner
(Appeals)
Commissioner
(Appeals)
Appellate
Tribunal
Within 45
days
Within 45
days
Within 45
days
Within 45
days
Within 60
days
High Court
Division (for
reference only)
Within 90
days
An assessee may also file revision petition before the Commissioner of Taxes within sixty days of
receipt of Order of the Deputy Commissioner of Taxes on payment of fees of taka 200 along
with payment of admitted liability. Revision petition will be deemed to have been allowed the
commissioner fails to make an order within sixty days from the date of filing the application for
revision.
Self-Assessment Questions
(a) What are the various Income Tax Appellate Authorities under I. T. Ordinance 1984?
(b) What are the time limits and relaxation thereof, if any, in respect of the following matters under the
I. T. Ordinance 1984:
i)
Filing of appeal to the Appellate Additional Joint Commissioner of Taxes u/s. 153;
Chapter 29
Miscellaneous
Contents
Introduction
Examination context
Topic List
1.16
Protection of Information
1.17
1.18
1.19
Introduction
Learning objectives
Understand protection of information and relevant provisions
Identify different types of offences and prosecutions to that
Specify different fiscal and other incentives given to foreign investors
Mention different sections where time limitation is proposed
Practical significance
This is a chapter that includes some important issues of income tax laws in the country. As due
to the assessment procedures, income tax authorities at different levels possess valuable
information of corporate houses and different individuals. In certain cases, the assessees expect
that the information will be protected and IT Ordinance prescribes different provisions related
to such protection of information.
Bangladesh government offers different fiscal and other incentives to foreign investors to attract
foreign investment in the country. It is important for economic development of the country and
to establish congenial environment for investment.
Another important coverage of the chapter is offences and prosecutions. Different types of
offences are identified with its ultimate prosecutions. Professional accountants should be very
expert in these areas to save their client from prosecutions.
At the end, it includes a summary of different sections of IT ordinance where different time
limitations are specified. These are very important in a sense that failure to abide by the time
frames in different sections may lead to non-compliance, even sometimes the assessee may be
considered as assessee in default.
Stop and think
Protection of information is a right to assessee. Foreign investors in Bangladesh enjoy fiscal and other
incentives. Punishable offences are subject to defined prosecutions. It is likely that you know all the
sections where a time frame is proposed. Have you stopped to think about how this affects the
actions that you take?
Working context
Professional accountants practice tax on behalf of their clients where protection of information is
important. They should also know different incentives available to foreign investors to attract
foreign investment in the country. Professional accountants should know different punishable
offences and limited time from to save their clients from possible trouble.
Syllabus links
The topics covered in this chapter are essential background knowledge which will underpin the
whole of your Taxation studies.
Examination context
Exam requirements
In the examination, candidates may be required to:
Question practice
For question practice on these topics go to the suggested questions and answers covering the
basic idea about taxation.
29.0
MISCELLANEOUS
Section overview
Specified statements, return, documents, any evidence and record should be protected.
Foreign investors enjoys fiscal and other incentives like tax holiday, accelerated depreciation,
double tax avoidance etc. to encourage them to invest in Bangladesh.
Some offences are punishable.
IT Ordinance prescribes time limit in different sections where compliance is important.
29.1
Protection of Information
As per section 163 (1) of Income Tax Ordinance, all particulars or information contained in the
following shall be confidential and shall not be disclosed:
a) any statement made, return furnished or accounts or documents produced under the
provisions of this Ordinance;
b) any evidence given, or affidavit or deposition made, in the course of any proceedings under
this Ordinance other than proceedings under Chapter XXI (Offences and Prosecution);
c) any record of any assessment proceedings or any proceeding relating to the recovery of
demand under this Ordinance.
However, the disclosure of following information in defined cases and purposes is not considered
confidential as per section 163(3):
a) any particulars in, or in respect of any statement, return, accounts, documents, evidence,
affidavit or deposition required for the purposes of prosecution of an offence under this
Ordinance, the Penal Code (XLV of 1860), or the Foreign Exchange Regulation Act, 1947
(VII of 1947);
b) any particulars or information which is necessary for the purposes of this Ordinance to any
person acting in the execution of this Ordinance, or of any particulars to any person being an
expert whose services have been placed at the disposal of the Government by any
international organization of which Bangladesh is a member;
c) any particulars or information which is occasioned by the lawful employment under this
Ordinance of any process for the service of any notice or the recovery of any demand;
d) any particulars of the amount due from an assessee under this Ordinance by the Board or
any officer authorised by it, or by the Commissioner, to any department of the Government,
local authority, bank, corporation or other organisation for the purpose of the recovery of
any demand;
e) any particulars to a Civil Court in any suit which relates to any matter arising out of any
proceeding under this Ordinance and to which Government is a party;
f)
any particulars to the Controller and Auditor-General of Bangladesh for the purpose of
enabling him to discharge his functions under the Constitution;
g) any particulars to any officer appointed by the Controller and Auditor-General of Bangladesh
or the Board for the purpose of auditing tax receipts or refunds;
h) any particulars relevant to any inquiry into the conduct of any official of the income tax
department to any person appointed to hold such inquiry or to a Public Service Commission
established under the Constitution when exercising its functions in relation to any matter
arising out of any such inquiry;
i)
any particulars relevant to any inquiry into a charge of misconduct in connection with
income tax proceedings against a lawyer, a chartered accountant or a cost and management
accountant to any authority empowered to take disciplinary action against such lawyer,
chartered accountant or cost and management accountant;
j)
any particulars by a public servant where the disclosure is occasioned by the lawful exercise
by him of the powers under the Stamp Act, 1899 (II of 1899), to impound an insufficiently
stamped document;
k) any facts to an authorised officer of the Government of any country outside Bangladesh with
which the Government of the People's Republic of Bangladesh has entered into an
agreement for the avoidance of double taxation and the prevention of fiscal evasion where
such disclosure is required under the terms of the agreement;
l)
any such facts to any officer to the Government as may be necessary for the purpose of
enabling the Government to levy or realise any tax imposed by it;
m) any such facts to any authority exercising power under the Excise and Salt Act, 1944 (I of
1944), the Gift-tax Act, 1963 (XIV of 1963), the Wealth-tax Act, 1963 (XV of 1963), the
Customs Act, 1969 (IV of 1969), the Sales Tax Ordinance, 1982, (XVill of 1982) or as may
be necessary for the purpose of enabling it duly to exercise such powers;
n) So much of any such particulars, to the appropriate authority as may be necessary to
establish whether a person has or has not been assessed to income tax in any particular year
or years, where, under the provisions of any law for the time being in force, such fact is
required to be established;
o) Any such particulars to the Bangladesh Bank as are required by that Bank to enable it to
discharge its functions under the foreign exchange control laws or to compile financial
statistics of international investments and balance of payments;
p) Any such information as may be required by any officer or department of the Government
for the purpose of investigation into the conduct and affairs of a public servant;
q) Any such particulars as may be required by any order made under section 19(2) of the
Foreign Exchange Regulation Act, 1947 (VII of 1947); or
r) A list of higher tax-payers in accordance with rules made in this behalf.
29.2
Punishment for
non-compliance of certain
obligations
false statement in
verification
Sec
165A
Sec
165B
Sec
166
Sec
167
Sec
168
disposal of property to
prevent attachment
disclosure of protected
information
Punishment
with imprisonment for a term which may extend to one year,
or with fine, or with both
with imprisonment for a term which may extend to three
years, but shall not be less than three months, or with fine, or
with both
with imprisonment for a term which may extend to three
years or with fine up to taka fifty thousand or both
with imprisonment for a term not exceeding one year, or
with a fine, or with both
with imprisonment which may extend to five years, but shall
not be less than three months, or with fine, or with both
with imprisonment for a term which may extend to five
years, or with fine, or with both
with imprisonment for a term which may extend to six
months, or with fine
29.3
of
Bangladesh export
Processing Zones
Authority (BEPZA)
29.4
Fiscal Incentives
Tax holiday
Other Incentives
100% Foreign Equity allowed
Accelerated
Depreciation
allowance
Concessionary income tax in lieu
of Tax holiday and accelerated
Depreciation allowance
Concessionary duty on imported
machinery
Avoidance of Double taxation in
selective countries
Additional Tax
payable by listed
companies
Non-payment of
Bank Interest within
3 years
Particulars
An individual is to be treated as resident assessee if he has
been in Bangladesh for:
Either 182 days or more in the income year or
90 days or more in the income year + 365 days or more
during 4 years preceding the income year
Where a public limited company, not being a banking or
insurance company, listed with any stock exchange In
Bangladesh, has not issued, declared or distributed dividend
or bonus share equivalent to at least 15% of its paid up
capital to its share holders within a period of 6 months
immediately following any income year, the company shall
be charged additional tax at the rate of 5% on the
undistributed profit in addition to income tax.
If any bank interest was not paid within 3 years after expiry
of the income year, to such extent as it remains unpaid,
shall be deemed to be business income of the assessee
during the income year immediately following the expiry of
the said 3 years.
Provided that where any interest or share of profit is paid in a
subsequent year, the amount so paid shall be deducted in
Ref
2(55)
16B
19(15)(aa)
Areas
Non-payment of
trading liability
within 3 years
Repayment of loan
within 3 years
Interest on
borrowed capital in
case of house
property income
Exemption of Capital
Gain In case of reinvestment for the
purpose of business
or profession
Carry forward of
loss
Re-investment of
40% tax holiday
income
Particulars
computing the income in respect of that year.
Trading liability or portion thereof as has not been paid
within 3 years of the expiration of the income year in
which deduction was made in respect of the liability, such
liability or portion, as the case may be, shall be deemed to
be the income of the assessee from business or profession
during the income year immediately following the expiry of
the said 3 years;
Provided that where a trading liability is paid in a subsequent
year, the amount so paid shall be deducted in computing the
income in respect of that year.
Where any sum, or aggregate of sums exceeding Tk.
50,000 is claimed or shown to have been received as loan
by an assessee during any income year from any person,
not being a banking company or a financial institution,
otherwise than by a crossed cheque drawn on a bank, and
has not been paid back in full within 3 years from the end
of the income year in which it is claimed or shown to have
been received, the said sum or part thereof which has not
been paid back, shall be deemed to be the income of the
assessee for the income year immediately following the
expiry of the said 3 years and be classifiable under the head
"Income from other sources":
Provided that where the loan referred to in this sub-section is
paid back in a subsequent income year, the amount so paid
shall be deducted in computing the income in respect of that
subsequent year.
Where the property has been constructed with borrowed
capital and no income under section 24 was earned from
that property during the period of such construction, the
interest payable during that period on such capital, in three
equal proportionate installments for subsequent first three
years for which Income is assessable from that property
Capital gain shall not be charged to tax where a new capital
asset for the same business is purchased within 1 year after
or before the date of transfer of the capital asset.
If business loss, loss In speculation business, loss under the
head Capital Gain, and loss under the head Agricultural
income cannot be wholly set-off during the year, the
amount of loss not so set-off shall be carried forward to
the next assessment year and so on for not more than 6
successive assessment years
If the undertaking is set-up in Dhaka and Chittagong divisions,
excluding the hill districts of Rangamati, Bandarban and
Khagrachari, for a period of 4 years beginning with the month
of commencement of commercial production or operation of
the said undertaking
30% of the tax holiday income is to be invested in the said
undertaking or in any new industrial undertakings during
the tax holiday period or within 1 year from the end of the
period and in addition to that another 10% is to be
Ref
19(15)(c)
19(21)
25(l)(gg)
32(5)
38, 39, 40
& 41
46A(1)(a)
&
46A(l)(b)
46A(2)(c)
Areas
Review of Tax
holiday decision
Carry forward of
loss during tax
holiday period
Consequence of
failure to deduct tax
Installments of
advance tax
Simple interest
payable by the Govt.
on excess payment
of advance tax
Simple interest
payable by the
assessee in
deficiency in
payment of advance
tax
Filing of the return
Particulars
invested in each year before the expiry of 3 months from
the end of the income year in the purchase of shares of a
listed companies.
Ref
46A(4)
46A(6)
57(1)(b)
66
72(2)
73(2)
75(2)(c) &
75(3)
Areas
Appeal effect
Particulars
However, the last date for the submission of return may be
extended by DCT up to 3 months at his own capacity and
further 3 months with the prior approval of IJCT.
The return as per notice U/S 77 (1) shall be filed within a
period of 21 days
While making assessment for a particular year DCT may
call for accounts/documents relating to any period being
earlier than 3 years prior to the income year
Assessment order U/S 82 is to be communicated within 30
days from date of assessment
Ref
77(2)
79
82
83(2)
84
89(2)
91(3)
93(3)
94
94(3)
Areas
Filing of return in
case of air transport
business
Retention of seized
asset
Finalization
of
assessment in case of
search and seizure
Time limitation for
passing order u/s
120
Refund on the basis
of appeal order
Interest on delayed
refund
Filing of appeal
Time within which
appeal order to be
communicated
Disposal of appeal
Filling of appeal to
the
appellate
Tribunal
Particulars
In case of non-resident air transport business, quarterly
return is to be filed to the DCT within 45 days from the
last day of each quarter of every financial year, that is to
say thirtieth day of September, the thirty-first day
December, the thirty-first day of March and the thirtieth
day of June, respectively
The seized books of accounts or other documents shall
not
be retained by the authorised officer for a period
exceeding
180 days from the date of the seizure unless for reasons
recorded in writing
After seizure on money, bullion, jewellery or other
valuable articles assessment is to be finalized within 90 days
of the seizure of the assets
No order shall be made U/S 120(1) after the expiry of 4
years from the date of the order sought to be revised
Ref
103A(2)
149
117(8)
118(2)
120(2)
151
154(2)
156(5)
156(6)
158(4)
159(4)
159(6)
160(1)
Areas
High Court Division
Correction of error
Correction of error
Application for
accelerated
depreciation to NBR
Particulars
90 days from the date of receipt of the order of the
Appellate Tribunal
Where any error is brought to the notice or the authority
concerned by the assessee and no amendment is made by
such authority within the financial year next following the
date in which the error is brought to its notice, the
amendment shall be deemed to have been made so as to
correct the error
No correction of error u/s 173(1) shall be made after the
expiration of 4 years from the date of the order south to
be amended
Application in the prescribed form for accelerated
depreciation allowance is to be submitted to NBR within 6
months from the end of the month of commencement of
commercial production or operation
The Board shall have to give its decision on application of
accelerated depreciation within 3 months from the date of
receipt of the application
Ref
173(3)
173(4)
3rd
Schedule
Para
7
A(2)(a)
3rd
Schedule
Para
7
A(3)
Chapter 30
Value Added Tax
Contents
Introduction
Examination context
Topic List
34.1 Introduction
34.2
34.3
34.4
VAT Registration
34.5
Imposition of VAT
34.6
34.7
34.8
VAT Payable
34.9
Introduction
Learning objectives
Practical significance
Value Added Tax (VAT) is an important source of financing to the Government of Bangladesh.
Every year, it comprises more than 30% of government tax revenue and thus the Government
heavily relies on Value Added Tax (VAT) for raising fund for running a big administration. Value
Added Tax (VAT) is the tax that is paid on the value added by the respective tax payer. VAT is
regulated by the Value Added Tax Act, 1991. Unless any exemption, VAT is chargeable and
payable on all goods and services imported, produced or rendered in Bangladesh at 15% except
on exports and re-imports on which tax is imposed at zero percent. Some person in some
cases required to register for the purposes of VAT by submitting application with some
documents. Determination of cost on which VAT will be computed is very important to VAT
practitioners. Method and time of payment of VAT need to be followed as per the Act. Various
books and documents are required to be maintained for VAT purposes. On certain services,
estimated value addition (truncated value) is instructed for determining VAT. In an economy like
Bangladesh where a significant portion of Government revenue comes from VAT, knowing VAT
with all technicalities is very significant. VAT Act also addresses required rules and provisions for
Turnover Tax and Supplementary Duty.
There are some differences between VAT and Turnover Tax. Turnover Tax is a tax on the
turnover of a manufacturer or producer of taxable goods or a provider of taxable services, as
the case may be, who is not required to register for the purposes of VAT. The rate of turnover
tax has now been re-fixed at 3% on turnover. There are some guidelines, rules and procedures
on Turnover relating to registration, payment, books and documents to be maintained and
penalties.
Input tax is VAT paid by a tax payer on his inputs. For claiming credit of input tax some
conditions are to be met.
Supplementary duty is an output tax, in addition to VAT, on luxuries, not essential and not
socially desirable goods and services. The rate of supplementary duty varies from 15% to 350%.
Stop and think
Think about other types of tax and VAT. Do you realize the significance of VAT, Turnover Tax,
Input Tax and Supplementary Duty?
Working context
The revenue collection through VAT is increasing sharply day by day. Turnover tax, input tax and
supplementary duty also have significance as sources for revenue to the Government. Different
methods, rules, conditions and procedures relating to VAT and other taxes are very important
to know.
Clients are sometime expecting the expert opinion in calculating and other legal procedures
relating to VAT and other taxes from accountants. Accountants should have clear concept with
practical exposure in this area so that they can take the opportunity to provide the service to
their clients.
Syllabus links
You will be using this knowledge again to underpin the technical aspects at the Advanced Stage.
Examination context
Exam requirements
In the examination, candidates may be required to:
h. Demonstrate the concept of VAT, supplementary duty and identify the application of tax
rate
i. Explain the registration procedures, method of computation of VAT payable, time of
payment of VAT and turnover tax
j. Mention the documents required for VAT administration
k. Identify the different schedule for VAT and supplementary duty
l. Identify the VAT authorities and its power and functions
m. Explain the consequences for non-compliance of VAT rules and regulation
Question practice
For question practice on these topics go to the suggested answers at the end of the manual
covering this chapter
Examiner's comments on how students tackle questions
Candidates need to be careful on different VAT bases and rates for computing VAT payable with
the respective dates of payments and the adjustments of VAT deducted/collected at sources with
VAT payable to compute the net amount.
30.0
30.1
Introduction
Value Added Tax (commonly known as VAT) is the tax on the value added by a tax payer. In an
economy where value addition is significant and value is added at different levels, Government
has sufficient rationality to impose such taxes. It is flexible for the authority to maximize revenue.
VAT is not a new tax; the excise duty on domestic production at the production stage and sales
tax on imports at the import stage are replaced by uniform VAT intended to be revenue neutral
with some exemptions of agricultural and service sectors and zero rating for exports while it was
introduced for the first time in Bangladesh with effect from 1 July 1991.
VAT is an important type of indirect tax where impact and incidence of taxes fall on different
persons. Any tax not borne by the person on whom it is initially imposed is an indirect tax. The
ultimate burden of VAT falls on final consumers as different persons have the mechanism to shift
the burden onto the shoulders of others. For example, the traders, on whom VAT is charged,
transfer the tax burden to subsequent traders until the goods reach the final buyers or
customers who cannot shift the incidence or burden to anyone else. VAT is levied on
expenditure rather than on income as done under direct tax system.
In Bangladesh, VAT is still regulated by the Value Added Tax Act, 1991(hereinafter referred to as
the Act); Value Added Tax Rules, 1991(hereinafter referred to as the Rules); Finance Acts and
various rules, regulations and notifications issued under the Act.
Unless exempted in terms of the First and Second Schedules under section 3(1) of the VAT Act,
1991, VAT is chargeable and payable on all goods and services imported, produced or rendered
in Bangladesh at 15% except on exports and re-imports on which tax is imposed at zero (0)
percent.
The zero rate is an actual tax rate of the VAT, the same as 15 percent, 10 percent etc. Thus, the
credit offset on purchases can be claimed against the liability i.e., zero. On the other hand, a
good which is exempt cannot claim any credit and has no tax liability against which to offset it
and thereby pays tax on input which must be wholly passed on or absorbed. In this way, the zero
rate allows consumers complete exemption because, for instance, the retailer can claim full
amount of tax he has paid on his input and, therefore, pays no tax, while all the previous stages
have passed their tax liability fully forward. Initially it will involve the required cost of
administration without yielding any revenue. But this will bring all economic activities under the
VAT system which will help achieving the ultimate objective of having an elastic tax system for
the country.
When VAT (output tax) is imposed on full value, tax payer pays VAT (output tax) at 15%; and
when VAT (output tax) is imposed on estimated added value, the tax payer pays VAT (output
tax) at 1.5%, 2.25%, 4.5%, 5% or 9%, depending on the estimated value addition ranging from
10%, 15%, 30%, 33.35%, or 60%, as the case may be.
100
130
180
205
225
20
15
20
15
-
F=
B15%
15.00
19.50
27.00
3.75
-
G=
E15%
19.50
27.00
30.75
33.75
-
H=
E+G
149.50
207.00
236.05
258.75
Total
E=
(B+C+D)
130
180
205
225
-
Profit
Processing Cost
10
35
5
5
Importer
Producer
Wholesaler
Retailer
Final Consumer
Value Addition
Value of Output / Sales
Consumer
VAT is computed as a percentage of the value added on goods or services. It is charged on the
value of consumption, applied at each point of transactions of goods or services from primary
production to final consumption. At every stage one has to pay as well as collect VAT before
reaching the stage of the final consumption. So, every one, except the final consumer, does not
have to bear any VAT from his own account. Because whatever the person other than the final
consumer has paid as VAT at the time of purchase he shall collect that amount of VAT from the
persons who shall buy his goods or services and also collect tax on value which is added by him
before selling. Value addition by the seller is the difference between the selling prices of the
goods or services (Output) and the cost of raw materials (Input) purchased. The amount of value
addition may consist of processing cost such as wages, overheads etc. and profit. Thus, VAT
collection increases at every stage because of the value addition that is maximized at the final
stage. This value addition stops when any goods or a service is purchased for final consumption
and the consumer has to bear the full amount of VAT. At each point of transaction the tax is
passed onto the shoulder of next person in the form of higher price, which consists of selling
price plus VAT. This process illustrates that a business does not bear VAT. Being at the final
point in the chain of total transaction, the final consumer bears the whole amount of the tax.
This above explanation is the basic procedure of VAT system which is explained below with an
example assuming five layers of transactions from importer through final consumer.
I (G-F)
19.50
7.50
3.75
3.00
33.75
The above table illustrates the collection, computation of VAT at different stages. Except for
importer, VAT payable in column (I) is computed by deducting VAT paid on input (F) from VAT
levied on output (G). In case of importer, the process has started from him in this illustration and
importer himself is responsible to pay total VAT to the Government Treasury at this stage.
However, the importer has collected the total VAT paid to Government from his customer i.e.
the producer. In other cases, such as producer who is responsible for payment of VAT of Tk.
7.50, this amount has been computed by deducting the VAT paid by the producer at input stage
(Tk. 19.50) from the VAT levied on sale (Tk. 27) which is to be collected from the wholesaler. In
other words, this is exactly 15% of value addition (C+D) by the producer (15% of Tk. 50) as in all
other cases except importer and final consumer.
Though the above illustration gives a view that VAT is a very simple system of taxation for the
taxpayer and government but practically this illustration reflects the system partially. Because in
Bangladesh, exceptions in VAT system are observed due to the presence of Truncated VAT
system, VAT exemption, Zero-rated VAT etc.
Under the Truncated VAT system reduced rates (lower than the standard rate of 15%) are
allowed to be collected from the consumers (who may or may not be final consumers) and the
seller cannot set off her/his input tax against her/his output tax. While you go through this book
you shall find these types of exceptions in details.
In case of VAT exemption, VAT is exempted at output stage and VAT paid at input stage cannot
be set off and should be treated as cost. But in case of Zero rated VAT the amount paid as VAT
at input stage can be recovered by getting refund of amount given at input stage.
30.2
all kinds of raw materials (any gas; and any material or packages used as fuels), packaging
materials, services, machinery and parts of machinery excluding labour, land, building, office
equipments and transport;
in case of trading, goods imported, purchased, acquired or otherwise obtained in any way for
sale, exchange or transfer in any manner sec 2(c).
Input Tax means Value Added Tax paid on inputs imported by registered person or purchased
from any other registered person sec 2(d).
Tax period means a term of one month or such term which may be fixed by the Government
for this purpose by Gazette notification sec 2(e).
Taxable goods mean the goods which are not included in the first schedule sec 2(f).
Taxable service means a service which not is included in the second schedule sec 2(g).
Current Account means an account maintained with the Commissioner by the registered
person in specified form in which details of purchases, sales, treasury deposits, payable and
deductible VAT, and where applicable, statement of other taxes will be entered sec 2(i).
Turnover means all money received or receivable by any person for the supply of taxable goods
produced or manufactured by him or for rendering of taxable services for a particular period
sec 2(k).
Return means the return required to file under Section 35 of this Act sec 2(n).
Fixed date means
Specified date to pay VAT or, where applicable, VAT and supplementary duty as per section
6 of this Act
Specified date to file return as per VAT Rules sec 2(o).
Goods mean all kinds of movable property, excluding shares, stocks, coins, securities and
recoverable claims sec 2(p).
Commercial documents means book of accounts, files, documents or papers maintained by a
person to record his commercial transaction showing financial condition of his business, namely
:- debit voucher, credit voucher, cash memo, daily accounts of purchase and sales cash book,
primary or journal book, bank account and accounts or documents related thereto, trial balance,
ledger, financial statement and analyses, profit and loss account, profit and loss appropriation
account, bank account reconciliation and balance sheet and all related documents including audit
report - sec 2(qqq).
Person includes any business organization, group of persons and association - sec 2(t).
Zero rated taxable goods or services means goods or services which are exported or
deemed to have been exported or any food or any material as described in sub section (2) of
section 3 on which value added tax or, where applicable, supplementary duty will not be imposed
and all other taxes and duties paid on materials used for manufacturing such exportable goods
(excluding advance income tax and any supplementary duty paid on such inputs used for
manufacturing exportable goods as notified by the Government for the purpose through Gazette
notification) shall be refunded - sec 2(v).
Total receipts mean the total amount of money received or receivable, including commission
or charge, by a provider of taxable services in exchange of such services rendered excluding VAT
sec 2(x).
30.3
In the South Asian Association for Regional Cooperation (SMRC) region, VAT has been
considered in great depth in India. This country introduced VAT in a different way under the
name of modified value added tax (MODVAT) in 1986. Unlike the VAT system of other
countries, the-Indian MODVAT system is designed to correct the excise duty. This tax is
adopted mainly to avoid the disadvantages of input taxation, such as tax cascading. The scope of
MODVAT has been extended over the years. Further, various attempts have been made to
introduce a broad-based VAT in place of several domestic trade taxes. There seems to be a
broad agreement among the Indian States to convert the State sales tax into a VAT. Among the
other members of the SAARC countries, Pakistan adopted VAT in 1990, Bangladesh in 1991, and
Nepal in 1997 while Sri Lanka introduced VAT in 1998.
As VAT is less distortive and more revenue-productive, it has been spreading all over the world.
This tax had been adopted by eight countries by the end of the 1960s. Since then the tax has
been introduced by at least one country each year except 1974, 1978 and 1979. By 2000, about
120 countries have adopted VAT and it is under consideration in many other countries. In fact,
VAT has become a popular topic for tax reform in recent years. Writing in Finance and
Development, Liam Ebrill claimed that "the rapid rise of the value-added tax was the most
dramatic-and probably most important-development in taxation in the latter part of the
twentieth century, and it still continues." From having been largely the preserve of more
developed countries in Europe and Latin America, it has become a pivotal component of the tax
systems of both developing and transition economies.
In April 1979, the Taxation Enquiry Commission (TEC) officially took up the issue of introducing
VAT in Bangladesh as an alternate to sales tax. Until 1982, sales tax was being collected under
the Sales Tax Act 1951, which was replaced by the Sales Tax Ordinance 1982 with effect from 1
July 1982. The World Bank played the pioneering role in introduction of VAT in Bangladesh. A
World Bank Mission visited Bangladesh for preparing an agenda for tax reform in Bangladesh in
December 1986. The mission submitted its final report on 15 October 1989. The report
recommended the introduction of a manufacturing-cum-import stage VAT at a single standard
rate within three years. Thereafter, a Bangladesh Tax Mission visited India, Indonesia, the
Philippines and Thailand during 13 November - 04 December 1989. The Mission submitted its
report in January 1990. The government discussed the issues relating to introduction of VAT
with all related private and public agencies including the various leading Chambers of Commerce
and Industry from time to time. The government prepared the Value Added Tax Act 1990
(Draft) in June 1990.
2006 -07
2007 -08
8.6
39200
31950
10605
33.19
8000
25.04
8.7
44868
36175
12398
34.27
8235
22.76
8.3
49472
39,247
13683
34.86
8279
21.09
8.8
60,539
48,012
17,013
35.43
9,300
19.37
2010-11
2005 -06
8.5
35400
28300
8575
30.30
7300
25.80
2009-10
2004 -05
8.3
31120
24950
8071
32.35
5875
23.55
2008-09
2003 -04
Tax-GDP ratio
Total Revenue
Total Tax Revenue
Value Added Tax
% of VAT to Tax Revenue
Customs Duty (CD)
% of CD to Tax revenue
2002 -03
Final version of the Value Added Tax Act was promulgated on 31 May 1991 as a Presidential
Ordinance with eight sections (relating to registration under VAT system and the appointment
and powers of VAT authorities). It was made effective from 2 June 1991. The Value Added Tax
Bill 1991 was introduced in the Parliament on 1 July 1991 and the Parliament passed it on 9 July
1991. With the Presidential assent to the bill on the next day it came into effect as The Value
Added Tax Act 1991. The VAT Act 1991 replaced the Business Turnover Tax Ordinance 1982
and the Sales Tax Ordinance 1982 with effect from 1 July 1991. Not VAT is a very important
source of revenue for the Government of Bangladesh which is reflected in the table below.
9.0
69,180
55,526
20,116
36.23
9,570
17.24
9.2
79,484
63,956
22,795
35.64
10,430
16.31
10.0
95,188
79,052
28,274
35.77
10,915
13.81
8924
22.74
11,005
22.92
13,538
24.38
16,560
25.89
22,105
27.96
VAT Registration
When Registration are Required for the Purposes of VAT
A person needs to register for the purposes of VAT before the commencement of:
(a) production or manufacture of taxable goods;
(b) trading of taxable goods;
(c) rendering of taxable services;
(d) import of taxable goods;
(e) export of taxable goods.
Once registered, no renewal of registration is required.
Persons Required to Register for the Purposes of VAT
The following persons are required to register for the purposes of VAT:
(a) Importer;
(b) Exporter;
(c) Producer;
(d) Trader; and
(e) Service provider.
The persons who are falling under the category of turnover tax and cottage industry are not
required to register for the purposes of VAT. However, producer or service provider having
turnover below Tk 60 lac, thereby falling under the category of turnover tax, and cottage
industry may voluntarily register for the purposes of VAT.
If any person who ought to register for the purposes of VAT fails to do so, the VAT Divisional
Officer registers the person under section 15(4) of the Act effective from the date the person
ought to have registered; and informs the person accordingly.
Documents to be Submitted for VAT Registration
Application for VAT Registration shall be made to the VAT Divisional Officer in Form VAT-6.
The following documents shall be submitted along with the application form:(a) Trade License;
(b) TIN Certificate (if any);
(c) IRC/ERC Certificate(if any);
(d) List of all related Selling Centers in the case of central registration;
(e) Declaration in Form VAT-7 of the production or business premises, plant, machinery,
fittings, finished or tradable goods, stocks, and inputs.
If the application is complete, the VAT Divisional Officer shall issue the Certificate of
Registration in Form VAT-8 within 7 days of the application.
No fee is payable for registration for the purposes of VAT.
If a person carries out business from various premises, he may obtain central registration so as
to pay VAT; and complies with the requirements of the VAT laws centrally. However, no
group (that is, various companies/entities under common management or ownership)
registration is permissible under the VAT Act, 1991.
If central registration is not obtained, then separate registration for separate premises shall be
required for the purposes of VAT. However, if a registered person changes his premises or
businesses, he will file declaration with the VAT Circle Office in Form VAT-9 at least 14 days
prior to such changes in his premises or businesses.
When registration may be cancelled for the purposes of VAT
The registration may be cancelled for the purposes of VAT if:(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
The registered person shall apply to the VAT Circle Office in VAT Form-10 for cancellation of
the registration.
30.5
Imposition of VAT
Different requirements for imposition of VAT are presented below as per section 3 of VAT Act.
(1) Value added Tax will be fixed and payable at 15% on all goods imported into Bangladesh
except the goods listed in the first schedule of this Act and on the supply of all goods not
listed in above schedule and on all services rendered in Bangladesh except those listed in the
second schedule of this Act. The rate (15%) will be applied on the value computed as per
section 5.
(2) Without prejudice to the above sub-section (1), tax will be imposed at Zero rate on the
following goods or services;
a.
b.
Provided that this sub-section will not be applicable to the following goods:
a. Any goods re-imported or treated as being re-imported into Bangladesh;
b. Such goods which have been presented for export in accordance with section 131 of the
customs Act 1969 but not exported within thirty days from the submission of the bill of
export or such extended time as allowed by the Commissioner for this purpose.
(3) Value Added Tax will be paid by:
a.
b.
c.
d.
(4) For fixing and computing VAT payable on any imported or supplied goods under this section,
same classification as made in Customs Act will apply.
30.6
(1)
The rate of Value Added Tax in case of supply of taxable goods or services will be that
rate of Value Added Tax imposed upon those goods fixed for the time being in accordance
with Section 6(2) or where applicable, Section 6(3).
(2)
The rate of Value Added Tax in case of import of taxable goods will be that rate of Value
Added Tax imposed on such taxable goods on the date as mentioned in section 30 of
Customs Act 1969 (IV of 1969).
The tax will come in force on that date on which the bill of entry is presented under the
Customs Act for clearance of the said goods for consumption within the country.
However, where the bill of entry is submitted before the conveyance in which the goods
are being imported has reached the country the relative date will be the date of submitting
the manifest after the said conveyance has arrived, and
Imposing of the tax will come in force at the date of release of goods from the godown
under Section 104 of Custom Act.
30.7
***
**
**
**
**
***
(2) In case of supply of goods, subject to the provision mentioned in sub-section 3, the Value
Added Tax which will be payable on the price receivable by the manufacturer or producer
or trader from the buyer. Such price includes raw material costs and other costs incurred by
the manufacturer or producer or trader and in appropriate cases, it also includes
commission, charges, fees, supplementary duties, any other duties and taxes (excluding value
added tax), and profit.
Provided that, in cases where goods subject to value added tax are manufactured with
imported material, or in the case of sale, exchange or transfer of imported goods in any
other manner, input tax credit is taken under section 9 of this Act on the basis of value
arrived at under sections 25 or 25 (A) of the Customs Act then the Value added tax due on
the goods so supplied shall be calculated on the basis of such value.
However, the Board may set the rules of computing value for VAT when one registered
manufacturer wants to manufacture branded product of another manufacturer.
(3) Where Value Added Tax is to be imposed on the basis of the retail price of goods, the
Government by Gazette notification will be able to fix the retail price of those goods on
which value added tax will be imposed and such retail price will be calculated by the
producer or manufacturer after approval of the proper officer which will include all kinds of
expenditure, commission, charges, duties and taxes and that commodity after being specially
branded or described will be sold at in that price to the consumer (the price must be printed
clearly, visibly, legibly and unreasonably on the surface of the goods or on their packet, bag
etc.)
(4) In the case of services, Value Added Tax will be imposed on the total receipts.
Provided that in the case of providing any specific service the Board, by an order, will be able
to determine the amount of Value Added Tax on the basis of a rate fixed for addition of cost
or actual addition of cost.
(5) Goods on which trade discount is allowed; value added tax on such goods are based on the
value at which it is supplied after deducting such discount. Provided that in case where goods
are supplied at a discount, the value at which the goods are supplied and the amount of the
discount will be shown on the invoice and the amount of trade discount must be consistent
with the normal business policy.
(6) Without prejudice to the remainder of this section, if the Board, on consideration of national
interest and after any necessary inquiry becomes satisfied that the fixation of a tariff value is
necessary in order to determine Value Added Tax, or where applicable Value Added Tax
and supplementary duty in case of taxable goods or services then the Board will be able to
fix a tariff value for the taxable goods or services by an order issued in a Gazette notification.
30.8
(7) Value Added Tax, on services rendered by any registered person during running business or
extension thereon, will be at the time of one of the following activities that occurs first.
a. When the service is given;
b. When an invoice relating to the service is given.
c. When part or full payment is received.
(8) Without prejudice to the remainder of this section the Board, under procedures specified by
rule will be able to fix the time and procedure to pay Value Added Tax along with advance
payment, or where applicable, supplementary duty, on any goods, classes of goods or
services.
(9) Notwithstanding anything contained in sub-section (4), the Board may direct through official
gazette to use secured stamp or banderole or special sign or mark of specified value on the
body of the package or container or pot of the goods or classes of goods for the purpose of
realizing value added tax or, where applicable, supplementary duty from the date of such
notification [Section 6(4A)].
(10) Without prejudice to any rules of this section, the Board may direct the service receivers or,
in appropriate cases, the person responsible for the payment of value of services or
commission, to collect or deduct VAT at source of any VAT registered person at the time of
making such payment and deposit the same to the treasury through defined procedure of
directives set by the Board [Section 6(4AA)].
(11) A person who realizes or deducts Value Added Tax at the source must give a certificate in
respect of such realization or deduction to the person who renders the service according to
a fixed procedure which will include the following information :
a.
b.
c.
d.
e.
(12) If the person responsible for the payment of value of services or commission as per subsection 4AA, failed to collect or deduct such value added taxes at source and also failed to
deposit the same, then (i) Such value added tax will be collected with 2% interest per month from the person
paying the value of services or commission as if he was such a person of providing
services under subsection (4AA);
(ii) Such value added tax collected, deducted and deposited under sub-section (4AA) shall
be treated as paid under the provisions of this Act on behalf of the concerned service
provider and may, subject to validity of the certificate issued under subsection (4B), be
shown in the return referred to in section 35 as paid by the concerned service
provider;
(iii) without any prejudice to the provisions of clause (i), in case of failure to deposit the
deducted or collected value added tax in the Government treasury within two months
from the date of such deduction or collection of value added tax at source, concerned
Commissioner may impose a personal penalty, not exceeding Tk. 25,000, on the
person responsible for collection or deduction, the person responsible for deposit and
the chief executive officer of the concerned organization.
(13) Value Added Tax payable on goods supplied or services rendered, except at the time of
importation, will be paid through the current account and the value added tax return in
accordance with the methods prescribed in the Rules.
30.9
Flat Rate =
10%
20%
30%
60%
15%
15%
15%
15%
1.5%
3.0%
4.5%
9.0%
Trade Services
VAT is payable by a distributor, agent, wholesaler and retailers on non-exempted goods @ 1.5%
of sales (that is, 15% on 10% value addition) on a monthly basis within 10 days of the next
month through treasury challans. No input tax credit is allowed against such payment of VAT.
However, VAT is not applicable on raw agricultural products and products to which excise duty
applies.
VAT is payable by a retailer in Dhaka and Chittagong City Corporations at Tk 4,200; in Rajshahi,
Khulna, Sylhet and Barisal City Corporations at Tk 3,000; in municipalities located at district level
at Tk 2,400; and in other areas at Tk 1,200. However, VAT is not applicable to raw agricultural
products and products to which excise duty applies.
Other Services
Some of other services, the value addition and the rates of VAT are as follows:
Taxable Services
Value Addition
VAT
4.50%
Construction contractors
4.50%
Building developers
1.50%
4.50%
4.50%
Securities Service
4.50%
Legal Adviser
4.50%
15.00%
Credit cards
15.00%
Coaching center
4.50%
4.50%
Specialized Doctor
4.50%
Government;
Semi-Government;
Autonomous Bodies;
NGOs;
Banks;
Insurance Companies; and
Limited Companies.
Any person responsible for deducting VAT shall be liable to pay deductible VAT along with
interest at 2% per month from the due date of deduction to the date of payment if the person
failed to collect, deduct and deposit the same.
30.12 VAT Authorities
The following are the VAT Authorities under section 20 of the VAT Act, 1991:1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
Turnover tax will be paid to the treasury, Bangladesh Bank or Sonali Bank, as the case may be,
through Challan Form T. R. -6, using 13 digit code; for example, 1/1133/0015/0321 for Dhaka
(North) Commissionarate; and 1/1133/0010/0321 for Dhaka (South) Commissionarate.
If any tax payer of turnover tax fails to pay tax on due date, the Superintendent of the VAT
Circle Office may impose on that tax payer fine up to Tk 5,000; and additional tax @ 2% per
month for the delayed or non-payment period.
No input tax is allowed as credit to the tax payer of turnover tax. No person can also claim
credit for payment of turnover tax through invoices against his turnover tax or VAT.
Books and Documents Required to be Maintained for Turnover Tax Purposes
1
2
3
4
5
VAT
Turnover Tax
1. Application for
Registration
Application is to be made to
the Divisional Office.
2. Tax Rate
5. Tax Payment
7. Return
In case of Import
In case of Goods Produced
or Manufactured in
Bangladesh
In case of service
rendered in Bangladesh
In case of Goods on
which VAT is imposed on
retail price
Except in the case of punishment order given by a Special Judge Court, no penalty can be
imposed of or business premises can be locked up under this section without giving the person
concerned a reasonable opportunity of being heard, either in person or by his legal
representative. A guilty person may be penalized by 3 months to 2 years jail or fined by the
amount equal to VAT amount including supplementary duty or maximum 1.5 times fine or both
[Section 37(6)].
Amount (Tk.)
40,000 x 500 x15%
Amount (Tk.)
30,00,000
10,00,000
20,00,000
Worked Example 2
Asset Development & Holdings Ltd sold an apartment, D-4, of 2000 sft to Mr. Rashed in Asset Plaza in
Gulshan, Dhaka at a cost of Tk. 40,00,000. The company wants to deliver the apartment to Mr. Rashed
on 30 August 2011. The Deed of Agreement specifies that VAT is payable by Mr. Rashed.
Calculate the VAT payable by Mr. Rashed.
Solution 2
VAT chargeable and payable
Amount (Tk.)
40,00,000x1.5%
Amount (Tk.)
60,000
Worked Example 3
Modhumati Sweets deals in sweets and milk products at 74 Mirpur Road, Dhanmondi, Dhaka. It obtained
registration for the purpose of turnover tax. It has declared that its yearly sales during the income year
ending 31 December 2010 would amount to Tk. 10,00,000; and it wants to pay turnover tax on a
monthly basis.
Calculate monthly turnover tax of Modhumati Sweets.
Solution 3:
2.
Amount (Tk.)
10,00,000x4%
40,000/12
Amount (Tk.)
40,000
3,333
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
10.
11.
What books and documents are to be maintained by a registered tax payer for the purposes of
VAT?
12.
For how many years such books and documents are to be maintained by such a tax payer?
13.
14.
15.
16.
17.
18.
19.
20.
21.
22.
23.
24.
25.
26.
27.
28.
29.
30.
31.
32.
33.
34.
Chapter 31
Ethics
Contents
Introduction
Examination context
Topic List
31.1
Fundamental principles
31.2
31.3
31.4
Disclosure of information
31.5
Conflict of interest
31.6
31.7
31.8
Anti-money laundering
31.9
Introduction
Learning objectives
Identify the guidance given in the IFAC Code of Ethics for Professional Accountants in relation to
a tax practice with regard to:
Tick Off
Identify ethical issues arising from tax work undertaken, explain the
relevance and importance of these issues and provides guidance in given
scenarios
Practical significance
Belonging to a professional body requires adherence to a code of ethics and have had claims for
breaches of confidentiality. This is part of what differentiates a Chartered Accountant from
unqualified accountants. Clients, members of the public, and the government recognise that we
are required to adhere to exacting standards and so expect a certain standard of behaviour from
us.
Money laundering has been a major problem in the past and as part of new laws designed to
combat this, professionals are required to participate in its prevention by reporting certain
suspicions relating to the proceeds of crime.
Stop and think
Accountants have been fined for non-compliance with the Code of Ethics. Even in the short time
that the anti-money laundering regulations have existed accountants have been prosecuted. It is
essential that professional accountants should act ethically in all of their work.
What sort of questions should you ask a potential client apart from the obvious ones? Should
you always do what the client wants whether you agree or not?
Working context
Ethical considerations underpin all of your studies as well as your work experience. You will
often make ethical decisions without even realising it, but sometimes you may find yourself in a
quandary and be unsure how to act. This is when the Code of Ethics will be of assistance. You
need to know what to look out for and how to act. You should always take particular care in
relation to client confidentiality; not always an easy task.
Syllabus links
The topics covered in this chapter are essential knowledge for the whole of your Taxation
studies. They will ensure that advice and communication is appropriate and in keeping with the
requirements of the ICAB.
Examination context
Exam requirements
In the examination, candidates may be required to:
Question practice
For question practice on these topics go to the end of this manual covering this chapter
31.0
Fundamental Principles
Section Overview
The International Federation of Accountants (IFAC) has produced a Code of Ethics for
professional accountants (IFAC Code).
ICAB has adopted and published IFAC Code of Ethics for ICAB Members.
The IFAC Code aims to ensure high quality ethical standards for use by professional
accountants around the world.
Part A of the IFAC Codes (the Codes) establishes the fundamental principles of professional
ethics for accountants.
Definition
Professional accountant: A member of the ICAB.
The Codes require a professional accountant to comply with the following five fundamental
principles:
Integrity
Objectivity
Professional competence and due care
Confidentiality
Professional behaviour
The purpose of this chapter is to provide background information which will assist your
understanding of the framework of the Bangladesh taxation system, why governments impose tax
and the principles of taxation.
The Bangladesh taxation system has developed over centuries from the then British India in 1860
to the present condition on a piecemeal basis. Successive ruler and governments have changed
the taxation system in accordance with their political objectives. There has never been an allparty political consensus about how the Bangladesh taxation system should be changed and there
probably never will be.
Integrity
Definition
Integrity: Requires all professional accountants to be straightforward and honest in professional
and business relationships.
A professional accountant should not be associated with any information where he believes that
the information:
Objectivity
Definition
Objectivity: Imposes an obligation on professional accountants not to compromise their
professional or business judgement because of bias, conflict of interest or the undue influence of
others.
Relationships that bias or unduly influence the professional judgement of the professional
accountant should be avoided.
Professional competence and due care
Definition
Professional competence and due care: Requires professional accountants to:
Maintain professional knowledge and skill at the level required to ensure that clients or
employers receive competent professional service based on current developments in
practice, legislation and techniques; and
Act diligently in accordance with applicable technical and professional standards when
providing professional services.
requiring
continuing
awareness
and
Steps should be taken to ensure that those working for the professional accountant have
appropriate training and supervision.
Any limitations relating to the service being provided must be made clear to clients and other
users to ensure that misinterpretation of facts or opinions does not take place.
Confidentiality
Definition
Confidentiality: Imposes an obligation on professional accountants to refrain from:
Disclosing outside the firm confidential information acquired as a result of professional and
business relationships without proper and specific authority or unless there is a legal or
professional right or duty to disclose; and
Using confidential information acquired as a result of professional and business relationships
to their personal advantage or the advantage of third parties.
professional accountant's control and persons from whom advice and assistance is obtained
respect the professional accountant's duty of confidentiality.
A professional accountant should also maintain confidentiality of information disclosed by a
prospective client or employer.
The need to comply with the principle of confidentiality continues even after the end of
relationships between a professional accountant and a client or employer. When a professional
accountant changes employment or acquires a new client, the professional accountant is entitled
to use prior experience. The professional accountant should not, however, use or disclose any
confidential information either acquired or received as a result of a professional or business
relationship.
Professional behaviour
Definition
Professional behaviour: Imposes an obligation on a professional accountant to comply with
relevant laws and regulations and avoid any action that may bring discredit to the profession.
This includes actions which a reasonable and informed third party, having knowledge of all
relevant information, would conclude negatively affects the good reputation of the profession.
Professional accountants should be honest and truthful and should not:
31.1
Make exaggerated claims for the services they are able to offer, the qualifications they
possess, or experience they have gained
Make disparaging references or unsubstantiated comparisons to the work of others
Self-interest threats, which may occur as a result of the financial or other interests of a
professional accountant or of an immediate or close family member
Self-review threats, which may occur when a previous judgment needs to be re-evaluated
by the professional accountant responsible for that judgment
Advocacy threats, which may occur when a professional accountant promotes a position
or opinion to the point that subsequent objectivity may be compromised
Familiarity threats, which may occur when, because of a close relationship, a professional
accountant becomes too sympathetic to the interests of others
Intimidation threats, which may occur when a professional accountant may be deterred
from acting objectively by threats, actual or perceived
Safeguards
If a professional accountant cannot implement appropriate safeguards, he should decline or
discontinue the specific professional service involved, or where necessary resign from the client.
Safeguards that may eliminate or reduce such threats to an acceptable level fall into two broad
categories:
Safeguards created by the profession, legislation or regulation include, but are not restricted to:
Educational, training and experience requirements for entry into the profession
Continuing professional development requirements
Corporate governance regulations
Professional standards
Professional or regulatory monitoring and disciplinary procedures
External review by a legally empowered third party of the reports, returns, communications
or information produced by a professional accountant
Certain safeguards may increase the likelihood of identifying or deterring unethical behaviour.
Such safeguards, which may be created by the accounting profession, legislation, regulation or an
employing organisation, include, but are not restricted to:
Effective, well publicised complaints systems operated by the employing organisation, the
profession or a regulator, which enable colleagues, employers and members of the public to
draw attention to unprofessional or unethical behavior
The nature of the safeguards to be applied will vary depending on the circumstances. In
exercising professional judgment, a professional accountant should consider what a reasonable
and informed third party, having knowledge of all relevant information, including the significance
of the threat and the safeguards applied, would conclude to be unacceptable.
31.2
Mr. J may first wish to approach the other directors of the company in order to resolve the
ethical conflict with Mr. G. If this course of action does not give Mr. J sufficient comfort that the
conflict is resolved he will have to consider going outside the company.
Mr. J may wish to obtain professional advice from the ICAB or the legal advisors, and thereby
obtain guidance on ethical issues without breaching confidentiality. Mr. J should consider
obtaining legal advice to determine whether there is a requirement to report.
If the ethical conflict remains unresolved, Mr. J should refuse to remain associated with the
matter creating the conflict. He may determine that, in the circumstances, it is appropriate to
resign altogether from the engagement.
31.3
Disclosure of information
Section Overview
Part A of the Codes contains a section relating to confidentiality.
The confidentiality section explains when a professional accountant may disclose information
to third parties without threatening the fundamental principle of confidentiality.
When to disclose
A professional accountant may disclose confidential information if:
Disclosure is permitted by law and is authorised by the client or the employer
Disclosure is required by law, for example:
- Production of documents or other provision of evidence in the course of legal
proceedings, or
- Disclosure to the appropriate public authorities of infringements of the law, e.g. under
antimony laundering legislation
Whether the interests of all parties, including third parties whose interests may be affected,
could be harmed if the client or employer consents to the disclosure of information by the
professional accountant
Whether all the relevant information is known and substantiated, to the extent it is
practicable to do so. When the situation involves unsubstantiated facts, incomplete
information or unsubstantiated conclusions, professional judgment should be used in
determining the type of disclosure to be made, if any
31.4
Conflicts of interest
Section Overview
Part B of both the IFAC Code and the ICAEW Code illustrate how the fundamental
principles are applied in certain situations for professional accountants in public practice.
One of the illustrations given in part B contains details relating to conflicts of interest.
The threat of a conflict of interest
A professional accountant should take reasonable steps to identify circumstances that could pose
a conflict of interest. These may give rise to threats to compliance with the fundamental
principles.
A conflict may arise between the firm and the client or between two conflicting clients being
managed by the same firm. For example where a firm acts for:
A Client which has specific interests which conflict with those of the firm;
Financial involvements between the client and the firm eg where a loan is made by or to a
client;
Both a husband and wife in a divorce settlement ;
A company and for its directors in their personal capacity; or
Two competing business
Evaluation of threats includes consideration as to whether the professional accountant has any
business interests or relationships with the client or a third party that could give rise to threats. If
there are other than clearly insignificant, safeguards should be considered and applied as necessary.
Safeguards
Depending upon the circumstances giving rise to the conflict, safeguards should ordinarily include
the professional accountant in public practice:
Notifying the client of the firm's business interest or activities that may represent a conflict
of interest
Notifying all known relevant parties that the professional accountant is acting for two or
more parties in respect of a matter where their respective interests are in conflict
Notifying the client that the professional accountant does not act exclusively for any one
client in the provision of proposed services (for example, in a particular market sector or
with respect to a specific service)
In each case the professional accountant should obtain the consent of the relevant parties to act.
Where a professional accountant has requested consent from a client to act for another party
(which may or may not be an existing client) and that consent has been refused, then he must
not continue to act for one of the parties in the matter giving rise to the conflict of interest.
The following additional safeguards should also be considered:
Where a conflict of interest poses a threat to one or more of the fundamental principles that
cannot be eliminated or reduced to an acceptable level through the application of safeguards, the
professional accountant should conclude that it is not appropriate to accept a specific
engagement or that resignation from one or more conflicting engagements is required.
Interactive question 2: Conflict of interest
A professional Accountant in Public Practice has had two partners, Mr. S and Mr. R as clients for
many years. Mr. S is intending to sell his share of the partnership to Mr. R so that can continue as
a sole trader. Both have asked if you will be their advisor.
Requirements
Outline the accountants position with regard to the potential conflict of interest.
Answer
The firm should not usually act for both parties in a transaction. However this can cause
particular problems where both have previously been clients.
There are available options,
The firm has three options,
To act for both
To act for one
To act for neither
In this situation where there is an element of doubt, the latter is probably the preferred
course of action.
31.5
Section Overview
One of the topics included in the statement is an explanation as to the accountant's
relationship with the client.
Agent or principal
It is very important that it is understood when an accountant is acting as an agent on behalf of a
client and when he is acting as the principal. The two different capacities carry different degrees
of risk and potential liability.
An explanation as to when an accountant is acting in each capacity should be given in a client
engagement letter. The letter should also explain the scope of the client's and the accountant's
responsibilities in each case.
Agent
An accountant acts as agent when he merely prepares documents on behalf of a client. The client
retains responsibility for the accuracy of the document itself. The accountant is thus an agent
when performing tax compliance work such as preparing and submitting a tax return on behalf of
a client. The client would be required to sign the return prior to its submission.
The accountant takes no responsibility for any information which he passes on to the tax
authorities when acting as an agent. The accountant is not normally liable if any of the
information proves to be incorrect.
Acting as an agent is therefore considered to be a low risk activity.
Principal
An accountant acts as principal when he provides advice to the client as to the taxation
consequences of different courses of action. The accountant takes full responsibility for the
advice given and may be liable to the taxpayer in the event the advice turns out to be incorrect
or inappropriate.
Where an accountant does not have the professional skill required to act as a principal in a
particular case he may still accept the engagement. However, he must ensure that the opinion of
a suitably qualified accountant is sought.
Acting as a principal is therefore considered to be a high risk activity.
31.6
Asked to authorise the professional accountant to advise Tax Authorities of the error; and
Warned of the possible legal consequences if he is reluctant to give the authority sought,
including interest and penalties and possible criminal prosecution; and
Advised that if consent is not given, the accountant will consider taking independent legal
advice with a view to:
Notifying Tax Authorities in any event, and notifying the client of his action; and
Ceasing to act for the client.
The professional accountant should ensure that a written record is kept of all advice given to
clients in connection with Tax Authorities errors.
If a professional accountant is specifically asked by Tax Authorities to agree a figure, he must
agree what he believes to be the correct figure; this may be a figure negotiated in the course of
discussions following full disclosure of the facts and circumstances. He may not accept a figure he
knows to be incorrect, and he does not need to seek his client's authority to disclose to Tax
Authorities its errors in this case.
31.7
Anti-money laundering
Section Overview
Money Laundering Prevention Act, 2002 has been Published with the purpose of combating
money laundering
Accountants should comply the requirement relating to money-laundering
Money laundering
Definition
Money laundering is the process of changing large amounts of money obtained from crimes, such
as drug trafficking, into origination from a legitimate source.
Money Laundering is the process by which criminals attempt to conceal the true origin and
ownership of the proceeds of criminal activities. If successful, the money can lose its criminal
identity and appear legitimate.
In terms of section 2 (tha) of Money Laundering Prevention Act, 2002, "Money Laundering means
(a) Properties acquired or earned directly or indirectly through illegal means; (b) Illegal transfer,
conversion, concealment of location or assistance in the above act of the properties acquired or
earned directly or indirectly through legal or illegal means." In this Act, Properties means
movable or immovable properties of any nature and description.
The term Money Laundering is used for a number of offences involving the proceeds of crime or
terrorist funds. It now includes possessing, or in any way dealing with, or concealing, the
proceeds of any crime.
Someone is engaged in money laundering under where they:
Acquire or earn properties directly or indirectly through illegal means
Transfer, convert, conceal location or assist in the above act of the properties acquired or
earned directly or indirectly through legal or illegal means
Where a professional accountant suspects that a client is involved in money laundering he should
report this to the authorities.
Tax related offences
Tax related offences are not in a special category. The proceeds or monetary advantage arising
from tax offences are treated no differently from the proceeds of theft, drug trafficking or other
criminal conduct.
(Tax avoidance and evasion is considered further in this chapter)
Anti-money laundering procedures
Businesses need to maintain the some procedures, in respect of all relevant business such as:
Appoint a Money Laundering Reporting Officer (MLRO) and implement internal reporting
procedures
Train staff to ensure that they are aware of the relevant legislation, know how to recognise
and deal with potential money laundering, how to report suspicions to the MLRO, and how
to identify clients
Establish internal procedures appropriate to deter and prevent money laundering, and make
relevant individuals aware of the procedures
Verify the identity of new clients and maintain evidence of identification
Maintain records of client identification, and any transactions undertaken for or with the
client
Report suspicions of money laundering
Records of client identification and transactions also need to be maintained for few years.
Client confidentiality in relation to money laundering
An accountant should disclose confidential information without client consent in certain
circumstances. In order to disclose confidential information, the accountant must have
knowledge or suspicion, or reasonable grounds for knowledge or suspicion, that a person has
committed a money laundering offence.
Disclosure without reasonable grounds for knowledge or suspicion will increase the risk of a
business or an individual being open to an action for breach of confidentiality.
Punishment for Money Laundering
If any person is engaged in Money Laundering in any way he will be regarded as a person who has
committed a crime and the concerned accused for that crime will be sentenced to imprisonment
for at least a period of six months and a maximum of seven years and will be fined for an amount
not exceeding double the amount involved in the crime.
31.8
or
Providing Tax Authorities with deliberately false information, for example by:
- Deducting expenses that have not been incurred
- Claiming capital allowances on plant that has not been purchased
Minor cases of tax evasion are generally settled out of court via the payment of penalties.
However, there is a statutory offence of evading income tax that can be dealt with in a
magistrates court.
Serious cases of tax evasion, particularly those involving fraud, continue to be the subject of
criminal prosecutions which may lead to fines and/or imprisonment on conviction.
Furthermore, tax evasion offences will fall within the definition of money laundering and in
certain cases individuals may be prosecuted under one of the money laundering offences. This
includes both the under declaring of income and the over claiming of expenses.
If the assets of any clients were derived from illegal activities or if the client has committed tax
evasion that considered under money laundering, a threat to compliance with the fundamental
principles would be created. In such situations, the professional accountant may consider seeking
legal advice and he should report this to the authorities.
Tax avoidance
Tax avoidance is not defined, but is broadly any legal method of reducing the tax burden.
In recent years there has been a requirement for promoters of certain tax avoidance schemes to
disclose their schemes to Tax Authorities, and for taxpayers to disclose details of which schemes
they have used. This may enable Tax Authorities to take action more rapidly to close the
ambiguity.
The End
CA in Bangladesh
www.facebook.com/cainbd